Asa 96 VPN Config

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 424

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.

6
Americas Headquarters
Cisco Systems, Inc.
170 West Tasman Drive
San Jose, CA 95134-1706
USA
http://www.cisco.com
Tel: 408 526-4000
800 553-NETS (6387)
Fax: 408 527-0883
THE SPECIFICATIONS AND INFORMATION REGARDING THE PRODUCTS IN THIS MANUAL ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE WITHOUT NOTICE. ALL STATEMENTS,
INFORMATION, AND RECOMMENDATIONS IN THIS MANUAL ARE BELIEVED TO BE ACCURATE BUT ARE PRESENTED WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. USERS MUST TAKE FULL RESPONSIBILITY FOR THEIR APPLICATION OF ANY PRODUCTS.

THE SOFTWARE LICENSE AND LIMITED WARRANTY FOR THE ACCOMPANYING PRODUCT ARE SET FORTH IN THE INFORMATION PACKET THAT SHIPPED WITH
THE PRODUCT AND ARE INCORPORATED HEREIN BY THIS REFERENCE. IF YOU ARE UNABLE TO LOCATE THE SOFTWARE LICENSE OR LIMITED WARRANTY,
CONTACT YOUR CISCO REPRESENTATIVE FOR A COPY.

The Cisco implementation of TCP header compression is an adaptation of a program developed by the University of California, Berkeley (UCB) as part of UCB's public domain version of
the UNIX operating system. All rights reserved. Copyright © 1981, Regents of the University of California.

NOTWITHSTANDING ANY OTHER WARRANTY HEREIN, ALL DOCUMENT FILES AND SOFTWARE OF THESE SUPPLIERS ARE PROVIDED “AS IS" WITH ALL FAULTS.
CISCO AND THE ABOVE-NAMED SUPPLIERS DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, THOSE OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT OR ARISING FROM A COURSE OF DEALING, USAGE, OR TRADE PRACTICE.

IN NO EVENT SHALL CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, CONSEQUENTIAL, OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES, INCLUDING, WITHOUT
LIMITATION, LOST PROFITS OR LOSS OR DAMAGE TO DATA ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS MANUAL, EVEN IF CISCO OR ITS SUPPLIERS
HAVE BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.

Any Internet Protocol (IP) addresses and phone numbers used in this document are not intended to be actual addresses and phone numbers. Any examples, command display output, network
topology diagrams, and other figures included in the document are shown for illustrative purposes only. Any use of actual IP addresses or phone numbers in illustrative content is unintentional
and coincidental.

All printed copies and duplicate soft copies of this document are considered uncontrolled. See the current online version for the latest version.

Cisco has more than 200 offices worldwide. Addresses and phone numbers are listed on the Cisco website at www.cisco.com/go/offices.

Cisco and the Cisco logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Cisco and/or its affiliates in the U.S. and other countries. To view a list of Cisco trademarks, go to this URL: www.cisco.com
go trademarks. Third-party trademarks mentioned are the property of their respective owners. The use of the word partner does not imply a partnership relationship between Cisco and any
other company. (1721R)
© 2005 –2015 Cisco Systems, Inc. All rights reserved.
CONTENTS

PREFACE About This Guide xix


Document Objectives xix
Related Documentation xix
Document Conventions xix
Communications, Services, and Additional Information xxi

PART I Site-to-Site and Client VPN 23

CHAPTER 1 IPsec and ISAKMP 1


About Tunneling, IPsec, and ISAKMP 1
IPsec Overview 2
ISAKMP and IKE Overview 2
Licensing for IPsec VPNs 3
Guidelines for IPsec VPNs 4
Configure ISAKMP 4
Configure IKEv1 and IKEv2 Policies 4
IKE Policy Keywords and Values 6
Enable IKE on the Outside Interface 9
Disable IKEv1 Aggressive Mode 10
Configure an ID Method for IKEv1 and IKEv2 ISAKMP Peers 10
INVALID_SELECTORS Notification 11
Configure IKEv2 Pre-shared Key in Hex 11
Enable or Disable Sending of IKE Notification 11
Configure IKEv2 Fragmentation Options 12
AAA Authentication With Authorization 13
Enable IPsec over NAT-T 13

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
iii
Contents

Enable IPsec with IKEv1 over TCP 15


Configure Certificate Group Matching for IKEv1 15
Configure IPsec 17
Define Crypto Maps 17
Example of LAN-to-LAN Crypto Maps 20
Set Public Key Infrastructure (PKI) Keys 26
Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces 27
Use Interface ACLs 27
Change IPsec SA Lifetimes 29
Change VPN Routing 30
Create Static Crypto Maps 30
Create Dynamic Crypto Maps 35
Provide Site-to-Site Redundancy 37
Managing IPsec VPNs 38
Viewing an IPsec Configuration 38
Wait for Active Sessions to Terminate Before Rebooting 38
Alert Peers Before Disconnecting 39
Clear Security Associations 39
Clear Crypto Map Configurations 40

CHAPTER 2 L2TP over IPsec 41


About L2TP over IPsec/IKEv1 VPN 41
IPsec Transport and Tunnel Modes 42
Licensing Requirements for L2TP over IPsec 43
Prerequisites for Configuring L2TP over IPsec 43
Guidelines and Limitations 43
Configuring L2TP over IPsec with CLI 45
Creating IKE Policies to Respond to Windows 7 Proposals 48
Configuration Example for L2TP over IPsec 49
Feature History for L2TP over IPsec 50

CHAPTER 3 General VPN Parameters 51


Guidelines and Limitations 51
Configure IPsec to Bypass ACLs 52

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
iv
Contents

Permitting Intra-Interface Traffic (Hairpinning) 52


NAT Considerations for Intra-Interface Traffic 53
Setting Maximum Active IPsec or SSL VPN Sessions 54
Use Client Update to Ensure Acceptable IPsec Client Revision Levels 54
Implement NAT-Assigned IP to Public IP Connection 56
Displaying VPN NAT Policies 57
Configure VPN Session Limits 58
Show License Resource Allocation 58
Show License Resource Usage 59
Limit VPN Sessions 59
Using an Identify Certificate When Negotiating 59
Configure the Pool of Cryptographic Cores 60
Configure Dynamic Split Tunneling 61
Viewing Active VPN Sessions 62
Viewing Active AnyConnect Sessions by IP Address Type 62
Viewing Active Clientless SSL VPN Sessions by IP Address Type 63
Viewing Active LAN to LAN VPN Sessions by IP Address Type 63
About ISE Policy Enforcement 64
Configure RADIUS Server Groups for ISE Policy Enforcement 64
Example Configurations for ISE Policy Enforcement 67
Troubleshooting Policy Enforcement 68

Configure Advanced SSL Settings 68


Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows 73
Configure Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows Using CLI 74
Troubleshooting Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows 74
Is the Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows Feature Enabled? 74
Locating Orphaned Flows 75

CHAPTER 4 Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users 77


Overview of Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users 77
Connection Profiles 78
General Connection Profile Connection Parameters 79
IPsec Tunnel-Group Connection Parameters 80
Connection Profile Connection Parameters for SSL VPN Sessions 81

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
v
Contents

Configure Connection Profiles 82


Maximum Connection Profiles 83
Default IPsec Remote Access Connection Profile Configuration 83
IPsec Tunnel-Group General Attributes 84
Configure Remote-Access Connection Profiles 84
Specify a Name and Type for the Remote Access Connection Profile 85
Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile General Attributes 85
Configure Double Authentication 89
Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile IPsec IKEv1 Attributes 91
Configure IPsec Remote-Access Connection Profile PPP Attributes 93
Configure LAN-to-LAN Connection Profiles 95
Default LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile Configuration 95
Specify a Name and Type for a LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile 95
Configure LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile General Attributes 96
Configure LAN-to-LAN IPsec IKEv1 Attributes 96
Configure Connection Profiles for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 99
Configure General Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 99
Configure Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 102
Customize Login Windows for Users of Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 107
About Tunnel Groups for Standards-based IKEv2 Clients 108
Standards-based IKEv2 Attribute Support 108
DAP Support 109
Tunnel Group Selection for Remote Access Clients 109
Authentication Support for Standards-based IKEv2 Clients 110
Configure the query-identity Option for Retrieval of EAP Identity 111
Configure Microsoft Active Directory Settings for Password Management 113
Use Active Directory to Force the User to Change Password at Next Logon 113
Use Active Directory to Specify Maximum Password Age 113
Use Active Directory to Enforce Minimum Password Length 114
Use Active Directory to Enforce Password Complexity 114
Configure the Connection Profile for RADIUS/SDI Message Support for the AnyConnect Client
115

Configure the Security Appliance to Support RADIUS/SDI Messages 115


Group Policies 117

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
vi
Contents

Modify the Default Group Policy 117


Configure Group Policies 120
Configure an External Group Policy 120
Create an Internal Group Policy 121
Configure General Internal Group Policy Attributes 122
Group Policy Name 122
Configure the Group Policy Banner Message 122
Specify Address Pools for Remote Access Connections 122
Assign an IPv4 Address Pool to an Internal Group Policy 123
Assign an IPv6 Address Pool to an Internal Group Policy 124
Specify the Tunneling Protocol for the Group Policy 125
Specify a VLAN for Remote Access or Apply a Unified Access Control Rule to the Group Policy
125

Specify VPN Access Hours for a Group Policy 128


Specify Simultaneous VPN Logins for a Group Policy 129
Restrict Access to a Specific Connection Profile 129
Specify the Maximum VPN Connection Time in a Group Policy 130
Specify a VPN Session Idle Timeout for a Group Policy 131
Configure WINS and DNS Servers for a Group Policy 132
Set the Split-Tunneling Policy 133
Specify a Network List for Split-Tunneling 134
Configure Domain Attributes for Split Tunneling 135
Configure DHCP Intercept for Windows XP and Split Tunneling 137
Configure Browser Proxy Settings for use with Remote Access Clients 138
Configure Security Attributes for IPsec (IKEv1) Clients 140
Configure IPsec-UDP Attributes for IKEv1 Clients 142
Configure Attributes for VPN Hardware Clients 143
Configure Group Policy Attributes for AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client Connections 146
Configure Backup Server Attributes 149
Configure Network Admission Control Parameters 150
Configure VPN Client Firewall Policies 154
Configure AnyConnect Client Firewall Policies 154
Use of a Zone Labs Integrity Server 155
Set the Firewall Client Type to Zone Labs 157

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
vii
Contents

Set the Client Firewall Parameters 158


Configure Client Access Rules 160
Configure User Attributes 162
View the Username Configuration 162
Configure Attributes for Individual Users 162
Set a User Password and Privilege Level 162
Configure User Attributes 163
Configure VPN User Attributes 164

CHAPTER 5 IP Addresses for VPNs 171


Configure an IP Address Assignment Policy 171
Configure IPv4 Address Assignments 172
Configure IPv6 Address Assignments 172
View Address Assignment Methods 172
Configure Local IP Address Pools 173
Configure Local IPv4 Address Pools 173
Configure Local IPv6 Address Pools 174
Configure AAA Addressing 174
Configure DHCP Addressing 175
Configure DHCP Addressing 176

CHAPTER 6 Remote Access IPsec VPNs 179


About Remote Access IPsec VPNs 179
Licensing Requirements for Remote Access IPsec VPNs for 3.1 180

Restrictions for IPsec VPN 180


Configure Remote Access IPsec VPNs 180
Configure Interfaces 180
Configure ISAKMP Policy and Enabling ISAKMP on the Outside Interface 181
Configure an Address Pool 182
Add a User 183
Create an IKEv1 Transform Set or IKEv2 Proposal 183
Define a Tunnel Group 185
Create a Dynamic Crypto Map 186
Create a Crypto Map Entry to Use the Dynamic Crypto Map 186

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
viii
Contents

Configuring IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multi-Context Mode 187


Configuration Examples for Remote Access IPsec VPNs 187
Configuration Examples for Standards-Based IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multiple-Context
Mode 188
Configuration Examples for AnyConnect IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multiple-Context
Mode 189
Feature History for Remote Access VPNs 191

CHAPTER 7 LAN-to-LAN IPsec VPNs 193


Summary of the Configuration 193
Configure Site-to-Site VPN in Multi-Context Mode 194
Configure Interfaces 195
Configure ISAKMP Policy and Enable ISAKMP on the Outside Interface 196
Configure ISAKMP Policies for IKEv1 Connections 196
Configure ISAKMP Policies for IKEv2 Connections 198
Create an IKEv1 Transform Set 198
Create an IKEv2 Proposal 199
Configure an ACL 200
Define a Tunnel Group 201
Create a Crypto Map and Applying It To an Interface 202
Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces 204

CHAPTER 8 AnyConnect VPN Client Connections 207


About the AnyConnect VPN Client 207
Licensing Requirements for AnyConnect 208
Configure AnyConnect Connections 208
Configure the ASA to Web-Deploy the Client 208
Enable Permanent Client Installation 210
Configure DTLS 211
Prompt Remote Users 212
Enable AnyConnect Client Profile Downloads 213
Enable AnyConnect Client Deferred Upgrade 214
Enable DSCP Preservation 216
Enable Additional AnyConnect Client Features 216

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
ix
Contents

Enable Start Before Logon 217


Translating Languages for AnyConnect User Messages 218
Understand Language Translation 218
Create Translation Tables 218
Remove Translation Tables 220
Configuring Advanced AnyConnect SSL Features 221
Enable Rekey 221
Configure Dead Peer Detection 222
Enable Keepalive 223
Use Compression 223
Adjust MTU Size 224
Update AnyConnect Client Images 224
Enable IPv6 VPN Access 225
Monitor AnyConnect Connections 226
Log Off AnyConnect VPN Sessions 227
Feature History for AnyConnect Connections 228

CHAPTER 9 AnyConnect HostScan 229


Prerequisites for HostScan 229
Licensing for HostScan 230
HostScan Packaging 230
Install or Upgrade HostScan 230
Enable or Disable HostScan 231
View the HostScan Version Enabled on the ASA 232
Uninstall HostScan 232
Assign AnyConnect Feature Modules to Group Policies 233
HostScan Related Documentation 234

CHAPTER 10 Easy VPN 235


About Easy VPN 235
Configure Easy VPN Remote 238
Configure Easy VPN Server 241
Feature History for Easy VPN 242

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
x
Contents

CHAPTER 11 Configure an External AAA Server for VPN 243


About External AAA Servers 243
Understanding Policy Enforcement of Authorization Attributes 243
Guidelines For Using External AAA Servers 244
Configure LDAP Authorization for VPN 244
Active Directory/LDAP VPN Remote Access Authorization Examples 246
Policy Enforcement of User-Based Attributes 246
Place LDAP Users in a Specific Group Policy 247
Enforce Static IP Address Assignment for AnyConnect Tunnels 249
Enforce Dial-in Allow or Deny Access 251
Enforce Logon Hours and Time-of-Day Rules 253

PART II Clientless SSL VPN 255

CHAPTER 12 Clientless SSL VPN Overview 257


Introduction to Clientless SSL VPN 257
Prerequisites for Clientless SSL VPN 258
Guidelines and Limitations for Clientless SSL VPN 258
Licensing for Clientless SSL VPN 259

CHAPTER 13 Basic Clientless SSL VPN Configuration 261


Rewrite Each URL 261
Switch Off URL Entry on the Portal Page 262
Trusted Certificate Pools 262
Configure Auto Import of Trustpool Certificates 263
Show the State of the Trustpool Policy 263
Clear CA Trustpool 263
Edit the Policy of the Trusted Certificate Pool 264
Configure Browser Access to Plug-ins 264
Prerequisites with Plug-Ins 265
Restrictions with Plug-Ins 265
Prepare the Security Appliance for a Plug-in 266
Install Plug-ins Redistributed by Cisco 266

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xi
Contents

Provide Access to a Citrix XenApp Server 268


Create and Install the Citrix Plug-in 269
View the Plug-ins Installed on the Security Appliance 269
Configure Port Forwarding 270
Prerequisites for Port Forwarding 271
Restrictions for Port Forwarding 271
Configure DNS for Port Forwarding 272
Make Applications Eligible for Port Forwarding 273
Assign a Port Forwarding List 273
Automate Port Forwarding 274
Enable and Switch off Port Forwarding 274
Configure File Access 275
CIFS File Access Requirement and Limitation 276
Add Support for File Access 276
Ensure Clock Accuracy for SharePoint Access 278
Virtual Desktop Infrastructure (VDI) 278
Limitations to VDI 278
Citrix Mobile Support 278
Supported Mobile Devices for Citrix 279
Limitations of Citrix 279
About Citrix Mobile Receiver User Logon 279
Configure the ASA to Proxy a Citrix Server 280
Assign a VDI Server to a Group Policy 280
Use SSL to Access Internal Servers 281
Configure Clientless SSL VPN and ASDM Ports 281
Use HTTPS for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 282
Configure Support for Proxy Servers 282
Configure SSL/TLS Encryption Protocols 285
Authenticate with Digital Certificates 285
Restrictions of Digital Certificates Authentication 285
Configure Browser Access to Client-Server Plug-ins 285
About Installing Browser Plug-ins 285
Requirements for Installing Browser Plug-ins 287
Set Up RDP Plug-in 287

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xii
Contents

Prepare the Security Appliance for a Plug-in 287


Configure the ASA to Use the New HTML File 288

CHAPTER 14 Advanced Clientless SSL VPN Configuration 289


Microsoft Kerberos Constrained Delegation Solution 289
How KCD Works 289
Authentication Flow with KCD 290
Configure the ASA for Cross-Realm Authentication 292
Configure KCD 293
Show KCD Status Information 294
Debug KCD 294
Show Cached Kerberos Tickets 294
Clear Cached Kerberos Tickets 295
Requirements for Microsoft Kerberos 295
Configure Application Profile Customization Framework 295
Manage APCF Packets 296
APCF Syntax 296
Encoding 299
View or Specify Character Encoding 299
Use Email over Clientless SSL VPN 301
Configure Web email: MS Outlook Web App 301

CHAPTER 15 Policy Groups 303


Create and Apply Clientless SSL VPN Policies for Accessing Resources 303
Connection Profile Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN 303
Group Policy and User Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN 304
Configure Group Policy Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 306
Specify a Deny Message 307
Configure Group Policy Filter Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 307
Specify the User Home Page 308
Configure Auto-Signon 309
Specify the ACL for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 309
Apply a URL List 310
Enable ActiveX Relay for a Group Policy 311

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xiii
Contents

Enable Application Access on Clientless SSL VPN Sessions for a Group Policy 311
Configure the Port-Forwarding Display Name 312
Configure the Maximum Object Size to Ignore for Updating the Session Timer 312
Specify HTTP Compression 313
Configure Clientless SSL VPN Access for Specific Users 313
Specify the Content/Objects to Filter from the HTML 315
Specify the User Home Page 315
Specify a Deny Message 316
Apply a URL List 316
Enable ActiveX Relay for a User 317
Enable Application Access for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions 317
Configure the Port-Forwarding Display Name 318
Configure the Maximum Object Size to Ignore for Updating the Session Timer 318
Configure Auto-Signon 319
Specify HTTP Compression 319
Smart Tunnel Access 320
About Smart Tunnels 321
Prerequisites for Smart Tunnels 321
Guidelines for Smart Tunnels 322
Add Applications to Be Eligible for Smart Tunnel Access 323
About Smart Tunnel Lists 323
Configure and Apply Smart Tunnel Policy 324
Configure and Apply a Smart Tunnel Tunnel-Policy 325
Create a Smart Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List 326
Add Servers to a Smart Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List 327
Automate Smart Tunnel Access 328
Enable and Switch Off Smart Tunnel Access 329
Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off 330
Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off when Its Parent Process Terminates 330
Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off with a Notification Icon 331
Clientless SSL VPN Capture Tool 331
Configure Portal Access Rules 332
Optimize Clientless SSL VPN Performance 333
Configure Caching 333

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xiv
Contents

Configure Content Transformation 333


Configure a Certificate for Signing Rewritten Java Content 333
Switch Off Content Rewrite 334
Use Proxy Bypass 334

CHAPTER 16 Clientless SSL VPN Remote Users 337


Clientless SSL VPN Remote Users 337
Usernames and Passwords 337
Communicate Security Tips 338
Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features 338
Capture Clientless SSL VPN Data 344
Create a Capture File 344
Use a Browser to Display Capture Data 345

CHAPTER 17 Clientless SSL VPN Users 347


Manage Passwords 347
Use Single Sign-On with Clientless SSL VPN 349
SSO Using SAML 2.0 349

About SSO and SAML 2.0 349

Guidelines and Limitations for SAML 2.0 350

Configure a SAML 2.0 Identity Provider (IdP) 351


Configure ASA as a SAML 2.0 Service Provider (SP) 353
Example SAML 2.0 and Onelogin 353
Troubleshooting SAML 2.0 355

Configure SSO with HTTP Basic or NTLM Authentication 355


Configure SSO with the HTTP Form Protocol 356
Gather HTTP Form Data 360
Configure SSO for Plug-ins 362
Configure SSO with Macro Substitution 363
Username and Password Requirements 364
Communicate Security Tips 365
Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features 365
About Clientless SSL VPN 365
Prerequisites for Clientless SSL VPN 366

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xv
Contents

Use the Clientless SSL VPN Floating Toolbar 366


Browse the Web 366
Browse the Network (File Management) 367
Use the Remote File Explorer 367
Use Port Forwarding 368
Use email Via Port Forwarding 369
Use email Via Web Access 370
Use email Via email Proxy 370
Use Smart Tunnel 370

CHAPTER 18 Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile Devices 373


Use Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile Devices 373
Restrictions of Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile 373

CHAPTER 19 Customizing Clientless SSL VPN 375


Clientless SSL VPN End User Setup 375
Define the End User Interface 375
View the Clientless SSL VPN Home Page 375
View the Clientless SSL VPN Application Access Panel 375
View the Floating Toolbar 376
Customize Clientless SSL VPN Pages 376
Information About Customization 376
Export a Customization Template 377
Edit the Customization Template 377
Import a Customization Object 379
Apply Customizations to Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users 379
Login Screen Advanced Customization 381
Modify Your HTML File 384
Customize Bookmark Help 385
Import a Help file to Flash Memory 386
Export a Previously Imported Help File from Flash Memory 386
Understand Language Translation 387
Create Translation Tables 388
Reference the Language in a Customization Object 389

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xvi
Contents

Change a Group Policy or User Attributes to Use the Customization Object 391

CHAPTER 20 Clientless SSL VPN Troubleshooting 393


Recover from Hosts File Errors When Using Application Access 393
Understanding the Hosts File 394
Reconfigure a Host’s File Automatically Using Clientless SSL VPN 394
Reconfigure Hosts File Manually 395
WebVPN Conditional Debugging 396
Capture Data 396
Create a Capture File 397
Use a Browser to Display Capture Data 397
Protect Clientless SSL VPN Session Cookies 398

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xvii
Contents

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xviii
About This Guide
The following topics explain how to use this guide.
• Document Objectives, on page xix
• Related Documentation, on page xix
• Document Conventions, on page xix
• Communications, Services, and Additional Information, on page xxi

Document Objectives
The purpose of this guide is to help you configure VPN on the Adaptive Security Appliance (ASA) using the
command-line interface. This guide does not cover every feature, but describes only the most common
configuration scenarios.
You can also configure and monitor the ASA by using Adaptive Security Device Manager (ASDM), a
web-based GUI application. ASDM includes configuration wizards to guide you through some common
configuration scenarios, and online help for less common scenarios.
This guide applies to the Cisco ASA series. Throughout this guide, the term “ASA” applies generically to
supported models, unless specified otherwise.

Related Documentation
For more information, see Navigating the Cisco ASA Series Documentation at http://www.cisco.com/go/asadocs.

Document Conventions
This document adheres to the following text, display, and alert conventions.

Text Conventions

Convention Indication

boldface Commands, keywords, button labels, field names, and user-entered text appear
in boldface. For menu-based commands, the full path to the command is shown.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xix
About This Guide
About This Guide

Convention Indication

italic Variables, for which you supply values, are presented in an italic typeface.
Italic type is also used for document titles, and for general emphasis.

monospace Terminal sessions and information that the system displays appear in monospace
type.

{x | y | z} Required alternative keywords are grouped in braces and separated by vertical


bars.

[] Elements in square brackets are optional.

[x | y | z] Optional alternative keywords are grouped in square brackets and separated by


vertical bars.

[] Default responses to system prompts are also in square brackets.

<> Non-printing characters such as passwords are in angle brackets.

!, # An exclamation point (!) or a number sign (#) at the beginning of a line of code
indicates a comment line.

Reader Alerts
This document uses the following for reader alerts:

Note Means reader take note. Notes contain helpful suggestions or references to material not covered in the manual.

Tip Means the following information will help you solve a problem.

Caution Means reader be careful. In this situation, you might do something that could result in equipment damage or
loss of data.

Timesaver Means the described action saves time. You can save time by performing the action described in the paragraph.

Warning Means reader be warned. In this situation, you might perform an action that could result in bodily injury.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xx
About This Guide
Communications, Services, and Additional Information

Communications, Services, and Additional Information


• To receive timely, relevant information from Cisco, sign up at Cisco Profile Manager.
• To get the business impact you’re looking for with the technologies that matter, visit Cisco Services.
• To submit a service request, visit Cisco Support.
• To discover and browse secure, validated enterprise-class apps, products, solutions and services, visit
Cisco Marketplace.
• To obtain general networking, training, and certification titles, visit Cisco Press.
• To find warranty information for a specific product or product family, access Cisco Warranty Finder.

Cisco Bug Search Tool


Cisco Bug Search Tool (BST) is a web-based tool that acts as a gateway to the Cisco bug tracking system
that maintains a comprehensive list of defects and vulnerabilities in Cisco products and software. BST provides
you with detailed defect information about your products and software.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xxi
About This Guide
Communications, Services, and Additional Information

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
xxii
PA R T I
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
• IPsec and ISAKMP, on page 1
• L2TP over IPsec, on page 41
• General VPN Parameters, on page 51
• Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users, on page 77
• IP Addresses for VPNs, on page 171
• Remote Access IPsec VPNs, on page 179
• LAN-to-LAN IPsec VPNs, on page 193
• AnyConnect VPN Client Connections, on page 207
• AnyConnect HostScan, on page 229
• Easy VPN, on page 235
• Configure an External AAA Server for VPN, on page 243
CHAPTER 1
IPsec and ISAKMP
• About Tunneling, IPsec, and ISAKMP, on page 1
• Licensing for IPsec VPNs, on page 3
• Guidelines for IPsec VPNs, on page 4
• Configure ISAKMP, on page 4
• Configure IPsec, on page 17
• Managing IPsec VPNs, on page 38

About Tunneling, IPsec, and ISAKMP


This topic describes the Internet Protocol Security (IPsec) and the Internet Security Association and Key
Management Protocol (ISAKMP) standards used to build Virtual Private Networks (VPNs).
Tunneling makes it possible to use a public TCP/IP network, such as the Internet, to create secure connections
between remote users and a private corporate network. Each secure connection is called a tunnel.
The ASA uses the ISAKMP and IPsec tunneling standards to build and manage tunnels. ISAKMP and IPsec
accomplish the following:
• Negotiate tunnel parameters
• Establish tunnels
• Authenticate users and data
• Manage security keys
• Encrypt and decrypt data
• Manage data transfer across the tunnel
• Manage data transfer inbound and outbound as a tunnel endpoint or router

The ASA functions as a bidirectional tunnel endpoint. It can receive plain packets from the private network,
encapsulate them, create a tunnel, and send them to the other end of the tunnel where they are unencapsulated
and sent to their final destination. It can also receive encapsulated packets from the public network,
unencapsulate them, and send them to their final destination on the private network.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
1
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
IPsec Overview

IPsec Overview
The ASA uses IPsec for LAN-to-LAN VPN connections and provides the option of using IPsec for
client-to-LAN VPN connections. In IPsec terminology, a peer is a remote-access client or another secure
gateway. For both connection types, the ASA supports only Cisco peers. Because we adhere to VPN industry
standards, ASAs can work with other vendors' peers; however, we do not support them.
During tunnel establishment, the two peers negotiate security associations that govern authentication, encryption,
encapsulation, and key management. These negotiations involve two phases: first, to establish the tunnel (the
IKE SA) and second, to govern traffic within the tunnel (the IPsec SA).
A LAN-to-LAN VPN connects networks in different geographic locations. In IPsec LAN-to-LAN connections,
the ASA can function as initiator or responder. In IPsec client-to-LAN connections, the ASA functions only
as responder. Initiators propose SAs; responders accept, reject, or make counter-proposals—all in accordance
with configured SA parameters. To establish a connection, both entities must agree on the SAs.

Understanding IPsec Tunnels


IPsec tunnels are sets of SAs that the ASA establishes between peers. The SAs specify the protocols and
algorithms to apply to sensitive data and also specify the keying material that the peers use. IPsec SAs control
the actual transmission of user traffic. SAs are unidirectional, but are generally established in pairs (inbound
and outbound).
The peers negotiate the settings to use for each SA. Each SA consists of the following:
• IKEv1 transform sets or IKEv2 proposals
• Crypto maps
• ACLs
• Tunnel groups
• Prefragmentation policies

ISAKMP and IKE Overview


ISAKMP is the negotiation protocol that lets two hosts agree on how to build an IPsec security association
(SA). It provides a common framework for agreeing on the format of SA attributes. This security association
includes negotiating with the peer about the SA and modifying or deleting the SA. ISAKMP separates
negotiation into two phases: Phase 1 and Phase 2. Phase 1 creates the first tunnel, which protects later ISAKMP
negotiation messages. Phase 2 creates the tunnel that protects data.
IKE uses ISAKMP to set up the SA for IPsec to use. IKE creates the cryptographic keys used to authenticate
peers.
The ASA supports IKEv1 for connections from the legacy Cisco VPN client, and IKEv2 for the AnyConnect
VPN client.
To set the terms of the ISAKMP negotiations, you create an IKE policy, which includes the following:
• The authentication type required of the IKEv1 peer, either RSA signature using certificates or preshared
key (PSK).
• An encryption method to protect the data and ensure privacy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
2
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Licensing for IPsec VPNs

• A Hashed Message Authentication Codes (HMAC) method to ensure the identity of the sender, and to
ensure that the message has not been modified in transit.
• A Diffie-Hellman group to determine the strength of the encryption-key-determination algorithm. The
ASA uses this algorithm to derive the encryption and hash keys.
• For IKEv2, a separate pseudo-random function (PRF) used as the algorithm to derive keying material
and hashing operations required for the IKEv2 tunnel encryption and so on.
• A limit to the time the ASA uses an encryption key before replacing it.

With IKEv1 policies, you set one value for each parameter. For IKEv2, you can configure multiple encryption
and authentication types, and multiple integrity algorithms for a single policy. The ASA orders the settings
from the most secure to the least secure and negotiates with the peer using that order. This ordering allows
you to potentially send a single proposal to convey all the allowed transforms instead of sending each allowed
combination as with IKEv1.
The ASA does not support IKEv2 multiple security associations (SAs). The ASA currently accepts inbound
IPsec traffic only on the first SA that is found. If IPsec traffic is received on any other SA, it is dropped with
reason vpn-overlap-conflict. Multiple IPsec SAs can come about from duplicate tunnels between two
peers, or from asymmetric tunneling.

Understanding IKEv1 Transform Sets and IKEv2 Proposals


An IKEv1 transform set or an IKEv2 proposal is a combination of security protocols and algorithms that
define how the ASA protects data. During IPsec SA negotiations, the peers must identify a transform set or
proposal that is the same at both peers. The ASA then applies the matching transform set or proposal to create
an SA that protects data flows in the ACL for that crypto map.
With IKEv1 transform sets, you set one value for each parameter. For IKEv2 proposals, you can configure
multiple encryption and authentication types and multiple integrity algorithms for a single proposal. The ASA
orders the settings from the most secure to the least secure and negotiates with the peer using that order. This
allows you to potentially send a single proposal to convey all the allowed combinations instead of the need
to send each allowed combination individually as with IKEv1.
The ASA tears down the tunnel if you change the definition of the transform set or proposal used to create
its SA. See the Clear Security Associations, on page 39” for further information.

Note If you clear or delete the only element in a transform set or proposal, the ASA automatically removes the
crypto map references to it.

Licensing for IPsec VPNs

Note This feature is not available on No Payload Encryption models.

IPsec remote access VPN using IKEv2 requires an AnyConnect Plus or Apex license, available separately.
IPsec remote access VPN using IKEv1 and IPsec site-to-site VPN using IKEv1 or IKEv2 uses the Other VPN

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
3
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Guidelines for IPsec VPNs

license that comes with the base license. See Cisco ASA Series Feature Licenses for maximum values per
model.

Guidelines for IPsec VPNs


Context Mode Guidelines
Supported in single or multiple context mode. Anyconnect Apex license is required for remote-access VPN
in multi-context mode. Although ASA does not specifically recognize an AnyConnect Apex license, it enforces
licenses characteristics of an Apex license such as AnyConnect Premium licensed to the platform limit,
AnyConnect for mobile, AnyConnect for Cisco VPN phone, and advanced endpoint assessment.

Firewall Mode Guidelines


Supported in routed firewall mode only. Does not support transparent firewall mode.

Failover Guidelines
IPsec VPN sessions are replicated in Active/Standby failover configurations only.

Configure ISAKMP
Configure IKEv1 and IKEv2 Policies
IKEv1 and IKEv2 each support a maximum of 20 IKE policies, each with a different set of values. Assign a
unique priority to each policy that you create. The lower the priority number, the higher the priority.
When IKE negotiations begin, the peer that initiates the negotiation sends all of its policies to the remote peer,
and the remote peer tries to find a match. The remote peer checks all of the peer's policies against each of its
configured policies in priority order (highest priority first) until it discovers a match.
A match exists when both policies from the two peers contain the same encryption, hash, authentication, and
Diffie-Hellman parameter values. For IKEv1, the remote peer policy must also specify a lifetime less than or
equal to the lifetime in the policy the initiator sent. If the lifetimes are not identical, the ASA uses the shorter
lifetime. For IKEv2 the lifetime is not negotiated but managed locally between each peer, making it possible
to configure lifetime independently on each peer. If no acceptable match exists, IKE refuses negotiation and
the SA is not established.
There is an implicit trade-off between security and performance when you choose a specific value for each
parameter. The level of security the default values provide is adequate for the security requirements of most
organizations. If you are interoperating with a peer that supports only one of the values for a parameter, your
choice is limited to that value.
You must include the priority in each of the ISAKMP commands. The priority number uniquely identifies
the policy and determines the priority of the policy in IKE negotiations.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
4
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure IKEv1 and IKEv2 Policies

Procedure

Step 1 To create an IKE policy, enter the crypto ikev1 | ikev2 policy command from global configuration mode in
either single or multiple context mode. The prompt displays IKE policy configuration mode.
Example:

hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 policy 1

Note New ASA configurations do not have a default IKEv1 or IKEv2 policy.

Step 2 Specify the encryption algorithm. The default is Triple DES .


encryption[aes | aes-192 | aes-256 | des | 3des]
Example:

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# encryption des

Step 3 Specify the hash algorithm. The default is SHA-1.


hash [md5 | sha]
Example:

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# hash md5

Step 4 Specify the authentication method. The default is preshared keys.


authentication[pre-shared]rsa-sig]
Example:

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# authentication rsa-sig

Step 5 Specify the Diffie-Hellman group identifier. The default is Group 2.


group[1 | 2 | 5]
Example:

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# group 5

Step 6 Specify the SA lifetime. The default is 86400 seconds (24 hours).
lifetime seconds
Example:
This examples sets a lifetime of 4 hours (14400 seconds):
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# lifetime 14400

Step 7 Specify additional settings using the IKEv1 and IKEv2 policy keywords and their values provided in IKE
Policy Keywords and Values, on page 6. If you do not specify a value for a given policy parameter, the
default value applies.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
5
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
IKE Policy Keywords and Values

IKE Policy Keywords and Values


Keyword Meaning Description

authentication rsa-sig A digital certificate with keys Specifies the authentication


generated by the RSA signatures method the ASA uses to
algorithm establish the identity of each
IPsec peer.

pre-share (default) Preshared keys Preshared keys do not scale well


with a growing network but are
easier to set up in a small
network.

encryption des 56-bit DES-CBC Specifies the symmetric


encryption algorithm that
3des (default) 168-bit Triple DES
protects data transmitted
between two IPsec peers. The
default is 168-bit Triple DES.

hash sha (default) SHA-1 (HMAC variant) Specifies the hash algorithm
used to ensure data integrity. It
ensures that a packet comes
from where it says it comes
from and that it has not been
modified in transit.

md5 MD5 (HMAC variant) The default is SHA-1. MD5 has


a smaller digest and is
considered to be slightly faster
than SHA-1. A successful (but
extremely difficult) attack
against MD5 has occurred;
however, the HMAC variant
IKE uses prevents this attack.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
6
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
IKE Policy Keywords and Values

Keyword Meaning Description

group 1 Group 1 (768-bit) Specifies the Diffie-Hellman


group identifier, which the two
2 (default) Group 2 (1024-bit) IPsec peers use to derive a
shared secret without
5 Group 5 (1536-bit) transmitting it to each other.
The lower the Diffie-Hellman
group number, the less CPU
time it requires to execute. The
higher the Diffie-Hellman group
number, the greater the security.
AES support is available on
security appliances licensed for
VPN-3DES only. To support the
large key sizes required by AES,
ISAKMP negotiation should use
Diffie-Hellman (DH) Group 5.

lifetime integer value 120 to 2147483647 seconds Specifies the SA lifetime. The
default is 86,400 seconds or 24
(86400 = default)
hours. As a general rule, a
shorter lifetime provides more
secure ISAKMP negotiations
(up to a point). However, with
shorter lifetimes, the ASA sets
up future IPsec SAs more
quickly.

Keyword Meaning Description

integrity sha (default) SHA-1 (HMAC variant) Specifies the hash algorithm
used to ensure data integrity. It
ensures that a packet comes
from where it says it comes
from and that it has not been
modified in transit.

md5 MD5 (HMAC variant) The default is SHA-1. MD5 has


a smaller digest and is
considered to be slightly faster
than SHA-1. A successful (but
extremely difficult) attack
against MD5 has occurred;
however, the HMAC variant
IKE user prevents this attack.

sha256 SHA 2, 256-bit digest Specifies the Secure Hash


Algorithm SHA 2 with the
256-bit digest.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
7
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
IKE Policy Keywords and Values

Keyword Meaning Description

sha384 SHA 2, 384-bit digest Specifies the Secure Hash


Algorithm SHA 2 with the
384-bit digest.

sha512 SHA 2, 512-bit digest Specifies the Secure Hash


Algorithm SHA 2 with the
512-bit digest.

null When AES-GCM is specified


as the encryption algorithm, an
administrator can choose null as
the IKEv2 integrity algorithm.

encryption des 56-bit DES-CBC Specifies the symmetric


encryption algorithm that
3des (default) 168-bit Triple DES
protects data transmitted
between two IPsec peers. The
default is 168-bit Triple DES.

aes aes-192 aes-256 The Advanced Encryption


Standard supports key lengths
of 128, 192, 256 bits.

aes-gcm aes-gcm-192 AES-GCM algorithm options to The Advanced Encryption


aes-gcm-256 null use for IKEv2 encryption Standard supports key lengths
of 128, 192, 256 bits.

policy_index Accesses the IKEv2 policy


sub-mode.

prf sha (default) SHA-1 (HMAC variant) Specifies the pseudo random
function (PRF)—the algorithm
used to generate keying
material.

md5 MD5 (HMAC variant) The default is SHA-1. MD5 has


a smaller digest and is
considered to be slightly faster
than SHA-1. A successful (but
extremely difficult) attack
against MD5 has occurred;
however, the HMAC variant
IKE uses prevents this attack.

sha256 SHA 2, 256-bit digest Specifies the Secure Hash


Algorithm SHA 2 with the
256-bit digest.

sha384 SHA 2, 384-bit digest Specifies the Secure Hash


Algorithm SHA 2 with the
384-bit digest.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
8
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable IKE on the Outside Interface

Keyword Meaning Description

sha512 SHA 2, 512-bit digest Specifies the Secure Hash


Algorithm SHA 2 with the
512-bit digest.

priority Extends the policy mode to


support the additional IPsec V3
features and makes the
AES-GCM and ECDH settings
part of the Suite B support.

group 1 Group 1 (768-bit) Specifies the Diffie-Hellman


group identifier, which the two
2 (default) Group 2 (1024-bit) IPsec peers use to derive a
shared secret without
5 Group 5 (1536-bit) transmitting it to each other.
14 19 20 21 24 The lower the Diffie-Hellman
group number, the less CPU
time it requires to execute. The
higher the Diffie-Hellman group
number, the greater the security.
The AnyConnect client supports
DH group 1, 2, and 5 in
non-FIPS mode, and groups 2
and only in FIPS mode.
AES support is available on
security appliances licensed for
VPN-3DES only. To support the
large key sizes required by AES,
ISAKMP negotiation should use
Diffie-Hellman (DH) Group 5.

lifetime integer value 120 to 2147483647 seconds Specifies the SA lifetime. The
default is 86,400 seconds or 24
(86400 = default)
hours. As a general rule, a
shorter lifetime provides more
secure ISAKMP negotiations
(up to a point). However, with
shorter lifetimes, the ASA sets
up future IPsec SAs more
quickly.

Enable IKE on the Outside Interface


You must enable IKE on the interface that terminates the VPN tunnel. Typically this is the outside, or public
interface. To enable IKEv1 or IKEv2, use the crypto [ikev1 | ikev2] enable interface-name command from
global configuration mode in either single or multiple context mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
9
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Disable IKEv1 Aggressive Mode

For example:

hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 enable outside

Disable IKEv1 Aggressive Mode


Phase 1 IKEv1 negotiations can use either main mode or aggressive mode. Both provide the same services,
but aggressive mode requires only two exchanges between the peers totaling three messages, rather than three
exchanges totaling six messages. Aggressive mode is faster, but does not provide identity protection for the
communicating parties. Therefore, the peers must exchange identification information before establishing a
secure SA. Aggressive mode is enabled by default.

Note Disabling aggressive mode prevents Cisco VPN clients from using preshared key authentication to establish
tunnels to the ASA. However, they may use certificate-based authentication (that is, ASA or RSA) to establish
tunnels.

To disable aggressive mode, enter the following command in either single or multiple context mode:

hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 am-disable

If you have disabled aggressive mode, and want to revert back to it, use the no form of the command. For
example:

hostname(config)# no crypto ikev1 am-disable

Configure an ID Method for IKEv1 and IKEv2 ISAKMP Peers


DuringIKEv1 or IKEv2 ISAKMP Phase I negotiations, the peers must identify themselves to each other. You
can choose the identification method from the following options.

Address Uses the IP addresses of the hosts exchanging


ISAKMP identity information.

Automatic Determines ISAKMP negotiation by connection type:


(default) • IP address for preshared key.
• Cert Distinguished Name for certificate
authentication.

Hostname Uses the fully qualified domain name of the hosts


exchanging ISAKMP identity information (default).
This name comprises the hostname and the domain
name.

Key ID Specifies the string used by the remote peer to look


up the preshared key.
key_id_string

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
10
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
INVALID_SELECTORS Notification

The ASA uses the Phase I ID to send to the peer. This is true for all VPN scenarios except LAN-to-LAN
IKEv1 connections in main mode that authenticate with preshared keys.
To change the peer identification method, enter the following command in either single or multiple context
mode:
crypto isakmp identity {address | hostname | key-id id-string | auto}
For example, the following command sets the peer identification method to hostname:

hostname(config)# crypto isakmp identity hostname

INVALID_SELECTORS Notification
If an IPsec system receives an inbound packet on an SA and the packet's header fields are not consistent with
the selectors for the SA, it MUST discard the packet. The audit log entry for this event includes the current
date/time, SPI, IPsec protocol(s), source and destination of the packet, any other vector values of the packet
that are available, and the selector values from the relevant SA entry. The system generates and sends an IKE
notification of INVALID_SELECTORS to the sender (IPsec peer), indicating that the received packet was
discarded because of failure to pass selector checks.
The ASA already implements the logging of this event in CTM using the existing syslog shown below:

%ASA-4-751027: IKEv2 Received INVALID_SELECTORS Notification from peer: <peer IP>. Peer
received a packet (SPI=<spi>) from <local_IP>. The decapsulated inner packet didn't match
the negotiated policy in the SA. Packet destination <pkt_daddr>, port <pkt_dest_port>,
source <pkt_saddr>, port <pkt_src_port>, protocol <pkt_prot>

An administrator can now enable or disable sending an IKEv2 notification to the peer when an inbound packet
is received on an SA that does not match the traffic selectors for that SA. If enabled, the IKEv2 notification
messages are rate limited to one notification message per SA every five seconds. The IKEv2 notification is
sent in an IKEv2 informational exchange to the peer.

Configure IKEv2 Pre-shared Key in Hex


You can configure the IKEv2 pre-shared keys in Hex by adding the keyword hex to both the local and remote
pre-shared key commands.

ikev2 local-authentication pre-shared-key [ 0 | 8 | hex ] <string>


ikev2 remote-authentication pre-shared-key [ 0 | 8 | hex ] <string>

Enable or Disable Sending of IKE Notification


An administrator can enable or disable sending an IKE notification to the peer when an inbound packet is
received on an IKEv2 IPsec VPN connection that does not match the traffic selectors for that connection.
Sending this notification is disabled by default. Sending IKE INVALID_SELECTORS Notifications when
Authorization of a username from ASDM certificate is enabled or disabled using the following CLI:
[no] crypto ikev2 notify invalid-selectors
When certificate authentication is performed, the CN from the certificate is the username, and authorization
is performed against the LOCAL server. If “service-type” attribute is retrieved, it is processed as described
earlier.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
11
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure IKEv2 Fragmentation Options

Configure IKEv2 Fragmentation Options


On the ASA, IKEv2 fragmentation can be enabled or disabled, the MTU (Maximum Transmission Unit) used
when fragmenting IKEv2 packets can be specified, and a preferred fragmentation method can be configured
by the administrator using the following command:
[no] crypto ikev2 fragmentation [mtu <mtu-size>] | [preferred-method [ietf | cisco]]
By default, all methods of IKEv2 fragmentation are enabled, the MTU is 576 for IPv4, or 1280 for IPv6, and
the preferred method is the IETF standard RFC-7383.
Specify the [mtu <mtu-size>] with the following considerations:
• The MTU value used should include the IP(IPv4/IPv6) header + UDP header size.
• If not specified by the administrator the default MTU is 576 for IPv4, or 1280 for IPv6.
• Once specified, the same MTU will be used for both IPv4 and IPv6.
• Valid range is 68-1500.

One of the following supported fragmentation methods can be configured as the preferred fragmentation
method for IKEv2 [preferred-method [ietf | cisco]]:
• IETF RFC-7383 standard based IKEv2 fragmentation.
• This method will be used when both peers specify support and preference during negotiation.
• Using this method, encryption is done after fragmentation providing individual protection for each
IKEv2 Fragment message.
• Cisco proprietary fragmentation.
• This method will be used if it is the only method provided by a peer, such as the AnyConnect client,
or if both peers specify support and preference during negotiation.
• Using this method fragmentation is done after encryption. The receiving peer cannot decrypt or
authenticate the message until all fragments are received.
• This method does not interoperate with non-Cisco peers.

The command show running-config crypto ikev2 will display the current configuration, and show crypto
ikev2 sa detail displays the MTU enforced if fragmentation was used for the SA.

Before you begin


• Path MTU Discovery is not supported, the MTU needs to be manually configured to match the needs of
the network.
• This configuration is global and will affect future SAs established after the configuration has been applied.
Older SAs will not be affected. Same behavior holds true when fragmentation is disabled.
• A maximum of a 100 fragments can be received.

Examples
• To disable IKEv2 fragmentation:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
12
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
AAA Authentication With Authorization

no crypto ikev2 fragmentation

• To reinstate the default operation:


crypto ikev2 fragmentation

or
crypto ikev2 fragmentation mtu 576
preferred-method ietf

• To change the MTU value to 600:


crypto ikev2 fragmentation mtu 600

• To restore the default MTU value:


no crypto ikev2 fragmentation mtu 576

• To change the preferred method of fragmentation to Cisco:


crypto ikev2 fragmentation preferred-method cisco

• To restore the preferred fragmentation method to IETF:


no crypto ikev2 fragmentation preferred-method cisco

or
crypto ikev2 fragmentation preferred-method ietf

AAA Authentication With Authorization


aaa authentication http console LOCAL
aaa authorization http console radius

AAA authentication is performed against the LOCAL server using the username/password typed in by the
user. Additional authorization is performed against the radius server using the same username. service-type
attribute, if retrieved, is processed as described earlier.

Enable IPsec over NAT-T


NAT-T lets IPsec peers establish a connection through a NAT device. It does this by encapsulating IPsec
traffic in UDP datagrams, using port 4500, which provides NAT devices with port information. NAT-T
auto-detects any NAT devices and only encapsulates IPsec traffic when necessary.

Note Due to a limitation of the AnyConnect client, you must enable NAT-T for the AnyConnect client to successfully
connect using IKEv2. This requirement applies even if the client is not behind a NAT-T device.

The ASA can simultaneously support standard IPsec, IPsec over TCP, NAT-T, and IPsec over UDP, depending
on the client with which it is exchanging data.
The following breakdown shows the connections with each option enabled.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
13
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable IPsec over NAT-T

Options Enabled Feature Client Position Feature Used

Option 1 If NAT-T is enabled and client is behind NAT, NAT-T is used


then

and no NAT exists, then Native IPsec (ESP) is


used

Option 2 If IPsec over UDP is and client is behind NAT, IPsec over UDP is used
enabled then

and no NAT exists, then IPsec over UDP is used

Option 3 If both NAT-T and and client is behind NAT, NAT-T is used
then
IPsec over UDP are
enabled and no NAT exists, then IPsec over UDP is used

Note When IPsec over TCP is enabled, it takes precedence over all other connection methods.

When you enable NAT-T, the ASA automatically opens port 4500 on all IPsec-enabled interfaces.
The ASA supports multiple IPsec peers behind a single NAT/PAT device operating in LAN-to-LAN or remote
access networks, but not both. In a mixed environment, the remote access tunnels fail the negotiation because
all peers appear to be coming from the same public IP address, address of the NAT device. Also, remote
access tunnels fail in a mixed environment because they often use the same name as the LAN-to-LAN tunnel
group (that is, the IP address of the NAT device). This match can cause negotiation failures among multiple
peers in a mixed LAN-to-LAN and remote access network of peers behind the NAT device.
To use NAT-T, perform the following site-to-site steps in either single or multiple context mode:

Procedure

Step 1 Enter the following command to enable IPsec over NAT-T globally on the ASA:
crypto isakmp nat-traversal natkeepalive
The range for the natkeepalive argument is 10 to 3600 seconds. The default is 20 seconds.
Example:
Enter the following command to enable NAT-T and set the keepalive value to one hour:

hostname(config)# crypto isakmp nat-traversal 3600

Step 2 Select the before-encryption option for the IPsec fragmentation policy by entering this command:

hostname(config)# crypto ipsec fragmentation before-encryption

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
14
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable IPsec with IKEv1 over TCP

This option lets traffic travel across NAT devices that do not support IP fragmentation. It does not impede
the operation of NAT devices that do support IP fragmentation.

Enable IPsec with IKEv1 over TCP


IPsec over TCP encapsulates both the IKEv1 and IPsec protocols within a TCP-like packet and enables secure
tunneling through both NAT and PAT devices and firewalls. This feature is disabled by default. IPsec/IKEv1
over TCP enables a Cisco VPN client to operate in an environment in which standard ESP or IKEv1 cannot
function or can function only with modification to existing firewall rules.

Note This feature does not work with proxy-based firewalls.

IPsec over TCP works with remote access clients. You enable IPsec over TCP on both the ASA and the client
to which it connects. On the ASA, it is enabled globally, working on all IKEv1-enabled interfaces. It does
not work for LAN-to-LAN connections.
The ASA can simultaneously support standard IPsec, IPsec over TCP, NAT-Traversal, and IPsec over UDP,
depending on the client with which it is exchanging data. IPsec over TCP, if enabled, takes precedence over
all other connection methods.
You can enable IPsec over TCP for up to 10 ports that you specify. If you enter a well-known port, for example
port 80 (HTTP) or port 443 (HTTPS), the system displays a warning that the protocol associated with that
port no longer works on the public interface. The consequence is that you can no longer use a browser to
manage the ASA through the public interface. To solve this problem, reconfigure the HTTP/HTTPS
management to different ports.
The default port is 10000.
You must configure TCP port(s) on the client as well as on the ASA. The client configuration must include
at least one of the ports you set for the ASA.
To enable IPsec over TCP for IKEv1 globally on the ASA, perform the following command in either single
or multiple context mode:
crypto ikev1 ipsec-over-tcp [port port 1...port0]
This example enables IPsec over TCP on port 45:

hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 ipsec-over-tcp port 45

Configure Certificate Group Matching for IKEv1


Tunnel groups define user connection terms and permissions. Certificate group matching lets you match a
user to a tunnel group using either the Subject DN or Issuer DN of the user certificate.

Note Certificate group matching applies to IKEv1 and IKEv2 LAN-to-LAN connections only. IKEv2 remote access
connections support the pull-down group selection configured in the webvpn-attributes of the tunnel-group
and webvpn configuration mode for certificate-group-map, and so on.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
15
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Certificate Group Matching for IKEv1

To match users to tunnel groups based on these fields of the certificate, you must first create rules that define
a matching criteria, and then associate each rule with the desired tunnel group.
To create a certificate map, use the crypto ca certificate map command. To define a tunnel group, use the
tunnel-group command.
You must also configure a certificate group matching policy, specifying to match the group from the rules,
or from the organizational unit (OU) field, or to use a default group for all certificate users. You can use any
or all of these methods.

Procedure

Step 1 To configure the policy and rules by which certificate-based ISAKMP sessions map to tunnel groups, and to
associate the certificate map entries with tunnel groups, enter the tunnel-group-map command in either single
or multiple context mode.
tunnel-group-map enable {rules | ou | ike-id | peer ip}
tunnel-group-map [rule-index] enable policy

policy Specifies the policy for deriving the tunnel group


name from the certificate. Policy can be one of the
following:
ike-id—Indicates that if a tunnel group is not
determined based on a rule lookup or taken from the
OU, then the certificate-based ISAKMP sessions are
mapped to a tunnel group based on the content of the
phase1 ISAKMP ID.
ou—Indicates that if a tunnel-group is not determined
based on a rule lookup, then use the value of the OU
in the subject distinguished name (DN).
peer-ip—Indicates that if a tunnel group is not
determined based on a rule lookup or taken from the
OU or ike-id methods, then use the peer IP address.
rules—Indicates that the certificate-based ISAKMP
sessions are mapped to a tunnel group based on the
certificate map associations configured by this
command.

rule index (Optional) Refers to parameters specified by the


crypto ca certificate map command. The values are
1 to 65535.

Be aware of the following:


• You can invoke this command multiple times as long as each invocation is unique and you do not reference
a map index more than once.
• Rules cannot be longer than 255 characters.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
16
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure IPsec

• You can assign multiple rules to the same group. To do that, you add the rule priority and group first.
Then you define as many criteria statements as you need for each group. When multiple rules are assigned
to the same group, a match results for the first rule that tests true.
• By creating a single rule, you can require all criteria to match before assigning a user to a specific tunnel
group. Requiring all criteria to match is equivalent to a logical AND operation. Alternatively, create one
rule for each criterion if you want to require that only one match before assigning a user to a specific
tunnel group. Requiring only one criterion to match is equivalent to a logical OR operation.

Step 2 Specify a default tunnel group to use when the configuration does not specify a tunnel group.
The syntax is tunnel-group-map [rule-index] default-group tunnel-group-name where rule-index is the
priority for the rule, and tunnel-group name must be for a tunnel group that already exists.

Examples
The following example enables mapping of certificate-based ISAKMP sessions to a tunnel group
based on the content of the phase1 ISAKMP ID:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group-map enable ike-id

The following example enables mapping of certificate-based ISAKMP sessions to a tunnel group
based on the IP address of the peer:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group-map enable peer-ip

The following example enables mapping of certificate-based ISAKMP sessions based on the
organizational unit (OU) in the subject distinguished name (DN):

hostname(config)# tunnel-group-map enable ou

The following example enables mapping of certificate-based ISAKMP sessions based on established
rules:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group-map enable rules

Configure IPsec
This section describes the procedures required to configure the ASA when using IPsec to implement a VPN.

Define Crypto Maps


Crypto maps define the IPsec policy to be negotiated in the IPsec SA. They include the following:
• ACL to identify the packets that the IPsec connection permits and protects.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
17
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Define Crypto Maps

• Peer identification.
• Local address for the IPsec traffic. (See Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces, on page 27 for more details.)
• Up to 11 IKEv1 transform sets or IKEv2 proposals, with which to attempt to match the peer security
settings.

A crypto map set consists of one or more crypto maps that have the same map name. You create a crypto map
set when you create its first crypto map. The following site-to-site task creates or adds to a crypto map in
either single or multiple context mode:
crypto map map-name seq-num match address access-list-name
Use the access-list-name to specify the ACL ID, as a string or integer up to 241 characters in length.

Tip Use all capital letters to more easily identify the ACL ID in your configuration.

You can continue to enter this command to add crypto maps to the crypto map set. In the following example,
mymap is the name of the crypto map set to which you might want to add crypto maps:
crypto map mymap 10 match address 101
The sequence number (seq-num) shown in the syntax above distinguishes one crypto map from another one
with the same name. The sequence number assigned to a crypto map also determines its priority among the
other crypto maps within a crypto map set. The lower the sequence number, the higher the priority. After you
assign a crypto map set to an interface, the ASA evaluates all IP traffic passing through the interface against
the crypto maps in the set, beginning with the crypto map with the lowest sequence number.
[no] crypto map map_name map_index set pfs [group1 | group2 | group5 | group14 | group19 | group20
| group21 | group24]
Specifies the ECDH group used for Perfect Forward Secrecy (PFS) for the cryptography map. Prevents you
from configuring group14 and group24 options for a cryptography map (when using an IKEv1 policy).
[no] crypto map map_name seq-num set reverse-route
Enables Reverse Route Injection (RRI) for any connection based on this crypto map entry. RRI is done upon
configuration and is considered static, remaining in place until the configuration changes or is removed. The
ASA automatically adds static routes to the routing table and announces these routes to its private network
or border routers using OSPF.
You cannot configure a dynamic crypto map with the same name as a static crypto map and vice versa, even
if one of the crypto maps is not actually in use.
[no] crypto map name priority set validate-icmp-errors
OR
[no]crypto dynamic-map name priority set validate-icmp-errors
Specifies whether incoming ICMP error messages are validated for the cryptography or dynamic cryptography
map.
[no] crypto map <name> <priority> set df-bit [clear-df | copy-df | set-df}
OR
[no] crypto map dynamic-map <name> <priority> set df-bit [clear-df | copy-df | set-df]

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
18
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Define Crypto Maps

Configures the existing do not fragment (DF) policy (at a security association level) for the cryptography or
dynamic cryptography map.
• clear-df—Ignores the DF bit.
• copy-df—Maintains the DF bit.
• set-df—Sets and uses the DF bit.

[no] crypto map <name> <priority> set tfc-packets [burst <length | auto] [payload-size <bytes | auto>
[timeout <seconds | auto>
OR
[no] crypto dynamic-map <name> <priority> set tfc-packets [burst <length | auto] [payload-size <bytes
| auto> [timeout <seconds | auto>
An administrator can enable dummy Traffic Flow Confidentiality (TFC) packets at random lengths and
intervals on an IPsec security association. You must have an IKEv2 IPsec proposal set before enabling TFC.
The ACL assigned to a crypto map consists of all of the ACEs that have the same ACL name, as shown in
the following command syntax:
access-list access-list-name {deny | permit} ip source source-netmask destination destination-netmask
You create an ACL when you create its first ACE. The following command syntax creates or adds to an ACL:
access-list access-list-name {deny | permit} ip source source-netmask destination destination-netmask
In the following example, the ASA applies the IPsec protections assigned to the crypto map to all traffic
flowing from the 10.0.0.0 subnet to the 10.1.1.0 subnet:
access-list 101 permit ip 10.0.0.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
The crypto map that matches the packet determines the security settings used in the SA negotiations. If the
local ASA initiates the negotiation, it uses the policy specified in the static crypto map to create the offer to
send to the specified peer. If the peer initiates the negotiation, the ASA attempts to match the policy to a static
crypto map, and if that fails, then it attempts to match any dynamic crypto maps in the crypto map set, to
decide whether to accept or reject the peer offer.
For two peers to succeed in establishing an SA, they must have at least one compatible crypto map. To be
compatible, a crypto map must meet the following criteria:
• The crypto map must contain compatible crypto ACLs (for example, mirror image ACLs). If the responding
peer uses dynamic crypto maps, so the ASA also must contain compatible crypto ACLs as a requirement
to apply IPsec.
• Each crypto map identifies the other peer (unless the responding peer uses dynamic crypto maps).
• The crypto maps have at least one transform set or proposal in common.

You can apply only one crypto map set to a single interface. Create more than one crypto map for a particular
interface on the ASA if any of the following conditions exist:
• You want specific peers to handle different data flows.
• You want different IPsec security to apply to different types of traffic.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
19
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Example of LAN-to-LAN Crypto Maps

For example, create a crypto map and assign an ACL to identify traffic between two subnets and assign one
IKEv1 transform set or IKEv2 proposal. Create another crypto map with a different ACL to identify traffic
between another two subnets and apply a transform set or proposal with different VPN parameters.
If you create more than one crypto map for an interface, specify a sequence number (seq-num) for each map
entry to determine its priority within the crypto map set.
Each ACE contains a permit or deny statement. The following table explains the special meanings of permit
and deny ACEs in ACLs applied to crypto maps.

Result of Crypto Map Evaluation Response

Match criterion in an ACE containing a permit Halt further evaluation of the packet against the
statement remaining ACEs in the crypto map set, and evaluate
the packet security settings against those in the IKEv1
transform sets or IKEv2 proposals assigned to the
crypto map. After matching the security settings to
those in a transform set or proposal, the ASA applies
the associated IPsec settings. Typically for outbound
traffic, this means that it decrypts, authenticates, and
routes the packet.

Match criterion in an ACE containing a deny Interrupt further evaluation of the packet against the
statement remaining ACEs in the crypto map under evaluation,
and resume evaluation against the ACEs in the next
crypto map, as determined by the next seq-num
assigned to it.

Fail to match all tested permit ACEs in the crypto Route the packet without encrypting it.
map set

ACEs containing deny statements filter out outbound traffic that does not require IPsec protection (for example,
routing protocol traffic). Therefore, insert initial deny statements to filter outbound traffic that should not be
evaluated against permit statements in a crypto ACL.
For an inbound, encrypted packet, the security appliance uses the source address and ESP SPI to determine
the decryption parameters. After the security appliance decrypts the packet, it compares the inner header of
the decrypted packet to the permit ACEs in the ACL associated with the packet SA. If the inner header fails
to match the proxy, the security appliance drops the packet. It the inner header matches the proxy, the security
appliance routes the packet.
When comparing the inner header of an inbound packet that was not encrypted, the security appliance ignores
all deny rules because they would prevent the establishment of a Phase 2 SA.

Note To route inbound, unencrypted traffic as clear text, insert deny ACEs before permit ACEs. ASA cannot push
more than 28 ACE in split-tunnel access-list.

Example of LAN-to-LAN Crypto Maps


The objective in configuring Security Appliances A, B, and C in this example LAN-to-LAN network is to
permit tunneling of all traffic originating from one of the hosts and destined for one of the other hosts. However,
because traffic from Host A.3 contains sensitive data from the Human Resources department, it requires strong

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
20
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Example of LAN-to-LAN Crypto Maps

encryption and more frequent rekeying than the other traffic. So you will want to assign a special transform
set for traffic from Host A.3.

The simple address notation shown in this figure and used in the following explanation is an abstraction. An
example with real IP addresses follows the explanation.
To configure Security Appliance A for outbound traffic, you create two crypto maps, one for traffic from
Host A.3 and the other for traffic from the other hosts in Network A, as shown in the following example:

Crypto Map Seq_No_1


deny packets from A.3 to B
deny packets from A.3 to C
permit packets from A to B
permit packets from A to C
Crypto Map Seq_No_2
permit packets from A.3 to B
permit packets from A.3 to C

After creating the ACLs, you assign a transform set to each crypto map to apply the required IPsec to each
matching packet.
Cascading ACLs involves the insertion of deny ACEs to bypass evaluation against an ACL and resume
evaluation against a subsequent ACL in the crypto map set. Because you can associate each crypto map with
different IPsec settings, you can use deny ACEs to exclude special traffic from further evaluation in the
corresponding crypto map, and match the special traffic to permit statements in another crypto map to provide
or require different security. The sequence number assigned to the crypto ACL determines its position in the
evaluation sequence within the crypto map set.
The following illustration shows the cascading ACLs created from the conceptual ACEs in this example. The
meaning of each symbol is defined as follows: .

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
21
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Example of LAN-to-LAN Crypto Maps

Crypto map within a crypto map set.

(Gap in a straight line) Exit from a crypto map when


a packet matches an ACE.

Packet that fits the description of one ACE. Each size


ball represents a different packet matching the
respective ACE in the figure. The differences in size
merely represent differences in the source and
destination of each packet.

Redirection to the next crypto map in the crypto map


set.

Response when a packet either matches an ACE or


fails to match all of the permit ACEs in a crypto map
set.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
22
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Example of LAN-to-LAN Crypto Maps

Figure 1: Cascading ACLs in a Crypto Map Set

Security Appliance A evaluates a packet originating from Host A.3 until it matches a permit ACE and attempts
to assign the IPsec security associated with the crypto map. Whenever the packet matches a deny ACE, the
ASA ignores the remaining ACEs in the crypto map and resumes evaluation against the next crypto map, as
determined by the sequence number assigned to it. So in the example, if Security Appliance A receives a
packet from Host A.3, it matches the packet to a deny ACE in the first crypto map and resumes evaluation of
the packet against the next crypto map. When it matches the packet to the permit ACE in that crypto map, it
applies the associated IPsec security (strong encryption and frequent rekeying).
To complete the ASA configuration in the example network, we assign mirror crypto maps to ASAs B and
C. However, because ASAs ignore deny ACEs when evaluating inbound, encrypted traffic, we can omit the
mirror equivalents of the deny A.3 B and deny A.3 C ACEs, and therefore omit the mirror equivalents of
Crypto Map 2. So the configuration of cascading ACLs in ASAs B and C is unnecessary.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
23
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Example of LAN-to-LAN Crypto Maps

The following table shows the ACLs assigned to the crypto maps configured for all three ASAs, A, B and C:

Security Appliance A Security Appliance B Security Appliance C

Crypto Map ACE Pattern Crypto Map ACE Pattern Crypto Map ACE Pattern
Sequence Sequence Sequence
No. No. No.

1 deny A.3 B 1 permit B A 1 permit C A

deny A.3 C

permit A B

permit A C permit B C permit C B

2 permit A.3 B

permit A.3 C

The following illustration maps the conceptual addresses shown previously to real IP addresses.

The real ACEs shown in the following table ensure that all IPsec packets under evaluation within this network
receive the proper IPsec settings.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
24
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Example of LAN-to-LAN Crypto Maps

Security Appliance Crypto Map ACE Pattern Real ACEs


Sequence
No.

A 1 deny A.3 B deny 192.168.3.3


255.255.255.192
192.168.12.0
255.255.255.248

deny A.3 C deny 192.168.3.3


255.255.255.192
192.168.201.0
255.255.255.224

permit A B permit 192.168.3.0


255.255.255.192
192.168.12.0
255.255.255.248

permit A C permit 192.168.3.0


255.255.255.192
192.168.201.0
255.255.255.224

2 permit A.3 B permit 192.168.3.3


255.255.255.192
192.168.12.0
255.255.255.248

permit A.3 C permit 192.168.3.3


255.255.255.192
192.168.201.0
255.255.255.224

B None needed permit B A permit 192.168.12.0


255.255.255.248
192.168.3.0
255.255.255.192

permit B C permit 192.168.12.0


255.255.255.248
192.168.201.0
255.255.255.224

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
25
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Set Public Key Infrastructure (PKI) Keys

Security Appliance Crypto Map ACE Pattern Real ACEs


Sequence
No.

C None needed permit C A permit 192.168.201.0


255.255.255.224
192.168.3.0
255.255.255.192

permit C B permit 192.168.201.0


255.255.255.224
192.168.12.0
255.255.255.248

You can apply the same reasoning shown in the example network to use cascading ACLs to assign different
security settings to different hosts or subnets protected by a ASA.

Note By default, the ASA does not support IPsec traffic destined for the same interface from which it enters. Names
for this type of traffic include U-turn, hub-and-spoke, and hairpinning. However, you can configure IPsec to
support U-turn traffic by inserting an ACE to permit traffic to and from the network. For example, to support
U-turn traffic on Security Appliance B, add a conceptual “permit B B” ACE to ACL1. The actual ACE would
be as follows: permit 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248 192.168.12.0 255.255.255.248

Set Public Key Infrastructure (PKI) Keys


You must set public key infrastructure (PKI) in order for an administrator to choose the Suite B ECDSA
algorithms when generating or zeroing a keypair:

Before you begin


If you are configuring a cryptography map to use an RSA or ECDSA trustpoint for authentication, you must
first generate the key set. You can then create the trustpoint and reference it in the tunnel group configuration.

Procedure

Step 1 Choose the Suite B ECDSA algorithm when generating a keypair:


crypto key generate [rsa [general-keys | label <name> | modules [512 | 768 | 1024 | 2048 | 4096] | noconfirm
| usage-keys] | ecdsa [label <name> | elliptic-curve [256 | 384 | 521] | noconfirm]]

Step 2 Choose the Suite B ECDSA algorithm when zeroizing a keypair:


crypto key zeroize [rsa | ecdsa] [default | label <name> | noconfirm]

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
26
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces

Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces


You must assign a crypto map set to each interface through which IPsec traffic flows. The ASA supports
IPsec on all interfaces. Assigning the crypto map set to an interface instructs the ASA to evaluate all the traffic
against the crypto map set and to use the specified policy during connection or SA negotiation.
Assigning a crypto map to an interface also initializes run-time data structures, such as the SA database and
the security policy database. Reassigning a modified crypto map to the interface resynchronizes the run-time
data structures with the crypto map configuration. Also, adding new peers through the use of new sequence
numbers and reassigning the crypto map does not tear down existing connections.

Use Interface ACLs


By default, the ASA lets IPsec packets bypass interface ACLs. If you want to apply interface ACLs to IPsec
traffic, use the no form of the sysopt connection permit-vpn command.
The crypto map ACL bound to the outgoing interface either permits or denies IPsec packets through the VPN
tunnel. IPsec authenticates and deciphers packets that arrive from an IPsec tunnel, and subjects them to
evaluation against the ACL associated with the tunnel.
ACLs define which IP traffic to protect. For example, you can create ACLs to protect all IP traffic between
two subnets or two hosts. (These ACLs are similar to ACLs used with the access-group command. However,
with the access-group command, the ACL determines which traffic to forward or block at an interface.)
Before the assignment to crypto maps, the ACLs are not specific to IPsec. Each crypto map references the
ACLs and determines the IPsec properties to apply to a packet if it matches a permit in one of the ACLs.
ACLs assigned to IPsec crypto maps have four primary functions:
• Select outbound traffic to be protected by IPsec (permit = protect).
• Trigger an ISAKMP negotiation for data traveling without an established SA.
• Process inbound traffic to filter out and discard traffic that should have been protected by IPsec.
• Determine whether to accept requests for IPsec SAs when processing IKE negotiation from the peer.
(Negotiation applies only to ipsec-isakmp crypto map entries.) The peer must permit a data flow
associated with an ipsec-isakmp crypto map command entry to ensure acceptance during negotiation.

Note If you delete the only element in an ACL, the ASA also removes the associated crypto map.

If you modify an ACL currently referenced by one or more crypto maps, use the crypto map interface
command to reinitialize the run-time SA database. See the crypto map command for more information.
We recommend that for every crypto ACL specified for a static crypto map that you define at the local peer,
you define a “mirror image” crypto ACL at the remote peer. The crypto maps should also support common
transforms and refer to the other system as a peer. This ensures correct processing of IPsec by both peers.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
27
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Use Interface ACLs

Note Every static crypto map must define an ACL and an IPsec peer. If either is missing, the crypto map is incomplete
and the ASA drops any traffic that it has not already matched to an earlier, complete crypto map. Use the
show conf command to ensure that every crypto map is complete. To fix an incomplete crypto map, remove
the crypto map, add the missing entries, and reapply it.

We discourage the use of the any keyword to specify source or destination addresses in crypto ACLs because
they cause problems. We strongly discourage the permit any any command statement because it does the
following:
• Protects all outbound traffic, including all protected traffic sent to the peer specified in the corresponding
crypto map.
• Requires protection for all inbound traffic.

In this scenario, the ASA silently drops all inbound packets that lack IPsec protection.
Be sure that you define which packets to protect. If you use the any keyword in a permit statement, preface
it with a series of deny statements to filter out traffic that would otherwise fall within that permit statement
that you do not want to protect.

Note Decrypted through traffic is permitted from the client despite having an access group on the outside interface,
which calls a deny ip any any access-list, while no sysopt connection permit-vpn is configured.
Users who want to control access to the protected network via site-to-site or remote access VPN using the no
sysopt permit command in conjunction with an access control list (ACL) on the outside interface are not
successful.
In this situation, when management-access inside is enabled, the ACL is not applied, and users can still connect
using SSH to the security appliance. Traffic to hosts on the inside network are blocked correctly by the ACL,
but cannot block decrypted through traffic to the inside interface.
The ssh and http commands are of a higher priority than the ACLs. In other words, to deny SSH, Telnet, or
ICMP traffic to the device from the VPN session, use ssh, telnet and icmp commands, which deny the IP
local pool should be added.

Regardless of whether the traffic is inbound or outbound, the ASA evaluates traffic against the ACLs assigned
to an interface. Follow these steps to assign IPsec to an interface:

Procedure

Step 1 Create the ACLs to be used for IPsec.


Step 2 Map the lists to one or more crypto maps, using the same crypto map name.
Step 3 Map the IKEv1 transform sets or IKEv2 proposals to the crypto maps to apply IPsec to the data flows.
Step 4 Apply the crypto maps collectively as a crypto map set by assigning the crypto map name they share to the
interface.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
28
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Change IPsec SA Lifetimes

Example
In this example, IPsec protection applies to traffic between Host 10.0.0.1 and Host 10.2.2.2 as the
data exits the outside interface on ASA A toward Host 10.2.2.2.

ASA A evaluates traffic from Host 10.0.0.1 to Host 10.2.2.2, as follows:


• source = host 10.0.0.1
• dest = host 10.2.2.2

ASA A also evaluates traffic from Host 10.2.2.2 to Host 10.0.0.1, as follows:
• source = host 10.2.2.2
• dest = host 10.0.0.1

The first permit statement that matches the packet under evaluation determines the scope of the
IPsec SA.

Change IPsec SA Lifetimes


You can change the global lifetime values that the ASA uses when negotiating new IPsec SAs. You can
override these global lifetime values for a particular crypto map.
IPsec SAs use a derived, shared, secret key. The key is an integral part of the SA; the keys time out together
to require the key to refresh. Each SA has two lifetimes: timed and traffic-volume. An SA expires after the
respective lifetime and negotiations begin for a new one. The default lifetimes are 28,800 seconds (eight
hours) and 4,608,000 kilobytes (10 megabytes per second for one hour).
If you change a global lifetime, the ASA drops the tunnel. It uses the new value in the negotiation of
subsequently established SAs.
When a crypto map does not have configured lifetime values and the ASA requests a new SA, it inserts the
global lifetime values used in the existing SA into the request sent to the peer. When a peer receives a
negotiation request, it uses the smaller of either the lifetime value the peer proposes or the locally configured
lifetime value as the lifetime of the new SA.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
29
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Change VPN Routing

The peers negotiate a new SA before crossing the lifetime threshold of the existing SA to ensure that a new
SA is ready when the existing one expires. The peers negotiate a new SA when about 5 to 15 percent of the
lifetime of the existing SA remains.

Change VPN Routing


By default, per-packet adjacency lookups are done for the outer ESP packets, lookups are not done for packets
sent through the IPsec tunnel.
In some network topologies, when a routing update has altered the inner packet’s path, but the local IPsec
tunnel is still up, packets through the tunnel may not be routed correctly and fail to reach their destination.
To prevent this, enable per-packet routing lookups for the IPsec inner packets.

Before you begin


To avoid any performance impact from these lookups, this feature is disabled by default. Enable it only when
necessary.

Procedure

Enable per-packet routing lookups for the IPsec inner packets.


[no] [crypto] ipsec inner-routing-lookup
Note This command, when configured, is only applicable for non-VTI based tunnels.

Example

ciscoasa(config)# crypto ipsec inner-routing-lookup


ciscoasa(config)# show run crypto ipsec
crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal GCM
protocol esp encryption aes-gcm
protocol esp integrity null
crypto ipsec inner-routing-lookup

Create Static Crypto Maps


To create a basic IPsec configuration using a static crypto map, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 To create an ACL to define the traffic to protect, enter the following command:
access-list access-list-name {deny | permit} ip source source-netmask destination destination-netmask

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
30
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create Static Crypto Maps

The access-list-name specifies the ACL ID, as a string or integer up to 241 characters in length. The
destination-netmask and source-netmask specifies an IPv4 network address and subnet mask. In this example,
the permit keyword causes all traffic that matches the specified conditions to be protected by crypto.
Example:

hostname(config)# access-list 101 permit ip 10.0.0.0 255.255.255.0 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0

Step 2 To configure an IKEv1 transform set that defines how to protect the traffic, enter the following command:
crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set transform-set-name encryption [authentication]
Encryption specifies which encryption method protects IPsec data flows:
• esp-aes—Uses AES with a 128-bit key.
• esp-aes-192—Uses AES with a 192-bit key.
• esp-aes-256—Uses AES with a 256-bit key.\
• esp-des—Uses 56-bit DES-CBC.
• esp-3des—Uses triple DES algorithm.
• esp-null—No encryption.

Authentication specifies which encryption method to protect IPsec data flows:


• esp-md5-hmac—Uses the MD5/HMAC-128 as the hash algorithm.
• esp-sha-hmac—Uses the SHA/HMAC-160 as the hash algorithm.
• esp-none—No HMAC authentication.

Example:
In this example, myset1 and myset2 and aes_set are the names of the transform sets.

hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set myset1 esp-des esp-sha-hmac


hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set myset2 esp-3des esp-sha-hmac
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set aes_set esp-md5-hmac esp-aes-256

Step 3 To configure an IKEv2 proposal that also defines how to protect the traffic, enter the following command:
crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal [proposal tag]
proposal tag is the name of the IKEv2 IPsec proposal, a string from 1 to 64 characters.
Create the proposal and enter the ipsec proposal configuration mode where you can specify multiple encryption
and integrity types for the proposal.
Example:

hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal secure

In this example, secure is the name of the proposal. Enter a protocol and encryption types:

hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)# protocol esp encryption 3des aes des

Example:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
31
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create Static Crypto Maps

This command chooses which AES-GCM or AES-GMAC algorithm to use:


[no] protocol esp encryption [3des | aes | aes-192 | aes-256 | aes-gcm | aes-gcm-192 | aes-gcm-256 | aes-gmac
| aes-gmac-192 | aes-gmac-256 | des | null]
If SHA-2 or null is chosen, you must choose which algorithm to use as an IPsec integrity algorithm. You must
choose the null integriy algorithm if AES-GCM/GMAC is configured as the encryption algorithm:
[no] protocol esp integrity [md5 | sha-1 | sha-256 | sha-384 | sha-512 | null]
Note You must choose the null integrity algorithm if AES-GCM/GMAC has been configured as the
encryption algorithm. SHA-256 can be used for integrity and PRF to establish IKEv2 tunnels, but
it can also be used for ESP integrity protection.

Step 4 (Optional) An administrator can enable path maximum transfer unit (PMTU) aging and set the interval at
which the PMTU value is reset to its original value.
[no] crypto ipsec security-association pmtu-aging reset-interval

Step 5 To create a crypto map, perform the following site-to-site steps using either single or multiple context mode:
a) Assign an ACL to a crypto map:
crypto map map-name seq-num match address access-list-name
A crypto map set is a collection of crypto map entries, each with a different sequence number (seq-num)
but the same map name. Use the access-list-name to specify the ACL ID, as a string or integer up to 241
characters in length. In the following example, mymap is the name of the crypto map set. The map set
sequence number 10, which is used to rank multiple entries within one crypto map set. The lower the
sequence number, the higher the priority.
Example:
In this example, the ACL named 101 is assigned to crypto map mymap.

crypto map mymap 10 match address 101

b) Specify the peer to which the IPsec-protected traffic can be forwarded:


crypto map map-name seq-num set peer ip-address
Example:

crypto map mymap 10 set peer 192.168.1.100

The ASA sets up an SA with the peer assigned the IP address 192.168.1.100. Specify multiple peers by
repeating this command.
c) Specify which IKEv1 transform sets or IKEv2 proposals are allowed for this crypto map. List multiple
transform sets or proposals in order of priority (highest priority first). You can specify up to 11 transform
sets or proposals in a crypto map using either of these two commands:
crypto map map-name seq-num set ikev1 transform-set transform-set-name1 [transform-set-name2,
…transform-set-name11]
OR
crypto map map-name seq-num set ikev2 ipsec-proposal proposal-name1 [proposal-name2, …
proposal-name11]

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
32
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create Static Crypto Maps

Proposal-name1 and proposal-name11 specifies one or more names of the IPsec proposals for IKEv2.
Each crypto map entry supports up to 11 proposals.
Example:
In this example for IKEv1, when traffic matches ACL 101, the SA can use either myset1 (first priority)
or myset2 (second priority) depending on which transform set matches the transform set of the peer.

crypto map mymap 10 set ikev1 transform-set myset1 myset2

d) (Optional) For IKEv2, specify the mode for applying ESP encryption and authentication to the tunnel.
This determines what part of the original IP packet has ESP applied.
crypto map map-name seq-num set ikev2 mode [transport | tunnel | transport-require]
• Tunnel mode—(default) Encapsulation mode will be tunnel mode. Tunnel mode applies ESP
encryption and authentication to the entire original IP packet (IP header and data), thus hiding the
ultimate source and destination addresses.The entire original IP datagram is encrypted, and it becomes
the payload in a new IP packet.
This mode allows a network device, such as a router, to act as an IPsec proxy. That is, the router
performs encryption on behalf of the hosts. The source router encrypts packets and forwards them
along the IPsec tunnel. The destination router decrypts the original IP datagram and forwards it on
to the destination system.
The major advantage of tunnel mode is that the end systems do not need to be modified to receive
the benefits of IPsec. Tunnel mode also protects against traffic analysis; with tunnel mode, an attacker
can only determine the tunnel endpoints and not the true source and destination of the tunneled
packets, even if they are the same as the tunnel endpoints.
• Transport mode— Encapsulation mode will be transport mode with option to fallback on tunnel
mode, if peer does not support it. In Transport mode only the IP payload is encrypted, and the original
IP headers are left intact.
This mode has the advantages of adding only a few bytes to each packet and allowing devices on
the public network to see the final source and destination of the packet. With transport mode, you
can enable special processing (for example, QoS) on the intermediate network based on the information
in the IP header. However, the Layer 4 header is encrypted, which limits examination of the packet.
• Transport Required— Encapsulation mode will be transport mode only, falling back to tunnel
mode is not allowed.

Where tunnel encapsulation mode is the default. transport encapsulation mode is transport mode with
the option to fallback to tunnel mode if the peer does not support it, and transport-require encapsulation
mode enforces transport mode only.
Note Transport mode is not recommended for Remote Access VPNs.

Examples of negotiation of the encapsulation mode is as follows:


• If the initiator proposes transport mode, and the responder responds with tunnel mode, the initiator
will fall back to Tunnel mode.
• If the initiator proposes tunnel mode, and responder responds with transport mode, the responder
will fallback to Tunnel mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
33
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create Static Crypto Maps

• If the initiator proposes tunnel mode and responder has transport-require mode, then NO PROPOSAL
CHOSEN will be sent by the responder.
• Similarly if initiator has transport-require, and responder has tunnel mode, NO PROPOSAL CHOSEN
will be sent by the responder.

e) (Optional) Specify an SA lifetime for the crypto map if you want to override the global lifetime.
crypto map map-name seq-num set security-association lifetime {seconds number | kilobytes {number
| unlimited}}
Map-name specifies the name of the crypto map set. Seq-num specifies the number you assign to the
crypto map entry. You can set both lifetimes based on time or on data transmitted. However, the data
transmitted lifetime applies to site-to-site VPN only, it does not apply to remote access VPN.
Example:
This example shortens the timed lifetime for the crypto map mymap 10 to 2700 seconds (45 minutes).
The traffic volume lifetime is not changed.

crypto map mymap 10 set security-association lifetime seconds 2700

f) (Optional) Specify that IPsec require perfect forward secrecy when requesting new SA for this crypto
map, or require PFS in requests received from the peer:
crypto map map_name seq-num set pfs [group1 | group2 | group5|group14]
Example:
This example requires PFS when negotiating a new SA for the crypto map mymap 10. The ASA uses the
1024-bit Diffie-Hellman prime modulus group in the new SA.

crypto map mymap 10 set pfs group15

g) (Optional) Enable Reverse Route Injection (RRI) for any connection based on this crypto map entry.
crypto map map_name seq-num set reverse-route
RRI is done upon configuration and is considered static, remaining in place until the configuration changes
or is removed. The ASA automatically adds static routes to the routing table and announces these routes
to its private network or border routers using OSPF.
Example:
crypto map mymap 10 set reverse-route

Step 6 Apply a crypto map set to an interface for evaluating IPsec traffic:
crypto map map-name interface interface-name
Map-name specifies the name of the crypto map set. Interface-name specifies the name of the interface on
which to enable or disable ISAKMP IKEv1 negotiation.
Example:
In this example, the ASA evaluates the traffic going through the outside interface against the crypto map
mymap to determine whether it needs to be protected.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
34
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create Dynamic Crypto Maps

crypto map mymap interface outside

Create Dynamic Crypto Maps


A dynamic crypto map is a crypto map without all of the parameters configured. It acts as a policy template
where the missing parameters are later dynamically learned, as the result of an IPsec negotiation, to match
the peer requirements. The ASA applies a dynamic crypto map to let a peer negotiate a tunnel if its IP address
is not already identified in a static crypto map. This occurs with the following types of peers:
• Peers with dynamically assigned public IP addresses.
Both LAN-to-LAN and remote access peers can use DHCP to obtain a public IP address. The ASA uses
this address only to initiate the tunnel.
• Peers with dynamically assigned private IP addresses.
Peers requesting remote access tunnels typically have private IP addresses assigned by the headend.
Generally, LAN-to-LAN tunnels have a predetermined set of private networks that are used to configure
static maps and therefore used to establish IPsec SAs.

As an administrator configuring static crypto maps, you might not know the IP addresses that are dynamically
assigned (via DHCP or some other method), and you might not know the private IP addresses of other clients,
regardless of how they were assigned. VPN clients typically do not have static IP addresses; they require a
dynamic crypto map to allow IPsec negotiation to occur. For example, the headend assigns the IP address to
a Cisco VPN client during IKE negotiation, which the client then uses to negotiate IPsec SAs.

Note A dynamic crypto map requires only the transform-set parameter.

Dynamic crypto maps can ease IPsec configuration, and we recommend them for use in networks where the
peers are not always predetermined. Use dynamic crypto maps for Cisco VPN clients (such as mobile users)
and routers that obtain dynamically assigned IP addresses.

Tip Use care when using the any keyword in permit entries in dynamic crypto maps. If the traffic covered by
such a permit entry could include multicast or broadcast traffic, insert deny entries for the appropriate address
range into the ACL. Remember to insert deny entries for network and subnet broadcast traffic, and for any
other traffic that IPsec should not protect.

Dynamic crypto maps work only to negotiate SAs with remote peers that initiate the connection. The ASA
cannot use dynamic crypto maps to initiate connections to a remote peer. With a dynamic crypto map, if
outbound traffic matches a permit entry in an ACL and the corresponding SA does not yet exist, the ASA
drops the traffic.
A crypto map set may include a dynamic crypto map. Dynamic crypto map sets should be the lowest priority
crypto maps in the crypto map set (that is, they should have the highest sequence numbers) so that the ASA
evaluates other crypto maps first. It examines the dynamic crypto map set only when the other (static) map
entries do not match.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
35
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create Dynamic Crypto Maps

Similar to static crypto map sets, a dynamic crypto map set consists of all of the dynamic crypto maps with
the same dynamic-map-name. The dynamic-seq-num differentiates the dynamic crypto maps in a set. If you
configure a dynamic crypto map, insert a permit ACL to identify the data flow of the IPsec peer for the crypto
ACL. Otherwise the ASA accepts any data flow identity the peer proposes.

Caution Do not assign module default routes for traffic to be tunneled to a ASA interface configured with a dynamic
crypto map set. To identify the traffic that should be tunneled, add the ACLs to the dynamic crypto map. Use
care to identify the proper address pools when configuring the ACLs associated with remote access tunnels.
Use Reverse Route Injection to install routes only after the tunnel is up.

Create a crypto dynamic map entry using either single or multiple context mode. You can combine static and
dynamic map entries within a single crypto map set.

Procedure

Step 1 (Optional) Assign an ACL to a dynamic crypto map:


crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num match address access-list-name
This determines which traffic should be protected and not protected. Dynamic-map-name specifies the name
of the crypto map entry that refers to a pre-existing dynamic crypto map. Dynamic-seq-num specifies the
sequence number that corresponds to the dynamic crypto map entry.
Example:
In this example, ACL 101 is assigned to dynamic crypto map dyn1. The map sequence number is 10.

crypto dynamic-map dyn1 10 match address 101

Step 2 Specify which IKEv1 transform sets or IKEv2 proposals are allowed for this dynamic crypto map. List multiple
transform sets or proposals in order of priority (highest priority first) using the command for IKEv1 transform
sets or IKEv2 proposals:
crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num set ikev1 transform-set transform-set-name1,
[transform-set-name2, …transform-set-name9]

crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num set ikev2 ipsec-proposal proposal-name1


[proposal-name2, … proposal-name11]
Dynamic-map-name specifies the name of the crypto map entry that refers to a pre-existing dynamic crypto
map. Dynamic-seq-num specifies the sequence number that corresponds to the dynamic crypto map entry.
The transform-set-name is the name of the transform-set being created or modified. The proposal-name
specifies one or more names of the IPsec proposals for IKEv2.
Example:
In this example for IKEv1, when traffic matches ACL 101, the SA can use either myset1 (first priority) or
myset2 (second priority), depending on which transform set matches the transform sets of the peer.

crypto dynamic-map dyn 10 set ikev1 transform-set myset1 myset2

Step 3 (Optional) Specify the SA lifetime for the crypto dynamic map entry if you want to override the global lifetime
value:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
36
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Provide Site-to-Site Redundancy

crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num set security-association lifetime {seconds


number | kilobytes {number | unlimited}}
Dynamic-map-name specifies the name of the crypto map entry that refers to a pre-existing dynamic crypto
map. Dynamic-seq-num specifies the sequence number that corresponds to the dynamic crypto map entry.
You can set both lifetimes based on time or on data transmitted. However, the data transmitted lifetime applies
to site-to-site VPN only, it does not apply to remote access VPN.
Example:
This example shortens the timed lifetime for dynamic crypto map dyn1 10 to 2700 seconds (45 minutes). The
time volume lifetime is not changed.

crypto dynamic-map dyn1 10 set security-association lifetime seconds 2700

Step 4 (Optional) Specify that IPsec ask for PFS when requesting new SAs for this dynamic crypto map, or should
demand PFS in requests received from the peer:
crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num set pfs [ group1 | group2 | group5 | group7]
Dynamic-map-name specifies the name of the crypto map entry that refers to a pre-existing dynamic crypto
map. Dynamic-seq-num specifies the sequence number that corresponds to the dynamic crypto map entry.
Example:

crypto dynamic-map dyn1 10 set pfs group5

Step 5 Add the dynamic crypto map set into a static crypto map set.
Be sure to set the crypto maps referencing dynamic maps to be the lowest priority entries (highest sequence
numbers) in a crypto map set.
crypto map map-name seq-num ipsec-isakmp dynamic dynamic-map-name
Map-name specifies the name of the crypto map set. Dynamic-map-name specifies the name of the crypto
map entry that refers to a pre-existing dynamic crypto map.
Example:

crypto map mymap 200 ipsec-isakmp dynamic dyn1

Provide Site-to-Site Redundancy


You can define multiple IKEv1 peers by using crypto maps to provide redundancy. This configuration is
useful for site-to-site VPNs. This feature is not supported with IKEv2.
If one peer fails, the ASA establishes a tunnel to the next peer associated with the crypto map. It sends data
to the peer that it has successfully negotiated with, and that peer becomes the active peer. The active peer is
the peer that the ASA keeps trying first for follow-on negotiations until a negotiation fails. At that point the
ASA goes on to the next peer. The ASA cycles back to the first peer when all peers associated with the crypto
map have failed.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
37
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Managing IPsec VPNs

Managing IPsec VPNs


Viewing an IPsec Configuration
These are the commands that you can enter in either single or multiple context mode to view information
about your IPsec configuration.

Table 1: Commands to View IPsec Configuration Information

show running-configuration crypto Displays the entire crypto configuration, including


IPsec, crypto maps, dynamic crypto maps, and
ISAKMP.

show running-config crypto ipsec Displays the complete IPsec configuration.

show running-config crypto isakmp Displays the complete ISAKMP configuration.

show running-config crypto map Displays the complete crypto map configuration.

show running-config crypto dynamic-map Displays the dynamic crypto map configuration.

show all crypto map Displays all of the configuration parameters, including
those with default values.

show crypto ikev2 sa detail Shows the Suite B algorithm support in the Encryption
statistics.

show crypto ipsec sa Shows the Suite B algorithm support and the ESPv3
IPsec output in either single or multiple context mode.

show ipsec stats Shows information about the IPsec subsystem in either
single or multiple context mode. ESPv3 statistics are
shown in TFC packets and valid and invalid ICMP
errors received.

Wait for Active Sessions to Terminate Before Rebooting


You can schedule an ASA reboot to occur only when all active sessions have terminated voluntarily. This
feature is disabled by default.
Use the reload command to reboot the ASA. If you set the reload-wait command, you can use the reload
quick command to override the reload-wait setting. The reload and reload-wait commands are available in
privileged EXEC mode; neither includes the isakmp prefix.

Procedure

To enable waiting for all active sessions to voluntarily terminate before the ASA reboots, perform the following
site-to-site task in either single or multiple context mode:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
38
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Alert Peers Before Disconnecting

crypto isakmp reload-wait


Example:

hostname(config)# crypto isakmp reload-wait

Alert Peers Before Disconnecting


Remote access or LAN-to-LAN sessions can drop for several reasons, such as an ASA shutdown or reboot,
session idle timeout, maximum connection time exceeded, or administrator cut-off.
The ASA can notify qualified peers (in LAN-to-LAN configurations or VPN clients) of sessions that are about
to be disconnected. The peer or client receiving the alert decodes the reason and displays it in the event log
or in a pop-up pane. This feature is disabled by default.
Qualified clients and peers include the following:
• Security appliances with Alerts enabled
• Cisco VPN clients running Version 4.0 or later software (no configuration required)

To enable disconnect notification to IPsec peers, enter the crypto isakmp disconnect-notify command in
either single or multiple context mode.

Clear Security Associations


Certain configuration changes take effect only during the negotiation of subsequent SAs. If you want the new
settings to take effect immediately, clear the existing SAs to reestablish them with the changed configuration.
If the ASA is actively processing IPsec traffic, clear only the portion of the SA database that the configuration
changes affect. Reserve clearing the full SA database for large-scale changes, or when the ASA is processing
a small amount of IPsec traffic.
The following table lists commands you can enter to clear and reinitialize IPsec SAs in either single or multiple
context mode.

Table 2: Commands to Clear and Reinitialize IPsec SAs

clear configure crypto Removes an entire crypto configuration, including


IPsec, crypto maps, dynamic crypto maps, and
ISAKMP.

clear configure crypto ca trustpoint Removes all trustpoints.

clear configure crypto dynamic-map Removes all dynamic crypto maps. Includes keywords
that let you remove specific dynamic crypto maps.

clear configure crypto map Removes all crypto maps. Includes keywords that let
you remove specific crypto maps.

clear configure crypto isakmp Removes the entire ISAKMP configuration.

clear configure crypto isakmp policy Removes all ISAKMP policies or a specific policy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
39
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Clear Crypto Map Configurations

clear crypto isakmp sa Removes the entire ISAKMP SA database.

Clear Crypto Map Configurations


The clear configure crypto command includes arguments that let you remove elements of the crypto
configuration, including IPsec, crypto maps, dynamic crypto maps, CA trustpoints, all certificates, certificate
map configurations, and ISAKMP.
Be aware that if you enter the clear configure crypto command without arguments, you remove the entire
crypto configuration, including all certificates.
For more information, see the clear configure crypto command in the Cisco ASA Series Command Reference.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
40
CHAPTER 2
L2TP over IPsec
This chapter describes how to configure L2TP over IPsec/IKEv1 on the ASA.
• About L2TP over IPsec/IKEv1 VPN, on page 41
• Licensing Requirements for L2TP over IPsec, on page 43
• Prerequisites for Configuring L2TP over IPsec, on page 43
• Guidelines and Limitations, on page 43
• Configuring L2TP over IPsec with CLI, on page 45
• Feature History for L2TP over IPsec, on page 50

About L2TP over IPsec/IKEv1 VPN


Layer 2 Tunneling Protocol (L2TP) is a VPN tunneling protocol that allows remote clients to use the public
IP network to securely communicate with private corporate network servers. L2TP uses PPP over UDP (port
1701) to tunnel the data.
L2TP protocol is based on the client/server model. The function is divided between the L2TP Network Server
(LNS), and the L2TP Access Concentrator (LAC). The LNS typically runs on a network gateway such as a
router, while the LAC can be a dial-up Network Access Server (NAS) or an endpoint device with a bundled
L2TP client such as Microsoft Windows, Apple iPhone, or Android.
The primary benefit of configuring L2TP with IPsec/IKEv1 in a remote access scenario is that remote users
can access a VPN over a public IP network without a gateway or a dedicated line, which enables remote access
from virtually anyplace with POTS. An additional benefit is that no additional client software, such as Cisco
VPN client software, is required.

Note L2TP over IPsec supports only IKEv1. IKEv2 is not supported.

The configuration of L2TP with IPsec/IKEv1 supports certificates using the preshared keys or RSA signature
methods, and the use of dynamic (as opposed to static) crypto maps. This summary of tasks assumes completion
of IKEv1, as well as pre-shared keys or RSA signature configuration. See Chapter 41, “Digital Certificates,”
in the general operations configuration guide for the steps to configure preshared keys, RSA, and dynamic
crypto maps.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
41
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
IPsec Transport and Tunnel Modes

Note L2TP with IPsec on the ASA allows the LNS to interoperate with native VPN clients integrated in such
operating systems as Windows, MAC OS X, Android, and Cisco IOS. Only L2TP with IPsec is supported,
native L2TP itself is not supported on ASA. The minimum IPsec security association lifetime supported by
the Windows client is 300 seconds. If the lifetime on the ASA is set to less than 300 seconds, the Windows
client ignores it and replaces it with a 300 second lifetime.

IPsec Transport and Tunnel Modes


By default, the ASA uses IPsec tunnel mode—the entire original IP datagram is encrypted, and it becomes
the payload in a new IP packet. This mode allows a network device, such as a router, to act as an IPsec proxy.
That is, the router performs encryption on behalf of the hosts. The source router encrypts packets and forwards
them along the IPsec tunnel. The destination router decrypts the original IP datagram and forwards it on to
the destination system. The major advantage of tunnel mode is that the end systems do not need to be modified
to receive the benefits of IPsec. Tunnel mode also protects against traffic analysis; with tunnel mode, an
attacker can only determine the tunnel endpoints and not the true source and destination of the tunneled
packets, even if they are the same as the tunnel endpoints.
However, the Windows L2TP/IPsec client uses IPsec transport mode—only the IP payload is encrypted, and
the original IP headers are left intact. This mode has the advantages of adding only a few bytes to each packet
and allowing devices on the public network to see the final source and destination of the packet. The following
figure illustrates the differences between IPsec tunnel and transport modes.
Figure 2: IPsec in Tunnel and Transport Modes

In order for Windows L2TP and IPsec clients to connect to the ASA, you must configure IPsec transport mode
for a transform set using the crypto ipsec transform-set trans_name mode transport command. This
command is used in the configuration procedure.

Note ASA cannot push more than 28 ACE in split-tunnel access-list.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
42
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Licensing Requirements for L2TP over IPsec

With this transport capability, you can enable special processing (for example, QoS) on the intermediate
network based on the information in the IP header. However, the Layer 4 header is encrypted, which limits
the examination of the packet. Unfortunately, if the IP header is transmitted in clear text, transport mode
allows an attacker to perform some traffic analysis.

Licensing Requirements for L2TP over IPsec

Note This feature is not available on No Payload Encryption models.

IPsec remote access VPN using IKEv2 requires an AnyConnect Plus or Apex license, available separately.
IPsec remote access VPN using IKEv1 and IPsec site-to-site VPN using IKEv1 or IKEv2 uses the Other VPN
license that comes with the base license. See Cisco ASA Series Feature Licenses for maximum values per
model.

Prerequisites for Configuring L2TP over IPsec


Configuring L2TP over IPsec has the following prerequisites:
• Group Policy-You can configure the default group policy (DfltGrpPolicy) or a user-defined group policy
for L2TP/IPsec connections. In either case, the group policy must be configured to use the L2TP/IPsec
tunneling protocol. If the L2TP/IPsec tunning protocol is not configured for your user-defined group
policy, configure the DfltGrpPolicy for the L2TP/IPsec tunning protocol and allow your user-defined
group policy to inherit this attribute.
• Connection Profile-You need to configure the default connection proflie (tunnel group), DefaultRAGroup,
if you are performing “pre-shared key” authentication. If you are performing certificate-based
authentication, you can use a user-defined connection profile that can be chosen based on certificate
identifiers.
• IP connectivity needs to be established between the peers. To test connectivity, try to ping the IP address
of the ASA from your endpoint and try to ping the IP address of your endpoint from the ASA.
• Make sure that UDP port 1701 is not blocked anywhere along the path of the connection.
• If a Windows 7 endpoint device authenticates using a certificate that specifies a SHA signature type, the
signature type must match that of the ASA, either SHA1 or SHA2.

Guidelines and Limitations


This section includes the guidelines and limitations for this feature.

Context Mode Guidelines


Supported in single context mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
43
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Guidelines and Limitations

Firewall Mode Guidelines


Supported only in routed firewall mode. Transparent mode is not supported.

Failover Guidelines
L2TP over IPsec sessions are not supported by stateful failover.

IPv6 Guidelines
There is no native IPv6 tunnel setup support for L2TP over IPsec.

Software Limitation on All Platforms


We currently only support 4096 L2TP over IPsec tunnels.

Authentication Guidelines
The ASA only supports the PPP authentications PAP and Microsoft CHAP, Versions 1 and 2, on the local
database. EAP and CHAP are performed by proxy authentication servers. Therefore, if a remote user belongs
to a tunnel group configured with the authentication eap-proxy or authentication chap commands, and the
ASA is configured to use the local database, that user will not be able to connect.

Supported PPP Authentication Types


L2TP over IPsec connections on the ASA support only the PPP authentication types as shown:

Table 3: AAA Server Support and PPP Authentication Types

AAA Server Type Supported PPP Authentication Types

LOCAL PAP, MSCHAPv1, MSCHAPv2

RADIUS PAP, CHAP, MSCHAPv1, MSCHAPv2, EAP-Proxy

TACACS+ PAP, CHAP, MSCHAPv1

LDAP PAP

NT PAP

Kerberos PAP

SDI SDI

Table 4: PPP Authentication Type Characteristics

Keyword Authentication Type Characteristics

CHAP In response to the server challenge,


chap the client returns the encrypted
[challenge plus password] with a
cleartext username. This protocol
is more secure than the PAP, but it
does not encrypt data.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
44
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuring L2TP over IPsec with CLI

Keyword Authentication Type Characteristics

EAP Enables EAP which permits the


eap-proxy security appliance to proxy the PPP
authentication process to an
external RADIUS authentication
server.

Microsoft CHAP, Version 1 Similar to CHAP but more secure


ms-chap-v1 in that the server stores and
ms-chap-v2 Microsoft CHAP, Version, 2
compares only encrypted passwords
rather than cleartext passwords as
in CHAP. This protocol also
generates a key for data encryption
by MPPE.

PAP Passes cleartext username and


pap password during authentication and
is not secure.

Configuring L2TP over IPsec with CLI


You must configure IKEv1 (ISAKMP) policy settings to allow native VPN clients to make a VPN connection
to the ASA using the L2TP over IPsec protocol.
• IKEv1 phase 1—3DES encryption with SHA1 hash method.
• IPsec phase 2—3DES or AES encryption with MD5 or SHA hash method.
• PPP Authentication—PAP, MS-CHAPv1, or MSCHAPv2 (preferred).
• Pre-shared key (only for iPhone).

Procedure

Step 1 Create a transform set with a specific ESP encryption type and authentication type.
crypto ipsec ike_version transform-set transform_name ESP_Encryption_Type ESP_Authentication_Type
Example:
crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set my-transform-set-ikev1 esp-des esp-sha-hmac

Step 2 Instruct IPsec to use transport mode rather than tunnel mode.
crypto ipsec ike_version transform-set trans_name mode transport
Example:
crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set my-transform-set-ikev1 mode transport

Step 3 Specify L2TP/IPsec as the vpn tunneling protocol.


vpn-tunnel-protocol tunneling_protocol

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
45
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuring L2TP over IPsec with CLI

Example:
hostname(config)# group-policy DfltGrpPolicy attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-tunnel-protocol l2tp-ipsec

Step 4 (Optional) Instruct the adaptive security appliance to send DNS server IP addresses to the client for the group
policy.
dns value [none | IP_Primary | IP_Secondary]
Example:
hostname(config)# group-policy DfltGrpPolicy attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# dns value 209.165.201.1 209.165.201.2

Step 5 (Optional) Instruct the adaptive security appliance to send WINS server IP addresses to the client for the group
policy.
wins-server value [none | IP_primary [IP_secondary]]
Example:
hostname(config)# group-policy DfltGrpPolicy attributes
hostname (config-group-policy)# wins-server value 209.165.201.3 209.165.201.4

Step 6 (Optional) Create an IP address pool.


ip local pool pool_name starting_address-ending_address mask subnet_mask
Example:
hostname(config)# ip local pool sales_addresses 10.4.5.10-10.4.5.20 mask 255.255.255.0

Step 7 (Optional) Associate the pool of IP addresses with the connection profile (tunnel group).
address-pool pool_name
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool sales_addresses

Step 8 Create a connection profile (tunnel group).


tunnel-group name type remote-access
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group sales-tunnel type remote-access

Step 9 Link the name of a group policy to the connection profile (tunnel group).
default-group-policy name
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy DfltGrpPolicy

Step 10 Specify a method to authenticate users attempting L2TP over IPsec connections, for the connection profile
(tunnel group). If you are not using the ASA to perform local authentication, and you want to fallback to local
authentication, add LOCAL to the end of the command.
authentication-server-group server_group [local]
Example:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
46
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuring L2TP over IPsec with CLI

hostname(config)# tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group sales_server LOCAL

Step 11 Specify a method to authenticate users attempting L2TP over IPsec connections, for the connection profile
(tunnel group). If you are not using the ASA to perform local authentication, and you want to fallback to local
authentication, add LOCAL to the end of the command.
authentication auth_type
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group name ppp-attributes
hostname(config-ppp)# authentication ms-chap-v1

Step 12 Set the pre-shared key for your connection profile (tunnel group).
tunnel-group tunnel group name ipsec-attributes
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev1 pre-shared-key cisco123

Step 13 (Optional) Generate a AAA accounting start and stop record for an L2TP session for the connection profile
(tunnel group).
accounting-server-group aaa_server_group
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group sales_tunnel general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group sales_aaa_server

Step 14 Configure the interval (in seconds) between hello messages. The range is 10 through 300 seconds. The default
interval is 60 seconds.
l2tp tunnel hello seconds
Example:
hostname(config)# l2tp tunnel hello 100

Step 15 (Optional) Enable NAT traversal so that ESP packets can pass through one or more NAT devices.
If you expect multiple L2TP clients behind a NAT device to attempt L2TP over IPsec connections to the
adaptive security appliance, you must enable NAT traversal.
crypto isakmp nat-traversal seconds
To enable NAT traversal globally, check that ISAKMP is enabled (you can enable it with the crypto isakmp
enable command) in global configuration mode, and then use the crypto isakmp nat-traversal command.
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 enable
hostname(config)# crypto isakmp nat-traversal 1500

Step 16 (Optional) Configure tunnel group switching. The goal of tunnel group switching is to give users a better
chance at establishing a VPN connection when they authenticate using a proxy authentication server. Tunnel
group is synonymous with connection profile.
strip-group
strip-realm

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
47
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Creating IKE Policies to Respond to Windows 7 Proposals

Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# strip-group
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# strip-realm

Step 17 (Optional) Create a user with the username jdoe, the password j!doe1. The mschap option specifies that
the password is converted to Unicode and hashed using MD4 after you enter it.
This step is needed only if you are using a local user database.
username name password password mschap
Example:
asa2(config)# username jdoe password j!doe1 mschap

Step 18 Create the IKE Policy for Phase 1 and assign it a number.
crypto ikev1 policy priority
group Diffie-Hellman Group
There are several different parameters of the IKE policy that you can configure. You can also specify a
Diffie-Hellman Group for the policy. The isakamp policy is used by the ASA to complete the IKE negotiation.
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 policy 5
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)#

Creating IKE Policies to Respond to Windows 7 Proposals


Windows 7 L2TP/IPsec clients send several IKE policy proposals to establish a VPN connection with the
ASA. Define one of the following IKE policies to facilitate connections from Windows 7 VPN native clients.
Follow the procedure Configuring L2TP over IPsec for ASA. Add the additional steps in this task to configure
the IKE policy for Windows 7 native VPN clients.

Procedure

Step 1 Display the attributes and the number of any existing IKE policies.
Example:
hostname(config)# show run crypto ikev1

Step 2 Configure an IKE policy. The number argument specifies the number of the IKE policy you are configuring.
This number was listed in the output of the show run crypto ikev1 command.
crypto ikev1 policy number

Step 3 Set the authentication method the ASA uses to establish the identity of each IPsec peer to use preshared keys.
Example:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
48
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuration Example for L2TP over IPsec

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# authentication pre-share

Step 4 Choose a symmetric encryption method that protects data transmitted between two IPsec peers. For Windows
7, choose 3des or aes for 128-bit AES, or aes-256.
encryption {3des|aes|aes-256}

Step 5 Choose the hash algorithm that ensures data integrity. For Windows 7, specify sha for the SHA-1 algorithm.
Example:
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# hash sha

Step 6 Choose the Diffie-Hellman group identifier. You can specify 5 for aes, aes-256, or 3des encryption types.
You can specify 2 only for 3des encryption types .
Example:
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# group 5

Step 7 Specify the SA lifetime in seconds. For Windows 7, specify 86400 seconds to represent 24 hours.
Example:
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# lifetime 86400

Configuration Example for L2TP over IPsec


The following example shows configuration file commands that ensure ASA compatibility with a native VPN
client on any operating system:
ip local pool sales_addresses 209.165.202.129-209.165.202.158
group-policy sales_policy internal
group-policy sales_policy attributes
wins-server value 209.165.201.3 209.165.201.4
dns-server value 209.165.201.1 209.165.201.2
vpn-tunnel-protocol l2tp-ipsec
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup general-attributes
default-group-policy sales_policy
address-pool sales_addresses
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup ipsec-attributes
pre-shared-key *
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup ppp-attributes
no authentication pap
authentication chap
authentication ms-chap-v1
authentication ms-chap-v2
crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set trans esp-des esp-sha-hmac

crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set trans mode transport


crypto dynamic-map dyno 10 set ikev1 transform-set trans
crypto map vpn 20 ipsec-isakmp dynamic dyno
crypto map vpn interface outside
crypto ikev1 enable outside
crypto ikev1 policy 10
authentication pre-share
encryption 3des

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
49
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Feature History for L2TP over IPsec

hash sha
group 2

lifetime 86400

Feature History for L2TP over IPsec


Feature Name Releases Feature Information

L2TP over IPsec 7.2(1) L2TP over IPsec provides the


capability to deploy and administer
an L2TP VPN solution alongside
the IPsec VPN and firewall services
in a single platform.
The primary benefit of configuring
L2TP over IPsec in a remote access
scenario is that remote users can
access a VPN over a public IP
network without a gateway or a
dedicated line, which enables
remote access from virtually
anyplace with POTS. An additional
benefit is that the only client
requirement for VPN access is the
use of Windows with Microsoft
Dial-Up Networking (DUN). No
additional client software, such as
Cisco VPN client software, is
required.
The following commands were
introduced or modified:
authentication eap-proxy,
authentication ms-chap-v1,
authentication ms-chap-v2,
authentication pap, l2tp tunnel
hello, vpn-tunnel-protocol
l2tp-ipsec.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
50
CHAPTER 3
General VPN Parameters
The ASA implementation of virtual private networking includes useful features that do not fit neatly into
categories. This chapter describes some of these features.
• Guidelines and Limitations, on page 51
• Configure IPsec to Bypass ACLs, on page 52
• Permitting Intra-Interface Traffic (Hairpinning), on page 52
• Setting Maximum Active IPsec or SSL VPN Sessions, on page 54
• Use Client Update to Ensure Acceptable IPsec Client Revision Levels, on page 54
• Implement NAT-Assigned IP to Public IP Connection, on page 56
• Configure VPN Session Limits, on page 58
• Using an Identify Certificate When Negotiating, on page 59
• Configure the Pool of Cryptographic Cores, on page 60
• Configure Dynamic Split Tunneling, on page 61
• Viewing Active VPN Sessions, on page 62
• About ISE Policy Enforcement, on page 64
• Configure Advanced SSL Settings, on page 68
• Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows, on page 73

Guidelines and Limitations


This section includes the guidelines and limitations for this feature.

Context Mode Guidelines


Supported in single and multiple context mode. In the appropriate release of the ASA General Operations
CLI Configuration Guide, refer to Guidelines for Multiple Context Mode for the list of what is not supported
in multiple context mode, and New Features which gives the breakdown of what was added throughout the
releases.

Firewall Mode Guidelines


Supported only in routed firewall mode. Transparent mode is not supported.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
51
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure IPsec to Bypass ACLs

Configure IPsec to Bypass ACLs


To permit any packets that come from an IPsec tunnel without checking ACLs for the source and destination
interfaces, enter the sysopt connection permit-vpn command in global configuration mode.
You might want to bypass interface ACLs for IPsec traffic if you use a separate VPN concentrator behind the
ASA and want to maximize the ASA performance. Typically, you create an ACL that permits IPsec packets
by using the access-list command and apply it to the source interface. Using an ACL allows you to specify
the exact traffic you want to allow through the ASA.
The following example enables IPsec traffic through the ASA without checking ACLs:

hostname(config)# sysopt connection permit-vpn

Note Decrypted through-traffic is permitted from the client despite having an access group on the outside interface,
which calls a deny ip any any ACL, while no sysopt connection permit-vpn is configured.
Trying to control access to the protected network via site-to-site or remote access VPN using the no sysopt
permit-vpn command in conjunction with an access control list (ACL) on the outside interface are not
successful.
sysopt connection permit-vpn will bypass ACLs (both in and out) on interface where crypto map for that
interesting traffic is enabled, along with egress (out) ACLs of all other interfaces, but not the ingress (in)
ACLs.
In this situation, when management-access inside is enabled, the ACL is not applied, and users can still connect
to the ASA using SSH. Traffic to hosts on the inside network is blocked correctly by the ACL, but decrypted
through-traffic to the inside interface is not blocked.
The ssh and http commands are of a higher priority than the ACLs. To deny SSH, Telnet, or ICMP traffic to
the box from the VPN session, use ssh, telnet and icmp commands.

Permitting Intra-Interface Traffic (Hairpinning)


The ASA includes a feature that lets a VPN client send IPsec-protected traffic to another VPN user by allowing
that traffic in and out of the same interface. This is also called “hairpinning”, which can be thought of as VPN
spokes (clients) connecting through a VPN hub (the ASA).
Hairpinning can also redirect incoming VPN traffic back out through the same interface as unencrypted traffic.
This can be useful, for example, to a VPN client that does not have split tunneling, but needs to both access
a VPN and browse the web.
The figure below shows VPN Client 1 sending secure IPsec traffic to VPN Client 2 while also sending
unencrypted traffic to a public web server.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
52
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
NAT Considerations for Intra-Interface Traffic

Figure 3: VPN Client Using Intra-Interface Feature for Hairpinning

To configure this feature, use the same-security-traffic command in global configuration mode with its
intra-interface argument.
The command syntax is same-security-traffic permit {inter-interface | intra-interface}.
The following example shows how to enable intra-interface traffic:

hostname(config)# same-security-traffic permit intra-interface


hostname(config)#

Note Use the same-security-traffic command with the inter-interface argument to permit communication between
interfaces with the same security level. This feature is not specific to IPsec connections. For more information,
see the “Configuring Interface Parameters” chapter of this guide.

To use hairpinning, you must apply the proper NAT rules to the ASA interface, as described in NAT
Considerations for Intra-Interface Traffic.

NAT Considerations for Intra-Interface Traffic


For the ASA to send unencrypted traffic back out through the interface, you must enable NAT for the interface
so that publicly routable addresses replace your private IP addresses (unless you already use public IP addresses
in your local IP address pool). The following example applies an interface PAT rule to traffic sourced from
the client IP pool:

hostname(config)# ip local pool clientpool 192.168.0.10-192.168.0.100


hostname(config)# object network vpn_nat
hostname(config-network-object)# subnet 192.168.0.0 255.255.255.0
hostname(config-network-object)# nat (outside,outside) interface

When the ASA sends encrypted VPN traffic back out this same interface, however, NAT is optional. The
VPN-to-VPN hairpinning works with or without NAT. To apply NAT to all outgoing traffic, implement only

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
53
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Setting Maximum Active IPsec or SSL VPN Sessions

the commands above. To exempt the VPN-to-VPN traffic from NAT, add commands (to the example above)
that implement NAT exemption for VPN-to-VPN traffic, such as:

hostname(config)# nat (outside,outside) source static vpn_nat vpn_nat destination static


vpn_nat vpn_nat

For more information on NAT rules, see the “Applying NAT” chapter of this guide.

Setting Maximum Active IPsec or SSL VPN Sessions


To limit VPN sessions to a lower value than the ASA allows, enter the vpn-sessiondb command in global
configuration mode:
vpn-sessiondb {max-anyconnect-premium-or-essentials-limit <number> | max-other-vpn-limit <number>}
The max-anyconnect-premium-or-essentials-limit keyword specifies the maximum number of AnyConnect
sessions, from 1 to the maximum sessions allowed by the license.

Note The correct licensing, term, tier, and user count is no longer determined with these commands. Refer to the
AnyConnect Ordering Guide: http://www.cisco.com/c/dam/en/us/products/collateral/security/anyconnect-og.pdf

The max-other-vpn-limit keyword specifies the maximum number of VPN sessions other than AnyConnect
client sessions, from 1 to the maximum sessions allowed by the license. This includes the Cisco VPN client
(IPsec IKEv1) and Lan-to-Lan VPN sessions.
This limit affects the calculated load percentage for VPN Load Balancing.
The following example shows how to set a maximum Anyconnect VPN session limit of 450:

hostname(config)# vpn-sessiondb max-anyconnect-premium-or-essentials-limit 450


hostname(config)#

Use Client Update to Ensure Acceptable IPsec Client Revision


Levels

Note The information in this section applies to IPsec connections only.

The client update feature lets administrators at a central location automatically notify VPN client users that
it is time to update the VPN client software.
Remote users might be using outdated VPN software or hardware client versions. You can use the client-update
command at any time to enable updating client revisions; specify the types and revision numbers of clients
to which the update applies; provide a URL or IP address from which to get the update; and, in the case of
Windows clients, optionally notify users that they should update their VPN client version. For Windows

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
54
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Use Client Update to Ensure Acceptable IPsec Client Revision Levels

clients, you can provide a mechanism for users to accomplish that update. This command applies only to the
IPsec remote-access tunnel-group type.
To perform a client update, enter the client-update command in either general configuration mode or
tunnel-group ipsec-attributes configuration mode. If the client is already running a software version on the
list of revision numbers, it does not need to update its software. If the client is not running a software version
on the list, it should update. The following procedure explains how to perform a client update:

Procedure

Step 1 In global configuration mode, enable client update by entering this command:

hostname(config)# client-update enable


hostname(config)#

Step 2 In global configuration mode, specify the parameters for the client update that you want to apply to all clients
of a particular type. That is, specify the type of client, the URL or IP address from which to get the updated
image, and the acceptable revision number or numbers for that client. You can specify up to four revision
numbers, separated by commas.
If the user’s client revision number matches one of the specified revision numbers, there is no need to update
the client. This command specifies the client update values for all clients of the specified type across the entire
ASA.
Use this syntax:

hostname(config)# client-update type type url url-string rev-nums rev-numbers


hostname(config)#

The available client types are win9X (includes Windows 95, Windows 98 and Windows ME platforms),
winnt (includes Windows NT 4.0, Windows 2000 and Windows XP platforms), windows (includes all
Windows based platforms).
If the client is already running a software version on the list of revision numbers, it does not need to update
its software. If the client is not running a software version on the list, it should update. You can specify up to
three of these client update entries. The keyword windows covers all of the allowable Windows platforms.
If you specify windows, do not specify the individual Windows client types.
Note For all Windows clients, you must use the protocol http:// or https:// as the prefix for the URL.
The following example configures client update parameters for the remote access tunnel group. It
designates the revision number 4.6.1 and the URL for retrieving the update, which is
https://support/updates.

hostname(config)# client-update type windows url https://support/updates/ rev-nums 4.6.1


hostname(config)#

Alternatively, you can configure client update just for individual tunnel groups, rather than for all clients of
a particular type. (See Step 3.)
Note You can have the browser automatically start an application by including the application name at
the end of the URL; for example: https://support/updates/vpnclient.exe.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
55
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Implement NAT-Assigned IP to Public IP Connection

Step 3 Define a set of client-update parameters for a particular ipsec-ra tunnel group.
In tunnel-group ipsec-attributes mode, specify the tunnel group name and its type, the URL or IP address from
which to get the updated image, and a revision number. If the user’s client’s revision number matches one of
the specified revision numbers, there is no need to update the client, for example, for a Windows client enter
this command:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp type ipsec-ra


hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# client-update type windows url https://support/updates/
rev-nums 4.6.1
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Step 4 (Optional) Send a notice to active users with outdated Windows clients that their client needs updating. For
these users, a pop-up window appears, offering them the opportunity to launch a browser and download the
updated software from the site that you specified in the URL. The only part of this message that you can
configure is the URL. (See Step 2 or 3.) Users who are not active get a notification message the next time
they log on. You can send this notice to all active clients on all tunnel groups, or you can send it to clients on
a particular tunnel group. For example, to notify all active clients on all tunnel groups, enter the following
command in privileged EXEC mode:

hostname# client-update all


hostname#

If the user’s client’s revision number matches one of the specified revision numbers, there is no need to update
the client, and no notification message is sent to the user.

What to do next

Note If you specify the client-update type as windows (specifying all Windows-based platforms) and later want to
enter a client-update type of win9x or winnt for the same entity, you must first remove the windows client
type with the no form of the command, then use new client-update commands to specify the new client types.

Implement NAT-Assigned IP to Public IP Connection


In rare situations, you might want to use a VPN peer’s real IP address on the inside network instead of an
assigned local IP address. Normally with VPN, the peer is given an assigned local IP address to access the
inside network. However, you might want to translate the local IP address back to the peer-s real public address
if, for example, your inside servers and network security is based on the peer’s real IP address.
Cisco ASA 55xx introduced a way to translate the VPN client’s assigned IP address on the internal/protected
network to its public (source) IP address. This feature supports the scenario where the target servers/services
on the internal network and network security policy require communication with the VPN client’s public/source
IP instead of the assigned IP on the internal corporate network.
You can enable this feature on one interface per tunnel group. Object NAT rules are dynamically added and
deleted when the VPN session is established or disconnected.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
56
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Displaying VPN NAT Policies

Because of routing issues, we do not recommend using this feature unless you know you need it.
• Only supports legacy (IKEv1) and AnyConnect clients.
• Return traffic to the public IP addresses must be routed back to the ASA so the NAT policy and VPN
policy can be applied.
• Only supports IPv4 assigned and public addresses.
• Multiple peers behind a NAT/PAT device are not supported.
• Does not support load balancing (because of routing issue).
• Does not support roaming.

Procedure

Step 1 In global configuration mode, enter tunnel general.


Step 2 Use this syntax to enable the address translation:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# nat-assigned-to-public-ip interface

This command dynamically installs NAT policies of the assigned IP address to the public IP address of the
source. The interface determines where to apply NAT.

Step 3 Use this syntax to disable the address translation:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# no nat-assigned-to-public-ip

Displaying VPN NAT Policies


Address translation uses the underlying object NAT mechanisms; therefore, the VPN NAT policy displays
just like manually configured object NAT policies. This example uses 95.1.226.4 as the assigned IP and
75.1.224.21 as the peer’s public IP:

hostname# show nat


Auto NAT Policies (Section 2)
1 (outside) to (inside) source static _vpn_nat_95.1.226.4 75.1.224.21
translate_hits = 315, untranslate_hits = 315

prompt# show nat detail

Auto NAT Policies (Section 2)


1 (outside) to (inside) source static _vpn_nat_95.1.226.4 75.1.224.21
translate_hits = 315, untranslate_hits = 315
Source - Origin: 95.1.226.4/32, Translated: 75.1.224.21/32

Outside is the interface to which the AnyConnect client connects and inside is the interface specific to the
new tunnel group.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
57
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure VPN Session Limits

Note Since VPN NAT policies are dynamic and not added to the configuration, the VPN NAT object and NAT
policy are hidden from the show run object and show run nat reports.

Configure VPN Session Limits


You can run as many IPsec and SSL VPN sessions as your platform and ASA license supports. To view the
licensing information including maximum sessions for your ASA, enter the show version command in global
configuration mode and look for the licensing section. The following example shows the command and the
licensing information from the output of this command; the other output is redacted for clarity.

hostname(config)# show version


...
Licensed features for this platform:
Maximum Physical Interfaces : Unlimited perpetual
Maximum VLANs : 500 perpetual
Inside Hosts : Unlimited perpetual
Failover : Active/Active perpetual
Encryption-DES : Enabled perpetual
Encryption-3DES-AES : Enabled perpetual
Security Contexts : 100 perpetual
Carrier : Enabled perpetual
AnyConnect Premium Peers : 5000 perpetual
AnyConnect Essentials : 5000 perpetual
Other VPN Peers : 5000 perpetual
Total VPN Peers : 5000 perpetual
AnyConnect for Mobile : Enabled perpetual
AnyConnect for Cisco VPN Phone : Enabled perpetual
Advanced Endpoint Assessment : Enabled perpetual
Shared License : Disabled perpetual
Total TLS Proxy Sessions : 3000 perpetual
Botnet Traffic Filter : Disabled perpetual
IPS Module : Disabled perpetual
Cluster : Enabled perpetual
Cluster Members : 2 perpetual

This platform has an ASA5555 VPN Premium license.

Show License Resource Allocation


Use the following command to show the resource allocation:
asa2(config)# sh resource allocation
Resource Total % of Avail
Conns[rate] 100(U) 0.00%
Inspects[rate] unlimited
Syslogs[rate] unlimited
Conns unlimited
Hosts unlimited
IPsec unlimited
Mac-addresses unlimited
ASDM 10 5.00%
SSH 10 10.00%
Telnet 10 10.0%
Xlates unlimited

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
58
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Show License Resource Usage

AnyConnect 1000 10%


AnyConnectBurst 200 2%
OtherVPN 2000 20%
OtherVPNBurst 1000 10%

Show License Resource Usage


Use the following command to show resource usage:

Note You can also use the sh resource usage system controller all 0 command to show system level usage with
the limit as the platform limit.
ASA(config-ca-trustpoint)# sh resource usage
Resource Current Peak Limit Denied Context
Conns 1 16 280000 0 System
Hosts 2 10 N/A 0 System
AnyConnect 2 25 1000 0 cust1
AnyConnectBurst 0 0 200 0 cust1
OtherVPN 1 1 2000 0 cust2
OtherVPNBurst 0 0 1000 0 cust2

Limit VPN Sessions


To limit AnyConnect VPN sessions (either IPsec/IKEv2 or SSL) to a lower value than the ASA allows, use
the vpn-sessiondb max-anyconnect-premium-or-essentials-limit command in global configuration mode. To
remove the session limit, use the no version of this command.
If the ASA license allows 500 SSL VPN sessions, and you want to limit the number of AnyConnect VPN
sessions to 250, enter the following command:
hostname(config)# vpn-sessiondb max-anyconnect-premium-or-essentials-limit 250
hostname(config)#

To remove the session limit, use the no version of this command.:


hostname(config)# no vpn-sessiondb max-anyconnect-premium-or-essentials-limit 250
hostname(config)#

Using an Identify Certificate When Negotiating


The ASA needs to use an identity certificate when negotiating the IKEv2 tunnel with AnyConnect clients.
For ikev2 remote access trustpoint configuration, use the following commands

crypto ikev2 remote-access trustpoint <name> [line<number>]

Using this command allows the AnyConnect client to support group selection for the end user. You can
configure two trustpoints at the same time: two RSA, two ECDSA, or one of each. The ASA scans the
configured trustpoint list and chooses the first one that the client supports. If ECDSA is preferred, you should
configure that trustpoint before the RSA trustpoint.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
59
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure the Pool of Cryptographic Cores

The line number option specifies where in the line number you want the trustpoint inserted. Typically, this
option is used to insert a trustpoint at the top without removing and re-adding the other line. If a line is not
specified, the ASA adds the trustpoint at the end of the list.
If you try to add a trustpoint that already exists, you receive an error. If you use the no crypto ikev2
remote-access trustpoint command without specifying which trustpoint name to remove, all trustpoint
configuration is removed.

Configure the Pool of Cryptographic Cores


You can change the allocation of cryptographic cores on Symmetric Multi-Processing (SMP) platforms to
increase the throughput of AnyConnect TLS/DTLS traffic. These changes can accelerate the SSL VPN datapath
and provide customer-visible performance gains in AnyConnect, smart tunnels, and port forwarding. These
steps describe configuring the pool of cryptographic cores in either single or multiple context mode.
Cryptographic core re-balancing is available on the following platforms:
• 5585-X
• 5545-X
• 5555-X
• ASASM

Procedure

Specify how to allocate crypto accelerator processors:


crypto engine accelerator-bias
• balanced—Equally distributes cryptography hardware resources (Admin/SSL and IPsec cores).
• ipsec—Allocates cryptography hardware resources to favor IPsec (includes SRTP encrypted voice traffic).
• ssl—Allocates cryptography hardware resources to favor Admin/SSL.

Example:

hostname(config)# crypto engine ?

configure mode commands/options:


accelerator-bias
Specify how to allocate crypto accelerator processors

hostname(config)# crypto engine accelerator-bias ?


configure mode commands/options
balanced - Equally distribute crypto hardware resources
ipsec - Allocate crypto hardware resources to favor IPsec/Encrypted Voice (SRTP)
ssl - Allocate crypto hardware resources to favor SSL

hostname(config)# crypto engine accelerator-bias ssl

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
60
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Dynamic Split Tunneling

Configure Dynamic Split Tunneling


With dynamic split tunneling, you can dynamically provision split exclude tunneling after tunnel establishment
based on the host DNS domain name. Dynamic split tunneling is configured by creating a custom attribute
and adding it to a group policy.

Before you begin


To use this feature, you must have AnyConnect release 4.5 (or later). Refer to About Dynamic Split Tunneling
for further explanation.

Procedure

Command or Action Purpose


Step 1 Define the custom attribute type in the
WebVPN context with the following
command:anyconnect-custom-attr
dynamic-split-exclude-domains
description dynamic split exclude
domains

Step 2 Define the custom attribute names for each


cloud/web service that needs access by the
client outside the VPN tunnel. For example,
add Google_domains to represent a list of DNS
domain names pertaining to Google web
services. The attribute value contains the list of
domain names to exclude from the VPN tunnel
and must be comma-separated-values (CSV)
format as the following:
anyconnect-custom-data
dynamic-split-exclude-domains webex.com,
webexconnect.com, tags.tiqcdn.com

Step 3 Attach the previously defined custom attribute


to a certain policy group with the following
command, executed in the group-policy
attributes context: anyconnect-custom
dynamic-split-exclude-domains value
webex_service_domains

What to do next
If split include tunneling is configured, a dynamic split exclusion is enforced only if at least one of the DNS
response IP addresses is part of the split-include network. If there is no overlap between any of the DNS
response IP addresses and any of the split-include networks, enforcing dynamic split exclusion is not necessary
since traffic matching all DNS response IP addresses is already excluded from tunneling.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
61
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Viewing Active VPN Sessions

Viewing Active VPN Sessions


The following topics explain how to view VPN session information.

Viewing Active AnyConnect Sessions by IP Address Type


To view active AnyConnect sessions using the command line interface, enter the show vpn-sessiondb
anyconnect filter p-ipversion or show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect filter a-ipversion command in privileged
EXEC mode.
• Display the active AnyConnect sessions which are filtered by the endpoint’s public IPv4 or IPv6 address.
The public address is the address assigned to the endpoint by the enterprise.

show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect filter p-ipversion {v4 | v6}


• Display the active AnyConnect sessions which are filtered by the endpoint’s assigned IPv4 or IPv6
address. The assigned address is the address assigned to the AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client by the
ASA.

show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect filter a-ipversion {v4 | v6}

Example Output from show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect filter p-ipversion [v4 | v6] command

hostname(config)# show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect filter p-ipversion v4

Session Type: AnyConnect

Username : user1 Index : 40


Assigned IP : 192.168.17.10 Public IP : 198.51.100.1
Protocol : AnyConnect-Parent SSL-Tunnel
License : AnyConnect Premium
Encryption : AnyConnect-Parent: (1)none SSL-Tunnel: (1)RC4
Hashing : AnyConnect-Parent: (1)none SSL-Tunnel: (1)SHA1
Bytes Tx : 10570 Bytes Rx : 8085
Group Policy : GroupPolicy_SSLACCLIENT
Tunnel Group : SSLACCLIENT
Login Time : 15:17:12 UTC Mon Oct 22 2012
Duration : 0h:00m:09s
Inactivity : 0h:00m:00s
NAC Result : Unknown
VLAN Mapping : N/A VLAN : none

Output from show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect filter a-ipversion [v4 | v6] command

hostname(config)# show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect filter a-ipversion v6

Session Type: AnyConnect

Username : user1 Index : 45


Assigned IP : 192.168.17.10
Public IP : 2001:DB8:8:1:90eb:3fe5:9eea:fb29
Assigned IPv6: 2001:DB8:9:1::24

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
62
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Viewing Active Clientless SSL VPN Sessions by IP Address Type

Protocol : AnyConnect-Parent SSL-Tunnel


License : AnyConnect Premium
Encryption : AnyConnect-Parent: (1)none SSL-Tunnel: (1)RC4
Hashing : AnyConnect-Parent: (1)none SSL-Tunnel: (1)SHA1
Bytes Tx : 10662 Bytes Rx : 17248
Group Policy : GroupPolicy_SSL_IPv6 Tunnel Group : SSL_IPv6
Login Time : 17:42:42 UTC Mon Oct 22 2012
Duration : 0h:00m:33s
Inactivity : 0h:00m:00s
NAC Result : Unknown
VLAN Mapping : N/A VLAN : none

Viewing Active Clientless SSL VPN Sessions by IP Address Type


To view active clientless SSL VPN sessions using the command line interface, enter the show vpn-sessiondb
webvpn filter ipversion command in privileged EXEC mode.
The public address is the address assigned to the endpoint by the enterprise.

show vpn-sessiondb webvpn filter ipversion {v4 | v6}

Examples

hostname# sh vpn-sessiondb webvpn filter ipversion v4

Session Type: WebVPN

Username : user1 Index : 63


Public IP : 171.16.17.6
Protocol : Clientless
License : AnyConnect Premium
Encryption : Clientless: (1)RC4 Hashing : Clientless: (1)SHA1
Bytes Tx : 62454 Bytes Rx : 13082
Group Policy : SSLv6 Tunnel Group : SSL_IPv6
Login Time : 18:07:48 UTC Mon Oct 22 2012
Duration : 0h:00m:16s
Inactivity : 0h:00m:00s
NAC Result : Unknown
VLAN Mapping : N/A VLAN : none

Viewing Active LAN to LAN VPN Sessions by IP Address Type


To view active clientless SSL VPN sessions using the command line interface, enter the show vpn-sessiondb
l2l filter ipversion command in privileged EXEC mode.
This command shows active lan to lan VPN sessions filtered by the connection’s public IPv4 or IPv6 address.
The public address is the address assigned to the endpoint by the enterprise.

show vpn-sessiondb l2l filter ipversion {v4 | v6}

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
63
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
About ISE Policy Enforcement

About ISE Policy Enforcement


The Cisco Identity Services Engine (ISE) is a security policy management and control platform. It automates
and simplifies access control and security compliance for wired, wireless, and VPN connectivity. Cisco ISE
is primarily used to provide secure access and guest access, support bring your own device (BYOD) initiatives,
and enforce usage policies in conjunction with Cisco TrustSec.
The ISE Change of Authorization (CoA) feature provides a mechanism to change the attributes of an
authentication, authorization, and accounting (AAA) session after it is established. When a policy changes
for a user or user group in AAA, CoA packets can be sent directly to the ASA from the ISE to reinitialize
authentication and apply the new policy. An Inline Posture Enforcement Point (IPEP) is not required to apply
access control lists (ACLs) for each VPN session established with the ASA.
ISE policy enforcement is supported on the following VPN clients:
• IPSec
• AnyConnect
• L2TP/IPSec

Note Some policy elements such as Dynamic ACL (dACL) and Security Group Tag (SGT) are supported, whereas
policy elements such as VLAN assignment and IP address assignment are not supported.

The system flow is as follows:


1. An end user requests a VPN connection.
2. The ASA authenticates the user to the ISE and receives a user ACL that provides limited access to the
network.
3. An accounting start message is sent to the ISE to register the session.
4. Posture assessment occurs directly between the NAC agent and the ISE. This process is transparent to the
ASA.
5. The ISE sends a policy update to the ASA via a CoA “policy push.” This identifies a new user ACL that
provides increased network access privileges.

Note Additional policy evaluations may occur during the lifetime of the connection, transparent to the ASA, via
subsequent CoA updates.

Configure RADIUS Server Groups for ISE Policy Enforcement


To enable ISE policy assessment and enforcement, configure a RADIUS AAA server group for the ISE servers
and add the servers to the group. When you configure the tunnel group for the VPN, you specify this server
group for AAA services in the group.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
64
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure RADIUS Server Groups for ISE Policy Enforcement

Procedure

Step 1 Create the RADIUS AAA server group.


aaa-server group_name protocol radius

hostname(config)# aaa-server servergroup1 protocol radius


hostname(config-aaa-server-group)#

Step 2 Enable the RADIUS dynamic authorization (CoA) services for the AAA server group.
dynamic-authorization [port number]
Specifying a port is optional. The default is 1700, the range is 1024 to 65535.
When you use the server group in a VPN tunnel, the RADIUS server group will be registered for CoA
notification and the ASA will listen to the port for the CoA policy updates from ISE

hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# dynamic-authorization

Step 3 If you do not want to use ISE for authentication, enable authorize-only mode for the RADIUS server group.
authorize-only
This indicates that when this server group is used for authorization, the RADIUS Access Request message
will be built as an “Authorize Only” request as opposed to the configured password methods defined for the
AAA server. If you do configure a common password using radius-common-pw command for the RADIUS
server, it will be ignored.
For example, you would use authorize-only mode if you want to use certificates for authentication rather than
this server group. You would still use this server group for authorization and accounting in the VPN tunnel.

hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# authorize-only

Step 4 Enable the periodic generation of RADIUS interim-accounting-update messages.


interim-accounting-update [periodic [hours]]
ISE maintains a directory of active sessions based on the accounting records that it receives from NAS devices
like the ASA. However, if ISE does not receive any indication that the session is still active (accounting
message or posture transactions) for a period of 5 days, it will remove the session record from its database.
To ensure that long-lived VPN connections are not removed, configure the group to send periodic
interim-accounting-update messages to ISE for all active sessions.
• periodic [hours] enables the periodic generation and transmission of accounting records for every VPN
session that is configured to send accounting records to the server group in question. You can optionally
include the interval, in hours, for sending these updates. The default is 24 hours, the range is 1 to 120.
• (No parameters.) If you use this command without the periodic keyword, the ASA sends
interim-accounting-update messages only when a VPN tunnel connection is added to a clientless VPN
session. When this happens the accounting update is generated in order to inform the RADIUS server
of the newly assigned IP address.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
65
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure RADIUS Server Groups for ISE Policy Enforcement

hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# interim-accounting-update periodic 12

Step 5 (Optional.) Merge a downloadable ACL with the ACL received in the Cisco AV pair from a RADIUS packet.
merge-dacl {before-avpair | after-avpair}
This option applies only to VPN connections. For VPN users, ACLs can be in the form of Cisco AV pair
ACLs, downloadable ACLs, and an ACL that is configured on the ASA. This option determines whether or
not the downloadable ACL and the AV pair ACL are merged, and does not apply to any ACLs configured on
the ASA.
The default setting is no merge dacl, which specifies that downloadable ACLs will not be merged with Cisco
AV pair ACLs. If both an AV pair and a downloadable ACL are received, the AV pair has priority and is
used.
The before-avpair option specifies that the downloadable ACL entries should be placed before the Cisco AV
pair entries.
The after-avpair option specifies that the downloadable ACL entries should be placed after the Cisco AV
pair entries.

hostname(config)# aaa-server servergroup1 protocol radius


hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# merge-dacl before-avpair

Step 6 (Optional.) Specify the maximum number of requests sent to a RADIUS server in the group before trying the
next server.
max-failed-attempts number
The range is from 1 and 5. The default is 3.
If you configured a fallback method using the local database (for management access only), and all the servers
in the group fail to respond, then the group is considered to be unresponsive, and the fallback method is tried.
The server group remains marked as unresponsive for a period of 10 minutes (by default), so that additional
AAA requests within that period do not attempt to contact the server group, and the fallback method is used
immediately. To change the unresponsive period from the default, see the reactivation-mode command in
the next step.
If you do not have a fallback method, the ASA continues to retry the servers in the group.

hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# max-failed-attempts 2

Step 7 (Optional.) Specify the method (reactivation policy) by which failed servers in a group are reactivated.
reactivation-mode {depletion [deadtime minutes] | timed}
Where:
• depletion [deadtime minutes] reactivates failed servers only after all of the servers in the group are
inactive. This is the default reactivation mode. You can specify the amount of time, between 0 and 1440
minutes, that elapses between the disabling of the last server in the group and the subsequent reenabling
of all servers. The default is 10 minutes.
• timed reactivates failed servers after 30 seconds of down time.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
66
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Example Configurations for ISE Policy Enforcement

hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# reactivation-mode deadtime 20

Step 8 (Optional.) Send accounting messages to all servers in the group.


accounting-mode simultaneous
To restore the default of sending messages only to the active server, enter the accounting-mode single
command.

hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# accounting-mode simultaneous

Step 9 Add the ISE RADIUS servers to the group.


aaa-server group_name [(interface_name)] host {server_ip | name} [key]
Where:
• group_name is the name of the RADIUS server group.
• (interface_name) is the name of the interface through which the server is reached. The default is (inside).
The parentheses are required.
• host {server_ip | name} is the IP address or the hostname of the ISE RADIUS server.
• key is the optional key for encrypting the connection. You can more easily enter this key on the key
command after entering the aaa-server-host mode. If you do not configure a key, the connection is not
encrypted (plain text). The key is a case-sensitive, alphanumeric string of up to 127 characters that is the
same value as the key on the RADIUS server.

You can add more than one server to the group.

hostname(config)# aaa-server servergroup1 (inside) host 10.1.1.3


hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# key sharedsecret
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# exit

Example Configurations for ISE Policy Enforcement


Configure VPN Tunnel for ISE Dynamic Authentication with Passwords
The following example shows how to configure an ISE server group for dynamic authorization (CoA) updates
and hourly periodic accounting. Included is the tunnel group configuration that configures password
authentication with ISE.

ciscoasa(config)# aaa-server ise protocol radius


ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-group)# interim-accounting-update periodic 1
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-group)# dynamic-authorization
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-group)# exit
ciscoasa(config)# aaa-server ise (inside) host 10.1.1.3
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-host)# key sharedsecret
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
ciscoasa(config)# tunnel-group aaa-coa general-attributes

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
67
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Troubleshooting Policy Enforcement

ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool vpn


ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group ise
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group ise
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# exit

Configure VPN Tunnel for ISE Authorization-Only


The following example shows how to configure a tunnel group for local certificate validation and authorization
with ISE. Include the authorize-only command in the server group configuration, because the server group
will not be used for authentication.

ciscoasa(config)# aaa-server ise protocol radius


ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-group)# authorize-only
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-group)# interim-accounting-update periodic 1
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-group)# dynamic-authorization
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-group)# exit
ciscoasa(config)# aaa-server ise (inside) host 10.1.1.3
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-host)# key sharedsecret
ciscoasa(config-aaa-server-host)# exit
ciscoasa(config)# tunnel-group aaa-coa general-attributes
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool vpn
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# authentication certificate
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-group ise
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group ise
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-general)# exit

Troubleshooting Policy Enforcement


The following commands can be used for debugging.
To trace CoA activity:

debug radius dynamic-authorization

To trace redirect URL functionality:

debug aaa url-redirect

To view NP classification rules corresponding to URL redirect functionality:

show asp table classify domain url-redirect

Configure Advanced SSL Settings


The ASA uses the Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) protocol and the Transport Layer Security (TLS) to support
secure message transmission for ASDM, Clientless SSL VPN, VPN, and browser-based sessions. The ASA
supports the SSLv3, TLSv1, TLv1.1, and TLSv1.2 protocols for SSL-based VPN and management connections.
In addition, DTLS is used for AnyConnect VPN client connections.
The following ciphers are supported as noted:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
68
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Advanced SSL Settings

Cipher TLSv1.1 / DTLS TLSV1.2


V1
AES128-GCM-SHA256 no yes
AES128-SHA yes yes
AES128-SHA256 no yes
AES256-GCM-SHA384 no yes
AES256-SHA yes yes
AES256-SHA256 no yes
DERS-CBC-SHA no no
DES-CBC-SHA yes yes
DHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256 no yes
DHE-RSA-AES128-SHA yes yes
DHE-RSA-AES128-SHA256 no yes
DHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384 no l
DHE-RSA-AES256-SHA yes yes
ECDHE-ECDSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256 no yes
ECDHE-ECDSA-AES128-SHA256 no yes
ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384 no yes
ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-SHA384 no yes
ECDHE-RSA-AES128-GCM-SHA256 yes yes
ECDHE-RSA-AES128-SHA256 no yes
ECDHE-RSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384 no yes
ECDHE-RSA-AES256-SHA384 no yes
NULL-SHA no no
RC4-MD5 no no
RC4-SHA no no

Note For Release 9.4(1), all SSLv3 keywords have been removed from the ASA configuration, and SSLv3 support
has been removed from the ASA. If you have SSLv3 enabled, a boot-time error will appear from the command
with the SSLv3 option. The ASA will then revert to the default use of TLSv1.
The Citrix mobile receiver may not support TLS 1.1/1.2 protocols; see
https://www.citrix.com/content/dam/citrix/en_us/documents/products-solutions/citrix-receiver-feature-matrix.pdf
for compatibility

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
69
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Advanced SSL Settings

To specify the minimum protocol version for which the ASA will negotiate SSL/TLS connections, perform
the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 Set the minimum protocol version for which the ASA will negotiate a connection.
ssl server-version [tlsv1 | tlsv1.1 | tlsv1.2 ]
Where:
• tlsv1—Enter this keyword to accept SSLv2 ClientHellos and negotiate TLSv1 (or greater)
• tlsv1.1—Enter this keyword to accept SSLv2 ClientHellos and negotiate TLSv1.1 (or greater)
• tlsv1.2 —Enter this keyword to accept SSLv2 ClientHellos and negotiate TLSv1.2 (or greater)

Example:
Examples:
hostname(config)# ssl server-version tlsv1.1

Step 2 Specify the SSL/TLS protocol version that the ASA uses when acting as a client.

ssl client-version [tlsv1 | tlsv1.1 | tlsv1.2]

hostname(config)# ssl client-version tlsv1

The tlsv1 keyword specifies that the ASA transmit TLSv1 client hellos and negotiate TLSv1 (or greater). The
tlsv1.1 keyword specifies that the ASA transmit TLSv1.1 client hellos and negotiate TLSv1.1 (or greater).
The tlsv1.2 keyword specifies that the ASA transmit TLSv1.2 client hellos and negotiate TLSv1.2 (or greater).
(DTLS not available for SSL client role).

Step 3 Specify the encryption algorithms for the SSL, DTLS, and TLS protocols.
ssl cipher version [ level | custom string
Where:
• The version argument specifies the SSL, DTLS, or TLS protocol version. Supported versions include:
• default—The set of ciphers for outbound connections.
• dtlsv1—The ciphers for DTLSv1 inbound connections.
• dtlsv1.2—The ciphers for DTLSv1.2 inbound connections.
• tlsv1—The ciphers for TLSv1 inbound connections.
• tlsv1.1—The ciphers for TLSv1.1 inbound connections.
• tlsv1.2—The ciphers for TLSv1.2 inbound connections.

• The level argument specifies the strength of the ciphers and indicates the minimum level of ciphers that
are configured. Valid values in increasing order of strength are:
• all—Includes all ciphers, including NULL-SHA.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
70
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Advanced SSL Settings

• low—Includes all ciphers except NULL-SHA.


• medium (this is the default for all protocol versions)—Includes all ciphers (except NULL-SHA,
DES-CBC-SHA, RC4-MD5, RC4-SHA, and DES-CBC3-SHA).
• fips—Includes all FIPS-compliant ciphers (except NULL-SHA, DES-CBC-SHA, RC4-MD5,
RC4-SHA, and DES-CBC3-SHA).
• high (applies only to TLSv1.2)—Includes only AES-256 with SHA-2 ciphers.

• Specifying the custom string option allows you to have full control of the cipher suite using OpenSSL
cipher definition strings. For more information, see https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html.

The recommended setting is medium. Using high may limit connectivity. Using custom may limit functionality
if there are only a few ciphers configured. Restricting the default custom value limits outbound connectivity,
including clustering.
The ASA specifies the order of priority for supported ciphers. See the command reference for more information.
This command replaces the ssl encryption command, which has been deprecated starting with Version 9.3(2).

Step 4 Allow multiple trustpoints on a single interface.


ssl trust-point name [[interface vpnlb-ip ] | domain domain-name]
hostname(config)# ssl trust-point www-cert domain www.example.com

The name argument specifies the name of the trustpoint. The interface argument specifies the name of the
interface on which a trustpoint is configured. The vpnlb-ip keyword applies only to interfaces and associates
this trustpoint with the VPN load-balancing cluster IP address on this interface. The domaindomain-name
keyword-argument pair specifies a trustpoint that is associated with a particular domain name that is used to
access the interface.
You may configure a maximum of 16 trustpoints per interface.
If you do not specify an interface or domain, this command creates the fallback trustpoint for all interfaces
that do not have a trustpoint configured.
If you enter the ssl trustpoint ? command, the available configured trustpoints appear. If you enter the ssl
trust-point name ? command (for example, ssl trust-point mysslcert ?), the available configured interfaces
for the trustpoint-SSL certificate association appear.
Observe these guidelines when using this command:
• The value for trustpoint must be the name of the CA trustpoint as configured in the crypto ca trustpoint
name command.
• The value for interface must be the nameif name of a previously configured interface.
• Removing a trustpoint also removes any ssl trust-point entries that reference that trustpoint.
• You can have one ssl trust-point entry for each interface and one that specifies no interfaces.
• You can reuse the same trustpoint for multiple entries.
• A trustpoint configured with the domain keyword may apply to multiple interfaces (depending on how
you connect).
• You may only have one ssl trust-point per domain-name value.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
71
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Advanced SSL Settings

• If the following error appears after you enter this command:

error:0B080074:x509 certificate routines:X509_check_private_key:key values


mismatch@x509_cmp.c:339

It means that a user has configured a new certificate to replace a previously configured certificate. No
action is required.
• The certificates are chosen in the following order:
• If a connection matches the value of the domain keyword, that certificate is chosen first. (ssl
trust-pointnamedomaindomain-name command)
• If a connection is made to the load-balancing address, the vpnlb-ip certificate is chosen. (ssl
trust-point name interface vpnlb-ip command)
• The certificate configured for the interface. (ssl trust-point name interface command)
• The default certificate not associated with an interface. (ssl trust-point name)
• The ASA's self-signed, self-generated certificate.

Step 5 Specify the DH group to be used with DHE-RSA ciphers that are used by TLS.

ssl dh-group [group1 | group2 | group5 | group14 | group24]

hostname(config)# ssl dh-group group5

Groups 1 and 2 are compatible with Java 7 and earlier versions. Groups 5, 14, and 24 are not compatible with
Java 7. All groups are compatible with Java 8. Groups 14 and 24 are FIPS-compliant. The default value is ssl
dh-group group2.

Step 6 Specify the group to be used with ECDHE-ECDSA ciphers that are used by TLS.

ssl ecdh-group [group19 | group20 | group21]

hostname(config)# ssl ecdh-group group20

The group19 keyword configures group 19 (256-bit EC). The group20 keyword configures group 20 (384-bit
EC). The group21 keyword configures group 21 (521-bit EC).
The default value is ssl ecdh-group group19.
Note ECDSA and DHE ciphers are the highest priority.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
72
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows

Example

Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows


In networks running a version of ASA software prior to Release 8.0.4, existing IPsec LAN-to-LAN or
Remote-Access TCP traffic flows going through an IPSec tunnel are dropped when the tunnel drops. The
flows are recreated as needed when and if the tunnel comes back up. This policy works well from the
resource-management and security standpoints. However, there are cases in which such behavior introduces
issues for users, particularly for those migrating from PIX to ASA-only environments and for legacy TCP
applications that do not restart easily or in networks that include gateways that tend to drop tunnels
frequently.(See CSCsj40681 and CSCsi47630 for details.)
The persistent IPsec tunneled flows feature addresses this issue. With this feature enabled, the ASA preserves
and resumes stateful (TCP) tunneled flows. All other flows are dropped when the tunnel drops and must
reestablish when a new tunnel comes up.

Note This feature supports IPsec LAN-to-LAN tunnels and IPsec Remote-Access tunnels running in
Network-Extension Mode. It does not support IPsec or AnyConnect/SSL VPN remote access tunnels.

The following example shows how the persistent IPsec tunneled flows feature works.
Figure 4: Network Scenario

In this example the BXB and RTP networks are connected through a secure LAN-to-LAN tunnel by a pair
of security appliances. A PC in the BXB network is executing an FTP transfer from a server in the RTP
network through the secure tunnel. In this scenario, assume that for some reason the tunnel drops after the PC
has logged into the server and started the transfer. Although the tunnel is be reestablished since the data is
still attempting to flow, the FTP transfer will not complete. The user must terminate the transfer and start over
by logging back into the server. However, if persistent IPsec tunnel flows is enabled, as long as the tunnel is
recreated within the timeout interval, the data continues to flow successfully through the new tunnel because
the security appliances retain the history (state information) for this flow.

Scenario
The following sections describe the data flow situations for a dropped and recovered tunnel, first with the
persistent IPsec tunneled flows feature disabled, then with the feature enabled. In both of these cases, see the
preceding figure for an illustration of the network. In this illustration:
• Flow B-C defines the tunnel and carries the encrypted ESP data.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
73
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows Using CLI

• Flow A-D is the TCP connection for the FTP transfer and traverses the tunnel defined by flow B-C. This
flow also contains state information used by the firewall to inspect the TCP/FTP flow. The state
information is vital and is constantly updated by the firewall as the transfer progresses.

Note The reverse flows in each direction are omitted for simplicity.

Disabled Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows


When the LAN-2-LAN tunnel drops, both flow A-D and flow B-C and any state information belonging to
them are deleted. Subsequently, the tunnel is reestablished, and flow B-C is recreated and is able to resume
carrying tunneled data. But the TCP/FTP flow A-D runs into trouble. Because the state information describing
the flow up to this point in the FTP transfer has been deleted, the stateful firewall blocks the in-flight FTP
data and rejects the flow A-D creation. Having lost the history of this flow ever existing, the firewall treats
the FTP transfer as stray TCP packets and drops them. This is the default behavior.

Enabled Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows


With the persistent IPsec tunneled flows feature enabled, as long as the tunnel is recreated within the timeout
window, data continues flowing successfully because the ASA still has access to the state information in flow
A-D.
With this feature enabled, the ASA treats the flows independently. This means that flow A-D is not deleted
when the tunnel defined by flow B-C is dropped. The ASA preserves and resumes stateful (TCP) tunneled
flows. All other flows are dropped and must reestablish on the new tunnel. This does not weaken the security
policy for tunneled flows, because the ASA drops any packets arriving on flow A-D while the tunnel is down.
Tunneled TCP flows are not dropped, so they rely on the TCP timeout for cleanup. However, if the timeout
is disabled for a particular tunneled flow, that flow remains in the system until being cleared manually or by
other means (for example, by a TCP RST from the peer).

Configure Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows Using CLI


Configuration Example

Troubleshooting Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows


Both the show asp table and the show conn commands can be useful in troubleshooting issues with persistent
IPsec tunneled flows.

Is the Persistent IPsec Tunneled Flows Feature Enabled?


To see whether a particular tunnel has this feature enabled, look at the VPN context associated with the tunnel
using the show asp table command. The show asp table vpn-context command displays a “+PRESERVE”
flag for each context that maintains stateful flows after the tunnel drops, as shown in the following example
(bolding added for legibility):

hostname(config)# show asp table vpn-context


VPN CTX=0x0005FF54, Ptr=0x6DE62DA0, DECR+ESP+PRESERVE, UP, pk=0000000000, rk=0000000000,
gc=0

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
74
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Locating Orphaned Flows

VPN CTX=0x0005B234, Ptr=0x6DE635E0, ENCR+ESP+PRESERVE, UP, pk=0000000000, rk=0000000000,


gc=0

---------------------------------------------------------------------------

hostname(config)# show asp table vpn-context detail

VPN CTX = 0x0005FF54

Peer IP = ASA_Private
Pointer = 0x6DE62DA0
State = UP
Flags = DECR+ESP+PRESERVE
SA = 0x001659BF
SPI = 0xB326496C
Group = 0
Pkts = 0
Bad Pkts = 0
Bad SPI = 0
Spoof = 0
Bad Crypto = 0
Rekey Pkt = 0
Rekey Call = 0

VPN CTX = 0x0005B234

Peer IP = ASA_Private
Pointer = 0x6DE635E0
State = UP
Flags = ENCR+ESP+PRESERVE
SA = 0x0017988D
SPI = 0x9AA50F43
Group = 0
Pkts = 0
Bad Pkts = 0
Bad SPI = 0
Spoof = 0
Bad Crypto = 0
Rekey Pkt = 0
Rekey Call = 0
hostname(config)#
Configuration and Restrictions
This configuration option is subject to the same CLI configuration restrictions as other
sysopt VPN CLI.

Locating Orphaned Flows


If a LAN-to-LAN/Network-Extension-Mode tunnel drops and does not recover before the timeout, there might
be a number of orphaned tunnel flows. These flows are not torn down as a result of the tunnel going down,
but all the data attempting to flow through them is dropped. To see these flows, use the show conn command,
as in the following examples (bolding added for emphasis and to show user input):

asa2(config)# show conn detail


9 in use, 14 most used
Flags: A - awaiting inside ACK to SYN, a - awaiting outside ACK to SYN,
B - initial SYN from outside, C - CTIQBE media, D - DNS, d - dump,
E - outside back connection, F - outside FIN, f - inside FIN,
G - group, g - MGCP, H - H.323, h - H.225.0, I - inbound data,
i - incomplete, J - GTP, j - GTP data, K - GTP t3-response
k - Skinny media, M - SMTP data, m - SIP media, n - GUP
O - outbound data, P - inside back connection, p - Phone-proxy TFTP connection,
q - SQL*Net data, R - outside acknowledged FIN,

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
75
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Locating Orphaned Flows

R - UDP SUNRPC, r - inside acknowledged FIN, S - awaiting inside SYN,


s - awaiting outside SYN, T - SIP, t - SIP transient, U - up,
V - VPN orphan, W - WAAS,
X - inspected by service module

The following example shows sample output from the show conn command when an orphan flow exists, as
indicated by the V flag:

hostname# show conn


16 in use, 19 most used
TCP out 192.168.110.251:7393 in 192.168.150.252:21 idle 0:00:00 bytes 1048 flags UOVB
TCP out 192.168.110.251:21137 in 192.168.150.252:21 idle bytes 1048 flags UIOB

To limit the report to those connections that have orphan flows, add the vpn_orphan option to the show conn
state command, as in the following example:

hostname# show conn state vpn_orphan


14 in use, 19 most used
TCP out 192.168.110.251:7393 in 192.168.150.252:5013 idle 0:00:00 bytes 2841019 flags UOVB

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
76
CHAPTER 4
Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users
This chapter describes how to configure VPN connection profiles (formerly called “tunnel groups”), group
policies, and users. This chapter includes the following sections.
• Overview of Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users, on page 77
• Connection Profiles, on page 78
• Configure Connection Profiles, on page 82
• Group Policies, on page 117
• Use of a Zone Labs Integrity Server, on page 155
• Configure User Attributes, on page 162

Overview of Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users


Groups and users are core concepts in managing the security of virtual private networks (VPNs) and in
configuring the ASA. They specify attributes that determine user access to and use of the VPN. A group is a
collection of users treated as a single entity. Users get their attributes from group policies. A connection profile
identifies the group policy for a specific connection. If you do not assign a particular group policy to a user,
the default group policy for the connection applies.
In summary, you first configure connection profiles to set the values for the connection. Then you configure
group policies. These set values for users in the aggregate. Then you configure users, which can inherit values
from groups and configure certain values on an individual user basis. This chapter describes how and why to
configure these entities.

Note You configure connection profiles using tunnel-group commands. In this chapter, the terms “connection
profile” and “tunnel group” are often used interchangeably.

Connection profiles and group policies simplify system management. To streamline the configuration task,
the ASA provides a default LAN-to-LAN connection profile (DefaultL2Lgroup), a default remote access
connection profile for IKEv2 VPN (DefaultRAgroup), a default connection profile for Clientless SSL and
AnyConnect SSL connections (DefaultWEBVPNgroup), and a default group policy (DfltGrpPolicy). The
default connection profiles and group policy provide settings are likely to be common for many users. As you
add users, you can specify that they “inherit” parameters from a group policy. Thus you can quickly configure
VPN access for large numbers of users.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
77
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Connection Profiles

If you decide to grant identical rights to all VPN users, then you do not need to configure specific connection
profiles or group policies, but VPNs seldom work that way. For example, you might allow a finance group
to access one part of a private network, a customer support group to access another part, and an MIS group
to access other parts. In addition, you might allow specific users within MIS to access systems that other MIS
users cannot access. Connection profiles and group policies provide the flexibility to do so securely.

Note The ASA also includes the concept of object groups, which are a superset of network lists. Object groups let
you define VPN access to ports as well as networks. Object groups relate to ACLs rather than to group policies
and connection profiles. For more information about using object groups, see Chapter 20, "Objects" in the
general operations configuration guide.

The security appliance can apply attribute values from a variety of sources. It applies them according to the
following hierarchy:
1. Dynamic Access Policy (DAP) record
2. Username
3. Group policy
4. Group policy for the connection profile
5. Default group policy

Therefore, DAP values for an attribute have a higher priority than those configured for a user, group policy,
or connection profile.
When you enable or disable an attribute for a DAP record, the ASA applies that value and enforces it. For
example, when you disable HTTP proxy in dap webvpn configuration mode, the ASA looks no further for a
value. When you instead use the no value for the http-proxy command, the attribute is not present in the DAP
record, so the security appliance moves down to the AAA attribute in the username, and if necessary, to the
group policy and finds a value to apply. The ASA clientless SSL VPN configuration supports only one
http-proxy and one https-proxy command each. We recommend that you use ASDM to configure DAP.

Connection Profiles
A connection profile consists of a set of records that determines tunnel connection policies. These records
identify the servers to which the tunnel user is authenticated, as well as the accounting servers, if any, to which
connection information is sent. They also identify a default group policy for the connection, and they contain
protocol-specific connection parameters. Connection profiles include a small number of attributes that pertain
to creating the tunnel itself. Connection profiles include a pointer to a group policy that defines user-oriented
attributes.
The ASA provides the following default connection profiles: DefaultL2Lgroup for LAN-to-LAN connections,
DefaultRAgroup for IPSEC remote access connections, and DefaultWEBVPNGroup for SSL VPN
(browser-based and AnyConnect Client based) connections. You can modify these default connection profiles,
but you cannot delete them. You can also create one or more connection profiles specific to your environment.
Connection profiles are local to the ASA and are not configurable on external servers.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
78
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
General Connection Profile Connection Parameters

Note Some profiles (such as IKEv1 in phase 1) may be unable to determine whether an endpoint is remote access
or LAN-to-LAN. If it cannot determine the tunnel group, it defaults to
tunnel-group-map default-group <tunnel-group-name>

(default is DefaultRAGroup).

General Connection Profile Connection Parameters


General parameters are common to all VPN connections. The general parameters include the following:
• Connection profile name—You specify a connection-profile name when you add or edit a connection
profile. The following considerations apply:
• For clients that use preshared keys to authenticate, the connection profile name is the same as the
group name that a client passes to the ASA.
• Clients that use certificates to authenticate pass this name as part of the certificate, and the ASA
extracts the name from the certificate.

• Connection type—Connection types include IKEv1 remote-access, IPsec LAN-to-LAN, and AnyConnect
(SSL/IKEv2). A connection profile can have only one connection type.
• Authentication, Authorization, and Accounting servers—These parameters identify the server groups or
lists that the ASA uses for the following purposes:
• Authenticating users
• Obtaining information about services users are authorized to access
• Storing accounting records

A server group can consist of one or more servers.


• Default group policy for the connection—A group policy is a set of user-oriented attributes. The default
group policy is the group policy whose attributes the ASA uses as defaults when authenticating or
authorizing a tunnel user.
• Client address assignment method—This method includes values for one or more DHCP servers or
address pools that the ASA assigns to clients.
• Password management—This parameter lets you warn a user that the current password is due to expire
in a specified number of days (the default is 14 days), then offer the user the opportunity to change the
password.
• Strip group and strip realm—These parameters direct the way the ASA processes the usernames it
receives. They apply only to usernames received in the form user@realm.
A realm is an administrative domain appended to a username with the @ delimiter (user@abc). If you
strip the realm, the ASA uses the username and the group (if present) for authentication. If you strip the
group, the ASA uses the username and the realm (if present) for authentication.
Enter the strip-realm command to remove the realm qualifier, and enter the strip-group command to
remove the group qualilfier from the username during authentication. If you remove both qualifiers,

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
79
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
IPsec Tunnel-Group Connection Parameters

authentication is based on the username alone. Otherwise, authentication is based on the full
username@realm or username<delimiter> group string. You must specify strip-realm if your server is
unable to parse delimiters.
In addition, for L2TP/IPsec clients only, when you specify the strip-group command the ASA selects
the connection profile (tunnel group) for user connections by obtaining the group name from the username
presented by the VPN client.

• Authorization required—This parameter lets you require authorization before a user can connect, or turn
off that requirement.
• Authorization DN attributes—This parameter specifies which Distinguished Name attributes to use when
performing authorization.

IPsec Tunnel-Group Connection Parameters


IPsec parameters include the following:
• A client authentication method: preshared keys, certificates, or both.
• For IKE connections based on preshared keys, this is the alphanumeric key itself (up to 128 characters
long), associated with the connection policy.
• Peer-ID validation requirement—This parameter specifies whether to require validating the identity
of the peer using the peer’s certificate.
• If you specify certificates or both for the authentication method, the end user must provide a valid
certificate in order to authenticate.

• An extended hybrid authentication method: XAUTH and hybrid XAUTH.


You use isakmp ikev1-user-authentication command to implement hybrid XAUTH authentication
when you need to use digital certificates for ASA authentication and a different, legacy method for remote
VPN user authentication, such as RADIUS, TACACS+ or SecurID.

• ISAKMP (IKE) keepalive settings. This feature lets the ASA monitor the continued presence of a remote
peer and report its own presence to that peer. If the peer becomes unresponsive, the ASA removes the
connection. Enabling IKE keepalives prevents hung connections when the IKE peer loses connectivity.
There are various forms of IKE keepalives. For this feature to work, both the ASA and its remote peer
must support a common form. This feature works with the following peers:
• Cisco AnyConnect VPN Client
• Cisco IOS software
• Cisco Secure PIX Firewall
Non-Cisco VPN clients do not support IKE keepalives.
If you are configuring a group of mixed peers, and some of those peers support IKE keepalives and
others do not, enable IKE keepalives for the entire group. The feature does not affect the peers that
do not support it.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
80
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Connection Profile Connection Parameters for SSL VPN Sessions

If you disable IKE keepalives, connections with unresponsive peers remain active until they time
out, so we recommend that you keep your idle timeout short. To change your idle timeout, see
Configure Group Policies, on page 120.

Note To reduce connectivity costs, disable IKE keepalives if this group includes any
clients connecting via ISDN lines. ISDN connections normally disconnect if idle,
but the IKE keepalive mechanism prevents connections from idling and therefore
from disconnecting.
If you do disable IKE keepalives, the client disconnects only when either its IKE
or IPsec keys expire. Failed traffic does not disconnect the tunnel with the Peer
Timeout Profile values as it does when IKE keepalives are enabled.
If you have a LAN-to-LAN configuration using IKE main mode, make sure that
the two peers have the same IKE keepalive configuration. Both peers must have
IKE keepalives enabled or both peers must have it disabled.

• If you configure authentication using digital certificates, you can specify whether to send the entire
certificate chain (which sends the peer the identity certificate and all issuing certificates) or just the
issuing certificates (including the root certificate and any subordinate CA certificates).
• You can notify users who are using outdated versions of Windows client software that they need to update
their client, and you can provide a mechanism for them to get the updated client version. You can configure
and change the client-update, either for all connection profiles or for particular connection profiles.
• If you configure authentication using digital certificates, you can specify the name of the trustpoint that
identifies the certificate to send to the IKE peer.

Connection Profile Connection Parameters for SSL VPN Sessions


The table below provides a list of connection profile attributes that are specific to SSL VPN (AnyConnect
client and clientless) connections. In addition to these attributes, you configure general connection profile
attributes common to all VPN connections. For step-by-step information about configuring connection profiles,
see Configure Connection Profiles for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions, on page 99.

Note In earlier releases, “connection profiles” were known as “tunnel groups.” You configure a connection profile
with tunnel-group commands. This chapter often uses these terms interchangeably.

Table 5: Connection Profile Attributes for SSL VPN

Function

authentication Sets the authentication method, AAA or certificate.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
81
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Connection Profiles

Function

customization Identifies the name of a previously defined


customization to apply. Customizations determine the
appearance of the windows that the user sees upon
login. You configure the customization parameters as
part of configuring clientless SSL VPN.

nbns-server Identifies the name of the NetBIOS Name Service


server (nbns-server) to use for CIFS name resolution.

group-alias Specifies one or more alternate names by which the


server can refer to a connection profile. At login, the
user selects the group name from a drop-down menu.

group-url Identifies one or more group URLs. If you configure


this attribute, users coming in on a specified URL
need not select a group at login.
A Load Balancing deployment that uses Group URLs
for AnyConnect client connectivity, requires each
ASA node in the cluster to configure a Group URL
for the virtual cluster address, as well as a Group URL
for the node's Load Balancing public address.

dns-group Identifies the DNS server group that specifies the DNS
server name, domain name, name server, number of
retries, and timeout values for a DNS server to use
for a connection profile.

hic-fail-group-policy Specifies a VPN feature policy if you use the Cisco


Secure Desktop Manager to set the Group-Based
Policy attribute to “Use Failure Group-Policy” or “Use
Success Group-Policy, if criteria match.”

override-svc-download Overrides downloading the group-policy or username


attributes configured for downloading the AnyConnect
VPN client to the remote user.

radius-reject-message Enables the display of the RADIUS reject message


on the login screen when authentication is rejected.

Configure Connection Profiles


This section describes the contents and configuration of connection profiles in both single-context mode or
multiple-context mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
82
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Maximum Connection Profiles

Note Multiple-context mode applies only to IKEv2 and IKEv1 site to site and does not apply to AnyConnect,
Clientless SSL VPN, legacy Cisco VPN client, the Apple native VPN client, the Microsoft native VPN client,
or cTCP for IKEv1 IPsec.

You can modify the default connection profiles, and you can configure a new connection profile as any of
the three tunnel-group types. If you do not explicitly configure an attribute in a connection profile, that attribute
gets its value from the default connection profile. The default connection-profile type is remote access. The
subsequent parameters depend upon your choice of tunnel type. To see the current configured and default
configuration of all your connection profiles, including the default connection profile, enter the show
running-config all tunnel-group command.

Maximum Connection Profiles


The maximum number of connection profiles (tunnel groups) that an ASA can support is a function of the
maximum number of concurrent VPN sessions for the platform + 5. Attempting to add an additional tunnel
group beyond the limit results in the following message: “ERROR: The limit of 30 configured tunnel groups
has been reached.”

Default IPsec Remote Access Connection Profile Configuration


The contents of the default remote-access connection profile are as follows:

tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup type remote-access


tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup general-attributes
no address-pool
no ipv6-address-pool
authentication-server-group LOCAL
accounting-server-group RADIUS
default-group-policy DfltGrpPolicy
no dhcp-server
no strip-realm
no password-management
no override-account-disable
no strip-group
no authorization-required
authorization-dn-attributes CN OU
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup webvpn-attributes
hic-fail-group-policy DfltGrpPolicy
customization DfltCustomization
authentication aaa
no override-svc-download
no radius-reject-message
dns-group DefaultDNS
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup ipsec-attributes
no pre-shared-key
peer-id-validate req
no chain
no trust-point
isakmp keepalive threshold 1500 retry 2
no radius-sdi-xauth
isakmp ikev1-user-authentication xauth
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup ppp-attributes
no authentication pap
authentication chap

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
83
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
IPsec Tunnel-Group General Attributes

authentication ms-chap-v1
no authentication ms-chap-v2
no authentication eap-proxy

tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup type remote-access


tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup general-attributes
no address-pool
no ipv6-address-pool
authentication-server-group LOCAL
accounting-server-group RADIUS
default-group-policy DfltGrpPolicy
no dhcp-server
no strip-realm
no password-management
no strip-group
no authorization-required
authorization-dn-attributes CN OU
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup webvpn-attributes
hic-fail-group-policy DfltGrpPolicy
customization DfltCustomization
authentication aaa
no override-svc-download
no radius-reject-message
dns-group DefaultDNS
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup ipsec-attributes
no pre-shared-key
peer-id-validate req
no chain
no trust-point
isakmp keepalive threshold 1500 retry 2
no radius-sdi-xauth
isakmp ikev1-user-authentication xauth
tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup ppp-attributes
no authentication pap
authentication chap
authentication ms-chap-v1
no authentication ms-chap-v2
no authentication eap-proxy

IPsec Tunnel-Group General Attributes


The general attributes are common across more than one tunnel-group type. IPsec remote access and clientless
SSL VPN tunnels share most of the same general attributes. IPsec LAN-to-LAN tunnels use a subset. Refer
to the Cisco ASA Series Command Reference for complete descriptions of all commands. This section describes,
in order, how to configure remote-access and LAN-to-LAN connection profiles.

Configure Remote-Access Connection Profiles


Use a remote-access connection profile when setting up a connection between the following remote clients
and a central-site ASA:
• AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client (connecting with SSL or IPsec/IKEv2)
• Clientless SSL VPN (browser-based connecting with SSL)
• Cisco ASA 5500 Easy VPN hardware client (connecting with IPsec/IKEv1)

We also provide a default group policy named DfltGrpPolicy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
84
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify a Name and Type for the Remote Access Connection Profile

To configure a remote-access connection profile, first configure the tunnel-group general attributes, then the
remote-access attributes. See the following sections:
• Specify a Name and Type for the Remote Access Connection Profile, on page 85.
• Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile General Attributes, on page 85.
• Configure Double Authentication, on page 89
• Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile IPsec IKEv1 Attributes, on page 91.
• Configure IPsec Remote-Access Connection Profile PPP Attributes, on page 93

Specify a Name and Type for the Remote Access Connection Profile

Procedure

Create the connection profile, specifying its name and type, by entering the tunnel-group command.
For a remote-access tunnel, the type is remote-access.
tunnel-group tunnel_group_name type remote-access
Example:
For example, to create a remote-access connection profile named TunnelGroup1, enter the following command:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group TunnelGroup1 type remote-access


hostname(config)#

Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile General Attributes


To configure or change the connection profile general attributes, specify the parameters in the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 To configure the general attributes, enter the tunnel-group general-attributes task in either single or multiple
context mode, which enters tunnel-group general-attributes configuration mode. The prompt changes to
indicate the change in mode.

hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel_group_name general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 2 Specify the name of the authentication-server group, if any, to use. If you want to use the LOCAL database
for authentication if the specified server group fails, append the keyword LOCAL:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group [(interface_name)] groupname


[LOCAL]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
85
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile General Attributes

The name of the authentication server group can be up to 16 characters long.


You can optionally configure interface-specific authentication by including the name of an interface after the
group name. The interface name, which specifies where the tunnel terminates, must be enclosed in parentheses.
The following command configures interface-specific authentication for the interface named test using the
server named servergroup1 for authentication:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group (test) servergroup1


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 3 Specify the name of the authorization-server group, if any, to use. When you configure this value, users must
exist in the authorization database to connect:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-group groupname


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

The name of the authorization server group can be up to 16 characters long. For example, the following
command specifies the use of the authorization-server group FinGroup:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-groupFinGroup
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 4 Specify the name of the accounting-server group, if any, to use:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group groupname


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

The name of the accounting server group can be up to 16 characters long. For example, the following command
specifies the use of the accounting-server group named comptroller:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group comptroller


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 5 Specify the name of the default group policy:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy policyname


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

The name of the group policy can be up to 64 characters long. The following example sets DfltGrpPolicy as
the name of the default group policy:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy DfltGrpPolicy


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 6 Specify the names or IP addresses of the DHCP server (up to 10 servers), and the names of the DHCP address
pools (up to 6 pools). The defaults are no DHCP server and no address pool. The dhcp-server command will
allow you to configure the ASA to send additional options to the specified DHCP servers when it is trying to
get IP addresses for VPN clients. See the dhcp-server command in the Cisco ASA Series Command Reference
guide for more information.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
86
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile General Attributes

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# dhcp-server server1 [...server10]


hostname(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool [(interface name)] address_pool1
[...address_pool6]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Note If you specify an interface name, you must enclosed it within parentheses.
You configure address pools with the ip local pool command in global configuration mode.

Step 7 Specify the name of the NAC authentication server group, if you are using Network Admission Control, to
identify the group of authentication servers to be used for Network Admission Control posture validation.
Configure at least one Access Control Server to support NAC. Use the aaa-server command to name the
ACS group. Then use the nac-authentication-server-group command, using the same name for the server
group.
The following example identifies acs-group1 as the authentication server group to be used for NAC posture
validation:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-authentication-server-group acs-group1


hostname(config-group-policy)

The following example inherits the authentication server group from the default remote access group:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-authentication-server-group
hostname(config-group-policy)

Note NAC requires a Cisco Trust Agent on the remote host.

Step 8 Specify whether to strip the group or the realm from the username before passing it on to the AAA server.
The default is not to strip either the group name or the realm:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# strip-group
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# strip-realm
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

A realm is an administrative domain. If you strip the realm, the ASA uses the username and the group (if
present) authentication. If you strip the group, the ASA uses the username and the realm (if present) for
authentication. Enter the strip-realm command to remove the realm qualifier, and use the strip-group command
to remove the group qualilfier from the username during authentication. If you remove both qualifiers,
authentication is based on the username alone. Otherwise, authentication is based on the full username@realm
or username<delimiter> group string. You must specify strip-realm if your server is unable to parse delimiters.

Step 9 Optionally, if your server is a RADIUS, RADIUS with NT, or LDAP server, you can enable password
management.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
87
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile General Attributes

Note If you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication, password management is supported
with the Sun Microsystems JAVA System Directory Server (formerly named the Sun ONE Directory
Server) and the Microsoft Active Directory.
Sun—The DN configured on the ASA to access a Sun directory server must be able to access the
default password policy on that server. We recommend using the directory administrator, or a user
with directory administrator privileges, as the DN. Alternatively, you can place an ACI on the default
password policy.
Microsoft—You must configure LDAP over SSL to enable password management with Microsoft
Active Directory.
This feature, which is disabled by default, warns a user when the current password is about to expire.
The default is to begin warning the user 14 days before expiration:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# password-management
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

If the server is an LDAP server, you can specify the number of days (0 through 180) before expiration to
begin warning the user about the pending expiration:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# password-management [password-expire in days n]


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Note The password-management command, entered in tunnel-group general-attributes configuration


mode replaces the deprecated radius-with-expiry command that was formerly entered in tunnel-group
ipsec-attributes mode.

When you configure the password-management command, the ASA notifies the remote user at login that
the user’s current password is about to expire or has expired. The ASA then offers the user the opportunity
to change the password. If the current password has not yet expired, the user can still log in using that password.
The ASA ignores this command if RADIUS or LDAP authentication has not been configured.
Note that this does not change the number of days before the password expires, but rather, the number of days
ahead of expiration that the ASA starts warning the user that the password is about to expire.
If you do specify the password-expire-in-days keyword, you must also specify the number of days.
Specifying this command with the number of days set to 0 disables this command. The ASA does not notify
the user of the pending expiration, but the user can change the password after it expires.
See Configure Microsoft Active Directory Settings for Password Management, on page 113 for more
information.
The ASA Version 7.1 and later generally supports password management for the AnyConnect VPN Client,
the Cisco IPsec VPN Client, the SSL VPN full-tunneling client, and Clientless connections when authenticating
with LDAP or with any RADIUS connection that supports MS-CHAPv2. Password management is not
supported for any of these connection types for Kerberos/AD (Windows password) or NT 4.0 Domain.
Some RADIUS servers that support MS-CHAP do not currently support MS-CHAPv2. The
password-management command requires MS-CHAPv2, so please check with your vendor.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
88
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Double Authentication

Note The RADIUS server (for example, Cisco ACS) could proxy the authentication request to another
authentication server. However, from the ASA perspective, it is talking only to a RADIUS server.
For LDAP, the method to change a password is proprietary for the different LDAP servers on the
market. Currently, the ASA implements the proprietary password management logic only for
Microsoft Active Directory and Sun LDAP servers. Native LDAP requires an SSL connection. You
must enable LDAP over SSL before attempting to do password management for LDAP. By default,
LDAP uses port 636.

Step 10
Step 11 Specify the attribute or attributes to use in deriving a name for an authorization query from a certificate. This
attribute specifies what part of the subject DN field to use as the username for authorization:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-dn-attributes {primary-attribute


[secondary-attribute] | use-entire-name}

For example, the following command specifies the use of the CN attribute as the username for authorization:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-dn-attributes CN
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

The authorization-dn-attributes are C (Country), CN (Common Name), DNQ (DN qualifier), EA (E-mail
Address), GENQ (Generational qualifier), GN (Given Name), I (Initials), L (Locality), N (Name), O
(Organization), OU (Organizational Unit), SER (Serial Number), SN (Surname), SP (State/Province), T
(Title), UID (User ID), and UPN (User Principal Name).

Step 12 Specify whether to require a successful authorization before allowing a user to connect. The default is not to
require authorization.

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-required
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Configure Double Authentication


Double authentication is an optional feature that requires a user to enter an additional authentication credential,
such as a second username and password, on the login screen. Specify the following commands to configure
double authentication.

Procedure

Step 1 Specify the secondary authentication server group. This command specifies the AAA server group to use as
the secondary AAA server.
Note This command applies only to AnyConnect client VPN connections.

The secondary server group cannot specify an SDI server group. By default, no secondary authentication is
required.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
89
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Double Authentication

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# secondary-authentication-server-group [interface_name]


{none | LOCAL | groupname [LOCAL]} [use-primary-name]

If you use the none keyword, no secondary authentication is required. The groupname value specifies the
AAA server group name. Local specifies the use of the internal server database, and when used with the
groupname value, LOCAL specifies fallback.
For example, to set the primary authentication server group to sdi_group and the secondary authentication
server group to ldap_server, enter the following commands:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# secondary-authentication-server-group

Note If you use the use-primary-name keyword, then the login dialog requests only one username. In
addition, if the usernames are extracted from a digital certificate, only the primary username is used
for authentication.

Step 2 If obtaining the secondary username from a certificate, enter secondary-username-from-certificate:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# secondary-username-from-certificate C | CN | ... | use-script

The values for the DN fields to extract from the certificate for use as a secondary username are the same as
for the primary username-from-certificate command. Alternatively, you can specify the use-script keyword,
which directs the ASA to use a script file generated by ASDM.
For example, to specify the Common Name as the primary username field and Organizational Unit as the
secondary username field, enter the following commands:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# tunnel-group test1 general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)# username-from-certificate cn
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# secondary-username-from-certificate ou

Step 3 Use the secondary-pre-fill-username command in tunnel-group webvpn-attributes mode to enable extracting
a secondary username from a client certificate for use in authentication. Use the keywords to specify whether
this command applies to a clientless connection or an SSL VPN (AnyConnect) client connection and whether
you want to hide the extracted username from the end user. This feature is disabled by default. Clientless and
SSL-client options can both exist at the same time, but you must configure them in separate commands.

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# secondary-pre-fill-username-from-certificate
{clientless | ssl-client} [hide]

For example, to specify the use of pre-fill-username for both the primary and secondary authentication for a
connection, enter the following commands:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# tunnel-group test1 general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)# pre-fill-username ssl-client
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# secondary-pre-fill-username ssl-client

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
90
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile IPsec IKEv1 Attributes

Step 4 Specify which authentication server to use to obtain the authorization attributes to apply to the connection.
The primary authentication server is the default selection. This command is meaningful only for double
authentication.

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-attr-from-server {primary | secondary}

For example, to specify the use of the secondary authentication server, enter the following commands:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# tunnel-group test1 general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-attr-from-server secondary

Step 5 Specify which authentication username, primary or secondary, to associate with the session. The default value
is primary. With double authentication enabled, it is possible that two distinct usernames are authenticated
for the session. The administrator must designate one of the authenticated usernames as the session username.
The session username is the username provided for accounting, session database, syslogs, and debug output.

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authenticated-session-username {primary | secondary}

For example, to specify that the authentication username associated with the session must come from the
secondary authentication server, enter the following commands:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# tunnel-group test1 general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authenticated-session-username secondary

Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile IPsec IKEv1 Attributes


To configure the IPsec IKEv1 attributes for a remote-access connection profile, perform the following steps.
The following description assumes that you have already created the remote-access connection profile.
Remote-access connection profiles have more attributes than LAN-to-LAN connection profiles.

Procedure

Step 1 To specify the IPsec attributes of an remote-access tunnel-group, enter tunnel-group ipsec-attributes mode by
entering the following command in either single or multiple context mode. The prompt changes to indicate
the mode change.

hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name ipsec-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

This command enters tunnel-group ipsec-attributes configuration mode, in which you configure the
remote-access tunnel-group IPsec attributes in either single or multiple context mode.
For example, the following command designates that the tunnel-group ipsec-attributes mode commands that
follow pertain to the connection profile named TG1. Notice that the prompt changes to indicate that you are
now in tunnel-group ipsec-attributes mode:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 type remote-access

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
91
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Remote-Access Connection Profile IPsec IKEv1 Attributes

hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 ipsec-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Step 2 Specify the preshared key to support IKEv1 connections based on preshared keys. For example, the following
command specifies the preshared key xyzx to support IKEv1 connections for an IPsec IKEv1 remote access
connection profile:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev1 pre-shared-key xyzx


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Step 3 Specify whether to validate the identity of the peer using the peer’s certificate:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# peer-id-validate option


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

The possible option values are req (required), cert (if supported by certificate), and nocheck (do not check).
The default is req.
For example, the following command specifies that peer-id validation is required:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# peer-id-validate req


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Step 4 Specify whether to enable sending of a certificate chain. The following command includes the root certificate
and any subordinate CA certificates in the transmission:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# chain
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

This attribute applies to all IPsec tunnel-group types.

Step 5 Specify the name of a trustpoint that identifies the certificate to be sent to the IKE peer:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev1 trust-point trust-point-name


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

The following command specifies mytrustpoint as the name of the certificate to be sent to the IKE peer:

hostname(config-ipsec)# ikev1 trust-point mytrustpoint

Step 6 Specify the ISAKMP keepalive threshold and the number of retries allowed:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold <number> retry <number>


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

The threshold parameter specifies the number of seconds (10 through 3600) that the peer is allowed to idle
before beginning keepalive monitoring. The retry parameter is the interval (2 through 10 seconds) between
retries after a keepalive response has not been received. IKE keepalives are enabled by default. To disable
ISAKMP keepalives, enter isakmp keepalive disable.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
92
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure IPsec Remote-Access Connection Profile PPP Attributes

For example, the following command sets the IKE keepalive threshold value to 15 seconds and sets the retry
interval to 10 seconds:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold 15 retry 10


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

The default value for the threshold parameter is 300 for remote-access and 10 for LAN-to-LAN, and the
default value for the retry parameter is 2.
To specify that the central site (secure gateway) should never initiate ISAKMP monitoring, enter the following
command:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold infinite


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Step 7 Specify the ISAKMP hybrid authentication method, XAUTH or hybrid XAUTH.
You use isakmp ikev1-user-authentication command to implement hybrid XAUTH authentication when
you need to use digital certificates for ASA authentication and a different, legacy method for remote VPN
user authentication, such as RADIUS, TACACS+ or SecurID. Hybrid XAUTH breaks phase 1 of IKE down
into the following two steps, together called hybrid authentication:
a) The ASA authenticates to the remote VPN user with standard public key techniques. This establishes an
IKE security association that is unidirectionally authenticated.
b) An XAUTH exchange then authenticates the remote VPN user. This extended authentication can use one
of the supported legacy authentication methods.
Note Before the authentication type can be set to hybrid, you must configure the authentication server,
create a preshared key, and configure a trustpoint.

You can use the isakmp ikev1-user-authentication command with the optional interface parameter to
specify a particular interface. When you omit the interface parameter, the command applies to all the
interfaces and serves as a back-up when the per-interface command is not specified. When there are two
isakmp ikev1-user-authentication commands specified for a connection profile, and one uses the interface
parameter and one does not, the one specifying the interface takes precedence for that particular interface.
For example, the following commands enable hybrid XAUTH on the inside interface for a connection
profile called example-group:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group example-group type remote-access


hostname(config)# tunnel-group example-group ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp ikev1-user-authentication (inside) hybrid
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Configure IPsec Remote-Access Connection Profile PPP Attributes


To configure the Point-to-Point Protocol attributes for a remote-access connection profile, perform the following
steps. PPP attributes apply only to IPsec remote-access connection profiles. The following description assumes
that you have already created the IPsec remote-access connection profile.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
93
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure IPsec Remote-Access Connection Profile PPP Attributes

Procedure

Step 1 Enter tunnel-group ppp-attributes configuration mode, in which you configure the remote-access tunnel-group
PPP attributes, by entering the following command. The prompt changes to indicate the mode change:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name type remote-access


hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name ppp-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#

For example, the following command designates that the tunnel-group ppp-attributes mode commands that
follow pertain to the connection profile named TG1. Notice that the prompt changes to indicate that you are
now in tunnel-group ppp-attributes mode:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 type remote-access


hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 ppp-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#

Step 2 Specify whether to enable authentication using specific protocols for the PPP connection. The protocol value
can be any of the following:
• pap—Enables the use of Password Authentication Protocol for the PPP connection.
• chap—Enables the use of Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol for the PPP connection.
• ms-chap-v1 or ms-chap-v2—Enables the use of Microsoft Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol,
version 1 or version 2 for the PPP connection.
• eap—Enables the use of Extensible Authentication protocol for the PPP connection.

CHAP and MSCHAPv1 are enabled by default.


The syntax of this command is:

hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# authentication protocol


hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#

To disable authentication for a specific protocol, use the no form of the command:

hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# no authentication protocol


hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#

For example, the following command enables the use of the PAP protocol for a PPP connection:

hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# authentication pap


hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#

The following command enables the use of the MS-CHAP, version 2 protocol for a PPP connection:

hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# authentication ms-chap-v2


hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
94
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure LAN-to-LAN Connection Profiles

The following command enables the use of the EAP-PROXY protocol for a PPP connection:

hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# authentication pap


hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#

The following command disables the use of the MS-CHAP, version 1 protocol for a PPP connection:

hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)# no authentication ms-chap-v1


hostname(config-tunnel-ppp)#

Configure LAN-to-LAN Connection Profiles


An IPsec LAN-to-LAN VPN connection profile applies only to LAN-to-LAN IPsec client connections. While
many of the parameters that you configure are the same as for IPsec remote-access connection profiles,
LAN-to-LAN tunnels have fewer parameters. The following sections show you how to configure a LAN-to-LAN
connection profile:
• Specify a Name and Type for a LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile, on page 95
• Configure LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile General Attributes, on page 96
• Configure LAN-to-LAN IPsec IKEv1 Attributes, on page 96

Default LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile Configuration


The contents of the default LAN-to-LAN connection profile are as follows:

tunnel-group DefaultL2LGroup type ipsec-l2l


tunnel-group DefaultL2LGroup general-attributes
default-group-policy DfltGrpPolicy
tunnel-group DefaultL2LGroup ipsec-attributes
no ikev1 pre-shared-key
peer-id-validate req
no chain
no ikev1 trust-point
isakmp keepalive threshold 10 retry 2

LAN-to-LAN connection profiles have fewer parameters than remote-access connection profiles, and most
of these are the same for both groups. For your convenience in configuring the connection, they are listed
separately here. Any parameters that you do not explicitly configure inherit their values from the default
connection profile.

Specify a Name and Type for a LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile


To specify a name and a type for a connection profile, enter the tunnel-group command, as follows:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel_group_name type tunnel_type

For a LAN-to-LAN tunnel, the type is ipsec-l2l.; for example, to create the LAN-to-LAN connection profile
named docs, enter the following command:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
95
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile General Attributes

hostname(config)# tunnel-group docs type ipsec-l2l


hostname(config)#

Configure LAN-to-LAN Connection Profile General Attributes


To configure the connection profile general attributes, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 Enter tunnel-group general-attributes mode by specifying the general-attributes keyword in either single or
multiple context mode:
tunnel-group tunnel-group-name general-attributes
Example:
For the connection profile named docs, enter the following command:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group docs general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

The prompt changes to indicate that you are now in config-general mode, in which you configure the
tunnel-group general attributes.

Step 2 Specify the name of the default group policy:


default-group-policy policyname
Example:
The following command specifies that the name of the default group policy is MyPolicy:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy MyPolicy


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Configure LAN-to-LAN IPsec IKEv1 Attributes


To configure the IPsec IKEv1 attributes, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 To configure the tunnel-group IPsec IKEv1 attributes, enter tunnel-group ipsec-attributes configuration mode
by entering the tunnel-group command with the IPsec-attributes keyword in either single or multiple context
mode.

hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name ipsec-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
96
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure LAN-to-LAN IPsec IKEv1 Attributes

For example, the following command enters config-ipsec mode so that you can configure the parameters for
the connection profile named TG1:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group TG1 ipsec-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

The prompt changes to indicate that you are now in tunnel-group ipsec-attributes configuration mode.

Step 2 Specify the preshared key to support IKEv1 connections based on preshared keys.

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev1 pre-shared-key key


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

For example, the following command specifies the preshared key XYZX to support IKEv1 connections for
an LAN-to-LAN connection profile:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev1 pre-shared-key xyzx


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 3 Specify whether to validate the identity of the peer using the peer’s certificate:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# peer-id-validate option


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

The available options are req (required), cert (if supported by certificate), and nocheck (do not check). The
default is req. For example, the following command sets the peer-id-validate option to nocheck:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# peer-id-validate nocheck


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Step 4 Specify whether to enable sending of a certificate chain. This action includes the root certificate and any
subordinate CA certificates in the transmission:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# chain
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

You can apply this attribute to all tunnel-group types.

Step 5 Specify the name of a trustpoint that identifies the certificate to be sent to the IKE peer:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# trust-point trust-point-name


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

For example, the following command sets the trustpoint name to mytrustpoint:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# trust-point mytrustpoint


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

You can apply this attribute to all tunnel-group types.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
97
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure LAN-to-LAN IPsec IKEv1 Attributes

Step 6 Specify the ISAKMP (IKE) keepalive threshold and the number of retries allowed. The threshold parameter
specifies the number of seconds (10 through 3600) that the peer is allowed to idle before beginning keepalive
monitoring. The retry parameter is the interval (2 through 10 seconds) between retries after a keepalive
response has not been received. IKE keepalives are enabled by default. To disable IKE keepalives, enter the
no form of the isakmp command:

hostname(config)# isakmp keepalive threshold <number> retry <number>


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

For example, the following command sets the ISAKMP keepalive threshold to 15 seconds and sets the retry
interval to 10 seconds:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold 15 retry 10


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

The default value for the threshold parameter for LAN-to-LAN is 10, and the default value for the retry
parameter is 2.
To specify that the central site (secure gateway) should never initiate ISAKMP monitoring, enter the following
command:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp keepalive threshold infinite


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Step 7 Specify the ISAKMP hybrid authentication method, XAUTH or hybrid XAUTH.
You use isakmp ikev1-user-authentication command to implement hybrid XAUTH authentication when
you need to use digital certificates for ASA authentication and a different, legacy method for remote VPN
user authentication, such as RADIUS, TACACS+ or SecurID. Hybrid XAUTH breaks phase 1 of IKE down
into the following two steps, together called hybrid authentication:
a) The ASA authenticates to the remote VPN user with standard public key techniques. This establishes an
IKE security association that is unidirectionally authenticated.
b) An XAUTH exchange then authenticates the remote VPN user. This extended authentication can use one
of the supported legacy authentication methods.
Note Before the authentication type can be set to hybrid, you must configure the authentication server,
create a preshared key, and configure a trustpoint.

For example, the following commands enable hybrid XAUTH for a connection profile called
example-group:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group example-group type remote-access


hostname(config)# tunnel-group example-group ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# isakmp ikev1-user-authentication hybrid
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
98
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Connection Profiles for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

Configure Connection Profiles for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions


The tunnel-group general attributes for clientless SSL VPN connection profiles are the same as those for IPsec
remote-access connection profiles, except that the tunnel-group type is webvpn and the strip-group and
strip-realm commands do not apply. You define the attribute specific to clientless SSL VPN separately. The
following sections describe how to configure clientless SSL VPN connection profiles:
• Configure General Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions, on page 99
• Configure Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions, on page 102

Configure General Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions


To configure or change the connection profile general attributes, specify the parameters in the following steps.

Procedure

Step 1 To configure the general attributes, enter tunnel-group general-attributes command, which enters tunnel-group
general-attributes configuration mode in either single or multiple context mode. Note that the prompt changes:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel_group_name general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

To configure the general attributes for TunnelGroup3, created in the previous section, enter the following
command:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group TunnelGroup3 general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 2 Specify the name of the authentication-server group, if any, to use. If you want to use the LOCAL database
for authentication if the specified server group fails, append the keyword LOCAL:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group groupname [LOCAL]


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

For example, to configure the authentication server group named test, and to provide fallback to the LOCAL
server if the authentication server group fails, enter the following command:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group test LOCAL


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

The authentication-server-group name identifies a previously configured authentication server or group of


servers. Use the aaa-server command to configure authentication servers. The maximum length of the group
tag is 16 characters.
You can also configure interface-specific authentication by including the name of an interface in parentheses
before the group name. The following interfaces are available by default:
• inside—Name of interface GigabitEthernet0/1
• outside— Name of interface GigabitEthernet0/0

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
99
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure General Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

Note The ASA’s outside interface address (for both IPv4/IPv6) cannot overlap with the private side
address space.

Other interfaces you have configured (using the interface command) are also available. The following
command configures interface-specific authentication for the interface named outside using the server
servergroup1 for authentication:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication-server-group (outside) servergroup1


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 3 Optionally, specify the name of the authorization-server group, if any, to use. If you are not using authorization,
go to Step 6. When you configure this value, users must exist in the authorization database to connect:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-group groupname


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Use the aaa-server command to configure authorization servers. The maximum length of the group tag is 16
characters.
For example, the following command specifies the use of the authorization-server group FinGroup:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-server-group FinGroup


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 4 Specify whether to require a successful authorization before allowing a user to connect. The default is not to
require authorization.

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-required
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 5 Specify the attribute or attributes to use in deriving a name for an authorization query from a certificate. This
attribute specifies what part of the subject DN field to use as the username for authorization:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-dn-attributes {primary-attribute


[secondary-attribute] | use-entire-name}

For example, the following command specifies the use of the CN attribute as the username for authorization:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authorization-dn-attributes CN
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

The authorization-dn-attributes are C (Country), CN (Common Name), DNQ (DN qualifier), EA (E-mail
Address), GENQ (Generational qualifier), GN (Given Name), I (Initials), L (Locality), N (Name), O
(Organization), OU (Organizational Unit), SER (Serial Number), SN (Surname), SP (State/Province), T
(Title), UID (User ID), and UPN (User Principal Name).

Step 6 Optionally, specify the name of the accounting-server group, if any, to use. If you are not using accounting,
go to Step 7. Use the aaa-server command to configure accounting servers. The maximum length of the group
tag is 16 characters.:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group groupname

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
100
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure General Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

For example, the following command specifies the use of the accounting-server group comptroller:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group comptroller


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 7 Optionally, specify the name of the default group policy. The default value is DfltGrpPolicy:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy policyname


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

The following example sets MyDfltGrpPolicy as the name of the default group policy:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy MyDfltGrpPolicy


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 8 Optionally, specify the name or IP address of the DHCP server (up to 10 servers), and the names of the DHCP
address pools (up to 6 pools). Separate the list items with spaces. The defaults are no DHCP server and no
address pool.

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# dhcp-server server1 [...server10]


hostname(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool [(interface name)] address_pool1
[...address_pool6]
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Note The interface name must be enclosed in parentheses.


You configure address pools with the ip local pool command in global configuration mode. See IP
Addresses for VPNs, on page 171 for information about configuring address pools.

Step 9 Optionally, if your server is a RADIUS, RADIUS with NT, or LDAP server, you can enable password
management.
Note If you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication, password management is supported
with the Sun Microsystems JAVA System Directory Server (formerly named the Sun ONE Directory
Server) and the Microsoft Active Directory.
• Sun—The DN configured on the ASA to access a Sun directory server must be able to access
the default password policy on that server. We recommend using the directory administrator,
or a user with directory administrator privileges, as the DN. Alternatively, you can place an
ACI on the default password policy.
• Microsoft—You must configure LDAP over SSL to enable password management with
Microsoft Active Directory.

This feature, which is enabled by default, warns a user when the current password is about to expire. The
default is to begin warning the user 14 days before expiration:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# password-management
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
101
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

If the server is an LDAP server, you can specify the number of days (0 through 180) before expiration to
begin warning the user about the pending expiration:

hostname(config-tunnel-general)# password-management [password-expire in days n]


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Note The password-management command, entered in tunnel-group general-attributes configuration


mode replaces the deprecated radius-with-expiry command that was formerly entered in tunnel-group
ipsec-attributes mode.

When you configure this command, the ASA notifies the remote user at login that the user’s current password
is about to expire or has expired. The ASA then offers the user the opportunity to change the password. If the
current password has not yet expired, the user can still log in using that password. The ASA ignores this
command if RADIUS or LDAP authentication has not been configured.
Note that this does not change the number of days before the password expires, but rather, the number of days
ahead of expiration that the ASA starts warning the user that the password is about to expire.
If you do specify the password-expire-in-days keyword, you must also specify the number of days.
See Configure Microsoft Active Directory Settings for Password Management, on page 113 for more
information.

Configure Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions


To configure the parameters specific to a clientless SSL VPN connection profile, follow the steps in this
section. Clientless SSL VPN was formerly known as WebVPN, and you configure these attributes in
tunnel-group webvpn-attributes mode.

Procedure

Step 1 To specify the attributes of a clientless SSL VPN tunnel-group, enter tunnel-group webvpn-attributes mode
by entering the following command. The prompt changes to indicate the mode change:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group tunnel-group-name webvpn-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

For example, to specify the webvpn-attributes for the clientless SSL VPN tunnel-group named sales, enter
the following command:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group sales webvpn-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

Step 2 To specify the authentication method to use: AAA, digital certificates, or both, enter the authentication
command. You can specify either aaa or certificate or both, in any order.

hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# authentication authentication_method


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
102
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

For example, The following command allows both AAA and certificate authentication:

hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# authentication aaa certificate


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

Step 3 The ASA queries NetBIOS name servers to map NetBIOS names to IP addresses. Clientless SSL VPN requires
NetBIOS to access or share files on remote systems. Clientless SSL VPN uses NetBIOS and the CIFS protocol
to access or share files on remote systems. When you attempt a file-sharing connection to a Windows computer
by using its computer name, the file server you specify corresponds to a specific NetBIOS name that identifies
a resource on the network.
To make the NBNS function operational, you must configure at least one NetBIOS server (host). You can
configure up to three NBNS servers for redundancy. The ASA uses the first server on the list for NetBIOS/CIFS
name resolution. If the query fails, it uses the next server.
To specify the name of the NBNS (NetBIOS Name Service) server to use for CIFS name resolution, use the
nbns-server command. You can enter up to three server entries. The first server you configure is the primary
server, and the others are backups, for redundancy. You can also specify whether this is a master browser
(rather than just a WINS server), the timeout interval, and the number of retries. A WINS server or a master
browser is typically on the same network as the ASA, or reachable from that network. You must specify the
timeout interval before the number of retries:

hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server {host-name | IP_address} [master] [seconds]


[retry number]
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

For example, to configure the server named nbnsprimary as the primary server and the server 192.168.2.2 as
the secondary server, each allowing three retries and having a 5-second timeout, enter the following command:

hostname(config)# name 192.168.2.1 nbnsprimary


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server nbnsprimary master timeout 5 retry 3
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server 192.168.2.2 timeout 5 retry 3
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

The timeout interval can range from 1 through 30 seconds (default 2), and the number of retries can be in the
range 0 through 10 (default 2).
The nbns-server command in tunnel-group webvpn-attributes configuration mode replaces the deprecated
nbns-server command in webvpn configuration mode.

Step 4 To specify alternative names for the group, use the group-alias command. Specifying the group alias creates
one or more alternate names by which the user can refer to a tunnel-group. The group alias that you specify
here appears in the drop-down list on the user’s login page. Each group can have multiple aliases or no alias,
each specified in separate commands. This feature is useful when the same group is known by several common
names, such as “Devtest” and “QA.”
For each group alias, enter a group-alias command. Each alias is enabled by default. You can optionally
explicitly enable or disable each alias:

hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias alias [enable | disable]


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

For example, to enable the aliases QA and Devtest for a tunnel-group named QA, enter the following commands:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
103
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias QA enable


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias Devtest enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

Note The webvpn tunnel-group-list must be enabled for the (dropdown) group list to appear.

Step 5 Specify incoming URLs or IP addresses for the group.


group-url url[enable | disable]
You can configure multiple URLs or addresses (or none) for a group. For each group URL or address, enter
a group-url command. Theurl specifies a URL or IP address for this tunnel group. You must specify the
entire URL or address, including either the http or https protocol. Each URL or address can be enabled (default)
or disabled individually.
Specifying a group URL or IP address eliminates the need for the user to select a group at login. When a user
logs in, the ASA looks for the user’s incoming URL or address in the tunnel-group-policy table. If it finds
the URL or address and if group-url is enabled in the connection profile, then the ASA automatically selects
the associated connection profile and presents the user with only the username and password fields in the
login window. This simplifies the user interface and has the added advantage of never exposing the list of
groups to the user. The login window that the user sees uses the customizations configured for that connection
profile.
If the URL or address is disabled and group-alias is configured, then the dropdown list of groups is displayed,
and the user must make a selection.
You cannot associate the same URL or address with multiple groups. The ASA verifies the uniqueness of the
URL or address before accepting the URL or address for a connection profile.
Example:
To enable the group URLs http://www.example.com and http://192.168.10.10 for the tunnel-group named
RadiusServer, enter the following commands:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group RadiusServer type webvpn


hostname(config)# tunnel-group RadiusServer general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# authentication server-group RADIUS
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# accounting-server-group RADIUS
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# tunnel-group RadiusServer webvpn-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias “Cisco Remote Access” enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-url http://www.example.com enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-url http://192.168.10.10 enable
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

For a more extensive example, see Customize Login Windows for Users of Clientless SSL VPN Sessions, on
page 107.
A Load Balancing deployment that uses Group URLs for AnyConnect client connectivity, requires each ASA
node in the cluster to configure a Group URL for the virtual cluster address, as well as a Group URL for the
node's Load Balancing public address.
Example:
Configure group-urls appropriately for a load balancing deployment with two ASA nodes in a cluster whose
addresses are as follows:
• Virtual IP for Load Balancing = https://vip-vpn.example.com/groupname

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
104
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

• ASA1 = https://asa1.example.com/groupname
• ASA2 = https://asa2.example.com/groupname

The Tunnel-Group configuration on ASA1 must have the following group-url's configured:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group LB1 type webvpn


hostname(config)# tunnel-group LB1 general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# group-url https://vip-vpn.example.com/groupname
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# group-url https://asa1.example.com/groupname

The Tunnel-Group configuration on ASA2 must have the following group-url's configured:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group LB2 type webvpn


hostname(config)# tunnel-group LB2 general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# group-url https://vip-vpn.example.com/groupname
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# group-url https://asa2.example.com/groupname

Step 6 (Optional.) To exempt certain users from running the Hostscan application of Cisco Secure Desktop on a per
connection profile basis if they enter one of the group URLs, enter the following command:

hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# without-csd [anyconnect]


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

Entering this command prevents the detection of endpoint conditions for these sessions, so you may need to
adjust the dynamic access policy (DAP) configuration.
Include the anyconnect keyword if you want to limit the exemption to AnyConnect connections only. If you
do not include the keyword, the exemption applies to clientless, Layer 3, and AnyConnect connections.

Step 7 To specify the DNS server group to use for a connection profile for clientless SSL VPN sessions, use the
dns-group command. The group you specify must be one you already configured in global configuration mode
(using the dns server-group and name-server commands).
By default, the connection profile uses the DNS server group DefaultDNS. However, this group must be
configured before the security appliance can resolve DNS requests.
The following example configures a new DNS server group named corp_dns and specifies that server group
for the connection profile telecommuters:

hostname(config)# dns server-group corp_dns


hostname(config-dns-server-group)# domain-name cisco.com
hostname(config-dns-server-group)# name-server 209.165.200.224

hostname(config)# tunnel-group telecommuters webvpn-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# dns-group corp_dns
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

Step 8 (Optional) To enable extracting a username from a client certificate for use in authentication and authorization,
use the pre-fill-username command in tunnel-group webvpn-attributes mode.

hostname(config)# pre-fill-username {ssl-client | clientless}

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
105
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Tunnel-Group Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

The pre-fill-username command enables the use of a username extracted from the certificate field specified
in the username-from-certificate command (in tunnel-group general-attributes mode) as the username for
username/password authentication and authorization. To use this pre-fill username from certificate feature,
you must configure both commands.
Note In Version 8.0.4, the username is not pre-filled; instead, any data sent in the username field is
ignored.

The following example, entered in global configuration mode, creates an IPsec remote access tunnel group
named remotegrp, enables getting the username from a certificate, and specifies that the name for an
authentication or authorization query for an SSL VPN client must be derived from a digital certificate:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp type ipsec_ra


hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# username-from-certificate CN OU
hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp webvpn-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# pre-fill-username ssl-client
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

Step 9 (Optional) To specify whether to override the group policy or username attributes configuration for downloading
an AnyConnect or SSL VPN client, use the override-svc-download command. This feature is disabled by
default.
The security appliance allows clientless or AnyConnect client connections for remote users based on whether
clientless and/or SSL VPN is enabled in the group policy or username attributes with the vpn-tunnel-protocol
command. The anyconnect ask command further modifies the client user experience by prompting the user
to download the client or return to the WebVPN home page.
However, you might want clientless users logging in under specific tunnel groups to not experience delays
waiting for the download prompt to expire before being presented with the clientless SSL VPN home page.
You can prevent delays for these users at the connection profile level with the override-svc-download
command. This command causes users logging through a connection profile to be immediately presented with
the clientless SSL VPN home page regardless of the vpn-tunnel-protocol or anyconnect ask command
settings.
In the following example, you enter tunnel-group webvpn attributes configuration mode for the connection
profile engineering and enable the connection profile to override the group policy and username attribute
settings for client download prompts:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group engineering webvpn-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# override-svc-download

Step 10 (Optional) To enable the display of a RADIUS reject message on the login screen when authentication is
rejected, use the radius-eject-message command.
The following example enables the display of a RADIUS rejection message for the connection profile named
engineering:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group engineering webvpn-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# radius-reject-message

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
106
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Customize Login Windows for Users of Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

Customize Login Windows for Users of Clientless SSL VPN Sessions


Customizations determine the appearance of the windows that the user sees upon login. You configure the
customization parameters as part of configuring clientless SSL VPN. To apply a previously defined web-page
customization to change the look-and-feel of the web page that the user sees at login, enter the customization
command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# customization customization_name


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

For example, to use the customization named blueborder, enter the following command:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# customization blueborder


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

You configure the customization itself by entering the customization command in webvpn mode.
The following example shows a command sequence that first establishes a customization named 123 that
defines a password prompt. The example then defines a group policy named testpolicy and uses the
customization command to specify the use of the customization named 123 for clientless SSL VPN sessions:

hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization 123
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# password-prompt Enter password
hostname(config-webvpn)# exit
hostname(config)# group-policy testpolicy nopassword
hostname(config)# group-policy testpolicy attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# customization value 123
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

You can set up different login windows for different groups by using a combination of customization profiles
and connection profiles. For example, assuming that you had created a customization profile called salesgui,
you can create a connection profile for clientless SSL VPN sessions called sales that uses that customization
profile, as the following example shows:

Procedure

Step 1 In webvpn mode, define a customization for clientless SSL VPN access, in this case named salesgui and
change the default logo to mycompanylogo.gif. You must have previously loaded mycompanylogo.gif onto
the flash memory of the ASA and saved the configuration. See Clientless SSL VPN Overview, on page 257
for details.

hostname# webvpn
hostname (config-webvpn)# customization value salesgui
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# logo file disk0:\mycompanylogo.gif
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)#

Step 2 In global configuration mode, set up a username and associate with it the customization for clientless SSL
VPN that you have just defined:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
107
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
About Tunnel Groups for Standards-based IKEv2 Clients

hostname# username seller attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization value salesgui
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# exit
hostname(config-username)# exit
hostname#

Step 3 In global configuration mode, create a tunnel-group for clientless SSL VPN sessions named sales:

hostname# tunnel-group sales type webvpn


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

Step 4 Specify that you want to use the salesgui customization for this connection profile:

hostname# tunnel-group sales webvpn-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# customization salesgui

Step 5 Set the group URL to the address that the user enters into the browser to log in to the ASA; for example, if
the ASA has the IP address 192.168.3.3, set the group URL to https://192.168.3.3:

hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-url https://192.168.3.3.


hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#

If a port number is required for a successful login, include the port number, preceded by a colon. The ASA
maps this URL to the sales connection profile and applies the salesgui customization profile to the login screen
that the user sees upon logging in to https://192.168.3.3.

About Tunnel Groups for Standards-based IKEv2 Clients


A tunnel group is a set of records that contain tunnel connection policies. You configure a tunnel group to
identify AAA servers, specify connection parameters, and define a default group policy. The ASA stores
tunnel groups internally.
The default tunnel group for IPsec remote access is the DefaultRAGroup. You may modify the default tunnel
group, but not delete it.
IKEv2 allows asymmetric authentication methods to be configured (that is, preshared key authentication for
the originator but certificate authentication or EAP authentication for the responder) using separate local and
remote authentication CLIs. Therefore, with IKEv2 you have asymmetric authentication, in which one side
authenticates with one credential and the other side uses another credential (either a preshared key, certificate,
or EAP).
The DefaultRAGroup should be configured for EAP authentication because these client connections cannot
be mapped to a specific tunnel group unless certificate authentication is used with certificate DN matching.

Standards-based IKEv2 Attribute Support


The ASA supports the following IKEv2 attributes:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
108
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
DAP Support

• INTERNAL_IP4_ADDRESS/INTERNAL_IP6_ADDRESS—IPv4 or IPv6 address

Note Dual stack (assignment of both an IPv4 and IPv6 address) is not supported for
IKEv2. If both an IPv4 and an IPv6 address are requested and both addresses
may be assigned, only an IPv4 address is assigned.

• INTERNAL_IP4_NETMASK—IPv4 address network mask


• INTERNAL_IP4_DNS/INTERNAL_IP6_DNS—Primary/Secondary DNS address
• INTERNAL_IP4_NBNS—Primary/Secondary WINS address
• INTERNAL_IP4_SUBNET/INTERNAL_IP6_SUBNET—Split-tunneling lists
• APPLICATION_VERSION—Ignored. No response is sent to avoid communicating any version
information about the ASA for security reasons. However, the client configuration payload request may
include this attribute, and the string appears on the ASA in the vpn-sessiondb command output and in
the syslog.

DAP Support
To allow DAP policy configuration per connection type, a new Client Type, IPsec-IKEv2-Generic-RA, can
be used to apply specific policy for this connection type.

Tunnel Group Selection for Remote Access Clients


The following table provides a list of remote access clients and their available tunnel group options:

Remote Access Tunnel Group Group URL Certificate DN Default Group Other
Client List Matching
(DefaultRAGroup)

AnyConnect Yes Yes Yes Yes N/A


VPN Client

Windows No No • Yes (when Yes N/A


L2TP/IPsec using local
machine
(Main Mode
certificates)
IKEv1)
• No (when
using PSK)

Standards-based No No • Yes (when Yes N/A


IKEv2 using local
Note You must use the
machine
DefaultRAGroup
certificates)
tunnel group.
• No (when
using EAP
authentication)

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
109
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Authentication Support for Standards-based IKEv2 Clients

Authentication Support for Standards-based IKEv2 Clients


The following table provides a list of standards-based IKEv2 clients and their supported authentication methods:

Note Authentication method limitations are based on lack of support on the client, not on the ASA. All EAP method
authentication is proxied by the ASA between the client and EAP server. EAP method support is based on
client and EAP server support for the EAP method.

Client Type/ EAP-TLS EAP-MSCHAPv2 EAP-MD5 Certificate Only PSK


Authentication
Method

StrongSwan on N/A • ISE—Yes • ISE—Yes Yes Yes


Linux
• ACS—Yes • ACS—Yes
• FreeRadius—Yes • FreeRadius—Yes
• AD via • AD via
FreeRadius—Yes FreeRadius—Yes

StrongSwan on N/A • ISE—Yes No Yes N/A


Android
• ACS —Yes
• FreeRadius—Yes
• AD via
FreeRadius—Yes

Windows 7/8/8.1 • ISE—Yes • ISE—Yes N/A Yes NA


• ACS —Yes • ACS —Yes
• FreeRadius—Yes • FreeRadius—Yes
• AD via • AD via
FreeRadius—Yes FreeRadius—Yes

Windows Phone • ISE—Yes • ISE—Yes N/A N/A N/A


• ACS —Yes • ACS —Yes
• FreeRadius—Yes • FreeRadius—Yes
• AD via • AD via
FreeRadius—Yes FreeRadius—Yes

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
110
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure the query-identity Option for Retrieval of EAP Identity

Client Type/ EAP-TLS EAP-MSCHAPv2 EAP-MD5 Certificate Only PSK


Authentication
Method

Samsung Knox N/A • ISE—Yes • ISE—Yes Yes N/A


• ACS —Yes • ACS —Yes
• FreeRadius—Yes • FreeRadius—Yes
• AD via • AD via
FreeRadius—Yes FreeRadius—Yes

iOS 8 • ISE—Yes • ISE—Yes N/A Yes Yes


• ACS —Yes • ACS —Yes
• FreeRadius—Yes • FreeRadius—Yes
• AD via • AD via
FreeRadius—Yes FreeRadius—Yes

Android Native N/A • ISE—Yes N/A Yes Yes


Client
• ACS —Yes
• FreeRadius—Yes
• AD via
FreeRadius—Yes

Configure the query-identity Option for Retrieval of EAP Identity


The Microsoft Windows 7 IKEv2 client sends an IP address as the Internet Key Exchange (IKE) identity that
prevents the Cisco ASA server from using it efficiently for tunnel-group lookup. The ASA must be configured
with the query-identity option for EAP authentication to allow the ASA to retrieve a valid EAP identity from
the client.
For certificate-based authentication, the ASA server and Microsoft Windows 7 client certificates must have
an Extended Key Usage (EKU) field as follows:
• For the client certificate, EKU field = client authentication certificate.
• For the server certificate, EKU field = server authentication certificate.

You can obtain the certificates from the Microsoft Certificate Server or other CA server.
For EAP authentication, the Microsoft Windows 7 IKEv2 client expects an EAP identity request before any
other EAP requests. Make sure that you configure the query-identity keyword in the tunnel group profile on
the IKEv2 ASA server to send an EAP identity request to the client.

Note DHCP intercept is supported for IKEv2 to allow Windows to do split-tunneling. This feature only works with
IPv4 split-tunneling attributes.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
111
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure the query-identity Option for Retrieval of EAP Identity

Procedure

Step 1 To set the connection type to IPsec remote access, enter the tunnel-group command. The syntax is
tunnel-group name type type, where name is the name you assign to the tunnel group, and type is the type
of tunnel:
In the following example, the IKEv2 preshared key is configured as 44kkaol59636jnfx:

hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev2 local-authentication pre-shared-key 44kkaol59636jnfx

Note You must configure the ikev2 remote-authentication pre-shared-key command or ikev2
remote-authentication certificate command to complete the authentication.

Step 2 To specify Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP) as the method that supports user authentication with
standards-based, third-party IKEv2 remote access clients, use the ikev2 remote-authentication eap
[query-identity] command.
Note Before you can enable EAP for remote authentication, you must configure local authentication using
a certificate and configure a valid trustpoint using the ikev2 local-authentication {certificate
trustpoint} command. Otherwise, the EAP authentication request is rejected.
You may configure multiple options that allow the client to use any of the configured options, but
not all, for remote authentication.
For IKEv2 connections, the tunnel group mapping must know which authentication methods to
allow for remote authentication (PSK, certificate, and EAP) and local authentication (PSK and
certificate), and which trust point to use for local authentication. Currently, mapping is performed
using the IKE ID, which is taken from the peer or peer certificate field value (using the certificate
map). If both options fail, then the in-coming connection is mapped to the default remote access
tunnel group, DefaultRAGroup. A certificate map is an applicable option only when the remote
peer is authenticated via a certificate. This map allows mapping to different tunnel groups. For
certificate authentication only, the tunnel group lookup is performed using rules or using the default
setting. For EAP and PSK authentication, the tunnel group lookup is performed using the IKE ID
on the client (it matches the tunnel group name) or using the default setting.
For EAP authentication, you must use the DefaultRAGroup tunnel group unless the client allows
the IKE ID and username to be configured independently.

The following example shows an EAP request for authentication being denied:

ciscoasa(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev2 remote-authentication eap query-identity


ciscoasa(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev2 remote-authentication certificate
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev2 local-authentication pre-shared-key 12345678
ERROR: The local-authentication method is required to be certificate based
if remote-authentication allows EAP
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev2 local-authentication certificate myIDcert

Step 3 Save your changes.

hostname(config)# write memory


hostname(config)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
112
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Microsoft Active Directory Settings for Password Management

To verify that the tunnel is up and running, use the show vpn-sessiondb summary or show crypto ipsec sa
command.

Configure Microsoft Active Directory Settings for Password Management


If you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication, password management is supported with the
Sun Microsystems JAVA System Directory Server (formerly named the Sun ONE Directory Server) and the
Microsoft Active Directory.
• Sun—The DN configured on the ASA to access a Sun directory server must be able to access the default
password policy on that server. We recommend using the directory administrator, or a user with directory
administrator privileges, as the DN. Alternatively, you can place an ACI on the default password policy.
• Microsoft—You must configure LDAP over SSL to enable password management with Microsoft Active
Directory.

To use password management with Microsoft Active Directory, you must set certain Active Directory
parameters as well as configuring password management on the ASA. This section describes the Active
Directory settings associated with various password management actions. These descriptions assume that you
have also enabled password management on the ASA and configured the corresponding password management
attributes. The specific steps in this section refer to Active Directory terminology under Windows 2000. This
section assumes that you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication.

Use Active Directory to Force the User to Change Password at Next Logon
To force a user to change the user password at the next logon, specify the password-management command
in tunnel-group general-attributes configuration mode on the ASA and perform the following steps under
Active Directory:

Procedure

Step 1 Choose Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Active Directory Users and Computers.
Step 2 Right-click to choose Username > Properties > Account.
Step 3 Check the User must change password at next logon check box.
The next time this user logs on, the ASA displays the following prompt: “New password required. Password
change required. You must enter a new password with a minimum length n to continue.” You can set the
minimum required password length, n, as part of the Active Directory configuration at Start > Programs >
Administrative Tools > Domain Security Policy > Windows Settings > Security Settings > Account Policies >
Password Policy. Select Minimum password length.

Use Active Directory to Specify Maximum Password Age


To enhance security, you can specify that passwords expire after a certain number of days. To specify a
maximum password age for a user password, specify the password-management command in tunnel-group
general-attributes configuration mode on the ASA and perform the following steps under Active Directory:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
113
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Use Active Directory to Enforce Minimum Password Length

Note The radius-with-expiry command, formerly configured as part of tunnel-group remote-access configuration
to perform the password age function, is deprecated. The password-management command, entered in
tunnel-group general-attributes mode, replaces it.

Procedure

Step 1 Choose Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Domain Security Policy > Windows Settings >
Security Settings > Account Policies > Password Policy.
Step 2 Double-click Maximum password age.
Step 3 Check the Define this policy setting check box and specify the maximum password age, in days, that you
want to allow.

Use Active Directory to Enforce Minimum Password Length


To enforce a minimum length for passwords, specify the password-management command in tunnel-group
general-attributes configuration mode on the ASA and perform the following steps under Active Directory:

Procedure

Step 1 Chose Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Domain Security Policy.
Step 2 Chose Windows Settings > Security Settings > Account Policies > Password Policy.
Step 3 Double-click Minimum Password Length.
Step 4 Check the Define this policy setting check box and specify the minimum number of characters that the
password must contain.

Use Active Directory to Enforce Password Complexity


To enforce complex passwords—for example, to require that a password contain upper- and lowercase letters,
numbers, and special characters—enter the password-management command in tunnel-group general-attributes
configuration mode on the ASA and perform the following steps under Active Directory:

Procedure

Step 1 Choose Start > Programs > Administrative Tools > Domain Security Policy. Select Windows Settings >
Security Settings > Account Policies > Password Policy.
Step 2 Double-click Password must meet complexity requirements to open the Security Policy Setting dialog box.
Step 3 Check the Define this policy setting check box and select Enable.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
114
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure the Connection Profile for RADIUS/SDI Message Support for the AnyConnect Client

Enforcing password complexity takes effect only when the user changes passwords; for example, when you
have configured Enforce password change at next login or Password expires in n days. At login, the user
receives a prompt to enter a new password, and the system will accept only a complex password.

Configure the Connection Profile for RADIUS/SDI Message Support for the
AnyConnect Client
This section describes procedures to ensure that the AnyConnect VPN client using RSA SecureID Software
tokens can properly respond to user prompts delivered to the client through a RADIUS server proxying to an
SDI server(s).

Note If you have configured the double-authentication feature, SDI authentication is supported only on the primary
authentication server.

When a remote user connects to the ASA with the AnyConnect VPN client and attempts to authenticate using
an RSA SecurID token, the ASA communicates with the RADIUS server, which in turn, communicates with
the SDI server about the authentication.
During authentication, the RADIUS server presents access challenge messages to the ASA. Within these
challenge messages are reply messages containing text from the SDI server. The message text is different
when the ASA is communicating directly with an SDI server than when communicating through the RADIUS
proxy. Therefore, in order to appear as a native SDI server to the AnyConnect client, the ASA must interpret
the messages from the RADIUS server.
Also, because the SDI messages are configurable on the SDI server, the message text on the ASA must match
(in whole or in part) the message text on the SDI server. Otherwise, the prompts displayed to the remote client
user may not be appropriate for the action required during authentication. The AnyConnect client may fail to
respond and authentication may fail.
Configure the Security Appliance to Support RADIUS/SDI Messages, on page 115 describes how to configure
the ASA to ensure successful authentication between the client and the SDI server.

Configure the Security Appliance to Support RADIUS/SDI Messages


To configure the ASA to interpret SDI-specific RADIUS reply messages and prompt the AnyConnect user
for the appropriate action, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 Configure a connection profile (tunnel group) to forward RADIUS reply messages in a manner that simulates
direct communication with an SDI server using the proxy-auth sdi command from tunnel-group webvpn
configuration mode. Users authenticating to the SDI server must connect over this connection profile.
Example:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group sales webvpn attributes


hostname(tunnel-group-webvpn)# proxy-auth sdi

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
115
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure the Security Appliance to Support RADIUS/SDI Messages

Step 2 Configure the RADIUS reply message text on the ASA to match (in whole or in part) the message text sent
by the RADIUS server with the proxy-auth_map sdi command from tunnel-group webvpn configuration
mode.
The default message text used by the ASA is the default message text used by Cisco Secure Access Control
Server (ACS). If you are using Cisco Secure ACS, and it is using the default message text, you do not need
to configure the message text on the ASA. Otherwise, use the proxy-auth_map sdi command to ensure the
message text matches.
The table below shows the message code, the default RADIUS reply message text, and the function of each
message. Because the security appliance searches for strings in the order that they appear in the table, you
must ensure that the string you use for the message text is not a subset of another string.
For example, “new PIN” is a subset of the default message text for both new-pin-sup and next-ccode-and-reauth.
If you configure new-pin-sup as “new PIN,” when the security appliance receives “new PIN with the next
card code” from the RADIUS server, it will match the text to the new-pin-sup code instead of the
next-ccode-and-reauth code.
SDI Op-codes, Default Message Text, and Message Function

Message Code Default RADIUS Reply Message Function


Text

next-code Enter Next PASSCODE Indicates the user must enter the
NEXT tokencode without the PIN.

new-pin-sup Please remember your new PIN Indicates the new system PIN has
been supplied and displays that PIN
for the user.

new-pin-meth Do you want to enter your own pin Requests from the user which new
PIN method to use to create a new
PIN.

new-pin-req Enter your new Alpha-Numerical Indicates a user-generated PIN and


PIN requests that the user enter the PIN.

new-pin-reenter Reenter PIN: Used internally by the ASA for


user-supplied PIN confirmation.
The client confirms the PIN without
prompting the user.

new-pin-sys-ok New PIN Accepted Indicates the user-supplied PIN was


accepted.

next-ccode-and-reauth new PIN with the next card code Follows a PIN operation and
indicates the user must wait for the
next tokencode and to enter both
the new PIN and next tokencode to
authenticate.

ready-for-sys- pin ACCEPT A SYSTEM Used internally by the ASA to


GENERATED PIN indicate the user is ready for the
system-generated PIN.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
116
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Group Policies

The following example enters aaa-server-host mode and changes the text for the RADIUS reply message
new-pin-sup:

hostname(config)# aaa-server radius_sales host 10.10.10.1


hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# proxy-auth_map sdi new-pin-sup “This is your
new PIN”

Group Policies
This section describes group policies and how to configure them.
A group policy is a set of user-oriented attribute/value pairs for IPsec connections that are stored either
internally (locally) on the device or externally on a RADIUS server. The connection profile uses a group
policy that sets terms for user connections after the tunnel is established. Group policies let you apply whole
sets of attributes to a user or a group of users, rather than having to specify each attribute individually for each
user.
Enter the group-policy commands in global configuration mode to assign a group policy to users or to modify
a group policy for specific users.
The ASA includes a default group policy. In addition to the default group policy, which you can modify but
not delete, you can create one or more group policies specific to your environment.
You can configure internal and external group policies. Internal groups are configured on the ASA’s internal
database. External groups are configured on an external authentication server, such as RADIUS. Group policies
include the following attributes:
• Identity
• Server definitions
• Client firewall settings
• Tunneling protocols
• IPsec settings
• Hardware client settings
• Filters
• Client configuration settings
• Connection settings

Modify the Default Group Policy


The ASA supplies a default group policy. You can modify this default group policy, but you cannot delete it.
A default group policy, named DfltGrpPolicy, always exists on the ASA, but this default group policy does
not take effect unless you configure the ASA to use it. When you configure other group policies, any attribute
that you do not explicitly specify inherits its value from the default group policy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
117
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Modify the Default Group Policy

Note AnyConnect profiles, including any or all AnyConnect Profile Types (such as Network Access Manager,
Umbrella, and so on), that are configured on (and then assigned to) the DfltGrpPolicy, are not inherited by
other group policies, unless the other group policies explicitly are configured to inherit from the DfltGrpPolicy.
In other words, AnyConnect profiles that are associated with the DfltGrpPolicy are not inherited when specific
AnyConnect profiles are configured on a group policy.

To view the default group policy, enter the following command:

hostname(config)# show running-config all group-policy DfltGrpPolicy


hostname(config)#

To configure the default group policy, enter the following command:

hostname(config)# group-policy DfltGrpPolicy internal


hostname(config)#

Note The default group policy is always internal. Despite the fact that the command syntax is hostname(config)#
group-policy DfltGrpPolicy {internal | external}, you cannot change its type to external.

To change any of the attributes of the default group policy, use the group-policy attributes command to enter
attributes mode, then specify the commands to change whatever attributes that you want to modify:

hostname(config)# group-policy DfltGrpPolicy attributes

Note The attributes mode applies only to internal group policies.

The default group policy, DfltGrpPolicy, that the ASA provides is as follows:

hostname# show run all group-policy DfltGrpPolicy


group-policy DfltGrpPolicy internal
group-policy DfltGrpPolicy attributes
banner none
wins-server none
dns-server value 10.10.10.1.1
dhcp-network-scope none
vpn-access-hours none
vpn-simultaneous-logins 3
vpn-idle-timeout 30
vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval 1
vpn-session-timeout none
vpn-session-timeout alert-interval 1
vpn-filter none
vpn-tunnel-protocol ikev1 ikev2 l2tp-ipsec ssl-client ssl-clientless
password-storage disable
ip-comp disable
re-xauth disable
group-lock none

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
118
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Modify the Default Group Policy

pfs disable
ipsec-udp disable
ipsec-udp-port 10000
split-tunnel-policy tunnelall
ipv6-split-tunnel-policy tunnelall
split-tunnel-network-list none
default-domain value cisco.com
split-dns none
split-tunnel-all-dns disable
intercept-dhcp 255.255.255.255 disable
secure-unit-authentication disable
user-authentication disable
user-authentication-idle-timeout 30
ip-phone-bypass disable
client-bypass-protocol disable
gateway-fqdn none
leap-bypass disable
nem disable
backup-servers keep-client-config
msie-proxy server none
msie-proxy method no-modify
msie-proxy except-list none
msie-proxy local-bypass disable
msie-proxy pac-url none
msie-proxy lockdown enable
vlan none
nac-settings none
address-pools none
ipv6-address-pools none
smartcard-removal-disconnect enable
scep-forwarding-url none
client-firewall none
client-access-rule none
webvpn
url-list none
filter none
homepage none
html-content-filter none
port-forward name Application Access
port-forward disable
http-proxy disable

anyconnect ssl dtls enable


anyconnect mtu 1406
anyconnect firewall-rule client-interface private none
anyconnect firewall-rule client-interface public none
anyconnect keep-installer installed
anyconnect ssl keepalive 20
anyconnect ssl rekey time none
anyconnect ssl rekey method none
anyconnect dpd-interval client 30
anyconnect dpd-interval gateway 30
anyconnect ssl compression none
anyconnect dtls compression lzs
anyconnect modules none
anyconnect profiles none
anyconnect ask none
customization none
keep-alive-ignore 4
http-comp gzip
download-max-size 2147483647
upload-max-size 2147483647
post-max-size 2147483647
user-storage none

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
119
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Group Policies

storage-objects value cookies,credentials


storage-key none
hidden-shares none
smart-tunnel disable
activex-relay enable
unix-auth-uid 65534
unix-auth-gid 65534
file-entry enable
file-browsing enable
url-entry enable
deny-message value Login was successful, but because certain criteria have not been met
or due to some specific group policy, you do not have permission to use any of the VPN
features. Contact your IT administrator for more information
smart-tunnel auto-signon disable
anyconnect ssl df-bit-ignore disable
anyconnect routing-filtering-ignore disable
smart-tunnel tunnel-policy tunnelall
always-on-vpn profile-setting

You can modify the default group policy, and you can also create one or more group policies specific to your
environment.

Configure Group Policies


A group policy can apply to any kind of tunnel. In each case, if you do not explicitly define a parameter, the
group takes the value from the default group policy.
You can perform these configuration tasks in both single context mode or multiple-context mode:

Note Multiple-context mode applies only to IKEv2 and IKEv1 site to site and does not apply to AnyConnect,
Clientless SSL VPN, the Apple native VPN client, the Microsoft native VPN client, or cTCP for IKEv1 IPsec.

Configure an External Group Policy


External group policies take their attribute values from the external server that you specify. For an external
group policy, you must identify the AAA server group that the ASA can query for attributes and specify the
password to use when retrieving attributes from the external AAA server group. If you are using an external
authentication server, and if your external group-policy attributes exist in the same RADIUS server as the
users that you plan to authenticate, you have to make sure that there is no name duplication between them.

Note External group names on the ASA refer to user names on the RADIUS server. In other words, if you configure
external group X on the ASA, the RADIUS server sees the query as an authentication request for user X. So
external groups are really just user accounts on the RADIUS server that have special meaning to the ASA. If
your external group attributes exist in the same RADIUS server as the users that you plan to authenticate,
there must be no name duplication between them.

The ASA supports user authorization on an external LDAP or RADIUS server. Before you configure the ASA
to use an external server, you must configure the server with the correct ASA authorization attributes and,
from a subset of these attributes, assign specific permissions to individual users. Follow the instructions in
Configure an External AAA Server for VPN, on page 243 to configure your external server.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
120
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create an Internal Group Policy

Procedure

To configure an external group policy, perform the following step and specify a name and type for the group
policy, along with the server-group name and a password:

hostname(config)# group-policy group_policy_name type server-group server_group_name password


server_password
hostname(config)#

Note For an external group policy, RADIUS is the only supported AAA server type.

For example, the following command creates an external group policy named ExtGroup that gets its attributes
from an external RADIUS server named ExtRAD and specifies that the password to use when retrieving the
attributes is newpassword:

hostname(config)# group-policy ExtGroup external server-group ExtRAD password newpassword


hostname(config)#

Note You can configure several vendor-specific attributes (VSAs), as described in Configure an External
AAA Server for VPN, on page 243. If a RADIUS server is configured to return the Class attribute
(#25), the ASA uses that attribute to authenticate the Group Name. On the RADIUS server, the
attribute must be formatted as: OU=groupname; where groupname is identical to the Group Name
configured on the ASA—for example, OU=Finance.

Create an Internal Group Policy


To configure an internal group policy, enter configuration mode, use the group-policy command, specify a
name, and the internal type for the group policy:

hostname(config)# group-policy group_policy_name internal


hostname(config)#

For example, the following command creates the internal group policy named GroupPolicy1:

hostname(config)# group-policy GroupPolicy1 internal


hostname(config)#

Note You cannot change the name of a group policy after you create it.

You can configure the attributes of an internal group policy by copying the values of a preexisting group
policy by appending the keyword from and specifying the name of the existing policy:

hostname(config)# group-policy group_policy_name internal from group_policy_name


hostname(config-group-policy)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
121
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure General Internal Group Policy Attributes

For example, the following command creates the internal group policy named GroupPolicy2 by copying the
attributes of GroupPolicy1:

hostname(config)# group-policy GroupPolicy2 internal from GroupPolicy1


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Configure General Internal Group Policy Attributes


Group Policy Name
The group policy name was chosen when the internal group policy was created. You cannot change the name
of a group policy once it has been created. See Create an Internal Group Policy, on page 121 for more
information.

Configure the Group Policy Banner Message


Specify the banner, or welcome message, if any, that you want to display. The default is no banner. The
message that you specify is displayed on remote clients when they connect. To specify a banner, enter the
banner command in group-policy configuration mode. The banner text can be up to 500 characters long.
Enter the “\n” sequence to insert a carriage return.
The overall banner length, which is displayed during post-login on the VPN remote client, has increased from
510 to 4000 characters in ASA version 9.5.1.

Note A carriage-return and line-feed included in the banner counts as two characters.

To delete a banner, enter the no form of this command. Be aware that using the no version of the command
deletes all banners for the group policy.
A group policy can inherit this value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a value, enter the none
keyword instead of specifying a value for the banner string, as follows:

hostname(config-group-policy)# banner {value banner_string | none}

The following example shows how to create a banner for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# banner value Welcome to Cisco Systems ASA 9.0.

Specify Address Pools for Remote Access Connections


When remote access clients connect to the ASA, the ASA can assign the client an IPv4 or IPv6 address based
on the group-policy specified for the connection.
You can specify a list of up to six local address pools to use for local address allocation. The order in which
you specify the pools is significant. The ASA allocates addresses from these pools in the order in which the
pools appear in this command.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
122
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Assign an IPv4 Address Pool to an Internal Group Policy

Assign an IPv4 Address Pool to an Internal Group Policy

Before you begin


Create the IPv4 address pool.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter group policy configuration mode.


group-policy value attributes
Example:

hostname> en
hostname# config t
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 2 Assign the address pool named ipv4-pool1, ipv4-pool2, and ipv4pool3 to the FirstGroup group policy. You
are allowed to specify up to 6 address pools for group-policy.
address-pools value pool-name1 pool-name2 pool-name6
Example:
asa4(config-group-policy)# address-pools value ipv4-pool1 ipv4-pool2 ipv4-pool3
asa4(config-group-policy)#

Step 3 (Optional) Use the no address-pools value pool-name command to remove the address-pools from the group
policy configuration and return the address pool setting to inherit the address pool information from other
sources such as the DefltGroupPolicy.
no address-pools value pool-name1 pool-name2 pool-name6
Example:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no address-pools value ipv4-pool1 ipv4-pool2 ipv4-pool3


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 4 (Optional) The address-pools none command disables this attribute from being inherited from other sources
of policy, such as the DefltGrpPolicy.

hostname(config-group-policy)# address-pools none


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 5 (Optional) The no address pools none command removes the address-pools none command from the group
policy, restoring the default value, which is to allow inheritance.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no address-pools none

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
123
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Assign an IPv6 Address Pool to an Internal Group Policy

hostname(config-group-policy)#

Assign an IPv6 Address Pool to an Internal Group Policy

Before you begin


Create the IPv6 address pool. See IP Addresses for VPNs, on page 171.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter group policy configuration mode.


group-policy value attributes
Example:

hostname> en
hostname# config t
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 2 Assign the address pool named ipv6-pool to the FirstGroup group policy. You can assign up to six ipv6 address
pools to a group policy.
Example:
This example shows ipv6-pool1, ipv6-pool2, and ipv6-pool3 being assigned to the FirstGroup group policy.

hostname(config-group-policy)# ipv6-address-pools value ipv6-pool1 ipv6-pool2 ipv6-pool3


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 3 (Optional) Use the no ipv6-address-pools value pool-name command to remove the address-pools from the
group policy configuration and return the address pool setting to inherit the address pool information from
other sources such as the DfltGroupPolicy.
no ipv6-address-pools value pool-name1 pool-name2 pool-name6
Example:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no ipv6-address-pools value ipv6-pool1 ipv6-pool2 ipv6-pool3


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 4 (Optional) Use the ipv6-address-pools none command to disable this attribute from being inherited
from other sources of policy, such as the DfltGrpPolicy.

hostname(config-group-policy)# ipv6-address-pools none


hostname(config-group-policy)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
124
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify the Tunneling Protocol for the Group Policy

Step 5 (Optional) Use the no ipv6-address pools none command to remove the ipv6-address-pools none command
from the group policy, restoring the default value, which is to allow inheritance.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no ipv6-address-pools none


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Specify the Tunneling Protocol for the Group Policy


Specify the VPN tunnel type for this group policy by entering the vpn-tunnel-protocol {ikev1 | ikev2 |
l2tp-ipsec | ssl-client | ssl-clientless} command from group-policy configuration mode.
The default value is to inherit the attributes of the Default Group Policy. To remove the attribute from the
running configuration, enter the no form of this command.
The parameter values for this command include:
• ikev1—Negotiates an IPsec IKEv1 tunnel between two peers (the Cisco VPN Client or another secure
gateway). Creates security associations that govern authentication, encryption, encapsulation, and key
management.
• ikev2—Negotiates an IPsec IKEv2 tunnel between two peers (the AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client
or another secure gateway). Creates security associations that govern authentication, encryption,
encapsulation, and key management.
• l2tp-ipsec—Negotiates an IPsec tunnel for an L2TP connection.
• ssl-client—Negotiates an SSL tunnel using TLS or DTLS with the AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client.
• ssl-clientless—Provides VPN services to remote users via an HTTPS-enabled web browser, and does
not require a client.

Enter this command to configure one or more tunneling modes. You must configure at least one tunneling
mode for users to connect over a VPN tunnel.
The following example shows how to configure the IPsec IKEv1 tunneling mode for the group policy named
FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-tunnel-protocol ikev1
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Specify a VLAN for Remote Access or Apply a Unified Access Control Rule to the Group Policy
Filters consist of rules that determine whether to allow or reject tunneled data packets coming through the
ASA, based on criteria such as source address, destination address, and protocol. You can specify an IPv4 or
IPv6 unified access control list for your group policy or allow it to inherit the ACLs specified in the Default
Group Policy.
Choose one of the following options to specify an egress VLAN (also called “VLAN mapping”) for remote
access or specify an ACL to filter the traffic:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
125
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify a VLAN for Remote Access or Apply a Unified Access Control Rule to the Group Policy

Note When doing VLAN mapping with IPv6, the outside (destination) address must be unique for each of the
VLANs so that decrypted traffic is routed to inside networks. You cannot have the same destination network
with different VLANs and route metrics.

• Enter the following command in group-policy configuration mode to specify the egress VLAN for remote
access VPN sessions assigned to this group policy or to a group policy that inherits this group policy:
[no] vlan {vlan_id |none}
no vlan removes the vlan_id from the group policy. The group policy inherits the vlan value from the
default group policy.
none removes the vlan_id from the group policy and disables VLAN mapping for this group policy. The
group policy does not inherit the vlan value from the default group policy.
vlan_id is the number of the VLAN, in decimal format, to assign to remote access VPN sessions that use
this group policy. The VLAN must be configured on this ASA per the instructions in the “Configuring
VLAN Subinterfaces and 802.1Q Trunking” in the general operations configuration guide.

Note The egress VLAN feature works for HTTP connections, but not for FTP and
CIFS.

• Specify the name of the access control rule (ACL) to apply to VPN session, using the vpn-filter command
in group policy mode. You can specify an IPv4 or IPv6 ACL using the vpn-filter command.

Note In previous releases, the deprecated ipv6-vpn-filter command could be used to


specify an IPv6 ACL if there were no IPv6 entries specified by vpn-filter. As of
ASA 9.1(4), ipv6-vpn-filter has been disabled and IPv6 ACL entries must be
specified using the vpn-filter command. If ipv6-vpn-filter is set, the VPN
connection will be terminated.

Note You can also configure this attribute in username mode, in which case the value
configured under username supersedes the group-policy value.

hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-filter {value ACL name | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

You configure ACLs to permit or deny various types of traffic for this group policy. You then enter the
vpn-filter command to apply those ACLs.
To remove the ACL, including a null value created by entering the vpn-filter none command, enter the no
form of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
126
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify a VLAN for Remote Access or Apply a Unified Access Control Rule to the Group Policy

A group policy can inherit this value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a value, enter the none
keyword instead of specifying an ACL name. The none keyword indicates that there is no ACL and sets a
null value, thereby disallowing an ACL.
The following example shows how to set a filter that invokes an ACL named acl_vpn for the group policy
named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-filter acl_vpn
hostname(config-group-policy)#

A vpn-filter command is applied to post-decrypted traffic after it exits a tunnel and pre-encrypted traffic
before it enters a tunnel. An ACL that is used for a vpn-filter should NOT also be used for an interface
access-group. When a vpn-filter command is applied to a group policy that governs Remote Access VPN
client connections, the ACL should be configured with the client assigned IP addresses in the src_ip position
of the ACL and the local network in the dest_ip position of the ACL.
When a vpn-filter command is applied to a group-policy that governs a LAN to LAN VPN connection, the
ACL should be configured with the remote network in the src_ip position of the ACL and the local network
in the dest_ip position of the ACL.
Caution should be used when constructing the ACLs for use with the vpn-filter feature. The ACLs are
constructed with the post-decrypted traffic in mind. However, ACLs are also applied to the traffic in the
opposite direction. For this pre-encrypted traffic that is destined for the tunnel, the ACLs are constructed with
the src_ip and dest_ip positions swapped.
In the following example, the vpn-filter is used with a Remote Access VPN client. This example assumes that
the client assigned IP address is 10.10.10.1/24 and the local network is 192.168.1.0/24.
The following ACE allows the Remote Access VPN client to telnet to the local network:

hostname(config-group-policy)# access-list vpnfilt-ra permit 10.10.10.1 255.255.255.255


192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0 eq 23

The following ACE allows the local network to telnet to the Remote Access client:

hostname(config-group-policy)# access-list vpnfilt-ra permit 10.10.10.1 255.255.255.255 eq


23 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0

Note The ACE access-list vpnfilt-ra permit 10.10.10.1 255.255.255.255 192.168.1.0


255.255.255.0 eq 23 allows the local network to initiate a connection to the Remote Access client on
any TCP port if it uses a source port of 23. The ACE access-list vpnfilt-ra permit 10.10.10.1
255.255.255.255 eq 23 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0 allows the Remote Access client to
initiate a connection to the local network on any TCP port if it uses a source port of 23.

In the next example, the vpn-filter is used with a LAN to LAN VPN connection. This example assumes that
the remote network is 10.0.0.0/24 and the local network is 192.168.1.0/24. The following ACE allows remote
network to telnet to the local network:

hostname(config-group-policy)# access-list vpnfilt-l2l permit 10.0.0.0 255.255.255.0

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
127
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify VPN Access Hours for a Group Policy

192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0 eq 23

The following ACE allows the local network to telnet to the remote network:

hostname(config-group-policy)# access-list vpnfilt-l2l permit 10.0.0.0 255.255.255.0 eq 23


192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0

Note The ACE access-list vpnfilt-l2l permit 10.0.0.0 255.255.255.0 192.168.1.0


255.255.255.0 eq 23 allows the local network to initiate a connection to the remote network on any
TCP port if it uses a source port of 23. The ACE access-list vpnfilt-l2l permit 10.0.0.0
255.255.255.0 eq 23 192.168.1.0 255.255.255.0 allows the remote network to initiate a
connection to the local network on any TCP port if it uses a source port of 23.

Specify VPN Access Hours for a Group Policy

Before you begin


Create a time range. See the "Configuring Time Ranges" in the general operations configuration guide.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter group policy configuration mode.


group-policy value attributes
Example:

hostname> en
hostname# config t
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 2 You can set the VPN access hours by associating a configured time-range policy with a group policy using
the vpn-access-hours command in group-policy configuration mode. This command assigns a VPN access
time range named business-hours to the group policy named FirstGroup.
A group policy can inherit a time-range value from a default or specified group policy. To prevent this
inheritance, enter the none keyword instead of the name of a time-range in this command. This keyword sets
VPN access hours to a null value, which allows no time-range policy.
vpn-access-hours value{time-range-name | none}
Example:

hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-access-hours value business-hours


hostname(config-group-policy)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
128
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify Simultaneous VPN Logins for a Group Policy

Specify Simultaneous VPN Logins for a Group Policy


Specify the number of simultaneous logins allowed for any user, using the vpn-simultaneous-logins integer
command in group-policy configuration mode.
The default value is 3. The range is an integer in the range 0 through 2147483647. A group policy can inherit
this value from another group policy. Enter 0 to disable login and prevent user access. The following example
shows how to allow a maximum of 4 simultaneous logins for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-simultaneous-logins 4
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Note While the maximum limit for the number of simultaneous logins is very large, allowing several simultaneous
logins could compromise security and affect performance.

Stale AnyConnect, IPsec Client, or Clientless sessions (sessions that are terminated abnormally) might remain
in the session database, even though a “new” session has been established with the same username.
If the value of vpn-simultaneous-logins is 1, and the same user logs in again after an abnormal termination,
then the stale session is removed from the database, and the new session is established. If, however, the existing
session is still an active connection and the same user logs in again, perhaps from another PC, the first session
is logged off and removed from the database, and the new session is established.
If the number of simultaneous logins is a value greater than 1, then, when you have reached that maximum
number and try to log in again, the session with the longest idle time is logged off. If all current sessions have
been idle an equally long time, then the oldest session is logged off. This action frees up a session and allows
the new login.

Restrict Access to a Specific Connection Profile


Specify whether to restrict remote users to access only through the connection profile, using the group-lock
command in group-policy configuration mode.

hostname(config-group-policy)# group-lock {value tunnel-grp-name | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)# no group-lock
hostname(config-group-policy)#

The tunnel-grp-name variable specifies the name of an existing connection profile that the ASA requires for
the user to connect. Group-lock restricts users by checking if the group configured in the VPN client is the
same as the connection profile to which the user is assigned. If it is not, the ASA prevents the user from
connecting. If you do not configure group-lock, the ASA authenticates users without regard to the assigned
group. Group locking is disabled by default.
To remove the group-lock attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This
option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy.
To disable group-lock, enter the group-lock command with the none keyword. The none keyword sets
group-lock to a null value, thereby allowing no group-lock restriction. It also prevents inheriting a group-lock
value from a default or specified group policy

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
129
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify the Maximum VPN Connection Time in a Group Policy

Specify the Maximum VPN Connection Time in a Group Policy

Procedure

Step 1 (Optional) Configure a maximum amount of time for VPN connections, using the vpn-session-timeout
{minutes command in group-policy configuration mode or in username configuration mode.
The minimum time is 1 minute, and the maximum time is 35791394 minutes. There is no default value. At
the end of this period of time, the ASA terminates the connection.
The following example shows how to set a VPN session timeout of 180 minutes for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-session-timeout 180
hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example shows how to set a VPN session timeout of 180 minutes for the user named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-session-timeout 180
hostname(config-username)#

Other actions using the [no] vpn-session-timeout {minutes | none} command:


• To remove the attribute from this policy and allow inheritance, enter the no vpn-session-timeout form
of this command.
• To allow an unlimited timeout period, and thus prevent inheriting a timeout value, enter
vpn-session-timeout none.

Step 2 Configure the time at which a session timeout alert message is displayed to the user using the
vpn-session-timeout alert-interval {minutes | } command.
This alert message tells users how many minutes left until their VPN session is automatically disconnected.
The following example shows how to specify that users will be notified 20 minutes before their VPN session
is disconnected. You can specify a range of 1-30 minutes.
hostname(config-webvpn)# vpn-session-timeout alert-interval 20

Other actions using the [no] vpn-session-timeout alert-interval {minutes | none} command:
• Use the no form of the command to indicate that the VPN session timeout alert-interval attribute will be
inherited from the Default Group Policy:
hostname(config-webvpn)# no vpn-session-timeout alert-interval

• The vpn-session-timeout alert-interval none indicates that users will not receive an alert.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
130
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify a VPN Session Idle Timeout for a Group Policy

Specify a VPN Session Idle Timeout for a Group Policy

Procedure

Step 1 (Optional) To configure a VPN idle timeout period use the vpn-idle-timeout minutes command in group-policy
configuration mode or in username configuration mode.
If there is no communication activity on the connection in this period, the ASA terminates the connection.
The minimum time is 1 minute, the maximum time is 35791394 minutes, and the default is 30 minutes.
The following example shows how to set a VPN idle timeout of 15 minutes for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-idle-timeout 15
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Other actions using the [no] vpn-idle-timeout {minutes | none} command:


• Enter vpn-idle-timeout none to disable VPN idle timeout and pevent inheriting a timeout value.
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-idle-timeout none
hostname(config-group-policy)#

This results in AnyConnect (both SSL and IPsec/IKEv2) and Clientless VPN using the global webvpn
default-idle-timeout seconds value. This command is entered in webvpn-config mode, for example:
hostnamee(config-webvpn)# default-idle-timeout 300. The default is 1800 seconds (30 min), the
range is 60-86400 seconds.
For all webvon connections , the default-idle-timeout value is enforced only if vpn-idle-timeout none
is set in the group policy/username attribute. A non-zero idle timeout value is required by ASA for all
AnyConnect connections.
For Site-to-Site (IKEv1, IKEv2) and IKEv1 remote-access VPNs, we recommend you Disable timeout
and allow for an unlimited idle period.
• To disable the idle timeout for this group policy or user policy, enter no vpn-idle-timeout. The value
will be inherited.
• If you do not set vpn-idle-timeout at all, in anyway, the value is inherited, which defaults to 30 minutes.

Step 2 (Optional) You can optionally configure the time at which an idle timeout alert message is displayed to the
user using the vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval {minutes} command.
This alert message tells users how many minutes they have left until their VPN session is disconnected due
to inactivity. The default alert interval is one minute.
The following example shows how to set a VPN idle timeout alert interval of 3 minutes for the user named
anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval 3
hostname(config-username)#

Other actions using the [no] vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval {minutes | none} command:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
131
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure WINS and DNS Servers for a Group Policy

• The none parameter indicates that users will not receive an alert.
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-idle-timeout none
hostname(config-username)#

• To remove the alert interval for this group or user policy enter no vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval. The
value will be inherited.
• If you do not set this parameter at all, the default alert interval is one minute.

Configure WINS and DNS Servers for a Group Policy


You can specify primary and secondary WINS servers and DNS servers. The default value in each case is
none. To specify these servers, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 Specify the primary and secondary WINS servers:

hostname(config-group-policy)# wins-server value {ip_address [ip_address] | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The first IP address specified is that of the primary WINS server. The second (optional) IP address is that of
the secondary WINS server. Specifying the none keyword instead of an IP address sets WINS servers to a
null value, which allows no WINS servers and prevents inheriting a value from a default or specified group
policy.
Every time that you enter the wins-server command, you overwrite the existing setting. For example, if you
configure WINS server x.x.x.x and then configure WINS server y.y.y.y, the second command overwrites the
first, and y.y.y.y becomes the sole WINS server. The same is true for multiple servers. To add a WINS server
rather than overwrite previously configured servers, include the IP addresses of all WINS servers when you
enter this command.
The following example shows how to configure WINS servers with the IP addresses 10.10.10.15 and
10.10.10.30 for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# wins-server value 10.10.10.15 10.10.10.30
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 2 Specify the primary and secondary DNS servers:

hostname(config-group-policy)# dns-server value {ip_address [ip_address] | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The first IP address specified is that of the primary DNS server. The second (optional) IP address is that of
the secondary DNS server. Specifying the none keyword instead of an IP address sets DNS servers to a null

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
132
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Set the Split-Tunneling Policy

value, which allows no DNS servers and prevents inheriting a value from a default or specified group policy.
You can specify up to four DNS server addresses: up to two IPv4 addresses and two IPv6 addresses.
Every time that you enter the dns-server command, you overwrite the existing setting. For example, if you
configure DNS server x.x.x.x and then configure DNS server y.y.y.y, the second command overwrites the
first, and y.y.y.y becomes the sole DNS server. The same is true for multiple servers. To add a DNS server
rather than overwrite previously configured servers, include the IP addresses of all DNS servers when you
enter this command.
The following example shows how to configure DNS servers with the IP addresses 10.10.10.15, 10.10.10.30,
2001:DB8::1, and 2001:DB8::2 for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# dns-server value 10.10.10.15 10.10.10.30
2001:DB8::1 2001:DB8::2
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 3 If there is no default domain name specified in the DefaultDNS DNS server group, you must specify a default
domain. Use the domain name and top level domain for example, example.com.

asa4(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


asa4(config-group-policy)# default-domain value example.com
asa4(config-group-policy)#

Step 4 Configure the DHCP network scope:

hostname(config-group-policy)# dhcp-network-scope {ip_address | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

DHCP scope specifies the range of IP addresses (that is, a subnetwork) that the ASA DHCP server should
use to assign addresses to users of this group policy.
The following example shows how to set an IP subnetwork of 10.10.85.0 (specifying the address range of
10.10.85.0 through 10.10.85.255) for the group policy named First Group:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# dhcp-network-scope 10.10.85.0

Set the Split-Tunneling Policy


Set the rules for tunneling traffic by specifying the split-tunneling policy for IPv4 traffic:
split-tunnel-policy {tunnelall | tunnelspecified | excludespecified}
no split-tunnel-policy
Set the rules for tunneling traffic by specifying the split-tunneling policy for IPv6 traffic:
ipv6-split-tunnel-policy {tunnelall | tunnelspecified | excludespecified}
no ipv6-split-tunnel-policy

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
133
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify a Network List for Split-Tunneling

The policies options are:


• tunnelspecified— Tunnels all traffic to or from the networks specified in the Network List through the
tunnel. Data to all other addresses travels in the clear and is routed by the remote user’s Internet service
provider.
For versions of ASA 9.1.4 and higher, when you specify an include list, you can also specify an exclude
list for a subnet inside the include range. Addresses in the excluded subnet will not be tunneled, and the
rest of the include list will be. The networks in the exclusion list will not be sent over the tunnel. The
exclusion list is specified using deny entries, and the inclusion list is specified using permit entries.

• excludespecified — Does not tunnel traffic to or from the networks specified in the Network List. Traffic
from or to all other addresses is tunneled. The VPN client profile that is active on the client must have
Local LAN Access enabled.

Note Networks in the exclusion list that are not a subset of the include list are ignored
by the client.

• tunnelall —Specifies that all traffic goes through the tunnel. This policy disables split tunneling. Remote
users have access to the corporate network, but they do not have access to local networks. This is the
default option.

Note Split tunneling is a traffic management feature, not a security feature. For optimum security, we recommend
that you do not enable split tunneling.

Example
The following examples shows how to set a split tunneling policy of tunneling only specified networks
for the group policy named FirstGroup for IPv4 and IPv6:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# split-tunnel-policy tunnelspecified

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# ipv6-split-tunnel-policy tunnelspecified

Specify a Network List for Split-Tunneling


In split tunneling, network lists determine what network traffic travels across the tunnel. AnyConnect makes
split tunneling decisions on the basis of a network list, which is an ACL.

hostname(config-group-policy)# split-tunnel-network-list {value access-list_name | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)# no split-tunnel-network-list value [access-list_name]

• value access-list name — identifies an ACL that enumerates the networks to tunnel or not tunnel. The
ACL can be a unified ACL with ACEs that specify both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
134
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Domain Attributes for Split Tunneling

• none — indicates that there is no network list for split tunneling; the ASA tunnels all traffic. Specifying
the none keyword sets a split tunneling network list with a null value, thereby disallowing split tunneling.
It also prevents inheriting a default split tunneling network list from a default or specified group policy.

To delete a network list, enter the no form of this command. To delete all split tunneling network lists, enter
the no split-tunnel-network-list command without arguments. This command deletes all configured network
lists, including a null list if you created one by entering the none keyword.
When there are no split tunneling network lists, users inherit any network lists that exist in the default or
specified group policy. To prevent users from inheriting such network lists, enter the split-tunnel-network-list
none command.
Example
The following example shows how to create a network list named FirstList, and add it to the group policy
named FirstGroup. FistList is an exclusion list and an inclusion list that is a subnet of the exclusion list:

hostname(config)# split-tunnel-policy tunnelspecified


hostname(config)# access-list FirstList deny ip 10.10.10.0 255.255.255.0 any
hostname(config)# access-list FirstList permit ip 10.0.0.0 255.0.0.0 any

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# split-tunnel-network-list value FirstList

The following example shows how to create a network list named v6, and add the v6 split tunnel policy to
the group policy named GroupPolicy_ipv6-ikev2. v6 is an exclusion list and an inclusion list that is a subnet
of the exclusion list:

hostname(config)# access-list v6 extended permit ip fd90:5000::/32 any6


hostname(config)# access-list v6 extended deny ip fd90:5000:3000:2880::/64 any6

hostname(config)# group-policy GroupPolicy_ipv6-ikev2 internal


hostname(config)# group-policy GroupPolicy_ipv6-ikev2 attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-tunnel-protocol ikev2 ssl-client
hostname(config-group-policy)# ipv6-split-tunnel-policy tunnelspecified
hostname(config-group-policy)# split-tunnel-network-list value v6

Verify the Split Tunnel Configuration


Run the show runn group-policy attributes command to verify your configuration. This example shows
that the administrator has set both an IPv4 and IPv6 network policy and used the network list (unified ACL),
FirstList for both policies.

hostname(config-group-policy)# show runn group-policy FirstGroup attributes


group-policy FirstGroup attributes
split-tunnel-policy tunnelspecified
ipv6-split-tunnel-policy tunnelspecified
split-tunnel-network-list value FirstList

Configure Domain Attributes for Split Tunneling


You can specify a default domain name or a list of domains to be resolved through the split tunnel, which we
refer to as split DNS.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
135
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Define a Default Domain Name

AnyConnect 3.1 supports true split DNS functionality for Windows and Mac OS X platforms. If the group
policy on the security appliance enables split-include tunneling, and if it specifies the DNS names to be
tunneled, AnyConnect tunnels any DNS queries that match those names to the private DNS server. True split
DNS allows tunnel access to only DNS requests that match the domains pushed to the client by the ASA.
These requests are not sent in the clear. On the other hand, if the DNS requests do not match the domains
pushed down by the ASA, AnyConnect lets the DNS resolver on the client operating system submit the host
name in the clear for DNS resolution.

Note Split DNS supports standard and update queries (including A, AAAA, NS, TXT, MX, SOA, ANY, SRV,
PTR, and CNAME). PTR queries matching any of the tunneled networks are allowed through the tunnel.

For Mac OS X, AnyConnect can use true split-DNS for a certain IP protocol only if one of the following
conditions is met:
• Split-DNS is configured for one IP protocol (such as IPv4), and Client Bypass Protocol is configured
for the other IP protocol (such as IPv6) in the group policy (with no address pool configured for the latter
IP protocol).
• Split-DNS is configured for both IP protocols.

Define a Default Domain Name


The ASA passes the default domain name to the AnyConnect client. The client appends the domain name to
DNS queries that omit the domain field. This domain name applies only to tunneled packets.When there are
no default domain names, users inherit the default domain name in the default group policy.
To specify the default domain name for users of the group policy, enter the default-domain command in
group-policy configuration mode. To delete a domain name, enter the no form of this command.

hostname(config-group-policy)# default-domain {value domain-name | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)# no default-domain [domain-name]

The value domain-name parameter identifies the default domain name for the group. To specify that there is
no default domain name, enter the none keyword. This command sets a default domain name with a null
value, which disallows a default domain name and prevents inheriting a default domain name from a default
or specified group policy.
To delete all default domain names, enter the no default-domain command without arguments. This command
deletes all configured default domain names, including a null list if you created one by entering the
default-domain command with the none keyword. The no form allows inheriting a domain name.
The following example shows how to set a default domain name of FirstDomain for the group policy named
FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# default-domain value FirstDomain

Define a List of Domains for Split Tunneling


Enter a list of domains to be resolved through the split tunnel, in addition to the default domain. Enter the
split-dns command in group-policy configuration mode. To delete a list, enter the no form of this command.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
136
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure DHCP Intercept for Windows XP and Split Tunneling

When there are no split tunneling domain lists, users inherit any that exist in the default group policy. To
prevent users from inheriting such split tunneling domain lists, enter the split-dns command with the none
keyword.
To delete all split tunneling domain lists, enter the no split-dns command without arguments. This deletes
all configured split tunneling domain lists, including a null list created by issuing the split-dns command with
the none keyword.
The parameter value domain-name provides a domain name that the ASA resolves through the split tunnel.
The none keyword indicates that there is no split DNS list. It also sets a split DNS list with a null value,
thereby disallowing a split DNS list, and prevents inheriting a split DNS list from a default or specified group
policy. The syntax of the command is as follows:

hostname(config-group-policy)# split-dns {value domain-name1 [domain-name2... domain-nameN]


| none}
hostname(config-group-policy)# no split-dns [domain-name domain-name2 domain-nameN]

Enter a single space to separate each entry in the list of domains. There is no limit on the number of entries,
but the entire string can be no longer than 255 characters. You can use only alphanumeric characters, hyphens
(-), and periods (.). If the default domain name is to be resolved through the tunnel, you must explicitly include
that name in this list.
The following example shows how to configure the domains Domain1, Domain2, Domain3, and Domain4
to be resolved through split tunneling for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# split-dns value Domain1 Domain2 Domain3 Domain4

Note When configuring split DNS, ensure the private DNS servers specified do not overlap with the DNS servers
configured for the client platform. If they do, name resolution does not function properly and queries may be
dropped.

Configure DHCP Intercept for Windows XP and Split Tunneling


A Microsoft XP anomaly results in the corruption of domain names if split tunnel options exceed 255 bytes.
To avoid this problem, the ASA limits the number of routes it sends to 27 to 40 routes, with the number of
routes dependent on the classes of the routes.
DHCP Intercept lets Microsoft Windows XP clients use split-tunneling with the ASA. The ASA replies directly
to the Microsoft Windows XP client DHCP Inform message, providing that client with the subnet mask,
domain name, and classless static routes for the tunnel IP address. For Windows clients prior to Windows
XP, DHCP Intercept provides the domain name and subnet mask. This is useful in environments in which
using a DHCP server is not advantageous.
The intercept-dhcp command enables or disables DHCP intercept.

hostname(config-group-policy)# intercept-dhcp netmask {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The netmask variable provides the subnet mask for the tunnel IP address. The no form of this command
removes the DHCP intercept from the configuration:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
137
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Browser Proxy Settings for use with Remote Access Clients

[no] intercept-dhcp
The following example shows how to set DHCP Intercepts for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# intercept-dhcp enable

Configure Browser Proxy Settings for use with Remote Access Clients
Follow these steps to configure the proxy server parameters for a client.

Procedure

Step 1 Configure a browser proxy server and port for a client device by entering the msie-proxy server command
in group-policy configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy server {value server[:port] | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The default value is none, which is not specifying any proxy server settings on the browser of the client device.
To remove the attribute from the configuration, use the no form of the command.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no msie-proxy server


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The line containing the proxy server IP address or hostname and the port number must be less than 100
characters long.
The following example shows how to configure the IP address 192.168.10.1 as a browser proxy server, using
port 880, for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy server value 192.168.21.1:880
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 2 Configure the browser proxy actions (“methods”) for a client device by entering the msie-proxy method
command in group-policy configuration mode.

hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy method [auto-detect | no-modify |


no-proxy | use-server]
hostname(config-group-policy)#

The default value is no-modify. To remove the attribute from the configuration, use the no form of the
command.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no msie-proxy method [auto-detect | no-modify |


no-proxy | use-server]

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
138
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Browser Proxy Settings for use with Remote Access Clients

hostname(config-group-policy)#

The available methods are as follows:


• auto-detect—Enables the use of automatic proxy server detection in the browser for the client device.
• no-modify—Leaves the HTTP browser proxy server setting in the browser unchanged for this client
device.
• no-proxy—Disables the HTTP proxy setting in the browser for the client device.
• use-server—Sets the HTTP proxy server setting in the browser to use the value configured in the
msie-proxy server command.

The line containing the proxy server IP address or hostname and the port number must be less than 100
characters long.
The following example shows how to configure auto-detect as the browser proxy setting for the group policy
named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy method auto-detect
hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example configures the browser proxy setting for the group policy named FirstGroup to use
the server QAserver, port 1001 as the server for the client device:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy server QAserver:port 1001
hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy method use-server
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 3 Configure browser proxy exception list settings for a local bypass on the client device by entering the
msie-proxy except-list command in group-policy configuration mode. These addresses are not accessed by
a proxy server. This list corresponds to the Exceptions box in the Proxy Settings dialog box.

hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy except-list {value server[:port] | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To remove the attribute from the configuration, use the no form of the command:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no msie-proxy except-list


hostname(config-group-policy)#

• value server:port—Specifies the IP address or name of an MSIE server and port that is applied for this
client device. The port number is optional.
• none—Indicates that there is no IP address/hostname or port and prevents inheriting an exception list.

By default, msie-proxy except-list is disabled.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
139
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Security Attributes for IPsec (IKEv1) Clients

The line containing the proxy server IP address or hostname and the port number must be less than 100
characters long.
The following example shows how to set a browser proxy exception list, consisting of the server at IP address
192.168.20.1, using port 880, for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy except-list value 192.168.20.1:880
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 4 Enable or disable browser proxy local-bypass settings for a client device by entering the msie-proxy
local-bypass command in group-policy configuration mode.

hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy local-bypass {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To remove the attribute from the configuration, use the no form of the command.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no msie-proxy local-bypass {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

By default, msie-proxy local-bypass is disabled.


The following example shows how to enable browser proxy local-bypass for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# msie-proxy local-bypass enable
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Configure Security Attributes for IPsec (IKEv1) Clients


To specify the security settings for a group, perform these steps.

Procedure

Step 1 Specify whether to let users store their login passwords on the client system, using the password-storage
command with the enable keyword in group-policy configuration mode. To disable password storage, use
the password-storage command with the disable keyword.

hostname(config-group-policy)# password-storage {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

For security reasons, password storage is disabled by default. Enable password storage only on systems that
you know to be in secure sites.
To remove the password-storage attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
140
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Security Attributes for IPsec (IKEv1) Clients

hostname(config-group-policy)# no password-storage
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Specifying the no form enables inheritance of a value for password-storage from another group policy.
This command does not apply to interactive hardware client authentication or individual user authentication
for hardware clients.
The following example shows how to enable password storage for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# password-storage enable
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 2 Specify whether to enable IP compression, which is disabled by default.


Note IP compression is not supported for IPsec IKEv2 connections.

hostname(config-group-policy)# ip-comp {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To enable LZS IP compression, enter the ip-comp command with the enable keyword in group-policy
configuration mode. To disable IP compression, enter the ip-comp command with the disable keyword.
To remove the ip-comp attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This
enables inheritance of a value from another group policy.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no ip-comp
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Enabling data compression might speed up data transmission rates for remote dial-in users connecting with
modems.
Tip Data compression increases the memory requirement and CPU usage for each user session and
consequently decreases the overall throughput of the ASA. For this reason, we recommend that you
enable data compression only for remote users connecting with a modem. Design a group policy
specific to modem users, and enable compression only for them.

Step 3 Specify whether to require that users reauthenticate on IKE re-key by using the re-xauth command with the
enable keyword in group-policy configuration mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
141
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure IPsec-UDP Attributes for IKEv1 Clients

Note IKE re-key is not supported for IKEv2 connections.


If you enable reauthentication on IKE re-key, the ASA prompts the user to enter a username and
password during initial Phase 1 IKE negotiation and also prompts for user authentication whenever
an IKE re-key occurs. Reauthentication provides additional security.
If the configured re-key interval is very short, users might find the repeated authorization requests
inconvenient. To avoid repeated authorization requests, disable reauthentication. To check the
configured re-key interval, in monitoring mode, enter the show crypto ipsec sa command to view
the security association lifetime in seconds and lifetime in kilobytes of data. To disable user
reauthentication on IKE re-key, enter the disable keyword. Reauthentication on IKE re-key is
disabled by default.

hostname(config-group-policy)# re-xauth {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To enable inheritance of a value for reauthentication on IKE re-key from another group policy, remove the
re-xauth attribute from the running configuration by entering the no form of this command:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no re-xauth
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Note Reauthentication fails if there is no user at the other end of the connection.

Step 4 Specify whether to enable perfect forward secrecy. In IPsec negotiations, perfect forward secrecy ensures that
each new cryptographic key is unrelated to any previous key. A group policy can inherit a value for perfect
forward secrecy from another group policy. Perfect forward secrecy is disabled by default. To enable perfect
forward secrecy, use the pfs command with the enable keyword in group-policy configuration mode.

hostname(config-group-policy)# pfs {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To disable perfect forward secrecy, enter the pfs command with the disable keyword.
To remove the perfect forward secrecy attribute from the running configuration and prevent inheriting a value,
enter the no form of this command.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no pfs
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Configure IPsec-UDP Attributes for IKEv1 Clients


IPsec over UDP, sometimes called IPsec through NAT, lets a hardware client connect via UDP to a ASA that
is running NAT. It is disabled by default. IPsec over UDP is proprietary; it applies only to remote-access
connections, and it requires mode configuration. The ASA exchanges configuration parameters with the client
while negotiating SAs. Using IPsec over UDP may slightly degrade system performance.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
142
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Attributes for VPN Hardware Clients

To enable IPsec over UDP, configure the ipsec-udp command with the enable keyword in group-policy
configuration mode, as follows:

hostname(config-group-policy)# ipsec-udp {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)# no ipsec-udp

To use IPsec over UDP, you must also configure the ipsec-udp-port command, as described in this section.
To disable IPsec over UDP, enter the disable keyword. To remove the IPsec over UDP attribute from the
running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This enables inheritance of a value for IPsec over
UDP from another group policy.
The following example shows how to set IPsec over UDP for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# ipsec-udp enable

If you enabled IPsec over UDP, you must also configure the ipsec-udp-port command in group-policy
configuration mode. This command sets a UDP port number for IPsec over UDP. In IPsec negotiations, the
ASA listens on the configured port and forwards UDP traffic for that port even if other filter rules drop UDP
traffic. The port numbers can range from 4001 through 49151. The default port value is 10000.
To disable the UDP port, enter the no form of this command. This enables inheritance of a value for the IPsec
over UDP port from another group policy.

hostname(config-group-policy)# ipsec-udp-port port

The following example shows how to set an IPsec UDP port to port 4025 for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# ipsec-udp-port 4025

Configure Attributes for VPN Hardware Clients


Procedure

Step 1 (Optional) Configure Network Extension Mode with the following command:
[no] nem [enable | disable]
Network extension mode lets hardware clients present a single, routable network to the remote private network
over the VPN tunnel. PAT does not apply. Therefore, devices behind the Easy VPN Server have direct access
to devices on the private network behind the Easy VPN Remote over the tunnel, and only over the tunnel,
and vice versa. The hardware client must initiate the tunnel, but after the tunnel is up, either side can initiate
data exchange.
Example:
The following example shows how to set NEM for the group policy named FirstGroup:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
143
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Attributes for VPN Hardware Clients

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# nem enable

To disable NEM, enter the disable keyword. To remove the NEM attribute from the running configuration,
enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy.

Step 2 (Optional) Configure Secure Unit Authentication with the following command:
[no] secure-unit-authentication [enable | disable ]
Secure unit authentication provides additional security by requiring VPN hardware clients to authenticate
with a username and password each time that the client initiates a tunnel. With this feature enabled, the
hardware client does not a use the saved username and password if configured. Secure unit authentication is
disabled by default.
Secure unit authentication requires that you have an authentication server group configured for the connection
profile the hardware client(s) uses. If you require secure unit authentication on the primary ASA, be sure to
configure it on any backup servers as well.
Note With this feature enabled, to bring up a VPN tunnel, a user must be present to enter the username
and password.

Example:
The following example shows how to enable secure unit authentication for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)#group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# secure-unit-authentication enable

To disable secure unit authentication, enter the disable keyword. To remove the secure unit authentication
attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance
of a value for secure unit authentication from another group policy.

Step 3 (Optional) Configure User Authentication with the following command:


[no] user-authentication [enable | disable]
When enabled, user authentication requires that individual users behind a hardware client authenticate to gain
access to the network across the tunnel. Individual users authenticate according to the order of authentication
servers that you configure. User authentication is disabled by default.
If you require user authentication on the primary ASA, be sure to configure it on any backup servers as well.
Example:
The following example shows how to enable user authentication for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# user-authentication enable

To disable user authentication, enter the disable keyword. To remove the user authentication attribute from
the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of a value for
user authentication from another group policy.

Step 4 Set an idle timeout for individual users that have authenticated with the following command:
[no] user-authentication-idle-timeout minutes | none ]

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
144
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Attributes for VPN Hardware Clients

The minutes parameter specifies the number of minutes in the idle timeout period. The minimum is 1 minute,
the default is 30 minutes, and the maximum is 35791394 minutes.
If there is no communication activity by a user behind a hardware client in the idle timeout period, the ASA
terminates the client’s access. This timer terminates only the client’s access through the VPN tunnel, not the
VPN tunnel itself.
Example:
The following example shows how to set an idle timeout value of 45 minutes for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# user-authentication enable
hostname(config-group-policy)#user-authentication-idle-timeout 45

To delete the idle timeout value, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of an idle
timeout value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting an idle timeout value, enter the
user-authentication-idle-timeout command with the none keyword. This command sets the idle timeout
with a null value, which disallows an idle timeout and prevents inheriting a user authentication idle timeout
value from a default or specified group policy.
Note The idle timeout indicated in response to the show uauth command is always the idle timeout value
of the user who authenticated the tunnel on the Cisco Easy VPN remote device.

Step 5 Configure IP Phone Bypass with the followng command:


ip-phone-bypass enable
IP Phone Bypass lets IP phones behind hardware clients connect without undergoing user authentication
processes. IP Phone Bypass is disabled by default. This only applies when IUA is enabled.
Note You must also configure MAC address exemption on the client to exempt these clients from
authentication.

To disable IP Phone Bypass, enter the disable keyword. To remove the IP phone Bypass attribute from the
running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of a value for IP
Phone Bypass from another group policy.

Step 6 Configure LEAP Bypass with the following command:


leap-bypass enable
LEAP Bypass only applies when user-authentication is enabled. This command lets LEAP packets from
Cisco wireless access point devices establish LEAP authentication and then authenticate again per user
authentication. LEAP Bypass is disabled by default.
LEAP users behind a hardware client have a circular dilemma: they cannot negotiate LEAP authentication
because they cannot send their credentials to the RADIUS server behind the central site device over the tunnel.
The reason they cannot send their credentials over the tunnel is that they have not authenticated on the wireless
network. To solve this problem, LEAP Bypass lets LEAP packets, and only LEAP packets, traverse the tunnel
to authenticate the wireless connection to a RADIUS server before individual users authenticate. Then the
users proceed with individual user authentication.
LEAP Bypass operates correctly under the following conditions:
• secure-unit-authentication must be disabled. If interactive unit authentication is enabled, a non-LEAP
(wired) device must authenticate the hardware client before LEAP devices can connect using that tunnel.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
145
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Group Policy Attributes for AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client Connections

• user-authentication is enabled. Otherwise, LEAP Bypass does not apply.


• Access points in the wireless environment must be Cisco Aironet Access Points running Cisco Discovery
Protocol (CDP). The wireless NIC cards for PCs can be other brands.

Example:
The following example shows how to set LEAP Bypass for the group policy named FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# user-authentication enable
hostname(config-group-policy)# leap-bypass enable

To disable LEAP Bypass, enter the disable keyword. To remove the LEAP Bypass attribute from the running
configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows inheritance of a value for LEAP Bypass
from another group policy:

Configure Group Policy Attributes for AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client


Connections
After enabling AnyConnect client connections as described in AnyConnect VPN Client Connections, on page
207, you can enable or require AnyConnect features for a group policy. Follow these steps in group-policy
webvpn configuration mode:

Procedure

Step 1 Enter group policy webvpn configuration mode. For example:

hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn

Step 2 To disable the permanent installation of the AnyConnect client on the endpoint computer, use the anyconnect
keep-installer command with the none keyword. For example:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect keep-installer none


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

The default is that permanent installation of the client is enabled. The client remains installed on the endpoint
at the end of the AnyConnect session.

Step 3 To enable compression of HTTP data over an AnyConnect SSL connection for the group policy, enter the
anyconnect ssl compression command. By default, compression is set to none (disabled). To enable
compression, use the deflate keyword. For example:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect compression deflate


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
146
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Group Policy Attributes for AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client Connections

Step 4 Configure Dead Peer Detection, on page 222


Step 5 You can ensure that an AnyConnect connection through a proxy, firewall, or NAT device remains open, even
if the device limits the time that the connection can be idle by adjusting the frequency of keepalive messages
using the anyconnect ssl keepalive command:
anyconnect ssl keepalive {none | seconds}
Adjusting keepalives also ensures the AnyConnect client does not disconnect and reconnect when the remote
user is not actively running a socket-based application, such as Microsoft Outlook or Microsoft Internet
Explorer.
The following example configures the security appliance to enable the AnyConnect client to send keepalive
messages, with a frequency of 300 seconds (5 minutes):

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect ssl keepalive 300


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Step 6 To enable the AnyConnect client to perform a re-key on an SSL session, use the anyconnect ssl rekey command:
anyconnect ssl rekey {method {ssl | new-tunnel} | time minutes | none}}
By default, re-key is disabled.
Specifying the method as new-tunnel specifies that the AnyConnect client establishes a new tunnel during
SSL re-key. Specifying the method as none disables re-key. Specifying the method as ssl specifies that SSL
renegotiation takes place during re-key. Instead of specifying the method, you can specify the time; that is,
the number of minutes from the start of the session until the re-key takes place, from 1 through 10080 (1
week).
The following example configures the AnyConnect client to renegotiate with SSL during re-key and configures
the re-key to occur 30 minutes after the session begins:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect ssl rekey method ssl


hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect ssl rekey time 30
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Step 7 The Client Protocol Bypass feature allows you to configure how the AnyConnect client manages IPv4 traffic
when ASA is expecting only IPv6 traffic or how it manages IPv6 traffic when it is expecting only IPv4 traffic.
When the AnyConnect client makes a VPN connection to the ASA, the ASA could assign it an IPv4, IPv6,
or both an IPv4 and IPv6 address. If the ASA assigns the AnyConnect connection only an IPv4 address or
only an IPv6 address, you can now configure the Client Bypass Protocol to drop network traffic for which
the ASA did not assign an IP address, or allow that traffic to bypass the ASA and be sent from the client
unencrypted or “in the clear.”
For example, assume that the ASA assigns only an IPv4 address to an AnyConnect connection and the endpoint
is dual stacked. When the endpoint attempts to reach an IPv6 address, if Client Bypass Protocol is disabled,
the IPv6 traffic is dropped; however, if Client Bypass Protocol is enabled, the IPv6 traffic is sent from the
client in the clear.
If establishing an IPsec tunnel (as opposed to an SSL connection), the ASA is not notified whether or not
IPv6 is enabled on the client, so ASA always pushes down the client bypass protocol setting.
Use the client-bypass-protocol command to enable or disable the client bypass protocol feature. This is the
command syntax:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
147
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Group Policy Attributes for AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client Connections

client-bypass-protocol {enable | disable}


The following example enables client bypass protocol:

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-bypass-protocol enable


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example disables client bypass protocol:

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-bypass-protocol disable


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example removes an enabled or disabled client bypass protocol setting:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no client-bypass-protocol enable


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 8 If you have configured Load Balancing between your ASAs, specify the FQDN of the ASA in order to resolve
the ASA IP address used for re-establishing the VPN session. This setting is critical to support client roaming
between networks of different IP protocols (such as IPv4 to IPv6).
You cannot use the ASA FQDN present in the AnyConnect profile to derive the ASA IP address after roaming.
The addresses may not match the correct device (the one the tunnel was established to) in the load balancing
scenario.
If the device FQDN is not pushed to the client, the client will try to reconnect to whatever IP address the
tunnel had previously established. In order to support roaming between networks of different IP protocols
(from IPv4 to IPv6), AnyConnect must perform name resolution of the device FQDN after roaming, so that
it can determine which ASA address to use for re-establishing the tunnel. The client uses the ASA FQDN
present in its profile during the initial connection. During subsequent session reconnects, it always uses the
device FQDN pushed by ASA (and configured by the administrator in the group policy), when available. If
the FQDN is not configured, the ASA derives the device FQDN (and sends it to the client) from whatever is
set under Device Setup > Device Name/Password and Domain Name.
If the device FQDN is not pushed by the ASA, the client cannot re-establish the VPN session after roaming
between networks of different IP protocols.
Use the gateway-fqdn command to configure the FQDN of the ASA. This is the command syntax:
gateway-fqdn { value FQDN_Name | none} or no gateway-fqdn
The following example defines the FQDN of the ASA as ASAName.example.cisco.com

hostname(config-group-policy)# gateway-fqdn value ASAName.example.cisco.com


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example removes the FQDN of the ASA from the group policy. The group policy then inherits
this value from the Default Group Policy.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no gateway-fqdn
hostname(config-group-policy)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
148
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Backup Server Attributes

The following example defines the FQDN as an empty value. The global FQDN configured using hostname
and domain-name commands will be used if available.

hostname(config-group-policy)# gateway-fqdn none


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Configure Backup Server Attributes


Configure backup servers if you plan on using them. IPsec backup servers let a VPN client connect to the
central site when the primary ASA is unavailable.When you configure backup servers, the ASA pushes the
server list to the client as the IPsec tunnel is established. Backup servers do not exist until you configure them,
either on the client or on the primary ASA.
Configure backup servers either on the client or on the primary ASA. If you configure backup servers on the
ASA, it pushes the backup server policy to the clients in the group, replacing the backup server list on the
client if one is configured.

Note If you are using hostnames, it is wise to have backup DNS and WINS servers on a separate network from that
of the primary DNS and WINS servers. Otherwise, if clients behind a hardware client obtain DNS and WINS
information from the hardware client via DHCP, and the connection to the primary server is lost, and the
backup servers have different DNS and WINS information, clients cannot be updated until the DHCP lease
expires. In addition, if you use hostnames and the DNS server is unavailable, significant delays can occur.

To configure backup servers, enter the backup-servers command in group-policy configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-policy)# backup-servers {server1 server2... server10 |


clear-client-config | keep-client-config}

To remove a backup server, enter the no form of this command with the backup server specified. To remove
the backup-servers attribute from the running configuration and enable inheritance of a value for backup-servers
from another group policy, enter the no form of this command without arguments.

hostname(config-group-policy)# no backup-servers [server1 server2... server10 |


clear-client-config | keep-client-config]

The clear-client-config keyword specifies that the client uses no backup servers. The ASA pushes a null
server list.
The keep-client-config keyword specifies that the ASA sends no backup server information to the client. The
client uses its own backup server list, if configured. This is the default.
The server1 server 2.... server10 parameter list is a space-delimited, priority-ordered list of servers for the
VPN client to use when the primary ASA is unavailable. This list identifies servers by IP address or hostname.
The list can be 500 characters long, and it can contain up to10 entries.
The following example shows how to configure backup servers with IP addresses 10.10.10.1 and 192.168.10.14,
for the group policy named FirstGroup:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
149
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Network Admission Control Parameters

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# backup-servers 10.10.10.1 192.168.10.14

Configure Network Admission Control Parameters


The group-policy NAC commands in this section all have default values. Unless you have a good reason for
changing them, accept the default values for these parameters.
The ASA uses Extensible Authentication Protocol (EAP) over UDP (EAPoUDP) messaging to validate the
posture of remote hosts. Posture validation involves the checking of a remote host for compliancy with safety
requirements before the assignment of a network access policy. An Access Control Server must be configured
for Network Admission Control before you configure NAC on the security appliance.
The Access Control Server downloads the posture token, an informational text string configurable on the
ACS, to the security appliance to aid in system monitoring, reporting, debugging, and logging. A typical
posture token is Healthy, Checkup, Quarantine, Infected, or Unknown. Following posture validation or
clientless authentication, the ACS downloads the access policy for the session to the security appliance.
To configure Network Admission Control settings for the default group policy or an alternative group policy,
perform the following steps.

Procedure

Step 1 (Optional) Configure the status query timer period. The security appliance starts the status query timer after
each successful posture validation and status query response. The expiration of this timer triggers a query for
changes in the host posture, referred to as a status query. Enter the number of seconds in the range 30 through
1800. The default setting is 300.
To specify the interval between each successful posture validation in a Network Admission Control session
and the next query for changes in the host posture, use the nac-sq-period command in group-policy
configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-sq-period seconds


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To inherit the value of the status query timer from the default group policy, access the alternative group policy
from which to inherit it, then use the no form of this command:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-sq-period [seconds]


hostname(config-group-policy

The following example changes the value of the status query timer to 1800 seconds:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-sq-period 1800


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example inherits the value of the status query timer from the default group policy:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-sq-period
hostname(config-group-policy)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
150
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Network Admission Control Parameters

Step 2 (Optional) Configure the NAC revalidation period. The security appliance starts the revalidation timer after
each successful posture validation. The expiration of this timer triggers the next unconditional posture validation.
The security appliance maintains posture validation during revalidation. The default group policy becomes
effective if the Access Control Server is unavailable during posture validation or revalidation. Enter the interval
in seconds between each successful posture validation. The range is 300 through 86400. The default setting
is 36000.
To specify the interval between each successful posture validation in a Network Admission Control session,
use the nac-reval-period command in group-policy configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-reval-period seconds


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To inherit the value of the Revalidation Timer from the default group policy, access the alternative group
policy from which to inherit it, then use the no form of this command:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-reval-period [seconds]


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example changes the revalidation timer to 86400 seconds:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-reval-period 86400


hostname(config-group-policy)

The following example inherits the value of the revalidation timer from the default group policy:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-reval-period
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 3 (Optional) Configure the default ACL for NAC. The security appliance applies the security policy associated
with the selected ACL if posture validation fails. Specify none or an extended ACL. The default setting is
none. If the setting is none and posture validation fails, the security appliance applies the default group policy.
To specify the ACL to be used as the default ACL for Network Admission Control sessions that fail posture
validation, use the nac-default-acl command in group-policy configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-default-acl {acl-name | none}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To inherit the ACL from the default group policy, access the alternative group policy from which to inherit
it, then use the no form of this command:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-default-acl [acl-name | none]


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The elements of this command are as follows:


• acl-name—Specifies the name of the posture validation server group, as configured on the ASA using
the aaa-server host command. The name must match the server-tag variable specified in that command.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
151
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Network Admission Control Parameters

• none—Disables inheritance of the ACL from the default group policy and does not apply an ACL to
NAC sessions that fail posture validation.

Because NAC is disabled by default, VPN traffic traversing the ASA is not subject to the NAC Default ACL
until NAC is enabled.
The following example identifies acl-1 as the ACL to be applied when posture validation fails:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-default-acl acl-1


hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example inherits the ACL from the default group policy:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac-default-acl
hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example disables inheritance of the ACL from the default group policy and does not apply an
ACL to NAC sessions that fail posture validation:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac-default-acl none


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 4 Configure NAC exemptions for VPN. By default, the exemption list is empty.The default value of the filter
attribute is none. Enter the vpn-nac-exempt command once for each operating system (and ACL) to be
matched to exempt remote hosts from posture validation.
To add an entry to the list of remote computer types that are exempt from posture validation, use the
vpn-nac-exempt command in group-policy configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-nac-exempt os "os name" [filter {acl-name | none}]


[disable]
hostname(config-group-policy)#

To disable inheritance and specify that all hosts are subject to posture validation, use the none keyword
immediately following vpn-nac-exempt:

hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-nac-exempt none


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To remove an entry from the exemption list, use the no form of this command and name the operating system
(and ACL) in the entry to be removed:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt [os "os name"] [filter {acl-name | none}]


[disable]
hostname(config-group-policy)#

To remove all entries from the exemption list associated with this group policy and inherit the list from the
default group policy, use the no form of this command without specifying additional keywords:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt
hostname(config-group-policy)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
152
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Network Admission Control Parameters

The syntax elements for these commands are as follows:


• acl-name—Name of the ACL present in the ASA configuration.
• disable—Disables the entry in the exemption list without removing it from the list.
• filter—(Optional) Apply an ACL to filter the traffic if the computer matches the OS name.
• none—When entered immediately after vpn-nac-exempt, this keyword disables inheritance and specifies
that all hosts are subject to posture validation.When entered immediately after filter, this keyword
indicates that the entry does not specify an ACL.
• OS—Exempts an operating system from posture validation.
• os name—Operating system name. Quotation marks are required only if the name includes a space (for
example, “Windows XP”).

The following example disables inheritance and specifies that all hosts will be subject to posture validation:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt none


hostname(config-group-policy)

The following example removes all entries from the exemption list:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no vpn-nac-exempt
hostname(config-group-policy)

Step 5 Enable or disable Network Admission Control by entering the following command:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac {enable | disable}


hostname(config-group-policy)#

To inherit the NAC setting from the default group policy, access the alternative group policy from which to
inherit it, then use the no form of this command:

hostname(config-group-policy)# no nac [enable | disable]


hostname(config-group-policy)#

By default, NAC is disabled. Enabling NAC requires posture validation for remote access. If the remote
computer passes the validation checks, the ACS server downloads the access policy for the ASA to enforce.
NAC is disabled by default.
An Access Control Server must be present on the network.
The following example enables NAC for the group policy:

hostname(config-group-policy)# nac enable


hostname(config-group-policy)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
153
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure VPN Client Firewall Policies

Configure VPN Client Firewall Policies


A firewall isolates and protects a computer from the Internet by inspecting each inbound and outbound packet
of data to determine whether to allow it through the firewall or to drop it. Firewalls provide extra security if
remote users in a group have split tunneling configured. In this case, the firewall protects the user’s computer,
and thereby the corporate network, from intrusions by way of the Internet or the user’s local LAN. Remote
users connecting to the ASA with the VPN client can choose the appropriate firewall option.
Set personal firewall policies that the ASA pushes to the VPN client during IKE tunnel negotiation by using
the client-firewall command in group-policy configuration mode. To delete a firewall policy, enter the no
form of this command.
To delete all firewall policies, enter the no client-firewall command without arguments. This command deletes
all configured firewall policies, including a null policy if you created one by entering the client-firewall
command with the none keyword.
When there are no firewall policies, users inherit any that exist in the default or other group policy. To prevent
users from inheriting such firewall policies, enter the client-firewall command with the none keyword.
The Add or Edit Group Policy dialog box on the Client Firewall tab lets you configure firewall settings for
VPN clients for the group policy being added or modified.

Note Only VPN clients running Microsoft Windows can use these firewall features. They are currently not available
to hardware clients or other (non-Windows) software clients.

In the first scenario, a remote user has a personal firewall installed on the PC. The VPN client enforces firewall
policy defined on the local firewall, and it monitors that firewall to make sure it is running. If the firewall
stops running, the VPN client drops the connection to the ASA. (This firewall enforcement mechanism is
called Are You There (AYT), because the VPN client monitors the firewall by sending it periodic “are you
there?” messages; if no reply comes, the VPN client knows the firewall is down and terminates its connection
to the ASA.) The network administrator might configure these PC firewalls originally, but with this approach,
each user can customize his or her own configuration.
In the second scenario, you might prefer to enforce a centralized firewall policy for personal firewalls on VPN
client PCs. A common example would be to block Internet traffic to remote PCs in a group using split tunneling.
This approach protects the PCs, and therefore the central site, from intrusions from the Internet while tunnels
are established. This firewall scenario is called push policy or Central Protection Policy (CPP). On the ASA,
you create a set of traffic management rules to enforce on the VPN client, associate those rules with a filter,
and designate that filter as the firewall policy. The ASA pushes this policy down to the VPN client. The VPN
client then in turn passes the policy to the local firewall, which enforces it.

Configure AnyConnect Client Firewall Policies


Firewall rules for the AnyConnect client can specify IPv4 and IPv6 addresses.

Before you begin


You have created Unified Access Rules with IPv6 addresses specified.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
154
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Use of a Zone Labs Integrity Server

Procedure

Step 1 Enter webvpn group policy configuration mode.


webvpn
Example:

hostname(config)# group-policy ac-client-group attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn

Step 2 Specify an access control rule for the private or public network rule. The private network rule is the rule
applied to the VPN virtual adapter interface on the client.
anyconnect firewall-rule client-interface {private | public} value [RuleName]
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect firewall-rule client-interface private value
ClientFWRule

Step 3 Display the group policy attributes as well as the webvpn policy attribute for the group policy.
show runn group-policy [value]
Example:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# show run group-policy FirstGroup


group-policy FirstGroup internal
group-policy FirstGroup attributes
webvpn
anyconnect firewall-rule client-interface private value ClientFWRule

Step 4 Remove the client firewall rule from the private network rule.
no anyconnect firewall-rule client-interface private value [RuleName]
Example:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no anyconnect firewall-rule client-interface private value


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Use of a Zone Labs Integrity Server


This section introduces the Zone Labs Integrity server, also called the Check Point Integrity server, and presents
an example procedure for configuring the ASA to support the Zone Labs Integrity server. The Integrity server
is a central management station for configuring and enforcing security policies on remote PCs. If a remote
PC does not conform to the security policy dictated by the Integrity server, it is not granted access to the
private network protected by the Integrity server and ASA.
The VPN client software and the Integrity client software are co-resident on a remote PC. The following steps
summarize the actions of the remote PC, ASA, and Integrity server in the establishment of a session between
the PC and the enterprise private network:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
155
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Use of a Zone Labs Integrity Server

1. The VPN client software (residing on the same remote PC as the Integrity client software) connects to
the ASA and tells the ASA what type of firewall client it is.
2. After the ASA approves the client firewall type, the ASA passes Integrity server address information back
to the Integrity client.
3. With the ASA acting as a proxy, the Integrity client establishes a restricted connection with the Integrity
server. A restricted connection is only between the Integrity client and the Integrity server.
4. The Integrity server determines if the Integrity client is in compliance with the mandated security policies.
If the Integrity client is in compliance with security policies, the Integrity server instructs the ASA to open
the connection and provide the Integrity client with connection details.
5. On the remote PC, the VPN client passes connection details to the Integrity client and signals that policy
enforcement should begin immediately and the Integrity client can enter the private network.
6. After the VPN connection is established, the Integrity server continues to monitor the state of the Integrity
client using client heartbeat messages.

Note The current release of the ASA supports one Integrity server at a time, even though the user interfaces support
the configuration of up to five Integrity servers. If the active Integrity server fails, configure another one on
the ASA and then reestablish the VPN client session.

To configure the Integrity server, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 Configure an Integrity server using the IP address 10.0.0.5.


zonelabs-Integrity server-address {hostname1 | ip-address1}

Example:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-Integrity server-address 10.0.0.5

Step 2 Specify port 300 (the default port is 5054).


zonelabs-integrity port port-number

Example:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity port 300

Step 3 Specify the inside interface for communications with the Integrity server.
zonelabs-integrity interface interface

Example:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity interface inside

Step 4 Ensure that the ASA waits 12 seconds for a response from either the active or standby Integrity servers before
declaring the Integrity server as failed and closing the VPN client connections.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
156
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Set the Firewall Client Type to Zone Labs

Note If the connection between the ASA and the Integrity server fails, the VPN client connections remain
open by default so that the enterprise VPN is not disrupted by the failure of an Integrity server.
However, you may want to close the VPN connections if the Zone Labs Integrity server fails.

zonelabs-integrity fail-timeout timeout

Example:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity fail-timeout 12

Step 5 Configure the ASA so that connections to VPN clients close when the connection between the ASA and the
Zone Labs Integrity server fails.
zonelabs-integrity fail-close

Example:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity fail-close

Step 6 Return the configured VPN client connection fail state to the default and ensure that the client connections
remain open.
zonelabs-integrity fail-open

Example:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity fail-open

Step 7 Specify that the Integrity server connects to port 300 (the default is port 80) on the ASA to request the server
SSL certificate.
zonelabs-integrity ssl-certificate-port cert-port-number

Example:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity ssl-certificate-port 300

Step 8 While the server SSL certificate is always authenticated, specify that the client SSL certificate of the Integrity
server be authenticated.

zonelabs-integrity ssl-client-authentication {enable | disable}

Example:
hostname(config)# zonelabs-integrity ssl-client-authentication enable

Set the Firewall Client Type to Zone Labs


Procedure

Command or Action Purpose


Step 1 To set the firewall client type to the Zone Labs client-firewall {opt | req} zonelabs-integrity
Integrity type, enter the following command:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
157
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Set the Client Firewall Parameters

Command or Action Purpose


Example:
hostname(config)# client-firewall req
zonelabs-integrity

What to do next
For more information, see Configure VPN Client Firewall Policies, on page 154. The command arguments
that specify firewall policies are not used when the firewall type is zonelabs-integrity, because the Integrity
server determines these policies.

Set the Client Firewall Parameters


Enter the following commands to set the appropriate client firewall parameters. You can configure only one
instance of each command. For more information, see Configure VPN Client Firewall Policies, on page 154.
• Cisco Integrated Firewall

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} cisco-integrated


acl-in ACL acl-out ACL
• Cisco Security Agent

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} cisco-security-agent

• No Firewall

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall none


• Custom Firewall

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} custom vendor-id num product-id


num policy {AYT | CPP acl-in ACL acl-out ACL} [description string]

• Zone Labs Firewalls

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} zonelabs-integrity

Note When the firewall type is zonelabs-integrity, do not include arguments. The
Zone Labs Integrity Server determines the policies.

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} zonelabs-zonealarm


policy {AYT | CPP acl-in ACL acl-out ACL}

client-firewall
hostname(config-group-policy)# {opt | req}
zonelabs-zonealarmorpro policy {AYT | CPP acl-in ACL acl-out ACL}

client-firewall {opt | req} zonelabs-zonealarmpro policy {AYT | CPP acl-in


ACL acl-out ACL}

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
158
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Set the Client Firewall Parameters

• Sygate Personal Firewalls

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} sygate-personal

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} sygate-personal-pro

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} sygate-security-agent

• Network Ice,Black Ice Firewall

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall {opt | req} networkice-blackice

Table 6: client-firewall Command Keywords and Variables

Parameter Description

acl-in ACL Provides the policy the client uses for inbound traffic.

acl-out ACL Provides the policy the client uses for outbound traffic.

AYT Specifies that the client PC firewall application


controls the firewall policy. The ASA checks to make
sure that the firewall is running. It asks, “Are You
There?” If there is no response, the ASA tears down
the tunnel.

cisco-integrated Specifies Cisco Integrated firewall type.

cisco-security-agent Specifies Cisco Intrusion Prevention Security Agent


firewall type.

CPP Specifies Policy Pushed as source of the VPN client


firewall policy.

custom Specifies Custom firewall type.

description string Describes the firewall.

networkice-blackice Specifies Network ICE Black ICE firewall type.

none Indicates that there is no client firewall policy. Sets a


firewall policy with a null value, thereby disallowing
a firewall policy. Prevents inheriting a firewall policy
from a default or specified group policy.

opt Indicates an optional firewall type.

product-id Identifies the firewall product.

req Indicates a required firewall type.

sygate-personal Specifies the Sygate Personal firewall type.

sygate-personal-pro Specifies Sygate Personal Pro firewall type.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
159
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Client Access Rules

sygate-security-agent Specifies Sygate Security Agent firewall type.

vendor-id Identifies the firewall vendor.

zonelabs-integrity Specifies Zone Labs Integrity Server firewall type.

zonelabs-zonealarm Specifies Zone Labs Zone Alarm firewall type.

zonelabs-zonealarmorpro policy Specifies Zone Labs Zone Alarm or Pro firewall type.

zonelabs-zonealarmpro policy Specifies Zone Labs Zone Alarm Pro firewall type.

The following example shows how to set a client firewall policy that requires Cisco Intrusion Prevention
Security Agent for the group policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# client-firewall req cisco-security-agent
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Configure Client Access Rules


Configure rules that limit the remote access client types and versions that can connect via IPsec through the
ASA by using the client-access-rule command in group-policy configuration mode. Construct rules according
to these guidelines:
• If you do not define any rules, the ASA permits all connection types.
• When a client matches none of the rules, the ASA denies the connection. If you define a deny rule, you
must also define at least one permit rule; otherwise, the ASA denies all connections.
• For both software and hardware clients, type and version must exactly match their appearance in the
show vpn-sessiondb remote display.
• The * character is a wildcard, which you can enter multiple times in each rule. For example, client-access
rule 3 deny type * version 3.* creates a priority 3 client access rule that denies all client types running
versions 3.x software.
• You can construct a maximum of 25 rules per group policy.
• There is a limit of 255 characters for an entire set of rules.
• You can enter n/a for clients that do not send client type and/or version.

To delete a rule, enter the no form of this command. This command is equivalent to the following command:

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-access-rule 1 deny type "Cisco VPN Client" version


4.0

To delete all rules, enter the no client-access-rule command without arguments. This deletes all configured
rules, including a null rule if you created one by issuing the client-access-rule command with the none
keyword.
By default, there are no access rules. When there are no client access rules, users inherit any rules that exist
in the default group policy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
160
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Client Access Rules

To prevent users from inheriting client access rules, enter the client-access-rule command with the none
keyword. The result of this command is that all client types and versions can connect.

hostname(config-group-policy)# client-access rule priority {permit | deny} type


type version {version | none}

hostname(config-group-policy)# no client-access rule [priority {permit | deny} type


type version version]

The table below explains the meaning of the keywords and parameters in these commands.

Table 7: client-access rule Command Keywords and Variables

Parameter Description

deny Denies connections for devices of a particular type


and/or version.

none Allows no client access rules. Sets client-access-rule


to a null value, thereby allowing no restriction.
Prevents inheriting a value from a default or specified
group policy.

permit Permits connections for devices of a particular type


and/or version.

priority Determines the priority of the rule. The rule with the
lowest integer has the highest priority. Therefore, the
rule with the lowest integer that matches a client type
and/or version is the rule that applies. If a lower
priority rule contradicts, the ASA ignores it.

type type Identifies device types via free-form strings. The string
must match exactly its appearance in the show
vpn-sessiondb remote display, except that you can
enter the * character as a wildcard.

version version Identifies the device version via free-form strings, for
example 7.0. A string must match exactly its
appearance in the show vpn-sessiondb remote
display, except that you can enter the * character as
a wildcard.

The following example shows how to create client access rules for the group policy named FirstGroup. These
rules permit Cisco VPN clients running software version 4.x, while denying all Windows NT clients:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# client-access-rule 1 deny type WinNT version *
hostname(config-group-policy)# client-access-rule 2 permit “Cisco VPN Client”
version 4.*

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
161
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure User Attributes

Note The “type” field is a free-form string that allows any value, but that value must match the fixed value that the
client sends to the ASA at connect time.

Configure User Attributes


This section describes user attributes and how to configure them.
By default, users inherit all user attributes from the assigned group policy. The ASA also lets you assign
individual attributes at the user level, overriding values in the group policy that applies to that user. For
example, you can specify a group policy giving all users access during business hours, but give a specific user
24-hour access.

View the Username Configuration


To display the configuration for all usernames, including default values inherited from the group policy, enter
the all keyword with the show running-config username command, as follows:

hostname# show running-config all username


hostname#

This displays the encrypted password and the privilege level, for all users, or, if you supply a username, for
that specific user. If you omit the all keyword, only explicitly configured values appear in this list. The
following example displays the output of this command for the user named testuser:

hostname# show running-config all username testuse


username testuser password 12RsxXQnphyr/I9Z encrypted privilege 15

Configure Attributes for Individual Users


To configure specific users, you assign a password (or no password) and attributes to a user using the username
command, which enters username mode. Any attributes that you do not specify are inherited from the group
policy.
The internal user authentication database consists of the users entered with the username command. The
login command uses this database for authentication. To add a user to the ASA database, enter the username
command in global configuration mode. To remove a user, use the no version of this command with the
username you want to remove. To remove all usernames, use the clear configure username command without
appending a username.

Set a User Password and Privilege Level


Enter the username command to assign a password and a privilege level for a user. You can enter the
nopassword keyword to specify that this user does not require a password. If you do specify a password, you
can specify whether that password is stored in an encrypted form.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
162
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure User Attributes

The optional privilege keyword lets you set a privilege level for this user. Privilege levels range from 0 (the
lowest) through 15. System administrators generally have the highest privilege level. The default level is 2.

hostname(config)# username name {nopassword | password password [encrypted]}


[privilege priv_level]}

hostname(config)# no username [name]

The table below describes the meaning of the keywords and variables used in this command.
username Command Keywords and Variables

Keyword/Variable Meaning

encrypted Indicates that the password is encrypted.

name Provides the name of the user.

nopassword Indicates that this user needs no password.

password password Indicates that this user has a password, and provides
the password.

privilege priv_level Sets a privilege level for this user. The range is from
0 to 15, with lower numbers having less ability to use
commands and administer the ASA. The default
privilege level is 2. The typical privilege level for a
system administrator is 15.

By default, VPN users that you add with this command have no attributes or group policy association. You
must explicitly configure all values.
The following example shows how to configure a user named anyuser with an encrypted password of
pw_12345678 and a privilege level of 12:

hostname(config)# username anyuser password pw_12345678 encrypted privilege


12
hostname(config)#

Configure User Attributes


After configuring the user’s password (if any) and privilege level, you set the other attributes. These can be
in any order. To remove any attribute-value pair, enter the no form of the command.
Enter username mode by entering the username command with the attributes keyword:

hostname(config)# username name attributes


hostname(config-username)#

The prompt changes to indicate the new mode. You can now configure the attributes.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
163
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure VPN User Attributes

Configure VPN User Attributes


The VPN user attributes set values specific to VPN connections, as described in the following sections.

Configure Inheritance
You can let users inherit from the group policy the values of attributes that you have not configured at the
username level. To specify the name of the group policy from which this user inherits attributes, enter the
vpn-group-policy command. By default, VPN users have no group-policy association:

hostname(config-username)# vpn-group-policy group-policy-name


hostname(config-username)# no vpn-group-policy group-policy-name

For an attribute that is available in username mode, you can override the value of an attribute in a group policy
for a particular user by configuring it in username mode.
The following example shows how to configure a user named anyuser to use attributes from the group policy
named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# vpn-group-policy FirstGroup
hostname(config-username)#

Configure Access Hours


Associate the hours that this user is allowed to access the system by specifying the name of a configured
time-range policy:
To remove the attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This option allows
inheritance of a time-range value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a value, enter the
vpn-access-hours none command. The default is unrestricted access.

hostname(config-username)# vpn-access-hours value {time-range | none}


hostname(config-username)# vpn-access-hours value none
hostname(config)#

The following example shows how to associate the user named anyuser with a time-range policy called 824:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# vpn-access-hours 824
hostname(config-username)#

Configure Maximum Simultaneous Logins


Specify the maximum number of simultaneous logins allowed for this user. The range is 0 through 2147483647.
The default is 3 simultaneous logins. To remove the attribute from the running configuration, enter the no
form of this command. Enter 0 to disable login and prevent user access.

hostname(config-username)# vpn-simultaneous-logins integer


hostname(config-username)# no vpn-simultaneous-logins
hostname(config-username)# vpn-session-timeout alert-interval none

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
164
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure the Idle Timeout

Note While the maximum limit for the number of simultaneous logins is very large, allowing several could
compromise security and affect performance.

The following example shows how to allow a maximum of 4 simultaneous logins for the user named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# vpn-simultaneous-logins 4
hostname(config-username)#

Configure the Idle Timeout

Procedure

Step 1 (Optional) To configure a VPN idle timeout period use the vpn-idle-timeout minutes command in group-policy
configuration mode or in username configuration mode.
If there is no communication activity on the connection in this period, the ASA terminates the connection.
The minimum time is 1 minute, the maximum time is 35791394 minutes, and the default is 30 minutes.
The following example shows how to set a VPN idle timeout of 15 minutes for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-idle-timeout 15
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Other actions using the [no] vpn-idle-timeout {minutes | none} command:


• Enter vpn-idle-timeout none to disable VPN idle timeout and pevent inheriting a timeout value.
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-idle-timeout none
hostname(config-group-policy)#

This results in AnyConnect (both SSL and IPsec/IKEv2) and Clientless VPN using the global webvpn
default-idle-timeout seconds value. This command is entered in webvpn-config mode, for example:
hostnamee(config-webvpn)# default-idle-timeout 300. The default is 1800 seconds (30 min), the
range is 60-86400 seconds.
For all webvon connections , the default-idle-timeout value is enforced only if vpn-idle-timeout none
is set in the group policy/username attribute. A non-zero idle timeout value is required by ASA for all
AnyConnect connections.
For Site-to-Site (IKEv1, IKEv2) and IKEv1 remote-access VPNs, we recommend you Disable timeout
and allow for an unlimited idle period.
• To disable the idle timeout for this group policy or user policy, enter no vpn-idle-timeout. The value
will be inherited.
• If you do not set vpn-idle-timeout at all, in anyway, the value is inherited, which defaults to 30 minutes.

Step 2 (Optional) You can optionally configure the time at which an idle timeout alert message is displayed to the
user using the vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval {minutes} command.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
165
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure the Maximum Connect Time

This alert message tells users how many minutes they have left until their VPN session is disconnected due
to inactivity. The default alert interval is one minute.
The following example shows how to set a VPN idle timeout alert interval of 3 minutes for the user named
anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval 3
hostname(config-username)#

Other actions using the [no] vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval {minutes | none} command:
• The none parameter indicates that users will not receive an alert.
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-idle-timeout none
hostname(config-username)#

• To remove the alert interval for this group or user policy enter no vpn-idle-timeout alert-interval. The
value will be inherited.
• If you do not set this parameter at all, the default alert interval is one minute.

Configure the Maximum Connect Time

Procedure

Step 1 (Optional) Configure a maximum amount of time for VPN connections, using the vpn-session-timeout
{minutes command in group-policy configuration mode or in username configuration mode.
The minimum time is 1 minute, and the maximum time is 35791394 minutes. There is no default value. At
the end of this period of time, the ASA terminates the connection.
The following example shows how to set a VPN session timeout of 180 minutes for the group policy named
FirstGroup:
hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# vpn-session-timeout 180
hostname(config-group-policy)#

The following example shows how to set a VPN session timeout of 180 minutes for the user named anyuser:
hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# vpn-session-timeout 180
hostname(config-username)#

Other actions using the [no] vpn-session-timeout {minutes | none} command:


• To remove the attribute from this policy and allow inheritance, enter the no vpn-session-timeout form
of this command.
• To allow an unlimited timeout period, and thus prevent inheriting a timeout value, enter
vpn-session-timeout none.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
166
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Apply an ACL Filter

Step 2 Configure the time at which a session timeout alert message is displayed to the user using the
vpn-session-timeout alert-interval {minutes | } command.
This alert message tells users how many minutes left until their VPN session is automatically disconnected.
The following example shows how to specify that users will be notified 20 minutes before their VPN session
is disconnected. You can specify a range of 1-30 minutes.
hostname(config-webvpn)# vpn-session-timeout alert-interval 20

Other actions using the [no] vpn-session-timeout alert-interval {minutes | none} command:
• Use the no form of the command to indicate that the VPN session timeout alert-interval attribute will be
inherited from the Default Group Policy:
hostname(config-webvpn)# no vpn-session-timeout alert-interval

• The vpn-session-timeout alert-interval none indicates that users will not receive an alert.

Apply an ACL Filter


Specify the name of a previously-configured, user-specific ACL to use as a filter for VPN connections. To
disallow an ACL and prevent inheriting an ACL from the group policy, enter the vpn-filter command with
the none keyword. To remove the ACL, including a null value created by issuing the vpn-filter none command,
enter the no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. There
are no default behaviors or values for this command.
You configure ACLs to permit or deny various types of traffic for this user. You then use the vpn-filter
command to apply those ACLs.

hostname(config-username)# vpn-filter {value ACL_name | none}


hostname(config-username)# no vpn-filter
hostname(config-username)#

Note Clientless SSL VPN does not use ACLs defined in the vpn-filter command.

The following example shows how to set a filter that invokes an ACL named acl_vpn for the user named
anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# vpn-filter value acl_vpn
hostname(config-username)#

Specify the IPv4 Address and Netmask


Specify the IP address and netmask to assign to a particular user. To remove the IP address, enter the no form
of this command.

hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ip-address {ip_address}


hostname(config-username)# no vpn-framed-ip-address

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
167
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Specify the IPv6 Address and Netmask

hostname(config-username)

The following example shows how to set an IP address of 10.92.166.7 for a user named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ip-address 10.92.166.7
hostname(config-username)

Specify the network mask to use with the IP address specified in the previous step. If you used the
no vpn-framed-ip-address command, do not specify a network mask. To remove the subnet mask, enter the
no form of this command. There is no default behavior or value.

hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ip-netmask {netmask}


hostname(config-username)# no vpn-framed-ip-netmask
hostname(config-username)

The following example shows how to set a subnet mask of 255.255.255. 254 for a user named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ip-netmask 255.255.255.254
hostname(config-username)

Specify the IPv6 Address and Netmask


Specify the IPv6 address and netmask to assign to a particular user. To remove the IP address, enter the no
form of this command.

hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ipv6-address {ip_address}


hostname(config-username)# no vpn-framed-ipv6-address
hostname(config-username)

The following example shows how to set an IP address and netmask of 2001::3000:1000:2000:1/64 for a user
named anyuser. This address indicates a prefix value of 2001:0000:0000:0000 and an interface ID of
3000:1000:2000:1.

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# vpn-framed-ipv6-address 2001::3000:1000:2000:1/64
hostname(config-username)

Specify the Tunnel Protocol


Specify the VPN tunnel types (IPsec or clientless SSL VPN) that this user can use. The default is taken from
the default group policy, the default for which is IPsec. To remove the attribute from the running configuration,
enter the no form of this command.

hostname(config-username)# vpn-tunnel-protocol {webvpn | IPsec}


hostname(config-username)# no vpn-tunnel-protocol [webvpn | IPsec]
hostname(config-username)

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
168
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Restrict Remote User Access

The parameter values for this command are as follows:


• IPsec—Negotiates an IPsec tunnel between two peers (a remote access client or another secure gateway).
Creates security associations that govern authentication, encryption, encapsulation, and key management.
• webvpn—Provides clientless SSL VPN access to remote users via an HTTPS-enabled web browser, and
does not require a client

Enter this command to configure one or more tunneling modes. You must configure at least one tunneling
mode for users to connect over a VPN tunnel.
The following example shows how to configure clientless SSL VPN and IPsec tunneling modes for the user
named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# vpn-tunnel-protocol webvpn
hostname(config-username)# vpn-tunnel-protocol IPsec
hostname(config-username)

Restrict Remote User Access


Configure the group-lock attribute with the value keyword to restrict remote users to access only through
the specified, preexisting connection profile. Group-lock restricts users by checking whether the group
configured in the VPN client is the same as the connection profile to which the user is assigned. If it is not,
the ASA prevents the user from connecting. If you do not configure group-lock, the ASA authenticates users
without regard to the assigned group.
To remove the group-lock attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This
option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. To disable group-lock, and to prevent inheriting
a group-lock value from a default or specified group policy, enter the group-lock command with the none
keyword.

hostname(config-username)# group-lock {value tunnel-grp-name | none}


hostname(config-username)# no group-lock
hostname(config-username)

The following example shows how to set group lock for the user named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# group-lock value tunnel-group-name
hostname(config-username)

Enable Password Storage for Software Client Users


Specify whether to let users store their login passwords on the client system. Password storage is disabled by
default. Enable password storage only on systems that you know to be in secure sites. To disable password
storage, enter the password-storage command with the disable keyword. To remove the password-storage
attribute from the running configuration, enter the no form of this command. This enables inheritance of a
value for password-storage from the group policy.

hostname(config-username)# password-storage {enable | disable}


hostname(config-username)# no password-storage

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
169
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable Password Storage for Software Client Users

hostname(config-username)

This command has no bearing on interactive hardware client authentication or individual user authentication
for hardware clients.
The following example shows how to enable password storage for the user named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# password-storage enable
hostname(config-username)

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
170
CHAPTER 5
IP Addresses for VPNs
• Configure an IP Address Assignment Policy, on page 171
• Configure Local IP Address Pools, on page 173
• Configure AAA Addressing, on page 174
• Configure DHCP Addressing, on page 175

Configure an IP Address Assignment Policy


The ASA can use one or more of the following methods for assigning IP addresses to remote access clients.
If you configure more than one address assignment method, the ASA searches each of the options until it
finds an IP address. By default, all methods are enabled.
• aaa Retrieves addresses from an external authentication, authorization, and accounting server on a per-user
basis. If you are using an authentication server that has IP addresses configured, we recommend using
this method. This method is available for IPv4 and IPv6 assignment policies.
• dhcp Obtains IP addresses from a DHCP server. If you want to use DHCP, you must configure a DHCP
server. You must also define the range of IP addresses that the DHCP server can use. This method is
available for IPv4 assignment policies.
• local Internally configured address pools are the easiest method of address pool assignment to configure.
If you choose local, you must also use the ip-local-pool command to define the range of IP addresses to
use. This method is available for IPv4 and IPv6 assignment policies.
• Allow the reuse of an IP address so many minutes after it is released—Delays the reuse of an IP
address after its return to the address pool. Adding a delay helps to prevent problems firewalls can
experience when an IP address is reassigned quickly. By default the ASA does not impose a delay.
This configurable element is available for IPv4 assignment policies.

Use one of the following methods to specify a way to assign IP addresses to remote access clients.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
171
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure IPv4 Address Assignments

Configure IPv4 Address Assignments


Procedure

Enable an address assignment method for the ASA to use when assigning IPv4 address to VPN connections.
The available methods to obtain an IP address are from a AAA server, DHCP server, or a local address pool.
All of these methods are enabled by default.
vpn-addr-assign {aaa | dhcp | local [reuse-delay minutes]}
Example:
For example, you can configure the reuse of an IP address for between 0 and 480 minutes after the IP address
has been released.
hostname(config)#vpn-addr-assign aaa
hostname(config)#vpn-addr-assign local reuse-delay 180

This example uses the no form of the command to disable an address assignment method.
hostname(config)# no vpn-addr-assign dhcp

Configure IPv6 Address Assignments


Procedure

Enable an address assignment method for the ASA to use when assigning IPv6 address to VPN connections.
The available methods to obtain an IP address are from a AAA server or a local address pool. Both of these
methods are enabled by default.
ipv6-vpn-addr-assign {aaa | local}
Example:
hostname(config)# ipv6-vpn-addr-assign aaa

This example uses the no form of the command to disable an address assignment method.
hostname(config)# no ipv6-vpn-addr-assign local

View Address Assignment Methods


Procedure

Use one of these methods to view the address assignment method configured on the ASA:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
172
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Local IP Address Pools

• View IPv4 Address Assignments


Show the configured address assignment method. The configured address method could be aaa, dhcp,
or local.
show running-config all vpn-addr-assign
vpn-addr-assign aaa
vpn-addr-assign dhcp
vpn-addr-assign local

• View IPv6 Address Assignments


Show the configured address assignment method. Configured address methods could be aaa or local.
show running-config all ipv6-vpn-addr-assign
ipv6-vpn-addr-assign aaa
ipv6-vpn-addr-assign local reuse-delay 0

Configure Local IP Address Pools


To configure IPv4 address pools to use for VPN remote access tunnels, enter the ip local pool command in
global configuration mode. To delete address pools, enter the no form of this command.
To configure IPv6 address pools to use for VPN remote access tunnels, enter the ipv6 local pool command
in global configuration mode. To delete address pools, enter the no form of this command.
The ASA uses address pools based on the connection profile or group policy for the connection. The order
in which you specify the pools is important. If you configure more than one address pool for a connection
profile or group policy, the ASA uses them in the order in which you added them to the ASA.
If you assign addresses from a non-local subnet, we suggest that you add pools that fall on subnet boundaries
to make adding routes for these networks easier.

Configure Local IPv4 Address Pools


Procedure

Step 1 Configure IP address pools as the address assignment method. Enter the vpn-addr-assign command with the
local argument.
Example:
hostname(config)# vpn-addr-assign local

Step 2 Configure an address pool. The command names the pool, specifies a range of IPv4 addresses and the subnet
mask.
ip local poolpoolname first_address-last_addressmaskmask
Example:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
173
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Local IPv6 Address Pools

This example configures an IP address pool named firstpool.The starting address is 10.20.30.40and the ending
address is 10.20.30.50.The network mask is 255.255.255.0.
hostname(config)# ip local pool firstpool 10.20.30.40-10.20.30.50 mask 255.255.255.0

This example deletes the IP address pool named firstpool.


hostname(config)# no ip local pool firstpool

Configure Local IPv6 Address Pools


Procedure

Step 1 Configures IP address pools as the address assignment method, enter the ipv6-vpn-addr-assign command
with the local argument.
Example:
hostname(config)# ipv6-vpn-addr-assign local

Step 2 Configures an address pool. The command names the pool, identifies the starting IPv6 address, the prefix
length in bits, and the number of addresses to use in the range.
ipv6 local pool pool_name starting_address prefix_length number_of_addresses
Example:
This example configures an IP address pool named ipv6pool. The starting address is 2001:DB8::1, the prefix
length is 32 bits, and the number of addresses to use in the pool is 100.
hostname(config)# ipv6 local pool ipv6pool 2001:DB8::1/32 100

This example deletes the IP address pool named ipv6pool.


hostname(config)# no ipv6 local pool ipv6pool

Configure AAA Addressing


To use a AAA server to assign addresses for VPN remote access clients, you must first configure a AAA
server or server group. See the aaa-server protocol command in the command reference.
In addition, the user must match a connection profile configured for RADIUS authentication.
The following examples illustrate how to define a AAA server group called RAD2 for the tunnel group named
firstgroup. It includes one more step than is necessary, in that previously you might have named the tunnel
group and defined the tunnel group type. This step appears in the following example as a reminder that you
have no access to subsequent tunnel-group commands until you set these values.
An overview of the configuration that these examples create follows:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
174
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure DHCP Addressing

hostname(config)# vpn-addr-assign aaa


hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup general-attributes
hostname(config)# authentication-server-group RAD2

To configure AAA for IP addressing, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 To configure AAA as the address assignment method, enter the vpn-addr-assign command with the aaa
argument:
hostname(config)# vpn-addr-assign aaa
hostname(config)#

Step 2 To establish the tunnel group called firstgroup as a remote access or LAN-to-LAN tunnel group, enter the
tunnel-group command with the type keyword. The following example configures a remote access tunnel
group.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)#

Step 3 To enter general-attributes configuration mode, which lets you define a AAA server group for the tunnel
group called firstgroup, enter the tunnel-group command with the general-attributes argument.
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup general-attributes
hostname(config-general)#

Step 4 To specify the AAA server group to use for authentication, enter the authentication-server-group command.
hostname(config-general)# authentication-server-group RAD2
hostname(config-general)#

What to do next
This command has more arguments that this example includes. For more information, see the command
reference.

Configure DHCP Addressing


To use DHCP to assign addresses for VPN clients, you must first configure a DHCP server and the range of
IP addresses that the DHCP server can use. Then you define the DHCP server on a connection profile basis.
Optionally, you can also define a DHCP network scope in the group policy associated with a connection
profile or username. This is either an IP network number or IP Address that identifies to the DHCP server
which pool of IP addresses to use.
The following examples define the DHCP server at IP address 172.33.44.19 for the connection profile named
firstgroup. They also define a DHCP network scope of 192.86.0.0 for the group policy called remotegroup.
(The group policy called remotegroup is associated with the connection profile called firstgroup). If you do

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
175
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure DHCP Addressing

not define a network scope, the DHCP server assigns IP addresses in the order of the address pools configured.
It goes through the pools until it identifies an unassigned address.
The following configuration includes more steps than are necessary, in that previously you might have named
and defined the connection profile type as remote access, and named and identified the group policy as internal
or external. These steps appear in the following examples as a reminder that you have no access to subsequent
tunnel-group and group-policy commands until you set these values.

Guidelines and Limitations


You can only use an IPv4 address to identify a DHCP server to assign client addresses.

Configure DHCP Addressing


Procedure

Step 1 Configure IP address pools as the address assignment method.


vpn-addr-assign dhcp

Step 2 Establish the connection profile called firstgroup as a remote access connection profile.
tunnel-group firstgroup type remote-access

Step 3 Enter the general-attributes configuration mode for the connection profile so that you can configure a DHCP
server.
tunnel-group firstgroup general-attributes

Step 4 Define the DHCP server by IPv4 address. You can not define a DHCP server by an IPv6 address. You can
specify more than one DHCP server address for a connection profile. Enter the dhcp-server command. This
command allows you to configure the ASA to send additional options to the specified DHCP servers when
it is trying to get IP addresses for VPN clients.
dhcp-server IPv4_address_of_DHCP_server
Example:
The example configures a DHCP server at IP address 172.33.44.19.
hostname(config-general)# dhcp-server 172.33.44.19
hostname(config-general)#

Step 5 Exit the tunnel-group mode.


hostname(config-general)# exit
hostname(config)#

Step 6 Create an internal group policy called remotegroup.


hostname(config)# group-policy remotegroup internal

Example:
The example enters group policy attributes configuration mode for remotegroup group-policy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
176
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure DHCP Addressing

hostname(config)# group-policy remotegroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)#

Step 7 (Optional) Enter the group-policy attributes configuration mode, which lets you configure a subnetwork of
IP addresses for the DHCP server to use. Enter the group-policy command with the attributes keyword.
Example:
hostname(config)# group-policy remotegroup attributes

Step 8 (Optional) To specify the range of IP addresses the DHCP server should use to assign addresses to users of
the group policy called remotegroup, enter the dhcp-network-scope command.
The example configures a network scope of 192.86.0.0.
hostname(config-group-policy)# dhcp-network-scope 192.86.0.0
hostname(config-group-policy)#

Note The dhcp-network-scope must be a routable IP address and not the subset of the DHCP pool. The
DHCP server determines which subnet this IP address belongs to and assigns an IP address from
that pool. You can use any IP address as the dhcp-network-scope, but it may require that static
routes be added to the network.

Example
A summary of the configuration that these examples create follows:
hostname(config)# vpn-addr-assign dhcp
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup type remote-access
hostname(config)# tunnel-group firstgroup general-attributes
hostname(config-general)# dhcp-server 172.33.44.19
hostname(config-general)# exit
hostname(config)# group-policy remotegroup internal
hostname(config)# group-policy remotegroup attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# dhcp-network-scope 192.86.0.0

What to do next
See the dhcp-server command in the Cisco Security Appliance Command Reference guide for more
information.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
177
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure DHCP Addressing

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
178
CHAPTER 6
Remote Access IPsec VPNs
• About Remote Access IPsec VPNs, on page 179
• Licensing Requirements for Remote Access IPsec VPNs for 3.1, on page 180
• Restrictions for IPsec VPN, on page 180
• Configure Remote Access IPsec VPNs, on page 180
• Configuration Examples for Remote Access IPsec VPNs, on page 187
• Configuration Examples for Standards-Based IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multiple-Context
Mode, on page 188
• Configuration Examples for AnyConnect IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multiple-Context Mode,
on page 189
• Feature History for Remote Access VPNs, on page 191

About Remote Access IPsec VPNs


Remote access VPNs allow users to connect to a central site through a secure connection over a TCP/IP
network. The Internet Security Association and Key Management Protocol, also called IKE, is the negotiation
protocol that lets the IPsec client on the remote PC and the ASA agree on how to build an IPsec Security
Association. Each ISAKMP negotiation is divided into two sections called Phase1 and Phase2.
Phase 1 creates the first tunnel to protect later ISAKMP negotiation messages. Phase 2 creates the tunnel that
protects data travelling across the secure connection.
To set the terms of the ISAKMP negotiations, you create an ISAKMP policy. It includes the following:
• An authentication method, to ensure the identity of the peers.
• An encryption method, to protect the data and ensure privacy.
• A Hashed Message Authentication Codes (HMAC) method to ensure the identity of the sender and to
ensure that the message has not been modified in transit.
• A Diffie-Hellman group to set the size of the encryption key.
• A time limit for how long the ASA uses an encryption key before replacing it.

A transform set combines an encryption method and an authentication method. During the IPsec security
association negotiation with ISAKMP, the peers agree to use a particular transform set to protect a particular
data flow. The transform set must be the same for both peers.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
179
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Licensing Requirements for Remote Access IPsec VPNs for 3.1

A transform set protects the data flows for the ACL specified in the associated crypto map entry. You can
create transform sets in the ASA configuration, and then specify a maximum of 11 of them in a crypto map
or dynamic crypto map entry. For more overview information, including a table that lists valid encryption
and authentication methods, see Create an IKEv1 Transform Set or IKEv2 Proposal, on page 183.
You can configure the ASA to assign an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or both an IPv4 and an IPv6 address
to an AnyConnect client by creating internal pools of addresses on the ASA or by assigning a dedicated address
to a local user on the ASA.
The endpoint must have the dual-stack protocol implemented in its operating system to be assigned both types
of addresses. In both scenarios, when no IPv6 address pools are left but IPv4 addresses are available or when
no IPv4 address pools are left but IPv6 addresses are available, connection still occurs. The client is not
notified; however, so the administrator must look through the ASA logs for the details.
Assigning an IPv6 address to the client is supported for the SSL protocol.

Licensing Requirements for Remote Access IPsec VPNs for 3.1

Note This feature is not available on No Payload Encryption models.

IPsec remote access VPN using IKEv2 requires an AnyConnect Plus or Apex license, available separately.
IPsec remote access VPN using IKEv1 and IPsec site-to-site VPN using IKEv1 or IKEv2 uses the Other VPN
license that comes with the base license. See Cisco ASA Series Feature Licenses for maximum values per
model.

Restrictions for IPsec VPN


• Context Mode Guidelines-Supported only in single context mode. Does not support multiple context
mode.
• Firewall Mode Guidelines-Supported only in routed firewall mode. Transparent mode is not supported.
• Failover Guidelines IPsec-VPN sessions are replicated in Active/Standby failover configurations only.
Active/Active failover configurations are not supported.

Configure Remote Access IPsec VPNs


This section describes how to configure remote access VPNs.

Configure Interfaces
An ASA has at least two interfaces, referred to here as outside and inside. Typically, the outside interface is
connected to the public Internet, while the inside interface is connected to a private network and is protected
from public access.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
180
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure ISAKMP Policy and Enabling ISAKMP on the Outside Interface

To begin, configure and enable two interfaces on the ASA. Then assign a name, IP address and subnet mask.
Optionally, configure its security level, speed and duplex operation on the security appliance.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter interface configuration mode from global configuration mode.


interface {interface}
Example:
hostname(config)# interface ethernet0
hostname(config-if)#

Step 2 Set the IP address and subnet mask for the interface.
ip address ip_address [mask] [standby ip_address]
Example:
hostname(config)# interface ethernet0
hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.10.4.200 255.255.0.0

Step 3 Specify a name for the interface (maximum of 48 characters). You cannot change this name after you set it.
nameif name
Example:
hostname(config-if)# nameif outside
hostname(config-if)#

Step 4 Enable the interface. By default, interfaces are disabled.shutdown


Example:
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
hostname(config-if)#

Configure ISAKMP Policy and Enabling ISAKMP on the Outside Interface


Procedure

Step 1 Specify the authentication method and the set of parameters to use during IKEv1 negotiation.
Priority uniquely identifies the Internet Key Exchange (IKE) policy and assigns a priority to the policy. Use
an integer from 1 to 65,534, with 1 being the highest priority and 65,534 the lowest.
In the steps that follow, we set the priority to 1.

Step 2 Specify the encryption method to use within an IKE policy.


crypto ikev1 policy priority encryption {aes | aes-192 | aes-256 | des | 3des}

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
181
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure an Address Pool

Example:
hostname(config)#
crypto ikev1 policy 1 encryption 3des

hostname(config)#

Step 3 Specify the hash algorithm for an IKE policy (also called the HMAC variant).
crypto ikev1 policy priority hash {md5 | sha}
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 policy 1 hash sha
hostname(config)#

Step 4 Specify the Diffie-Hellman group for the IKE policy—the crypto protocol that allows the IPsec client and the
ASA to establish a shared secret key.
crypto ikev1 policy priority group {1 | 2 | 5| }
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 policy 1 group 2
hostname(config)#

Step 5 Specify the encryption key lifetime—the number of seconds each security association should exist before
expiring.
crypto ikev1 policy priority lifetime {seconds}
The range for a finite lifetime is 120 to 2147483647 seconds. Use 0 seconds for an infinite lifetime.
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 policy 1 lifetime 43200
hostname(config)#

Step 6 Enable ISAKMP on the interface named outside.


crypto ikev1 enable interface-name
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 enable outside
hostname(config)#

Step 7 Save the changes to the configuration.


write memory

Configure an Address Pool


The ASA requires a method for assigning IP addresses to users. This section uses address pools as an example.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
182
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Add a User

Procedure

Create an address pool with a range of IP addresses, from which the ASA assigns addresses to the clients.
ip local pool poolname first-address—last-address [mask mask]
The address mask is optional. However, You must supply the mask value when the IP addresses assigned to
VPN clients belong to a non-standard network and the data could be routed incorrectly if you use the default
mask. A typical example is when the IP local pool contains 10.10.10.0/255.255.255.0 addresses, since this is
a Class A network by default. This could cause routing issues when the VPN client needs to access different
subnets within the 10 network over different interfaces.
Example:
hostname(config)# ip local pool testpool 192.168.0.10-192.168.0.15
hostname(config)#

Add a User
Procedure

Create a user, password, and privilege level.


username name {nopassword | password password [mschap | encrypted | nt-encrypted]} [privilege
priv_level]
Example:
Hostname(config)# username testuser password 12345678

Create an IKEv1 Transform Set or IKEv2 Proposal


This section shows how to configure a transform set (IKEv1) or proposal (IKEv2), which combines an
encryption method and an authentication method.
The following steps show how to create both an IKEv1 and an IKEv2 proposal.

Procedure

Step 1 Configure an IKEv1 transform set that specifies the IPsec IKEv1 encryption and hash algorithms to be used
to ensure data integrity.
crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set transform-set-name encryption-method [authentication]
Use one of the following values for encryption:
• esp-aes to use AES with a 128-bit key.
• esp-aes-192 to use AES with a 192-bit key.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
183
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create an IKEv1 Transform Set or IKEv2 Proposal

• esp-aes-256 to use AES with a 256-bit key.


• esp-des to use 56-bit DES-CBC.
• esp-3des to use triple DES algorithm.
• esp-null to not use encryption.

Use one of the following values for authentication:


• esp-md5-hmac to use the MD5/HMAC-128 as the hash algorithm.
• esp-sha-hmac to use the SHA/HMAC-160 as the hash algorithm.
• esp-none to not use HMAC authentication.

Example:
To configure an IKEv1 transform set:
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec transform set FirstSet esp-3des esp-md5-hmac

Step 2 Configure an IKEv2 proposal set that specifies the IPsec IKEv2 protocol, encryption, and integrity algorithms
to be used.
esp specifies the Encapsulating Security Payload (ESP) IPsec protocol (currently the only supported protocol
for IPsec).
crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal proposal_name
protocol {esp} {encryption {des | 3des | aes | aes-192 | aes-256 | null} | integrity {md5 | sha-1}
Use one of the following values for encryption:
• des to use 56-bit DES-CBC encryption for ESP.
• 3des (default) to use the triple DES encryption algorithm for ESP.
• aes to use AES with a 128-bit key encryption for ESP.
• aes-192 to use AES with a 192-bit key encryption for ESP.
• aes-256 to use AES with a 256-bit key encryption for ESP.
• null to not use encryption for ESP.

Use one of the following values for integrity:


• md5 specifies the md5 algorithm for the ESP integrity protection.
• sha-1 (default) specifies the Secure Hash Algorithm (SHA) SHA-1, defined in the U.S. Federal Information
Processing Standard (FIPS), for ESP integrity protection.

To configure an IKEv2 proposal:


hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal secure_proposal
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)# protocol esp encryption des integrity md5

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
184
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Define a Tunnel Group

Define a Tunnel Group


A tunnel group is a collection of tunnel connection policies. You configure a tunnel group to identify AAA
servers, specify connection parameters, and define a default group policy. The ASA stores tunnel groups
internally.
There are two default tunnel groups in the ASA system: DefaultRAGroup, which is the default remote-access
tunnel group, and DefaultL2Lgroup, which is the default LAN-to-LAN tunnel group. You can change these
groups, but do not delete them. The ASA uses these groups to configure default tunnel parameters for remote
access and LAN-to-LAN tunnel groups when there is no specific tunnel group identified during tunnel
negotiation.

Procedure

Step 1 Create an IPsec remote access tunnel-group (also called connection profile).
tunnel-group name type type
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup type ipsec-ra
hostname(config)#

Step 2 Enter tunnel group general attributes mode where you can enter an authentication method.
tunnel-group name general-attributes
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)#

Step 3 Specify an address pool to use for the tunnel group.


address-pool [(interface name)] address_pool1 [...address_pool6]
Example:
hostname(config-general)# address-pool testpool

Step 4 Enter tunnel group ipsec attributes mode where you can enter IPsec-specific attributes for IKEv1 connections.
tunnel-group name ipsec-attributes
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)#

Step 5 (Optional) Configure a pre-shared key (IKEv1 only). The key can be an alphanumeric string from 1-128
characters.
The keys for the adaptive security appliance and the client must be identical. If a Cisco VPN Client with a
different preshared key size tries to connect, the client logs an error message indicating it failed to authenticate
the peer.
ikev1 pre-shared-key key

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
185
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create a Dynamic Crypto Map

Example:
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# pre-shared-key 44kkaol59636jnfx

Create a Dynamic Crypto Map


Dynamic crypto maps define policy templates in which not all the parameters are configured. This lets the
ASA receive connections from peers that have unknown IP addresses, such as remote access clients.
Dynamic crypto map entries identify the transform set for the connection. You can also enable reverse routing,
which lets the ASA learn routing information for connected clients, and advertise it via RIP or OSPF.
Perform the following task:

Procedure

Step 1 Create a dynamic crypto map and specifies an IKEv1 transform set or IKEv2 proposal for the map.
• For IKEv1, use this command:
crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name seq-num set ikev1 transform-set transform-set-name
• For IKEv2, use this command:
crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name seq-num set ikev2 ipsec-proposal proposal-name

Example:
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map dyn1 1 set ikev1 transform-set FirstSet
hostname(config)#
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map dyn1 1 set ikev2 ipsec-proposal secure_proposal
hostname(config)#

Step 2 (Optional) Enable Reverse Route Injection for any connection based on this crypto map entry.
crypto dynamic-map dynamic-map-name dynamic-seq-num set reverse-route
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map dyn1 1 set reverse route
hostname(config)#

Create a Crypto Map Entry to Use the Dynamic Crypto Map


Create a crypto map entry that lets the ASA use the dynamic crypto map to set the parameters of IPsec security
associations.
In the following examples for this command, the name of the crypto map is mymap, the sequence number is
1, and the name of the dynamic crypto map is dyn1, which you created in the previous section.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
186
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuring IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multi-Context Mode

Procedure

Step 1 Create a crypto map entry that uses a dynamic crypto map.
crypto map map-name seq-num ipsec-isakmp dynamic dynamic-map-name
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto map mymap 1 ipsec-isakmp dynamic dyn1

Step 2 Apply the crypto map to the outside interface.


crypto map map-name interface interface-name
Example:
hostname(config)# crypto map mymap interface outside

Step 3 Saves the changes to the configuration.


write memory

Configuring IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multi-Context Mode


For more information about configuring Remote Access IPsec VPNs, see the following sections:
• Configure Interfaces, on page 180
• Configure an Address Pool, on page 182
• Add a User, on page 183
• Create an IKEv1 Transform Set or IKEv2 Proposal, on page 183
• Define a Tunnel Group, on page 185
• Create a Dynamic Crypto Map, on page 186
• Create a Crypto Map Entry to Use the Dynamic Crypto Map, on page 186

Configuration Examples for Remote Access IPsec VPNs


The following example shows how to configure a remote access IPsec/IKEv1 VPN:

hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 policy 10


hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# authentication pre-share
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# encryption aes-256
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# hash sha
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# group 2
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 enable outside
hostname(config)# ip local pool POOL 192.168.0.10-192.168.0.15
hostname(config)# username testuser password 12345678
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev1 transform set AES256-SHA

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
187
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuration Examples for Standards-Based IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multiple-Context Mode

esp-aes-256 esp-sha-hmac
hostname(config)# tunnel-group RAVPN type remote-access
hostname(config)# tunnel-group RAVPN general-attributes
hostname(config-general)# address-pool POOL
hostname(config)# tunnel-group RAVPN ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-ipsec)# ikev1 pre-shared-key ravpnkey
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map DYNMAP 1 set ikev1
transform-set AES256-SHA
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map DYNMAP 1 set reverse-route
hostname(config)# crypto map CMAP 1 ipsec-isakmp dynamic DYNMAP
hostname(config)# crypto map CMAP interface outside

The following example shows how to configure a remote access IPsec/IKEv2 VPN:

hostname(config)# crypto ikev2 policy 1


hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# group 2
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# integrity sha512
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# prf sha512
hostname(config)# crypto ikev2 enable outside
hostname(config)# ip local pool POOL 192.168.0.10-192.168.0.15
hostname(config)# username testuser password 12345678
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal AES256-SHA512
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)# protocol esp encryption aes-256
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)# protocol esp integrity sha-512
hostname(config)# tunnel-group RAVPN type remote-access
hostname(config)# tunnel-group RAVPN general-attributes
hostname(config-general)# address-pool POOL
hostname(config)# tunnel-group RAVPN ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev2 local-authentication
pre-shared-key localravpnkey
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev2 remote-authentication
pre-shared-key remoteravpnkey
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map DYNMAP 1 set ikev2
ipsec-proposal AES256-SHA512
hostname(config)# crypto dynamic-map DYNMAP 1 set reverse-route
hostname(config)# crypto map CMAP 1 ipsec-isakmp dynamic DYNMAP
hostname(config)# crypto map CMAP interface outside

Configuration Examples for Standards-Based IPSec IKEv2


Remote Access VPN in Multiple-Context Mode
The following examples show how to configure ASA for Standards-based remote access IPsec/IKEv2 VPN
in multi-context mode. The examples provide information for the System Context and User Context
configurations respectively.
For the System Context configuration:

class default
limit-resource All 0
limit-resource Mac-addresses 65536
limit-resource ASDM 5
limit-resource SSH 5
limit-resource Telnet 5
limit-resource VPN AnyConnect 4.0%

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
188
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuration Examples for AnyConnect IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multiple-Context Mode

hostname(config)#context CTX2
hostname(config-ctx)#member default ===============> License allotment for contexts using
class
hostname(config-ctx)#allocate-interface Ethernet1/1.200
hostname(config-ctx)#allocate-interface Ethernet1/3.100
hostname(config-ctx)#config-url disk0:/CTX2.cfg

For the User Context configuration:

hostname/CTX2(config)#ip local pool CTX2-pool 1.1.2.1-1.1.2.250 mask 255.255.255.0


hostname/CTX2(config)#aaa-server ISE protocol radius
hostname/CTX2(config)#aaa-server ISE (inside) host 10.10.190.100
hostname/CTX2(config-aaa-server-host)#key *****
hostname/CTX2(config-aaa-server-host)#exit
hostname/CTX2(config)#

hostname/CTX2(config)#group-policy GroupPolicy_CTX2-IKEv2 internal


hostname/CTX2(config)#group-policy GroupPolicy_CTX2-IKEv2 attributes
hostname/CTX2(config-group-policy)#vpn-tunnel-protocol ikev2
hostname/CTX2(config-group-policy)#exit
hostname/CTX2(config)#

hostname/CTX2(config)#crypto dynamic-map SYSTEM_DEFAULT_CRYPTO_MAP 65535 set ikev2


ipsec-proposal AES256 AES192 AES 3DES DES
hostname/CTX2(config)#crypto map outside_map 65535 ipsec-isakmp dynamic
SYSTEM_DEFAULT_CRYPTO_MAP
hostname/CTX2(config)#crypto map outside_map interface outside

IPSec/IKEv2 Remote Access Connections from Standard-based Clients by default fall on tunnel group
"DefaultRAGroup".
hostname/CTX2(config)#tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup type remote-access
hostname/CTX2(config)#tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup general-attributes
hostname/CTX2(config-tunnel-general)#default-group-policy GroupPolicy_CTX2-IKEv2
hostname/CTX2(config-tunnel-general)#address-pool CTX2-pool
hostname/CTX2(config-tunnel-general)#authentication-server-group ISE
hostname/CTX2(config-tunnel-general)#exit
hostname/CTX2(config)#
hostname/CTX2(config)#tunnel-group DefaultRAGroup ipsec-attributes
hostname/CTX2(config-tunnel-ipsec)#ikev2 remote-authentication eap query-identity
hostname/CTX2(config-tunnel-ipsec)#ikev2 local-authentication certificate ASDM_TrustPoint0
hostname/CTX2(config-tunnel-ipsec)#exit
hostname/CTX2(config)#

Configuration Examples for AnyConnect IPSec IKEv2 Remote


Access VPN in Multiple-Context Mode
The following examples show how to configure ASA for AnyConnect remote access IPsec/IKEv2 VPN in
multi-context mode. The examples provide information for the System Context and User Context configurations
respectively.
For the System Context configuration:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
189
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuration Examples for AnyConnect IPSec IKEv2 Remote Access VPN in Multiple-Context Mode

class default
limit-resource All 0
limit-resource Mac-addresses 65536
limit-resource ASDM 5
limit-resource SSH 5
limit-resource Telnet 5
limit-resource VPN AnyConnect 4.0%

hostname(config)#context CTX3
hostname(config-ctx)#member default ===============> License allotment for contexts using
class
hostname(config-ctx)#allocate-interface Ethernet1/1.200
hostname(config-ctx)#allocate-interface Ethernet1/3.100
hostname(config-ctx)#config-url disk0:/CTX3.cfg

Virtual File System creation for each context can have Cisco Anyconnect files like Image and profile.
hostname(config-ctx)#storage-url shared disk0:/shared disk0

For the User Context configuration:

hostname/CTX3(config)#ip local pool ctx3-pool 1.1.3.1-1.1.3.250 mask 255.255.255.0


hostname/CTX3(config)#webvpn
hostname/CTX3(config-webvpn)#enable outside
hostname/CTX3(config-webvpn)# anyconnect image
disk0:/anyconnect-win-4.6.00010-webdeploy-k9.pkg 1
hostname/CTX3(config-webvpn)#anyconnect profiles IKEv2-ctx1 disk0:/ikev2-ctx1.xml
hostname/CTX3(config-webvpn)#anyconnect enable
hostname/CTX3(config-webvpn)#tunnel-group-list enable

hostname/CTX3(config)#username cisco password *****


hostname/CTX3(config)#ssl trust-point ASDM_TrustPoint0 outside
hostname/CTX3(config)#group-policy GroupPolicy_CTX3-IKEv2 internal
hostname/CTX3(config)#group-policy GroupPolicy_CTX3-IKEv2 attributes

hostname/CTX3(config-group-policy)#vpn-tunnel-protocol ikev2 ssl-client


hostname/CTX3(config-group-policy)#dns-server value 10.3.5.6
hostname/CTX3(config-group-policy)#wins-server none
hostname/CTX3(config-group-policy)#default-domain none
hostname/CTX3(config-group-policy)#webvpn
hostname/CTX3(config-group-webvpn)#anyconnect profiles value IKEv2-ctx1 type user

hostname/CTX3(config)#crypto ikev2 enable outside client-services port 443


hostname/CTX3(config)#crypto ikev2 remote-access trustpoint ASDM_TrustPoint0
hostname/CTX3(config)#crypto dynamic-map SYSTEM_DEFAULT_CRYPTO_MAP 65535 set ikev2
ipsec-proposal AES256 AES192 AES 3DES DES
hostname/CTX3(config)#crypto map outside_map 65535 ipsec-isakmp dynamic
SYSTEM_DEFAULT_CRYPTO_MAP
hostname/CTX3(config)#crypto map outside_map interface outside

hostname/CTX3(config)#tunnel-group CTX3-IKEv2 type remote-access


hostname/CTX3(config)#tunnel-group CTX3-IKEv2 general-attributes
hostname/CTX3(config-tunnel-general)#default-group-policy GroupPolicy_CTX3-IKEv2

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
190
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Feature History for Remote Access VPNs

hostname/CTX3(config-tunnel-general)#address-pool ctx3-pool
hostname/CTX3(config)#tunnel-group CTX3-IKEv2 webvpn-attributes
hostname/CTX3(config-tunnel-webvpn)#group-alias CTX3-IKEv2 enable

Feature History for Remote Access VPNs


Feature Name Releases Feature Information

Remote access VPNs for IPsec 7.0 Remote access VPNs allow users
IKEv1 and SSL. to connect to a central site through
a secure connection over a TCP/IP
network such as the Internet.

Remote access VPNs for IPsec 8.4(1) Added IPsec IKEv2 support for the
IKEv2. AnyConnect Secure Mobility
Client.

Remote access VPNs for IPsec 9.9(2) Support for configuring ASA to
IKEv2 in Multi-Context mode allow Anyconnect and third party
Standards-based IPSec IKEv2 VPN
clients to establish Remote Access
VPN sessions to ASA operating in
multi-context mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
191
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Feature History for Remote Access VPNs

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
192
CHAPTER 7
LAN-to-LAN IPsec VPNs
A LAN-to-LAN VPN connects networks in different geographic locations.
You can create LAN-to-LAN IPsec connections with Cisco peers and with third-party peers that comply with
all relevant standards. These peers can have any mix of inside and outside addresses using IPv4 and IPv6
addressing.
This chapter describes how to build a LAN-to-LAN VPN connection.
• Summary of the Configuration, on page 193
• Configure Site-to-Site VPN in Multi-Context Mode, on page 194
• Configure Interfaces, on page 195
• Configure ISAKMP Policy and Enable ISAKMP on the Outside Interface, on page 196
• Create an IKEv1 Transform Set, on page 198
• Create an IKEv2 Proposal, on page 199
• Configure an ACL, on page 200
• Define a Tunnel Group, on page 201
• Create a Crypto Map and Applying It To an Interface, on page 202

Summary of the Configuration


This section provides a summary of the example LAN-to-LAN configuration this chapter describes. Later
sections provide step-by-step instructions.

hostname(config)# interface ethernet0/0


hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.10.4.100 255.255.0.0
hostname(config-if)# nameif outside
hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 policy 1
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# authentication pre-share
hostname(config-ikev1-policy) # encryption 3des
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# hash sha
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# group 2
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# lifetime 43200
hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 enable outside
hostname(config)# crypto ikev2 policy 1
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# # encryption 3des
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# group 2
hostname(config-ikev12-policy)# prf sha
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# lifetime 43200

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
193
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Site-to-Site VPN in Multi-Context Mode

hostname(config)# crypto ikev2 enable outside


hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set FirstSet esp-3des esp-md5-hmac
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal secure
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)# protocol esp encryption 3des aes des
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)# protocol esp integrity sha-1
hostname(config)# access-list l2l_list extended permit ip 192.168.0.0 255.255.0.0 150.150.0.0
255.255.0.0
hostname(config)# tunnel-group 10.10.4.108 type ipsec-l2l
hostname(config)# tunnel-group 10.10.4.108 ipsec-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev1 pre-shared-key 44kkaol59636jnfx
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 match address l2l_list
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 set peer 10.10.4.108
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 set ikev1 transform-set FirstSet
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 set ikev2 ipsec-proposal secure
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap interface outside
hostname(config)# write memory

Configure Site-to-Site VPN in Multi-Context Mode


Follow these steps to allow site-to-site support in multi-mode. By performing these steps, you can see how
resource allocation breaks down.

Procedure

Step 1 To configure the VPN in multi-mode, configure a resource class and choose VPN licenses as part of the
allowed resource. The "Configuring a Class for Resource Management" provides these configuration steps.
The following is an example configuration:

class ctx1
limit-resource VPN Burst Other 100
limit-resource VPN Other 1000

Step 2 Configure a context and make it a member of the configured class that allows VPN licenses. The following
is an example configuration:

context context1
member ctx1
allocate-interface GigabitEthernet3/0.2
allocate-interface GigabitEthernet3/1.2
allocate-interface Management0/0
config-url disk0:/sm_s2s_ik1_ip4_no_webvpn.txt
join-failover-group 1

Step 3 Configure connection profiles, policies, crypto maps, and so on, just as you would with single context VPN
configuration of site-to-site VPN.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
194
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Interfaces

Configure Interfaces
An ASA has at least two interfaces, referred to here as outside and inside. Typically, the outside interface is
connected to the public Internet, while the inside interface is connected to a private network and is protected
from public access.
To begin, configure and enable two interfaces on the ASA. Then, assign a name, IP address and subnet mask.
Optionally, configure its security level, speed, and duplex operation on the security appliance.

Note The ASA’s outside interface address (for both IPv4/IPv6) cannot overlap with the private side address space.

Procedure

Step 1 To enter Interface configuration mode, in global configuration mode enter the interface command with the
default name of the interface to configure. In the following example the interface is ethernet0.

hostname(config)# interface ethernet0/0


hostname(config-if)#

Step 2 To set the IP address and subnet mask for the interface, enter the ip address command. In the following
example the IP address is 10.10.4.100 and the subnet mask is 255.255.0.0.

hostname(config-if)# ip address 10.10.4.100 255.255.0.0


hostname(config-if)#

Step 3 To name the interface, enter the nameif command, maximum of 48 characters. You cannot change this name
after you set it. In the following example the name of the ethernet0 interface is outside.

hostname(config-if)# nameif outside


hostname(config-if)##

Step 4 To enable the interface, enter the no version of the shutdown command. By default, interfaces are disabled.

hostname(config-if)# no shutdown
hostname(config-if)#

Step 5 To save your changes, enter the write memory command:

hostname(config-if)# write memory


hostname(config-if)#

Step 6 To configure a second interface, use the same procedure.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
195
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure ISAKMP Policy and Enable ISAKMP on the Outside Interface

Configure ISAKMP Policy and Enable ISAKMP on the Outside


Interface
ISAKMP is the negotiation protocol that lets two hosts agree on how to build an IPsec security association
(SA). It provides a common framework for agreeing on the format of SA attributes. This includes negotiating
with the peer about the SA, and modifying or deleting the SA. ISAKMP separates negotiation into two phases:
Phase 1 and Phase 2. Phase 1 creates the first tunnel, which protects later ISAKMP negotiation messages.
Phase 2 creates the tunnel that protects data.
IKE uses ISAKMP to setup the SA for IPsec to use. IKE creates the cryptographic keys used to authenticate
peers.
The ASA supports IKEv1 for connections from the legacy Cisco VPN client, and IKEv2 for the AnyConnect
VPN client.
To set the terms of the ISAKMP negotiations, you create an IKE policy, which includes the following:
• The authentication type required of the IKEv1 peer, either RSA signature using certificates or preshared
key (PSK).
• An encryption method, to protect the data and ensure privacy.
• A Hashed Message Authentication Codes (HMAC) method to ensure the identity of the sender, and to
ensure that the message has not been modified in transit.
• A Diffie-Hellman group to determine the strength of the encryption-key-determination algorithm. The
ASA uses this algorithm to derive the encryption and hash keys.
• For IKEv2, a separate pseudo-random function (PRF) used as the algorithm to derive keying material
and hashing operations required for the IKEv2 tunnel encryption.
• A limit to the time the ASA uses an encryption key before replacing it.

With IKEv1 policies, for each parameter, you set one value. For IKEv2, you can configure multiple encryption
and authentication types, and multiple integrity algorithms for a single policy. The ASA orders the settings
from the most secure to the least secure and negotiates with the peer using that order. This allows you to
potentially send a single proposal to convey all the allowed transforms instead of the need to send each allowed
combination as with IKEv1.
The following sections provide procedures for creating IKEv1 and IKEv2 policies and enabling them on an
interface:
• Configure ISAKMP Policies for IKEv1 Connections, on page 196
• Configure ISAKMP Policies for IKEv2 Connections, on page 198

Configure ISAKMP Policies for IKEv1 Connections


To configure ISAKMP policies for IKEv1 connections, use the crypto ikev1 policy priority command to
enter IKEv1 policy configuration mode where you can configure the IKEv1 parameters.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
196
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure ISAKMP Policies for IKEv1 Connections

Procedure

Step 1 Enter IPsec IKEv1 policy configuration mode. For example:

hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 policy 1


hostname(config-ikev1-policy)#

Step 2 Set the authentication method. The following example configures a preshared key:

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# authentication pre-share


hostname(config-ikev1-policy)#

Step 3 Set the encryption method. The following example configures 3DES:

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# encryption 3des


hostname(config-ikev1-policy)#

Step 4 Set the HMAC method. The following example configures SHA-1:

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# hash sha


hostname(config-ikev1-policy)#

Step 5 Set the Diffie-Hellman group. The following example configures Group 2:

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# group 2
hostname(config-ikev1-policy)#

Step 6 Set the encryption key lifetime. The following example configures 43,200 seconds (12 hours):

hostname(config-ikev1-policy)# lifetime 43200


hostname(config-ikev1-policy)#

Step 7 Enable IKEv1 on the interface named outside in either single or multiple context mode:

hostname(config)# crypto ikev1 enable outside


hostname(config)#

Step 8 To save your changes, enter the write memory command:

hostname(config)# write memory


hostname(config)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
197
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure ISAKMP Policies for IKEv2 Connections

Configure ISAKMP Policies for IKEv2 Connections


To configure ISAKMP policies for IKEv2 connections, use the crypto ikev2 policy priority command to
enter IKEv2 policy configuration mode where you can configure the IKEv2 parameters.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter IPsec IKEv2 policy configuration mode. For example:


hostname(config)# crypto ikev2 policy 1
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)#

Step 2 Set the encryption method. The following example configures 3DES:
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# encryption 3des
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)#

Step 3 Set the Diffie-Hellman group. The following example configures Group 2:
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# group 2
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)#

Step 4 Set the pseudo-random function (PRF) used as the algorithm to derive keying material and hashing operations
required for the IKEv2 tunnel encryption. The following example configures SHA-1 (an HMAC variant):
hostname(config-ikev12-policy)# prf sha
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)#

Step 5 Set the encryption key lifetime. The following example configures 43,200 seconds (12 hours):
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)# lifetime seconds 43200
hostname(config-ikev2-policy)#

Step 6 Enable IKEv2 on the interface named outside:


hostname(config)# crypto ikev2 enable outside
hostname(config)#

Step 7 To save your changes, enter the write memory command:


hostname(config)# write memory
hostname(config)#

Create an IKEv1 Transform Set


An IKEv1 transform set combines an encryption method and an authentication method. During the IPsec
security association negotiation with ISAKMP, the peers agree to use a particular transform set to protect a
particular data flow. The transform set must be the same for both peers.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
198
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create an IKEv2 Proposal

A transform set protects the data flows for the ACL specified in the associated crypto map entry. You can
create transform sets in the ASA configuration, and then specify a maximum of 11 of them in a crypto map
or dynamic crypto map entry.
The table below lists valid encryption and authentication methods.

Table 8: Valid Encryption and Authentication Methods

Valid Encryption Methods Valid Authentication Methods

esp-des esp-md5-hmac

esp-3des (default) esp-sha-hmac (default)

esp-aes (128-bit encryption)

esp-aes-192

esp-aes-256

esp-null

Tunnel Mode is the usual way to implement IPsec between two ASAs that are connected over an untrusted
network, such as the public Internet. Tunnel mode is the default and requires no configuration.
To configure a transform set, perform the following site-to-site tasks in either single or multiple context mode:

Procedure

Step 1 In global configuration mode enter the crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set command. The following example
configures a transform set with the name FirstSet, esp-3des encryption, and esp-md5-hmac authentication.
The syntax is as follows:
esp-sha-hmac (default)
crypto ipsec ikev1 transform-set transform-set-nameencryption-method authentication-method
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec transform-set FirstSet esp-3des esp-md5-hmac

hostname(config)#

Step 2 Save your changes.


hostname(config)# write memory
hostname(config)#

Create an IKEv2 Proposal


For IKEv2, you can configure multiple encryption and authentication types, and multiple integrity algorithms
for a single policy. The ASA orders the settings from the most secure to the least secure and negotiates with

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
199
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure an ACL

the peer using that order. This allows you to potentially send a single proposal to convey all the allowed
transforms instead of the need to send each allowed combination as with IKEv1.
The table below lists valid IKEv2 encryption and authentication methods.

Table 9: Valid IKEv2 Encryption and Integrity Methods

Valid Encryption Methods Valid Integrity Methods

des sha (default)

3des (default) md5

aes .

aes-192

aes-256

To configure an IKEv2 proposal, perform the following tasks in either single or multiple context mode:

Procedure

Step 1 In global configuration mode, use the crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal command to enter ipsec proposal
configuration mode where you can specify multiple encryption and integrity types for the proposal. In this
example, secure is the name of the proposal:
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec ikev2 ipsec-proposal secure
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)#

Step 2 Then enter a protocol and encryption types. ESP is the only supported protocol. For example:
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)#
protocol esp encryption 3des aes des
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)#

Step 3 Enter an integrity type. For example:


hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)# protocol esp integrity sha-1
hostname(config-ipsec-proposal)#

Step 4 Save your changes.

Configure an ACL
The ASA uses access control lists to control network access. By default, the adaptive security appliance denies
all traffic. You need to configure an ACL that permits traffic. For more information, see "Information About
Access Control Lists" in the general operations configuration guide.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
200
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Define a Tunnel Group

The ACLs that you configure for this LAN-to-LAN VPN control connections are based on the source and
translated destination IP addresses. Configure ACLs that mirror each other on both sides of the connection.
An ACL for VPN traffic uses the translated address.

Note For more information on configuring an ACL with a VPN filter, see the Specify a VLAN for Remote Access
or Apply a Unified Access Control Rule to the Group Policy, on page 125.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter the access-list extended command. The following example configures an ACL named l2l_list that lets
traffic from IP addresses in the 192.168.0.0 network travel to the 150.150.0.0 network. The syntax is access-list
listname extended permit ip source-ipaddress source-netmask destination-ipaddress destination-netmask.

hostname(config)# access-list l2l_list extended permit ip 192.168.0.0 255.255.0.0 150.150.0.0


255.255.0.0
hostname(config)#

Step 2 Configure an ACL for the ASA on the other side of the connection that mirrors the ACL. Subnets that are
defined in two different crypto ACLs and are attached to the same crypto map should not overlap. In the
following example, the prompt for the peer is hostname2.

hostname2(config)# access-list l2l_list extended permit ip 150.150.0.0 255.255.0.0 192.168.0.0


255.255.0.0
hostname(config)#

Define a Tunnel Group


A tunnel group is a set of records that contain tunnel connection policies. You configure a tunnel group to
identify AAA servers, specify connection parameters, and define a default group policy. The ASA stores
tunnel groups internally.
There are two default tunnel groups in the ASA: DefaultRAGroup, which is the default IPsec remote-access
tunnel group, and DefaultL2Lgroup, which is the default IPsec LAN-to-LAN tunnel group. You can modify
them, but not delete them.
The main difference between IKE versions 1 and 2 lies in terms of the authentication method they allow.
IKEv1 allows only one type of authentication at both VPN ends (that is, either preshared key or certificate).
However, IKEv2 allows asymmetric authentication methods to be configured (that is, preshared key
authentication for the originator but certificate authentication for the responder) using separate local and
remote authentication CLIs. Therefore, with IKEv2 you have asymmetric authentication, in which one side
authenticates with one credential and the other side uses another credential (either a preshared key or certificate).
You can also create one or more new tunnel groups to suit your environment. The ASA uses these groups to
configure default tunnel parameters for remote access and LAN-to-LAN tunnel groups when there is no
specific tunnel group identified during tunnel negotiation.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
201
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create a Crypto Map and Applying It To an Interface

To establish a basic LAN-to-LAN connection, you must set two attributes for a tunnel group:
• Set the connection type to IPsec LAN-to-LAN.
• Configure an authentication method for the IP address (that is, a preshared key for IKEv1 and IKEv2).

Procedure

Step 1 To set the connection type to IPsec LAN-to-LAN, enter the tunnel-group command.
The syntax is tunnel-group name type type, where name is the name you assign to the tunnel group, and type
is the type of tunnel. The tunnel types as you enter them in the CLI are:
• remote-access (IPsec, SSL, and clientless SSL remote access)
• ipsec-l2l (IPsec LAN-to-LAN)

In the following example, the name of the tunnel group is the IP address of the LAN-to-LAN peer, 10.10.4.108.

hostname(config)# tunnel-group 10.10.4.108 type ipsec-l2l


hostname(config)#

Note LAN-to-LAN tunnel groups that have names that are not IP addresses can be used only if the tunnel
authentication method is Digital Certificates and/or the peer is configured to use Aggressive Mode.
1.

Step 2 To set the authentication method to use a preshared key, enter the ipsec-attributes mode and then enter the
ikev1pre-shared-key command to create the preshared key. You need to use the same preshared key on both
ASAs for this LAN-to-LAN connection.
The key is an alphanumeric string of 1-128 characters.
In the following example, the IKEv1 preshared key is 44kkaol59636jnfx:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group 10.10.4.108 ipsec-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-ipsec)# ikev1-pre-shared-key 44kkaol59636jnfx

Step 3 Save your changes.

hostname(config)# write memory


hostname(config)#

To verify that the tunnel is up and running, use the show vpn-sessiondb summary, show vpn-sessiondb
detail l2l, or show crypto ipsec sa command.

Create a Crypto Map and Applying It To an Interface


Crypto map entries pull together the various elements of IPsec security associations, including the following:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
202
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create a Crypto Map and Applying It To an Interface

• Which traffic IPsec should protect, which you define in an ACL.


• Where to send IPsec-protected traffic, by identifying the peer.
• What IPsec security applies to this traffic, which a transform set specifies.
• The local address for IPsec traffic, which you identify by applying the crypto map to an interface.

For IPsec to succeed, both peers must have crypto map entries with compatible configurations. For two crypto
map entries to be compatible, they must, at a minimum, meet the following criteria:
• The crypto map entries must contain compatible crypto ACLs (for example, mirror image ACLs). If the
responding peer uses dynamic crypto maps, the entries in the ASA crypto ACL must be “permitted” by
the peer’s crypto ACL.
• The crypto map entries each must identify the other peer (unless the responding peer is using a dynamic
crypto map).
• The crypto map entries must have at least one transform set in common.

If you create more than one crypto map entry for a given interface, use the sequence number (seq-num) of
each entry to rank it: the lower the seq-num, the higher the priority. At the interface that has the crypto map
set, the ASA evaluates traffic against the entries of higher priority maps first.
Create multiple crypto map entries for a given interface if either of the following conditions exist:
• Different peers handle different data flows.
• You want to apply different IPsec security to different types of traffic (to the same or separate peers),
for example, if you want traffic between one set of subnets to be authenticated, and traffic between
another set of subnets to be both authenticated and encrypted. In this case, define the different types of
traffic in two separate ACLs, and create a separate crypto map entry for each crypto ACL.

Note

To create a crypto map and apply it to the outside interface in global configuration mode, perform the following
steps in either single or multiple context mode:

Procedure

Step 1 To assign an ACL to a crypto map entry, enter the crypto map match address command.
The syntax is crypto map map-name seq-num match address aclname. In the following example the map
name is abcmap, the sequence number is 1, and the ACL name is l2l_list.
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 match address l2l_list
hostname(config)#

Step 2 To identify the peer (s) for the IPsec connection, enter the crypto map set peer command.
The syntax is crypto map map-name seq-num set peer {ip_address1 | hostname1}[... ip_address10 |
hostname10]. In the following example the peer name is 10.10.4.108.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
203
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces

hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 set peer 10.10.4.108


hostname(config)#

Step 3 To specify an IKEv1 transform set for a crypto map entry, enter the crypto map ikev1 set transform-set
command.
The syntax is crypto map map-name seq-num ikev1 set transform-set transform-set-name. In the following
example, the transform set name is FirstSet.
hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 set transform-set FirstSet
hostname(config)#

Step 4 To specify an IKEv2 proposal for a crypto map entry, enter the crypto map ikev2 set ipsec-proposal command:
The syntax is crypto map map-name seq-num set ikev2 ipsec-proposal proposal-name. In the following
example, the proposal name is secure.
With the crypto map command, you can specify multiple IPsec proposals for a single map index. In that case,
multiple proposals are transmitted to the IKEv2 peer as part of the negotiation, and the order of the proposals
is determined by the administrator upon the ordering of the crypto map entry.
Note If combined mode (AES-GCM/GMAC) and normal mode (all others) algorithms exist in the IPsec
proposal, then you cannot send a single proposal to the peer. You must have at least two proposals
in this case, one for combined mode and one for normal mode algorithms.

hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap 1 set ikev2 ipsec-proposal secure


hostname(config)#

Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces


You must apply a crypto map set to each interface through which IPsec traffic travels. The ASA supports
IPsec on all interfaces. Applying the crypto map set to an interface instructs the ASA to evaluate all interface
traffic against the crypto map set and to use the specified policy during connection or security association
negotiations.
Binding a crypto map to an interface also initializes the runtime data structures, such as the security association
database and the security policy database. When you later modify a crypto map in any way, the ASA
automatically applies the changes to the running configuration. It drops any existing connections and
reestablishes them after applying the new crypto map.
To apply the configured crypto map to the outside interface, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Step 1 Enter the crypto map interface command. The syntax is crypto map map-name interface interface-name.

hostname(config)# crypto map abcmap interface outside


hostname(config)#

Step 2 Save your changes.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
204
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces

hostname(config)# write memory


hostname(config)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
205
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Apply Crypto Maps to Interfaces

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
206
CHAPTER 8
AnyConnect VPN Client Connections
This section describes how to configure AnyConnect VPN Client Connections.
• About the AnyConnect VPN Client, on page 207
• Licensing Requirements for AnyConnect, on page 208
• Configure AnyConnect Connections, on page 208
• Monitor AnyConnect Connections, on page 226
• Log Off AnyConnect VPN Sessions, on page 227
• Feature History for AnyConnect Connections, on page 228

About the AnyConnect VPN Client


The Cisco AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client provides secure SSL and IPsec/IKEv2 connections to the ASA
for remote users. Without a previously-installed client, remote users enter the IP address in their browser of
an interface configured to accept SSL or IPsec/IKEv2 VPN connections. Unless the ASA is configured to
redirect http:// requests to https://, users must enter the URL in the form https://<address>.
After entering the URL, the browser connects to that interface and displays the login screen. If the user satisfies
the login and authentication, and the ASA identifies the user as requiring the client, it downloads the client
that matches the operating system of the remote computer. After downloading, the client installs and configures
itself, establishes a secure SSL or IPsec/IKEv2 connection and either remains or uninstalls itself (depending
on the configuration) when the connection terminates.
In the case of a previously installed client, when the user authenticates, the ASA examines the revision of the
client, and upgrades the client as necessary.
When the client negotiates an SSL VPN connection with the ASA, it connects using Transport Layer Security
(TLS), and optionally, Datagram Transport Layer Security (DTLS). DTLS avoids latency and bandwidth
problems associated with some SSL connections and improves the performance of real-time applications that
are sensitive to packet delays.
The AnyConnect client can be downloaded from the ASA, or it can be installed manually on the remote PC
by the system administrator. For more information about installing the client manually, see the appropriate
release of the Cisco AnyConnect Secure Mobility Configuration Guide .
The ASA downloads the client based on the group policy or username attributes of the user establishing the
connection. You can configure the ASA to automatically download the client, or you can configure it to
prompt the remote user about whether to download the client. In the latter case, if the user does not respond,
you can configure the ASA to either download the client after a timeout period or present the login page.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
207
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Licensing Requirements for AnyConnect

Requirements for AnyConnect


For the requirements of endpoint computers running the AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client, see the appropriate
release of the Cisco AnyConnect Secure Mobility Release Notes.

Guidelines and Limitations for AnyConnect


• The ASA does not verify remote HTTPS certificates.
• Supported in single or multiple context mode. AnyConnect Apex license is required for remote-access
VPN in multi-context mode. Although ASA does not specifically recognize an AnyConnect Apex license,
it enforces licenses characteristics of an Apex license such as AnyConnect Premium licensed to the
platform limit, AnyConnect for mobile, AnyConnect for Cisco VPN phone, and advanced endpoint
assessment. Shared licensing, AnyConnect Essentials, failover license aggregation, and flex/time-based
licenses are not supported.

Licensing Requirements for AnyConnect

Note This feature is not available on No Payload Encryption models.

VPN Licenses require an AnyConnect Plus or Apex license, available separately. See Cisco ASA Series
Feature Licenses for maximum values per model.
If you start a clientless SSL VPN session and then start an AnyConnect client session from the portal, 1 session
is used in total. However, if you start the AnyConnect client first (from a standalone client, for example) and
then log into the clientless SSL VPN portal, then 2 sessions are used.

Configure AnyConnect Connections


This section describes prerequisites, restrictions, and detailed tasks to configure the ASA to accept AnyConnect
VPN client connections.

Configure the ASA to Web-Deploy the Client


The section describes the steps to configure the ASA to web-deploy the AnyConnect client.

Before you begin


Copy the client image package to the ASA using TFTP or another method.

Procedure

Step 1 Identify a file on flash as an AnyConnect client package file.


The ASA expands the file in cache memory for downloading to remote PCs. If you have multiple clients,
assign an order to the client images with the order argument.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
208
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure the ASA to Web-Deploy the Client

The ASA downloads portions of each client in the order you specify until it matches the operating system of
the remote PC. Therefore, assign the lowest number to the image used by the most commonly-encountered
operating system.
anyconnect image filename order
Example:

hostname(config-webvpn)# anyconnect image


anyconnect-win-2.3.0254-k9.pkg 1
hostname(config-webvpn)# anyconnect image
anyconnect-macosx-i386-2.3.0254-k9.pkg 2
hostname(config-webvpn)# anyconnect image
anyconnect-linux-2.3.0254-k9.pkg 3

Note You must issue the anyconnect enable command after configuring the AnyConnect images with
the anyconnect image command. If you do not enable AnyConnect, it will not operate as expected,
and show webvpn anyconnect considers the SSL VPN client as not enabled rather than listing the
installed AnyConnect packages.

Step 2 Enable SSL on an interface for clientless or AnyConnect SSL connections.


enable interface
Example:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside

Step 3 Without issuing this command, AnyConnect does not function as expected, and a show webvpn anyconnect
command returns that the “SSL VPN is not enabled,” instead of listing the installed AnyConnect packages.
anyconnect enable

Step 4 (Optional) Create an address pool. You can use another method of address assignment, such as DHCP and/or
user-assigned addressing.
ip local pool poolname startaddr-endaddr mask mask
Example:
hostname(config)# ip local pool vpn_users 209.165.200.225-209.165.200.254
mask 255.255.255.224

Step 5 Assign an address pool to a tunnel group.


address-pool poolname
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group telecommuters general-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# address-pool vpn_users

Step 6 Assign a default group policy to the tunnel group.


default-group-policy name
hostname(config-tunnel-general)# default-group-policy sales

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
209
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable Permanent Client Installation

Step 7 Enable the display of the tunnel-group list on the clientless portal and AnyConnect GUI login page. The list
of aliases is defined by the group-alias name enable command.
group-alias name enable
Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group telecommuters webvpn-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias sales_department enable

Step 8 Specify the AnyConnect clients as a permitted VPN tunneling protocol for the group or user.
tunnel-group-list enable
Example:
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# tunnel-group-list enable

Step 9 Specify SSL as a permitted VPN tunneling protocol for the group or user. You can also specify additional
protocols. For more information, see the vpn-tunnel-protocol command in the command reference.
vpn-tunnel-protocol
Example:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# vpn-tunnel-protocol

What to do next
For more information about assigning users to group policies, see Chapter 6, Configuring Connection Profiles,
Group Policies, and Users.

Enable Permanent Client Installation


Enabling permanent client installation disables the automatic uninstalling feature of the client. The client
remains installed on the remote computer for subsequent connections, reducing the connection time for the
remote user.
To enable permanent client installation for a specific group or user, use the anyconnect keep-installer command
from group-policy or username webvpn modes.
The default is that permanent installation of the client is enabled. The client remains on the remote computer
at the end of the session. The following example configures the existing group-policy sales to remove the
client on the remote computer at the end of the session:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-policy)# anyconnect keep-installer installed none

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
210
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure DTLS

Configure DTLS
Datagram Transport Layer Security (DTLS) allows the AnyConnect client establishing an SSL VPN connection
to use two simultaneous tunnels—an SSL tunnel and a DTLS tunnel. Using DTLS avoids latency and bandwidth
problems associated with SSL connections and improves the performance of real-time applications that are
sensitive to packet delays.

Before you begin


See, Configure Advanced SSL Settings, on page 68 to configure DTLS on this headend, and which version
of DTLS is used.
In order for DTLS to fall back to a TLS connection, Dead Peer Detection (DPD) must be enabled. If you do
not enable DPD, and the DTLS connection experiences a problem, the connection terminates instead of falling
back to TLS. For more information on DPD, see Configure Dead Peer Detection, on page 222.

Procedure

Step 1 Specify DTLS options for AnyConnect VPN connections:


a) Enable SSL and DTLS on the interface in webvpn mode.
By default, DTLS is enabled when SSL VPN access is enabled on an interface.
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside

Disable DTLS for all AnyConnect client users with the enable interface tls-only command in webvpn
configuration mode.
If you disable DTLS, SSL VPN connections connect with an SSL VPN tunnel only.
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside tls-only

b) Configure the ports for SSL and DTLS using the port and dtls port commands.
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside
hostname(config-webvpn)# port 555
hostname(config-webvpn)# dtls port 556

Step 2 Specify DTLS options for specific group policies.


a) Enable DTLS for specific groups or users with the anyconnect ssl dtls command in group policy webvpn
or username webvpn configuration mode.
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect ssl dtls enable

b) If desired, enable DTLS compression using the anyconnect dtls compression command.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
211
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Prompt Remote Users

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect dtls compression lzs

Prompt Remote Users


Procedure

You can enable the ASA to prompt remote SSL VPN client users to download the client with the anyconnect
ask command from group policy webvpn or username webvpn configuration modes:
[no] anyconnect ask {none | enable [default {webvpn | } timeout value]}
• anyconnect enable prompts the remote user to download the client or go to the clientless portal page
and waits indefinitely for user response.
• anyconnect ask enable default immediately downloads the client.
• anyconnect ask enable default webvpn immediately goes to the portal page.
• anyconnect ask enable default timeout value prompts the remote user to download the client or go to
the clientless portal page and waits the duration of value before taking the default action—downloading
the client.
• anyconnect ask enable default clientless timeout value prompts the remote user to download the client
or go to the clientless portal page, and waits the duration of value before taking the default
action—displaying the clientless portal page.

The figure below shows the prompt displayed to remote users when either default anyconnect timeout value
or default webvpn timeout value is configured:
Figure 5: Prompt Displayed to Remote Users for SSL VPN Client Download

Example
The following example configures the ASA to prompt the user to download the client or go to the
clientless portal page and wait 10 seconds for a response before downloading the client:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect ask enable default anyconnect timeout
10

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
212
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable AnyConnect Client Profile Downloads

Enable AnyConnect Client Profile Downloads


You enable Cisco AnyConnect Secure Mobility client features in the AnyConnect profiles—XML files that
contain configuration settings for the core client with its VPN functionality and for the optional client modules.
The ASA deploys the profiles during AnyConnect installation and updates. Users cannot manage or modify
profiles.
You can configure a profile using the AnyConnect profile editor, a convenient GUI-based configuration tool
launched from ASDM or ISE. The AnyConnect software package for Windows includes the editor, which
activates when you load the AnyConnect package on the chosen headend device and specify it as an AnyConnect
client image.
We also provide a standalone version of the profile editor for Windows that you can use as an alternative to
the profile editor integrated with ASDM or ISE. If you are predeploying the client, you can use the standalone
profile editor to create profiles for the VPN service and other modules that you deploy to computers using
your software management system.
For more information on the AnyConnect client and its Profile Editor, see the appropriate release of the Cisco
AnyConnect Secure Mobility Configuration Guide .

Note The AnyConnect client protocol defaults to SSL. To enable IPsec IKEv2, you must configure the IKEv2
settings on the ASA and also configure IKEv2 as the primary protocol in the client profile. The IKEv2enabled
profile must be deployed to the endpoint computer; otherwise the client attempts to connect using SSL.

Procedure

Step 1 Use the profile editor from ASDM/ISE or the standalone profile editor to create a profile.
Step 2 Load the profile file into flash memory on the ASA using tftp or another method.
Step 3 Use the anyconnect profiles command from webvpn configuration mode to identify the file as a client profile
to load into cache memory.
Example:
The following example specifies the files sales_hosts.xml and engineering_hosts.xml as profiles:

asa1(config-webvpn)# anyconnect profiles sales


disk0:/sales_hosts.xml
asa1(config-webvpn)# anyconnect profiles engineering
disk0:/engineering_hosts.xml

The profiles are now available to group policies.


View the profiles loaded in cache memory using the dir cache:stc/profiles command:

hostname(config-webvpn)# dir cache:/stc/profiles

Directory of cache:stc/profiles/

0 ---- 774 11:54:41 Nov 22 2006 engineering.xml


0 ---- 774 11:54:29 Nov 22 2006 sales.xml

2428928 bytes total (18219008 bytes free)

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
213
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable AnyConnect Client Deferred Upgrade

hostname(config-webvpn)#

Step 4 Enter group policy webvpn configuration mode and specify a client profile for a group policy with the
anyconnect profiles command:
Example:
You can enter the anyconnect profiles value command followed by a question mark (?) to view the available
profiles. For example:

asa1(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect profiles value ?

config-group-webvpn mode commands/options:


Available configured profile packages: engineering sales

The next example configures the group policy to use the profile sales with the client profile type vpn:

asa1(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect profiles value sales type vpn


asa1(config-group-webvpn)#

Enable AnyConnect Client Deferred Upgrade


Deferred Upgrade allows the AnyConnect user to delay download of a client upgrade. When a client update
is available, AnyConnect opens a dialog asking the user if they would like to update, or to defer the upgrade.
This upgrade dialog will not appear unless you have AutoUpdate set to Enabled in the AnyConnect profile
setting.
Deferred Upgrade is enabled by adding custom attribute types and named values to the ASA; then referencing
and configuring those attributes in a group policy.
The following custom attributes support Deferred Upgrade:

Table 10: Custom Attributes for Deferred Upgrade

Custom Attribute Type Valid Values Default Value Notes

DeferredUpdateAllowed true false false True enables deferred update. If deferred update is
disabled (false), the settings below are ignored.

DeferredUpdateMinimumVersion x.y.z 0.0.0 Minimum version of AnyConnect that must be


installed for updates to be deferrable.
The minimum version check applies to all modules
enabled on the headend. If any enabled module
(including VPN) is not installed or does not meet
the minimum version, then the connection is not
eligible for deferred update.
If this attribute is not specified, then a deferral
prompt is displayed (or auto-dismissed) regardless
of the version installed on the endpoint.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
214
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable AnyConnect Client Deferred Upgrade

Custom Attribute Type Valid Values Default Value Notes

DeferredUpdateDismissTimeout 0-300 (seconds) none (disabled) Number of seconds that the deferred upgrade prompt
is displayed before being dismissed automatically.
This attribute only applies when a deferred update
prompt is to be displayed (the minimum version
attribute is evaluated first).
If this attribute is missing, then the auto-dismiss
feature is disabled, and a dialog is displayed (if
required) until the user responds.
Setting this attribute to zero allows automatic
deferral or upgrade to be forced based on:
• The installed version and the value of
DeferredUpdateMinimumVersion.
• The value of DeferredUpdateDismissResponse.

DeferredUpdateDismissResponse defer update update Action to take when DeferredUpdateDismissTimeout


occurs.

Procedure

Step 1 Create the custom attribute types with the anyconnnect-custom-attr command in webvpn configuration
mode:
[no] anyconnect-custom-attr attr-type [description description ]
Example:
The following example shows how to add the custom attribute types DeferredUpdateAllowed and
DeferredUpdateDismissTimeout:

hostame(config-webvpn)# anyconnect-custom-attr DeferredUpdateAllowed


description Indicates if the deferred update feature is enabled or not
hostame(config-webvpn)# anyconnect-custom-attr DeferredUpdateDismissTimeout

Step 2 Add named values for custom attributes with the anyconnect-custom-data command in global configuration
mode. For attributes with long values, you can provide a duplicate entry, and it allows concatenation. However,
with a duplicate configuration entry, the Defer Update dialog will not appear, and a user cannot defer the
upgrade; instead, the upgrade happens automatically.
[no] anyconnect-custom-data attr-type attr-name attr-value
Example:
The following example shows how to add a named value for the custom attribute type
DeferredUpdateDismissTimeout and for enabling DeferredUpdateAllowed:

hostname(config)# anyconnect-custom-data DeferredUpdateDismissTimeout


def-timeout 150
hostname(config)# anyconnect-custom-data DeferredUpdateAllowed

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
215
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable DSCP Preservation

def-allowed true

Step 3 Add or remove the custom attribute named values to a group policy using the anyconnect-custom command:
• anyconnect-custom attr-type value attr-name
• anyconnect-custom attr-type none
• no anyconnect-custom attr-type

Example:
The following example shows how to enable Deferred Update for the group policy named sales and set the
timeout to 150 seconds:

hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# anyconnect-custom DeferredUpdateAllowed
value def-allowed
hostname(config-group-policy)# anyconnect-custom DeferredUpdateDismissTimeout
value def-timeout

Enable DSCP Preservation


By setting another custom attribute, you can control Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) on Windows
or OS X platforms for DTLS connections only. Enabling DSCP preservation allows devices to prioritize
latency sensitive traffic; the router takes into account whether this is set and marks prioritized traffic to improve
outbound connection quality.

Procedure

Step 1 Create the custom attribute types with the anyconnect-custom-attrcommand in webvpn configuration mode:
[no] anyconnect-custom-attr DSCPPreservationAllowed description Set to control Differentiated Services
Code Point (DSCP) on Windows or OS X platforms for DTLS connections only.

Step 2 Add named values for custom attributes with the anyconnect-custom-data command in global configuration
mode:
[no] anyconnect-custom-data DSCPPreservationAllowed true
Note By default, AnyConnect performs DSCP preservation (true). To disable it, set the custom attributes
to false on the headend and reinitiate the connection.

Enable Additional AnyConnect Client Features


To minimize download time, the client only requests downloads (from the ASA or ISE) of the core modules
that it needs. As additional features become available for the AnyConnect client, you need to update the remote
clients in order for them to use the features.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
216
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable Start Before Logon

To enable new features, you must specify the new module names using the anyconnect modules command
from group policy webvpn or username webvpn configuration mode:
[no]anyconnect modules {none | value string}
Separate multiple strings with commas.

Enable Start Before Logon


Start Before Logon (SBL) allows login scripts, password caching, drive mapping, and more, for the AnyConnect
client installed on a Windows PC. For SBL, you must enable the ASA to download the module which enables
graphical identification and authentication (GINA) for the AnyConnect client. The following procedure shows
how to enable SBL:

Procedure

Step 1 Enable the ASA to download the GINA module for VPN connection to specific groups or users using the
anyconnect modules vpngina command from group policy webvpn or username webvpn configuration modes.
Example:
In the following example, the user enters group-policy attributes mode for the group policy telecommuters,
enters webvpn configuration mode for the group policy, and specifies the string vpngina:
hostname(config)# group-policy telecommuters attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostame(config-group-webvpn)#anyconnect modules value vpngina

Step 2 Retrieve a copy of the client profiles file (AnyConnectProfile.tmpl).


Step 3 Edit the profiles file to specify that SBL is enabled. The example below shows the relevant portion of the
profiles file (AnyConnectProfile.tmpl) for Windows:
<Configuration>
<ClientInitialization>
<UseStartBeforeLogon>false</UseStartBeforeLogon>
</ClientInitialization>

The <UseStartBeforeLogon> tag determines whether the client uses SBL. To turn SBL on, replace false with
true. The example below shows the tag with SBL turned on:
<ClientInitialization>
<UseStartBeforeLogon>true</UseStartBeforeLogon>
</ClientInitialization>

Step 4 Save the changes to AnyConnectProfile.tmpl and update the profile file for the group or user on the ASA
using the profile command from webvpn configuration mode. For example:
asa1(config-webvpn)#anyconnect profiles sales disk0:/sales_hosts.xml

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
217
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Translating Languages for AnyConnect User Messages

Translating Languages for AnyConnect User Messages


The ASA provides language translation for the portal and screens displayed to users that initiate browser-based,
Clientless SSL VPN connections, as well as the interface displayed to Cisco AnyConnect VPN Client users.
This section describes how to configure the ASA to translate these user messages.

Understand Language Translation


Functional areas and their messages that are visible to remote users are organized into translation domains.
All messages displayed on the user interface of the Cisco AnyConnect VPN Client are located in the
AnyConnect domain.
The software image package for the ASA includes a translation table template for the AnyConnect domain.
You can export the template, which creates an XML file of the template at the URL you provide. The message
fields in this file are empty. You can edit the messages and import the template to create a new translation
table object that resides in flash memory.
You can also export an existing translation table. The XML file created displays the messages you edited
previously. Reimporting this XML file with the same language name creates an new version of the translation
table object, overwriting previous messages. Changes to the translation table for the AnyConnect domain are
immediately visible to AnyConnect client users.

Create Translation Tables


The following procedure describes how to create translation tables for the AnyConnect domain:

Procedure

Step 1 Export a translation table template to a computer with the export webvpn translation-table command from
privileged EXEC mode.
In the following example, the show import webvpn translation-table command shows available translation
table templates and tables.

hostname# show import webvpn translation-table


Translation Tables' Templates:
customization
AnyConnect

PortForwarder
url-list
webvpn
Citrix-plugin
RPC-plugin
Telnet-SSH-plugin
VNC-plugin

Translation Tables:

Then the user exports the translation table for the AnyConnect translation domain. The filename of the XML
file created is named client and contains empty message fields:

hostname# export webvpn translation-table AnyConnect

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
218
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Create Translation Tables

template tftp://209.165.200.225/client

In the next example, the user exports a translation table named zh, which was previously imported from a
template. zh is the abbreviation by Microsoft Internet Explorer for the Chinese language.

hostname# export webvpn translation-table customization


language zh tftp://209.165.200.225/chinese_client

Step 2 Edit the Translation Table XML file. The following example shows a portion of the AnyConnect template.
The end of this output includes a message ID field (msgid) and a message string field (msgstr) for the message
Connected, which is displayed on the AnyConnect client GUI when the client establishes a VPN connection.
The complete template contains many pairs of message fields:

# SOME DESCRIPTIVE TITLE.


# Copyright (C) YEAR THE PACKAGE'S COPYRIGHT HOLDER
# This file is distributed under the same license as the PACKAGE package.
# FIRST AUTHOR <EMAIL@ADDRESS>, YEAR.
#
#, fuzzy
msgid ""
msgstr ""
"Project-Id-Version: PACKAGE VERSION\n"
"Report-Msgid-Bugs-To: \n"
"POT-Creation-Date: 2006-11-01 16:39-0700\n"
"PO-Revision-Date: YEAR-MO-DA HO:MI+ZONE\n"
"Last-Translator: FULL NAME <EMAIL@ADDRESS>\n"
"Language-Team: LANGUAGE <[email protected]>\n"
"MIME-Version: 1.0\n"
"Content-Type: text/plain; charset=CHARSET\n"
"Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit\n"

#: C:\cygwin\home\<user>\cvc\main\Api\AgentIfc.cpp:23
#: C:\cygwin\home\<user>\cvc\main\Api\check\AgentIfc.cpp:22
#: C:\cygwin\home\<user>\cvc\main\Api\save\AgentIfc.cpp:23
#: C:\cygwin\home\<user>\cvc\main\Api\save\AgentIfc.cpp~:20
#: C:\cygwin\home\<user>\cvc\main\Api\save\older\AgentIfc.cpp:22
msgid "Connected"
msgstr ""

The msgid contains the default translation. The msgstr that follows msgid provides the translation. To create
a translation, enter the translated text between the quotes of the msgstr string. For example, to translate the
message “Connected” with a Spanish translation, insert the Spanish text between the quotes:

msgid "Connected"
msgstr "Conectado"

Be sure to save the file.

Step 3 Import the translation table using the import webvpn translation-table command from privileged EXEC
mode. Be sure to specify the name of the new translation table with the abbreviation for the language that is
compatible with the browser.
In the following example, the XML file is imported es-us—the abbreviation used by Microsoft Internet
Explorer for Spanish spoken in the United States.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
219
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Remove Translation Tables

hostname# import webvpn translation-table AnyConnect


language es-us tftp://209.165.200.225/client
hostname# !!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
hostname# show import webvpn translation-table
Translation Tables' Templates:
AnyConnect
PortForwarder

customization
keepout
url-list
webvpn
Citrix-plugin
RPC-plugin
Telnet-SSH-plugin
VNC-plugin

Translation Tables:
es-us AnyConnect

Remove Translation Tables


If you no longer need a translation table, you can remove it.

Procedure

Step 1 List the existing translation tables.


In the following example, the show import webvpn translation-table command shows available translation
table templates and tables. Various tables are available for French (fr), Japanese (ja), and Russian (ru).

hostname# show import webvpn translation-table


Translation Tables' Templates:
AnyConnect
PortForwarder
banners
csd
customization
url-list
webvpn
Translation Tables:
fr PortForwarder
fr AnyConnect
fr customization
fr webvpn
ja PortForwarder
ja AnyConnect
ja customization
ja webvpn
ru PortForwarder
ru customization
ru webvpn

Step 2 Remove the unwanted translation table.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
220
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configuring Advanced AnyConnect SSL Features

revert webvpn translation-table translationdomain language language


Where translationdomain is the domain listed on the right in the Translation Tables listing shown above, and
language is the 2-character language name.
You must remove each table individually. You cannot remove all of the tables for a given language with one
command.
For example, to remove the French translation table for AnyConnect:

ciscoasa# revert webvpn translation-table anyconnect language fr


ciscoasa#

Configuring Advanced AnyConnect SSL Features


The following section describes advanced features that fine-tune AnyConnect SSL VPN connections.

Enable Rekey
When the ASA and the AnyConnect client perform a rekey on an SSL VPN connection, they renegotiate the
crypto keys and initialization vectors, increasing the security of the connection.
To enable the client to perform a rekey on an SSL VPN connection for a specific group or user, use the
anyconnect ssl rekey command from group-policy or username webvpn modes.
[no]anyconnect ssl rekey {method {new-tunnel | none | ssl} | time minutes}
• method new-tunnel specifies that the client establishes a new tunnel during rekey.
• method ssl specifies that the client establishes a new tunnel during rekey.
• method none disables rekey.
• time minutes specifies the number of minutes from the start of the session, or from the last rekey, until
the rekey takes place, from 1 to 10080 (1 week).

Note Configuring the rekey method as ssl or new-tunnel specifies that the client establishes a new tunnel during
rekey instead of the SSL renegotiation taking place during the rekey. See the command reference for a history
of the anyconnect ssl rekey command.

In the following example, the client is configured to renegotiate with SSL during rekey, which takes place
30 minutes after the session begins, for the existing group-policy sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect ssl rekey method ssl
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect ssl rekey time 30

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
221
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Dead Peer Detection

Configure Dead Peer Detection


Dead Peer Detection (DPD) ensures that the ASA (gateway) or the client can quickly detect a condition where
the peer is not responding, and the connection has failed. To enable dead peer detection (DPD) and set the
frequency with which either the AnyConnect client or the ASA gateway performs DPD, do the following:

Before you begin


• This feature applies to connectivity between the ASA gateway and the AnyConnect SSL VPN Client
only. It does not work with IPsec since DPD is based on the standards implementation that does not allow
padding, and CLientless SSL VPN is not supported.
• If you enable DTLS, enable Dead Peer Detection (DPD) also. DPD enables a failed DTLS connection
to fallback to TLS. Otherwise, the connection terminates.
• When DPD is enabled on the ASA, you can use the Optimal MTU (OMTU) function to find the largest
endpoint MTU at which the client can successfully pass DTLS packets. Implement OMTU by sending
a padded DPD packet to the maximum MTU. If a correct echo of the payload is received from the head
end, the MTU size is accepted. Otherwise, the MTU is reduced, and the probe is sent again until the
minimum MTU allowed for the protocol is reached.

Procedure

Step 1 Go to the desired group policy.


Enter group policy or username webvpn mode:
hostname(config)# group-policy group-policy-name attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Or,
hostname# username username attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname (config-username-webvpn #

Step 2 Set Gateway Side Detection.


Use the [no] anyconnect dpd-interval {[gateway {seconds | none}] command.
The gateway refers to the ASA. You enable DPD and specify the frequency with which the ASA performs
the DPD test as a range of from 30 (default) to 3600 seconds (1 hour). A value of 300 is recommended.
Specifying none disables the DPD testing that the ASA performs. Use no anyconnect dpd-interval to remove
this command from the configuration.

Step 3 Set Client Side Detection.


Use the [no] anyconnect dpd-interval {[client {seconds | none}]} command.
The client refers to the AnyConnect client. You enable DPD and specify the frequency with which the client
performs the DPD test as a range of from 30 (default) to 3600 seconds (1 hour). A value of 300 is recommended.
Specifying client none disables DPD performed by the client. Use no anyconnect dpd-interval to remove
this command from the configuration.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
222
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable Keepalive

Example
The following example sets the frequency of DPD performed by the ASA to 30 seconds, and the
frequency of DPD performed by the client set to 10 seconds for the existing group-policy sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect dpd-interval gateway 30
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect dpd-interval client 10

Enable Keepalive
You can adjust the frequency of keepalive messages to ensure that an SSL VPN connection through a proxy,
firewall, or NAT device remains open, even if the device limits the time that the connection can be idle.
Adjusting the frequency also ensures that the client does not disconnect and reconnect when the remote user
is not actively running a socket-based application, such as Microsoft Outlook or Microsoft Internet Explorer.
Keepalives are enabled by default. If you disable keepalives, in the event of a failover, SSL VPN client sessions
are not carried over to the standby device.
To set the frequency of keepalive messages, use the keepalive command from group-policy webvpn or
username webvpn configuration mode: Use the no form of the command to remove the command from the
configuration and cause the value to be inherited:
[no] anyconnect ssl keepalive {none | seconds}
• none disables client keepalive messages.
• seconds enables the client to send keepalive messages, and specifies the frequency of the messages in
the range of 15 to 600 seconds.

In the following example, the ASA is configured to enable the client to send keepalive messages
with a frequency of 300 seconds (5 minutes), for the existing group-policy sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect ssl keepalive 300

Use Compression
Compression increases the communications performance between the ASA and the client by reducing the
size of the packets being transferred for low-bandwidth connections. By default, compression for all SSL
VPN connections is enabled on the ASA, both at the global level and for specific groups or users.

Note When implementing compression on broadband connections, you must carefully consider the fact that
compression relies on loss-less connectivity. This is the main reason that it is not enabled by default on
broadband connections.

Compression must be turned-on globally using the compression command from global configuration mode,
and then it can be set for specific groups or users with the anyconnect ssl compression command in
group-policy and username webvpn modes.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
223
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Adjust MTU Size

Changing Compression Globally


To change the global compression settings, use the anyconnect ssl compression command from global
configuration mode. To remove the command from the configuration, use the no form of the command.
In the following example, compression is disabled for all SSL VPN connections globally:
hostname(config)# no compression

Changing Compression for Groups and Users


To change compression for a specific group or user, use the anyconnect ssl compression command in the
group-policy and username webvpn modes:
[no] anyconnect ssl compression {deflate | none}
By default, for groups and users, SSL compression is set to deflate (enabled).
To remove the anyconnect ssl compression command from the configuration and cause the value to be
inherited from the global setting, use the no form of the command:
In the following example, compression is disabled for the group-policy sales:
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no anyconnect ssl compression none

Adjust MTU Size


You can adjust the MTU size (from 576 to 1406 bytes) for SSL VPN connections established by the client
with the anyconnect mtu command from group policy webvpn or username webvpn configuration mode:
[no] anyconnect mtu size
This command affects only the AnyConnect client. The legacy Cisco SSL VPN Client () is not capable of
adjusting to different MTU sizes. Also, client connections established in SSL and those established in SSL
with DTLS are impacted by this command.
The default for this command in the default group policy is no anyconnect mtu. The MTU size is adjusted
automatically based on the MTU of the interface that the connection uses, minus the IP/UDP/DTLS overhead.
You may receive an "MTU configuration sent from the secure gateway is too small" message, for example,
when running the ISE Posture AnyConnect module. If you enter anyconnect mtu 1200 along with anyconnect
ssl df-bit-ignore disable, you can avoid these system scan errors.

Example
The following example configures the MTU size to 1200 bytes for the group policy telecommuters:
hostname(config)# group-policy telecommuters attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect mtu 1200

Update AnyConnect Client Images


You can update the client images on the ASA at any time using the following procedure:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
224
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable IPv6 VPN Access

Procedure

Step 1 Copy the new client images to the ASA using the copy command from privileged EXEC mode, or using
another method.
Step 2 If the new client image files have the same filenames as the files already loaded, reenter the anyconnect image
command that is in the configuration. If the new filenames are different, uninstall the old files using the
[no]anyconnect imageimage command. Then use the anyconnect image command to assign an order to the
images and cause the ASA to load the new images.

Enable IPv6 VPN Access


If you want to configure IPv6 access, you must use the command-line interface. Release 9.0(x) of the ASA
adds support for IPv6 VPN connections to its outside interface using SSL and IKEv2/IPsec protocols.
You enable IPv6 access using the ipv6 enable command as part of enabling SSL VPN connections. The
following is an example for an IPv6 connection that enables IPv6 on the outside interface:
hostname(config)# interface GigabitEthernet0/0
hostname(config-if)# ipv6 enable

To enable IPV6 SSL VPN, do the following general actions:


1. Enable IPv6 on the outside interface.
2. Enable IPv6 and an IPv6 address on the inside interface.
3. Configure an IPv6 address local pool for client assigned IP Addresses.
4. Configure an IPv6 tunnel default gateway.

Procedure

Step 1 Configure Interfaces:

interface GigabitEthernet0/0
nameif outside
security-level 0
ip address 192.168.0.1 255.255.255.0
ipv6 enable ; Needed for IPv6.
!
interface GigabitEthernet0/1
nameif inside
security-level 100
ip address 10.10.0.1 255.255.0.0
ipv6 address 2001:DB8::1/32 ; Needed for IPv6.
ipv6 enable ; Needed for IPv6.

Step 2 Configure an 'ipv6 local pool' (used for IPv6 address assignment):
ipv6 local pool ipv6pool 2001:DB8:1:1::5/32 100 ; Use your IPv6 prefix here

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
225
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Monitor AnyConnect Connections

Note You can configure the ASA to assign an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or both an IPv4 and an IPv6
address to an AnyConnect client by creating internal pools of addresses on the ASA or by assigning
a dedicated address to a local user on the ASA.

Step 3 Add the ipv6 address pool to your tunnel group policy (or group-policy):
tunnel-group YourTunGrp1 general-attributes ipv6-address-pool ipv6pool

Note You must also configure an IPv4 address pool here as well (using the 'address-pool' command).

Step 4 Configure an IPv6 tunnel default gateway:


ipv6 route inside ::/0 X:X:X:X::X tunneled

Monitor AnyConnect Connections


To view information about active sessions, use the show vpn-sessiondb command:

Command Purpose

show vpn-sessiondb Displays information about active sessions.

vpn-sessiondb logoff Logs off VPN sessions.

show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect Enhances the VPN session summary to show OSPFv3
session information.

show vpn-sessiondb ratio encryption Shows the number of tunnels and percentages for the
Suite B algorithms (such as AES-GCM-128,
AES-GCM-192, AES-GCM-256, AES-GMAC-128,
and so on).

Example
The Inactivity field shows the elapsed time since an AnyConnect session lost connectivity. If the
session is active, 00:00m:00s appears in this field.

hostname# show vpn-sessiondb

Session Type: SSL VPN Client

Username : lee
Index : 1 IP Addr : 209.165.200.232
Protocol : SSL VPN Client Encryption : 3DES
Hashing : SHA1 Auth Mode : userPassword
TCP Dst Port : 443 TCP Src Port : 54230
Bytes Tx : 20178 Bytes Rx : 8662
Pkts Tx : 27 Pkts Rx : 19
Client Ver : Cisco STC 1.1.0.117
Client Type : Internet Explorer
Group : DfltGrpPolicy

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
226
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Log Off AnyConnect VPN Sessions

Login Time : 14:32:03 UTC Wed Mar 20 2007


Duration : 0h:00m:04s
Inactivity : 0h:00m:04s
Filter Name :

hostname# vpn-sessiondb logoff


INFO: Number of sessions of type "" logged off : 1

hostname# vpn-sessiondb logoff name tester


Do you want to logoff the VPN session(s)? [confirm]
INFO: Number of sessions with name "tester" logged off : 1

Log Off AnyConnect VPN Sessions


To log off all VPN sessions, use the vpn-sessiondb logoff command in global configuration mode:
The following example logs off all VPN sessions:
hostname# vpn-sessiondb logoff
INFO: Number of sessions of type “” logged off : 1

You can log off individual sessions using either the name argument or the index argument:
vpn-sessiondb logoff name name
vpn-sessiondb logoff index index
The sessions that have been inactive the longest time are marked as idle (and are automatically logged off)
so that license capacity is not reached and new users can log in. If the session resumes at a later time, it is
removed from the inactive list.
You can find both the username and the index number (established by the order of the client images) in the
output of the show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect command. The following examples shows the username lee
and index number 1.

hostname# show vpn-sessiondb anyconnect

Session Type: AnyConnect

Username : lee Index : 1


Assigned IP : 192.168.246.1 Public IP : 10.139.1.2
Protocol : AnyConnect-Parent SSL-Tunnel DTLS-Tunnel
License : AnyConnect Premium
Encryption : RC4 AES128 Hashing : SHA1
Bytes Tx : 11079 Bytes Rx : 4942
Group Policy : EngPolicy Tunnel Group : EngGroup
Login Time : 15:25:13 EST Fri Jan 28 2011
Duration : 0h:00m:15s
Inactivity : 0h:00m:00s
NAC Result : Unknown
VLAN Mapping : N/A VLAN : none

The following example terminates the session using the name option of the vpn-session-db logoff command:

hostname# vpn-sessiondb logoff name lee


Do you want to logoff the VPN session(s)? [confirm]
INFO: Number of sessions with name “lee” logged off : 1

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
227
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Feature History for AnyConnect Connections

hostname#

Feature History for AnyConnect Connections


The following table lists the release history for this feature.

Table 11: Feature History for AnyConnect Connections

Feature Name Releases Feature Information

AnyConnect Connections 7.2(1) The following commands were


introduced or modified:
authentication eap-proxy,
authentication ms-chap-v1,
authentication ms-chap-v2,
authentication pap, l2tp tunnel
hello, vpn-tunnel-protocol
l2tp-ipsec.

IPsec IKEv2 8.4(1) IKEv2 was added to support IPsec


IKEv2 connections for AnyConnect
and LAN-to-LAN.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
228
CHAPTER 9
AnyConnect HostScan
The AnyConnect Posture Module provides the AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client the ability to identify the
operating system, anti-virus, anti-spyware, and firewall software installed on the host. The HostScan application
gathers this information. Posture assessment requires HostScan to be installed on the host.
Using the secure desktop manager tool in the Adaptive Security Device Manager (ASDM), you can create a
prelogin policy which evaluates the operating system, anti-virus, anti-spyware, and firewall software Host
Scan identifies. Based on the result of the prelogin policy’s evaluation, you can control which hosts are allowed
to create a remote access connection to the security appliance.
The HostScan support chart contains the product name and version information for the anti-virus, anti-spyware,
and firewall applications you use in your prelogin policies. We deliver HostScan and the HostScan support
chart, as well as other components, in the HostScan package.
Starting with AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client, release 3.0, HostScan is available separately from CSD.
This means you can deploy HostScan functionality without having to install CSD and you will be able to
update your HostScan support charts by upgrading the latest HostScan package.
• Prerequisites for HostScan, on page 229
• Licensing for HostScan, on page 230
• HostScan Packaging, on page 230
• Install or Upgrade HostScan, on page 230
• Enable or Disable HostScan, on page 231
• View the HostScan Version Enabled on the ASA, on page 232
• Uninstall HostScan, on page 232
• Assign AnyConnect Feature Modules to Group Policies, on page 233
• HostScan Related Documentation, on page 234

Prerequisites for HostScan


The AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client with the posture module requires these minimum ASA components:
• ASA 8.4
• ASDM 6.4

These AnyConnect features require that you install the posture module.
• SCEP authentication

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
229
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Licensing for HostScan

• AnyConnect Telemetry Module

The posture module can be installed on any of these platforms:


• Windows 7, 8, 8.1, 10, 10 RS1, RS2, & RS3 (x86 (32-bit) and x64 (64-bit)
• macOS 10.11, 10.12, and 10.13
• Linux Red Hat 6, 7 & Ubuntu 14.04 (LTS) and 16.04 (LTS) (64-bit only)

Licensing for HostScan


These are the AnyConnect licensing requirements for the HostScan:
• AnyConnect Apex.

HostScan Packaging
You can load the HostScan package on to the ASA as a standalone package: hostscan-version.pkg. This file
contains the HostScan software as well as the HostScan library and support charts.

Install or Upgrade HostScan


Use this procedure to install or upgrade the HostScan package and enable it using the command line interface
for the ASA.

Before you begin

Note If you are attempting to upgrade to HostScan version 4.6.x or later from a 4.3.x version or earlier, you will
receive an error message due to the fact that all existing AV/AS/FW DAP policies and LUA script(s) that you
have previously established are incompatible with HostScan 4.6.x or greater.
There is a one time migration procedure that must be done to adapt your configuration. This procedure involves
leaving this dialog box to migrate your configuration to be comptaible with HostScan 4.4.x before saving this
configuration. Abort this procedure and refer to the AnyConnect HostScan 4.3.x to 4.6.x Migration Guide for
detailed instructions. Briefly, migration involves navigating to the ASDM DAP policy page to review and
manually deleting the incompatible AV/AS/FW attributes, and then reviewing and rewriting LUA scripts.

• Log on to the ASA and enter global configuration mode. In global configuration mode, the ASA displays
this prompt: hostname(config)#
• Upload the hostscan_version-k9.pkg file to the ASA.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
230
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enable or Disable HostScan

Procedure

Step 1 Enter webvpn configuration mode.


Example:

hostname(config)# webvpn

Step 2 Specify the path to the package you want to designate as the HostScan image. You can specify a standalone
HostScan package or an AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client package as the HostScan package.
hostscan image path
Example:

ASAName(webvpn)#hostscan image disk0:/ hostscan-3.6.0-k9.pkg

Step 3 Enable the HostScan image you designated in the previous step.
Example:

ASAName(webvpn)#hostscan enable

Step 4 Save the running configuration to flash. After successfully saving the new configuration to flash memory,
you receive the message [OK].
Example:

hostname(webvpn)# write memory

Step 5

Enable or Disable HostScan


These commands enable or disable an installed HostScan image using the command line interface of the ASA.

Before you begin


Log on to the ASA and enter global configuration mode. In global configuration mode, the ASA displays this
prompt: hostname(config)#

Procedure

Step 1 Enter webvpn configuration mode.


Example:
webvpn

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
231
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
View the HostScan Version Enabled on the ASA

Step 2 Enable the standalone HostScan image if it has not been uninstalled from your ASA.
hostscan enable

Step 3 Disable HostScan for all installed HostScan packages.


Note Before you uninstall the enabled HostScan image, you must first disable HostScan using this
command.

no hostscan enable

View the HostScan Version Enabled on the ASA


Use this procedure to determine the enabled HostScan version using ASA’s command line interface.

Before you begin


Log on to the ASA and enter privileged exec mode. In privileged exec mode, the ASA displays this prompt:
hostname#

Procedure

Show the version of HostScan enabled on the ASA.


show webvpn hostscan

Uninstall HostScan
Uninstalling HostScan package removes it from view on the ASDM interface and prevents the ASA from
deploying it even if HostScan is enabled. Uninstalling HostScan does not delete the HostScan package from
the flash drive.

Before you begin


Log on to the ASA and enter global configuration mode. In global configuration mode, the ASA displays this
prompt: hostname(config)#.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter webvpn configuration mode.


webvpn

Step 2 Disable the HostScan image you want to uninstall.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
232
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Assign AnyConnect Feature Modules to Group Policies

no hostscanenable

Step 3 Specify the path to the HostScan image you want to uninstall. A standalone HostScan package may have been
designated as the HostScan package.
no hostscan image path
Example:

hostname(webvpn)#no hostscan image disk0:/hostscan-3.6.0-k9.pkg

Step 4 Save the running configuration to flash.After successfully saving the new configuration to flash memory, you
receive the message [OK].
write memory

Assign AnyConnect Feature Modules to Group Policies


This procedure associates AnyConnect feature modules with a group policy. When VPN users connect to the
ASA, the ASA downloads and installs these AnyConnect feature modules to their endpoint computer.

Before you begin


Log on to the ASA and enter global configuration mode. In global configuration mode, the ASA displays this
prompt: hostname(config)#

Procedure

Step 1 Adds an internal group policy for Network Client Access


group-policy name internal
Example:

hostname(config)# group-policy PostureModuleGroup internal

Step 2 Edit the new group policy. After entering the command, you receive the prompt for group policy configuration
mode, hostname(config-group-policy)#.
group-policy name attributes
Example:
hostname(config)# group-policy PostureModuleGroup attributes
Step 3 Enter group policy webvpn configuration mode. After you enter the command, the ASA returns this prompt:
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
webvpn

Step 4 Configure the group policy to download AnyConnect feature modules for all users in the group.
anyconnect modules value AnyConnect Module Name

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
233
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
HostScan Related Documentation

The value of the anyconnect module command can contain one or more of the following values. When
specifying more than one module, separate the values with a comma:

value AnyConnect Modul/Feature Name

dart AnyConnect DART (Diagnostics and Reporting Tool)

vpngina AnyConnect SBL (Start Before Logon)

websecurity AnyConnect Web Security Module

telemetry AnyConnect Telemetry Module

posture AnyConnect Posture Module

nam AnyConnect Network Access Manager

none Used by itself to remove all AnyConnect modules


from the group policy.

Example:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect modules value websecurity,telemetry,posture

To remove one of the modules, re-send the command specifying only the module values you want to keep.
For example, this command removes the websecurity module:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# anyconnect modules value telemetry,posture

Step 5 Save the running configuration to flash.


After successfully saving the new configuration to flash memory, you receive the message [OK] and the ASA
returns you to this prompt hostname(config-group-webvpn)#
write memory

HostScan Related Documentation


Once HostScan gathers the posture credentials from the endpoint computer, you will need to understand
subjects like configuring dynamic access policies and using LUA expressions to make use of the information.
These topics are covered in detail in these documents:
• Cisco Secure Desktop Configuration Guides
• Cisco Adaptive Security Device Manager Configuration Guides

See also the Cisco AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client Administrator Guide for more information about how
HostScan works with AnyConnect clients.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
234
CHAPTER 10
Easy VPN
This chapter describes how to configure any ASA as an Easy VPN Server, and the Cisco ASA with
FirePOWER- 5506-X, 5506W-X, 5506H-X, and 5508-X models as an Easy VPN Remote hardware client.
• About Easy VPN, on page 235
• Configure Easy VPN Remote, on page 238
• Configure Easy VPN Server, on page 241
• Feature History for Easy VPN, on page 242

About Easy VPN


Cisco Ezvpn greatly simplifies configuration and deployment of VPN for remote offices and mobile workers.
Cisco Easy VPN offers flexibility, scalability, and ease of use for site-to-site and remote-access VPNs. It
implements the Cisco Unity Client protocol, allowing administrators to define most VPN parameters on the
Easy VPN Server, simplifying the Easy VPN Remote configuration.
The Cisco ASA with FirePOWER models 5506-X, 5506W-X, 5506H-X, and 5508-X support Easy VPN
Remote as a hardware client that initiates the VPN tunnel to an Easy VPN Server. The Easy VPN server can
be another ASA (any model), or a Cisco IOS-based router. An ASA cannot function as both an Easy VPN
Remote and an Easy VPN Server simultaneously.

Note The Cisco ASA 5506-X, 5506W-X, 5506H-X and 5508-X models support L3 switching not L2 switching.
Use an external switch when using Easy VPN Remote with multiple hosts or devices on the inside network.
A switch is not required if a single host is on the inside network of the ASA.

The following sections describe Easy VPN options and settings.

Easy VPN Interfaces


Upon system startup, the Easy VPN external and internal interfaces are determined by their security level.
The physical interface with the lowest security level is used for the external connection to an Easy VPN server.
The physical interface with the highest security level is used for the internal connection to secure resources.
If Easy VPN determines that there are two or more interfaces with the same highest security level, Easy VPN
is disabled.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
235
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
About Easy VPN

Easy VPN Connections


Easy VPN uses IPsec IKEv1 tunnels. The Easy VPN Remote hardware client's configuration must be compatible
with the VPN configuration on the Easy VPN Server headend. If using secondary servers, their configuration
must be identical to the primary server.
The ASA Easy VPN Remote configures the IP address of the primary Easy VPN Server and optionally, up
to 10 secondary (backup) servers. Use the vpnclient server command in global configuration mode to configure
these servers. If unable to set up the tunnel to the primary server, the client tries the connection to the first
secondary VPN server, and then sequentially down the list of VPN servers at 8 second intervals. If the setup
tunnel to the first secondary server fails, and the primary server comes online during this time, the client will
proceed to set up the tunnel to the second secondary VPN server.
By default, the Easy VPN hardware client and server encapsulate IPsec in User Datagram Protocol (UDP)
packets. Some environments, such as those with certain firewall rules, or NAT and PAT devices, prohibit
UDP. To use standard Encapsulating Security Protocol (ESP, Protocol 50) or Internet Key Exchange (IKE,
UDP 500) in such environments, you must configure the client and the server to encapsulate IPsec within
TCP packets to enable secure tunneling. Use the vpnclient ipsec-over-tcp command to configure this. If
your environment allows UDP, however, configuring IPsec over TCP adds unnecessary overhead.

Easy VPN Tunnel Groups


Upon tunnel establishment, the Easy VPN Remote specifies the tunnel group, configured on the Easy VPN
Server, that will be used for the connection. The Easy VPN Server pushes group policy or user attributes to
the Easy VPN Remote hardware client determining tunnel behavior. To change certain attributes, you must
modify them on the ASAs configured as primary or secondary Easy VPN Servers.
The Easy VPN Remote client specifies the group policy using the vpnclient vpngroup command to configure
its name and pre-shared key, or the vpnclient trustpoint command to identify a pre-configured trustpoint.

Easy VPN Mode of Operation


The mode determines whether the hosts behind the Easy VPN Remote are accessible or not from the enterprise
network over the tunnel:
• Client mode, also called Port Address Translation (PAT) mode, isolates all devices on the Easy VPN
Remote private network from those on the enterprise network. The Easy VPN Remote performs Port
Address Translation (PAT) for all VPN traffic for its inside hosts. The network and addresses on the
private side of the Easy VPN Remote are hidden, and cannot be accessed directly. IP address management
is not required for the Easy VPN Client inside interface or the inside hosts.
• Network Extension Mode (NEM) makes the inside interface and all inside hosts route-able across the
enterprise network over the tunnel. Hosts on the inside network obtain their IP addresses from an accessible
subnet (statically or via DHCP) pre-configured with static IP addresses. PAT does not apply to VPN
traffic in NEM. This mode does not require a VPN configuration or tunnel for each host on the inside
network, the Easy VPN Remote provides tunneling for all of the hosts.

The Easy VPN Server defaults to Client mode. To configure NEM mode use the nem enable command in
group policy configuration mode. Specifying one of the modes of operation on the Easy VPN Remote is
mandatory before establishing a tunnel because it does not have a default mode. On the Easy VPN Remote
use the vpnclient mode command to configure PAT or NEM.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
236
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
About Easy VPN

Note The Easy VPN Remote ASA configured for NEM mode supports automatic tunnel initiation. Automatic
initiation requires the configuration and storage of credentials used to set up the tunnel. Automatic tunnel
initiation is disabled if secure unit authentication is enabled.
An Easy VPN Remote in Network Extension Mode with multiple interfaces configured builds a tunnel for
locally encrypted traffic only from the interface with the highest security level.

Easy VPN User Authentication


The ASA Easy VPN Remote can store the username and password for automatic login using the vpnclient
username command..
For additional security, the Easy VPN Server can require:
• Secure unit authentication (SUA)—ignores the configured username and password requiring a user to
manually authenticate. By default, SUA is disabled, enable SUA on the Easy VPN Serverusing the
secure-unit-authentication enable command .
• Individual user authentication (IUA)—requires users behind the Easy VPN Remote to authenticate before
receiving access to the enterprise VPN network. By default, IUA is disabled, enable IUA on the Easy
VPN Serverusing the user-authentication enable command .
When using IUA, specific devices, such as Cisco IP Phones or printers, behind the hardware client will
need to bypass individual user authentication. To configure this, specify IP phone bypass, using the
ip-phone-bypass command, on the Easy VPN Server and MAC address exemption, using the mac-exempt
command, on the Easy VPN Remote.
Additionally, the Easy VPN Server can set or remove the idle timeout period after which the Easy VPN
Server terminates the client’s access using the user-authentication-idle-timeout command on the Easy
VPN Server.

The Cisco Easy VPN server intercepts HTTP traffic and redirects the user to a login page if the user name
and password is not configured, or SUA is disabled, or IUA is enabled. HTTP redirection is automatic and
does not require configuration on the Easy VPN Server.

Remote Management
The ASA operating as an Easy VPN Remote hardware client supports management access using SSH or
HTTPS, with or without additional IPsec encryption.
By default, management tunnels use IPsec encryption within SSH or HTTPS encryption. You can clear the
IPsec encryption layer allowing management access outside of the VPN tunnel using the vpnclient management
clear command. Clearing tunnel management merely removes the IPsec encryption level and does not affect
any other encryption, such as SSH or HTTPS, that exists on the connection.
For additional security, the Easy VPN Remote can require the IPsec encryption and limit administrative access
to specific hosts or networks on the corporate side using the vpnclient management tunnel command in
global configuration mode.
Use no vpnclient management to return to default remote management operation.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
237
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Easy VPN Remote

Note Do not configure a management tunnel on a ASA Easy VPN Remote if a NAT device is operating between
it and the Internet. In that configuration, clear remote management using the vpnclient management clear
command.
Regardless of your configuration, DHCP requests (including renew messages) should not flow over IPsec
tunnels. Even with a vpnclient management tunnel, DHCP traffic is prohibited.

Configure Easy VPN Remote


Before you begin
Gather the following information to configure the Easy VPN Remote:
• The address of the primary Easy VPN Server, and secondary servers if available.
• The addressing mode, Client or NEM, the Easy VPN Remote should operate in.
• The Easy VPN Server group policy name and password (pre-shared key), or a pre-configured trust point
that will select and authenticate the desired group policy.
• The user(s) configured on the Easy VPN Server that are authorized to use the VPN tunnel.
• If a BVI interface is being used for a remote management interface, management-access must be
configured on that interface.

Procedure

Step 1 Configure the Easy VPN Server addresses.


vpnclient server ip-primary [ip-secondary-1... ip-secondary-n]
• ip-primary-address—the IP address or DNS name of the primary Easy VPN server.
• ip-secondary-n (Optional)—a list of the IP addresses or DNS names of up to ten backup Easy VPN
servers. Use a space to separate the items in the list.

Example:
asa(config)#vpnclient server 10.10.10.15 10.10.10.30 192.168.10.10

Step 2 Specify the mode of operation.


vpnclient mode {client-mode | network-extension-mode}
• client-mode—Uses Port Address Translation (PAT) mode to isolate the addresses of the inside hosts,
relative to the client, from the enterprise network.
• network-extension-mode—Addresses of the inside hosts are accessible from the enterprise network.

Example:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
238
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Easy VPN Remote

asa(config)#vpnclient mode network-extension-mode

Step 3 (Optional) If desired, configure the Easy VPN hardware client to use TCP-encapsulated IPsec.
vpnclient ipsec-over-tcp [port tcp_port]
The Easy VPN hardware client uses port 10000 if not specified.
If you configure an Easy VPN Remote to use TCP-encapsulated IPsec, enter the crypto ipsec df-bit clear-df
outside command to clear the Don't Fragment (DF) bit from the encapsulated header. A DF bit is a bit within
the IP header that determines whether the packet can be fragmented. This command lets the Easy VPN hardware
client send packets that are larger than the MTU size.
Example:
Configure the Easy VPN hardware client to use TCP-encapsulated IPsec, using the port 10501, and let it send
large packets over the outside interface:
hostname(config)# vpnclient ipsec-over-tcp port 10501
hostname(config)# crypto ipsec df-bit clear-df outside

Step 4 Identify the tunnel group, configured on the Easy VPN Server, using one of the following methods:
• Specify the Easy VPN Server group policy name and password (pre-shared key).
vpnclient vpngroup group_name password preshared_key
• group_name—name of the VPN tunnel group configured on the Easy VPN server. You must
configure this tunnel group on the server before establishing a connection.
• preshared_key—the IKE pre-shared key used for authentication on the Easy VPN Server.

For example, enter the following command to identify the VPN tunnel group named TestGroup1 and
the IKE pre-shared key my_key123.
hostname(config)# vpnclient vpngroup TestGroup1 password my_key123
hostname(config)#

• Specify a per-configured trust point to select and authenticate the group policy.
vpnclient trustpoint trustpoint_name [chain]
• trustpoint_name—names the trustpoint identifying the RSA certificate to use for authentication.
• chain(Optional)—sends the entire certificate chain.

For example, enter the following command to specify the identity certificate named central and send the
entire certificate chain:
hostname(config)# crypto ca trustpoint central
hostname(config)# vpnclient trustpoint central chain
hostname(config)#

Step 5 If NEM and split-tunneling are configured in the group policy, configure the VPN tunnel to autoconnect.
vpnclient nem-st-autoconnect

Step 6 (Optional) If Individual User Authentication (IAU) and IP Phone Bypass is configured in the group policy
on the Easy VPN Server, exempt devices such as Cisco IP phones, wireless access points, and printers, from
authentication since they are incapable of authenticating.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
239
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Easy VPN Remote

vpnclient mac-exempt mac_addr_1 mac_mask_1 [mac_addr_2 mac_mask_2...mac_addr_n mac_mask_n]


• The list of addresses cannot exceed 15.
• mac_addr—the MAC address, in dotted hexadecimal notation, of the device to bypass individual user
authentication.
• mac_mask—the network mask for the corresponding MAC address.
A MAC mask of ffff.ff00.0000 matches all devices made by the same manufacturer. A MAC mask of
ffff.ffff.ffff matches a single device.
Only the first six characters of the specific MAC address are required if you use the MAC mask
ffff.ff00.0000 to specify all devices by the same manufacturer.

Example:
Cisco IP phones have the Manufacturer ID 00036b, so the following command exempts any Cisco IP phone,
including Cisco IP phones, you might add in the future:
hostname(config)# vpnclient mac-exempt 0003.6b00.0000 ffff.ff00.0000
hostname(config)#

Note Individual User Authentication and IP Phone Bypass must be configured on the Easy VPN Server
group policy as shown:
hostname(config-group-policy)#user-authentication enable
hostname(config-group-policy)#ip-phone-bypass enable

Step 7 Configure automatic Xauth user login credentials.


vpnclient username username password password

Step 8 (Optional) Configure Remote Management of the Easy VPN Remote.


By default, management tunnels use IPsec encryption within SSH or HTTPS encryption. Use one of the
following commands to remove the IPsec encryption or retain this encryption and only allow certain hosts to
manage the ASA.
• vpnclient management clear
Clears the IPsec encryption layer allowing management access outside of the VPN tunnel.
• vpnclient management tunnel ip_addr_1 ip_mask_1 [ip_addr_2 ip_mask_2...ip_addr_n ip_mask_n]

Example:
Enter the following command to automate the creation of an IPsec tunnel to provide management access to
the host with IP address 192.168.10.10:
hostname(config)# vpnclient management tunnel 192.198.10.10 255.255.255.0

Note Do not configure a management tunnel on a ASA Easy VPN Remote if a NAT device is operating
between it and the Internet. In that configuration, clear remote management using the vpnclient
management clear command.

Step 9 Enable the Easy VPN hardware client on the ASA.


vpnclient enable

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
240
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure Easy VPN Server

The server address(es), mode, and tunnel group specification must be configured before you can enable Easy
VPN Remote.

Step 10 (Optional) Manually connect the Easy VPN tunnel if your configuration requires this.
vpnclient connect

Configure Easy VPN Server


Before you begin
Ensure all secondary Easy VPN Servers are configured with the identical options and settings as the primary
Easy VPN Server.

Procedure

Step 1 Configure the Easy VPN Server for IPsec IKEv1 support. See Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users,
on page 77.
Step 2 Set the specific Easy VPN Server atttributes. See Configure Attributes for VPN Hardware Clients, on page
143.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
241
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Feature History for Easy VPN

Feature History for Easy VPN


Feature Name Releases Feature Information

Cisco Easy VPN client on the ASA 9.5(1) This release supports Cisco Easy
5506-X, 5506W-X, 5506H-X, and VPN on the ASA 5506-X series
5508-X and for the ASA 5508-X. The ASA
acts as a VPN hardware client when
connecting to the VPN headend.
Any devices (computers, printers,
and so on) behind the ASA on the
Easy VPN port can communicate
over the VPN; they do not have to
run VPN clients individually. Note
that only one ASA interface can act
as the Easy VPN port; to connect
multiple devices to that port, you
need to place a Layer 2 switch on
the port, and then connect your
devices to the switch.
We introduced the following
commands: vpnclient enable,
vpnclient server, vpnclient mode,
vpnclient username, vpnclient
ipsec-over-tcp, vpnclient
management, vpnclient
vpngroup, vpnclient trustpoint,
vpnclient nem-st-autoconnect,
vpnclient mac-exempt

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
242
CHAPTER 11
Configure an External AAA Server for VPN
• About External AAA Servers, on page 243
• Guidelines For Using External AAA Servers, on page 244
• Configure LDAP Authorization for VPN, on page 244
• Active Directory/LDAP VPN Remote Access Authorization Examples, on page 246

About External AAA Servers


This ASA can be configured to use an external LDAP, RADIUS, or TACACS+ server to support Authentication,
Authorization, and Accounting (AAA) for the ASA. The external AAA server enforces configured permissions
and attributes. Before you configure the ASA to use an external server, you must configure the external AAA
server with the correct ASA authorization attributes and, from a subset of these attributes, assign specific
permissions to individual users.

Understanding Policy Enforcement of Authorization Attributes


The ASA supports several methods of applying user authorization attributes (also called user entitlements or
permissions) to VPN connections. You can configure the ASA to obtain user attributes from any combination
of:
• a Dynamic Access Policy (DAP) on the ASA
• an external RADIUS or LDAP authentication and/or authorization server
• a group policy on the ASA

If the ASA receives attributes from all sources, the attributes are evaluated, merged, and applied to the user
policy. If there are conflicts between attributes, the DAP attributes take precedence.
The ASA applies attributes in the following order:
1. DAP attributes on the ASA—Introduced in Version 8.0(2), these attributes take precedence over all others.
If you set a bookmark or URL list in DAP, it overrides a bookmark or URL list set in the group policy.
2. User attributes on the AAA server—The server returns these attributes after successful user authentication
and/or authorization. Do not confuse these with attributes that are set for individual users in the local AAA
database on the ASA (User Accounts in ASDM).

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
243
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Guidelines For Using External AAA Servers

3. Group policy configured on the ASA—If a RADIUS server returns the value of the RADIUS CLASS
attribute IETF-Class-25 (OU=group-policy) for the user, the ASA places the user in the group policy of
the same name and enforces any attributes in the group policy that are not returned by the server.
For LDAP servers, any attribute name can be used to set the group policy for the session. The LDAP
attribute map that you configure on the ASA maps the LDAP attribute to the Cisco attribute
IETF-Radius-Class.
4. Group policy assigned by the Connection Profile (called tunnel-group in the CLI)—The Connection
Profile has the preliminary settings for the connection, and includes a default group policy applied to the
user before authentication. All users connecting to the ASA initially belong to this group, which provides
any attributes that are missing from the DAP, user attributes returned by the server, or the group policy
assigned to the user.
5. Default group policy assigned by the ASA (DfltGrpPolicy)—System default attributes provide any values
that are missing from the DAP, user attributes, group policy, or connection profile.

Guidelines For Using External AAA Servers


The ASA enforces the LDAP attributes based on attribute name, not numeric ID. RADIUS attributes, are
enforced by numeric ID, not by name.
For ASDM Version 7.0, LDAP attributes include the cVPN3000 prefix. For ASDM Versions 7.1 and later,
this prefix was removed.
LDAP attributes are a subset of the Radius attributes, which are listed in the Radius chapter.

Configure LDAP Authorization for VPN


After LDAP authentication for VPN access has succeeded, the ASA queries the LDAP server, which returns
LDAP attributes. These attributes generally include authorization data that applies to the VPN session.
You may require authorization from an LDAP directory server that is separate and distinct from the
authentication mechanism. For example, if you use an SDI or certificate server for authentication, no
authorization information is passed back. For user authorizations in this case, you can query an LDAP directory
after successful authentication, accomplishing authentication and authorization in two steps.
To set up VPN user authorization using LDAP, perform the following steps.

Procedure

Step 1 Create a AAA server group.


aaa-server server_group protocol {kerberos | ldap | nt | radius | sdi | tacacs+}
Example:

hostname(config)# aaa-server servergroup1 protocol ldap


hostname(config-aaa-server-group)

Step 2 Create an IPsec remote access tunnel group named remotegrp.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
244
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Configure LDAP Authorization for VPN

tunnel-group groupname
Example:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp

Step 3 Associate the server group and the tunnel group.


tunnel-group groupname general-attributes
Example:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group remotegrp general-attributes

Step 4 Assigns a new tunnel group to a previously created AAA server group for authorization.
authorization-server-group group-tag
Example:

hostname(config-general)# authorization-server-group ldap_dir_1

Example
The following example shows commands for enabling user authorization with LDAP. The example
then creates an IPsec remote access tunnel group named RAVPN and assigns that new tunnel group
to the previously created LDAP AAA server group for authorization:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group RAVPN type remote-access


hostname(config)# tunnel-group RAVPN general-attributes
hostname(config-general)# authorization-server-group (inside) LDAP
hostname(config-general)#

After you complete this configuration work, you can then configure additional LDAP authorization
parameters such as a directory password, a starting point for searching a directory, and the scope of
a directory search by entering the following commands:

hostname(config)# aaa-server LDAP protocol ldap


hostname(config-aaa-server-group)# aaa-server LDAP (inside) host 10.0.2.128
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-base-dn DC=AD,DC=LAB,DC=COM
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-group-base-dn DC=AD,DC=LAB,DC=COM
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-scope subtree
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-dn AD\cisco
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-login-password cisco123
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-over-ssl enable
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# server-type microsoft

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
245
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Active Directory/LDAP VPN Remote Access Authorization Examples

Active Directory/LDAP VPN Remote Access Authorization


Examples
This section presents example procedures for configuring authentication and authorization on the ASA using
the Microsoft Active Directory server. It includes the following topics:
• Policy Enforcement of User-Based Attributes, on page 246
• Place LDAP Users in a Specific Group Policy, on page 247
• Enforce Static IP Address Assignment for AnyConnect Tunnels, on page 249
• Enforce Dial-in Allow or Deny Access, on page 251
• Enforce Logon Hours and Time-of-Day Rules, on page 253

Other configuration examples available on Cisco.com include the following TechNotes.


• ASA/PIX: Mapping VPN Clients to VPN Group Policies Through LDAP Configuration Example
• PIX/ASA 8.0: Use LDAP Authentication to Assign a Group Policy at Login

Policy Enforcement of User-Based Attributes


This example displays a simple banner to the user, showing how you can map any standard LDAP attribute
to a well-known Vendor-Specific Attribute (VSA), and you can map one or more LDAP attribute(s) to one
or more Cisco LDAP attributes. It applies to any connection type, including the IPsec VPN client, AnyConnect
SSL VPN client, or clientless SSL VPN.
To enforce a simple banner for a user who is configured on an AD LDAP server use the Office field in the
General tab to enter the banner text. This field uses the attribute named physicalDeliveryOfficeName. On the
ASA, create an attribute map that maps physicalDeliveryOfficeName to the Cisco attribute Banner1.
During authentication, the ASA retrieves the value of physicalDeliveryOfficeName from the server, maps the
value to the Cisco attribute Banner1, and displays the banner to the user.

Procedure

Step 1 Right-click the username, open the Properties dialog box then the General tab and enter banner text in the
Office field, which uses the AD/LDAP attribute physicalDeliveryOfficeName.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
246
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Place LDAP Users in a Specific Group Policy

Step 2 Create an LDAP attribute map on the ASA.


Create the map Banner and map the AD/LDAP attribute physicalDeliveryOfficeName to the Cisco attribute
Banner1:

hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map Banner


hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-name physicalDeliveryOfficeName Banner1

Step 3 Associate the LDAP attribute map to the AAA server.


Enter the aaa server host configuration mode for the host 10.1.1.2 in the AAA server group MS_LDAP, and
associate the attribute map Banner that you previously created:

hostname(config)# aaa-server MS_LDAP host 10.1.1.2


hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map Banner

Step 4 Test the banner enforcement.

Place LDAP Users in a Specific Group Policy


This example applies to any connection type, including the IPsec VPN client, AnyConnect SSL VPN client,
or clientless SSL VPN. In this example, User1 is connecting through a clientless SSL VPN connection.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
247
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Place LDAP Users in a Specific Group Policy

To place an LDAP user into a specific group policy use the Department field of the Organization tab to enter
the name of the group policy. Then create an attribute map, and map Department to the Cisco attribute
IETF-Radius-Class.
During authentication, the ASA retrieves the value of Department from the server, maps the value to the
IETF-Radius-Class, and places User1 in the group policy.

Procedure

Step 1 Right-click the username, open the Properties dialog box then the Organization tab and enter Group-Policy-1
in the Department field.

Step 2 Define an attribute map for the LDAP configuration.


Map the AD attribute Department to the Cisco attribute IETF-Radius-Class:

hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map group_policy


hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-name Department IETF-Radius-Class

Step 3 Associate the LDAP attribute map to the AAA server.


Enter the aaa server host configuration mode for the host 10.1.1.2 in the AAA server group MS_LDAP, and
associate the attribute map group_policy that you previously created:

hostname(config)# aaa-server MS_LDAP host 10.1.1.2

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
248
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enforce Static IP Address Assignment for AnyConnect Tunnels

hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map group_policy

Step 4 Add the group-policy, Group-policy-1 as entered in the Department field on the server, on the ASA and
configure the required policy attributes that will be assigned to the user:

hostname(config)# group-policy Group-policy-1 external server-group LDAP_demo


hostname(config-aaa-server-group)#

Step 5 Establish the VPN connection as the user would, and verify that the session inherits the attributes from
Group-Policy1 (and any other applicable attributes from the default group-policy).
Step 6 Monitor the communication between the ASA and the server by enabling the debug ldap 255 command from
privileged EXEC mode. The following is sample output from this command, which has been edited to provide
the key messages:

[29] Authentication successful for user1 to 10.1.1.2


[29] Retrieving user attributes from server 10.1.1.2
[29] Retrieved Attributes:
[29] department: value = Group-Policy-1
[29] mapped to IETF-Radius-Class: value = Group-Policy-1

Enforce Static IP Address Assignment for AnyConnect Tunnels


This example applies to full-tunnel clients, such as the IPsec client and the SSL VPN clients.
To enforce static AnyConnect static IP assignments configure the AnyConnect client user Web1 to receive a
static IP address, enter the address in the Assign Static IP Address field of the Dialin tab on the AD LDAP
server (this field uses the msRADIUSFramedIPAddress attribute), and create an attribute map that maps this
attribute to the Cisco attribute IETF-Radius-Framed-IP-Address.
During authentication, the ASA retrieves the value of msRADIUSFramedIPAddress from the server, maps
the value to the Cisco attribute IETF-Radius-Framed-IP-Address, and provides the static address to User1.

Procedure

Step 1 Right-click the username, open the Properties dialog box then the Dial-in tab, check the Assign Static IP
Address check box, and enter an IP address of 10.1.1.2.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
249
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enforce Static IP Address Assignment for AnyConnect Tunnels

Step 2 Create an attribute map for the LDAP configuration shown.


Map the AD attribute msRADIUSFramedIPAddress used by the Static Address field to the Cisco attribute
IETF-Radius-Framed-IP-Address:

hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map static_address


hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-name msRADIUSFramedIPAddress
IETF-Radius-Framed-IP-Address

Step 3 Associate the LDAP attribute map to the AAA server.


Enter the aaa server host configuration mode for the host 10.1.1.2 in the AAA server group MS_LDAP, and
associates the attribute map static_address that you previously created in:

hostname(config)# aaa-server MS_LDAP host 10.1.1.2


hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map static_address

Step 4 Verify that the vpn-address-assignment command is configured to specify AAA by viewing this part of the
configuration:

hostname(config)# show run all vpn-addr-assign


vpn-addr-assign aaa << Make sure this is configured >>

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
250
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enforce Dial-in Allow or Deny Access

no vpn-addr-assign dhcp
vpn-addr-assign local
hostname(config)#

Step 5 Establish a connection to the ASA with the AnyConnect client. Observe that the user receives the IP address
configured on the server and mapped to the ASA.
Step 6 Use the show vpn-sessiondb svc command to view the session details and verify the address assigned:

hostname# show vpn-sessiondb svc

Session Type: SVC


Username : web1 Index : 31
Assigned IP : 10.1.1.2 Public IP : 10.86.181.70
Protocol : Clientless SSL-Tunnel DTLS-Tunnel
Encryption : RC4 AES128 Hashing : SHA1
Bytes Tx : 304140 Bytes Rx : 470506
Group Policy : VPN_User_Group Tunnel Group : Group1_TunnelGroup
Login Time : 11:13:05 UTC Tue Aug 28 2007
Duration : 0h:01m:48s
NAC Result : Unknown
VLAN Mapping : N/A VLAN : none

Enforce Dial-in Allow or Deny Access


This example creates an LDAP attribute map that specifies the tunneling protocols allowed by the user. You
map the allow access and deny access settings on the Dialin tab to the Cisco attribute Tunneling-Protocol,
which supports the following bitmap values:

Value Tunneling Protocol

1 PPTP

2 L2TP

4 IPsec (IKEv1)

8 L2TP/IPsec

16 Clientless SSL

32 SSL client—AnyConnect or SSL VPN client

64 IPsec (IKEv2)
1
(1) IPsec and L2TP over IPsec are not supported simultaneously. Therefore, the values 4 and 8 are
mutually exclusive.
2
(2) See note 1.
Use this attribute to create an Allow Access (TRUE) or a Deny Access (FALSE) condition for the protocols,
and enforce the method for which the user is allowed access.
See Tech Note ASA/PIX: Mapping VPN Clients to VPN Group Policies Through LDAP Configuration
Example for another example of enforcing dial-in allow access or deny access.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
251
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enforce Dial-in Allow or Deny Access

Procedure

Step 1 Right-click the username, open the Properties dialog box then the Dial-in tab, and click the Allow Access
radio button.

Note If you choose the Control access through the Remote Access Policy option, then a value is not
returned from the server, and the permissions that are enforced are based on the internal group policy
settings of the ASA.

Step 2 Create an attribute map to allow both an IPsec and AnyConnect connection, but deny a clientless SSL
connection.
a) Create the map tunneling_protocols:

hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map tunneling_protocols

b) Map the AD attribute msNPAllowDialin used by the Allow Access setting to the Cisco attribute
Tunneling-Protocols:

hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-name msNPAllowDialin Tunneling-Protocols

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
252
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enforce Logon Hours and Time-of-Day Rules

c) Add map values:

hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-value msNPAllowDialin FALSE 48


hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-value msNPAllowDialin TRUE 4

Step 3 Associate the LDAP attribute map to the AAA server.


a) Enter the aaa server host configuration mode for the host 10.1.1.2 in the AAA server group MS_LDAP:

hostname(config)# aaa-server MS_LDAP host 10.1.1.2

b) Associates the attribute map tunneling_protocols that you created:

hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map tunneling_protocols

Step 4 Verify that the attribute map works as configured.


Try connections using clientless SSL, the user should be informed that an unauthorized connection mechanism
was the reason for the failed connection. The IPsec client should connect because IPsec is an allowed tunneling
protocol according to the attribute map.

Enforce Logon Hours and Time-of-Day Rules


The following example shows how to configure and enforce the hours that a clientless SSL user (such as a
business partner) is allowed to access the network.
On the AD server, use the Office field to enter the name of the partner, which uses the
physicalDeliveryOfficeName attribute. Then we create an attribute map on the ASA to map that attribute to
the Cisco attribute Access-Hours. During authentication, the ASA retrieves the value of
physicalDeliveryOfficeName and maps it to Access-Hours.

Procedure

Step 1 Select the user, right-click Properties, and open the General tab:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
253
Site-to-Site and Client VPN
Enforce Logon Hours and Time-of-Day Rules

Step 2 Create an attribute map.


Create the attribute map access_hours and map the AD attribute physicalDeliveryOfficeName used by the
Office field to the Cisco attribute Access-Hours.

hostname(config)# ldap attribute-map access_hours


hostname(config-ldap-attribute-map)# map-name physicalDeliveryOfficeName Access-Hours

Step 3 Associate the LDAP attribute map to the AAA server.


Enter the aaa server host configuration mode for host 10.1.1.2 in the AAA server group MS_LDAP and
associate the attribute map access_hours that you created.

hostname(config)# aaa-server MS_LDAP host 10.1.1.2


hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# ldap-attribute-map access_hours

Step 4 Configure time ranges for each value allowed on the server.
Configure Partner access hours from 9am to 5pm Monday through Friday:

hostname(config)# time-range Partner


hostname(config-time-range)# periodic weekdays 09:00 to 17:00

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
254
PA R T II
Clientless SSL VPN
• Clientless SSL VPN Overview, on page 257
• Basic Clientless SSL VPN Configuration, on page 261
• Advanced Clientless SSL VPN Configuration, on page 289
• Policy Groups, on page 303
• Clientless SSL VPN Remote Users, on page 337
• Clientless SSL VPN Users, on page 347
• Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile Devices, on page 373
• Customizing Clientless SSL VPN, on page 375
• Clientless SSL VPN Troubleshooting, on page 393
CHAPTER 12
Clientless SSL VPN Overview
• Introduction to Clientless SSL VPN, on page 257
• Prerequisites for Clientless SSL VPN, on page 258
• Guidelines and Limitations for Clientless SSL VPN, on page 258
• Licensing for Clientless SSL VPN, on page 259

Introduction to Clientless SSL VPN


Clientless SSL VPN enables end users to securely access resources on the corporate network from anywhere
using an SSL-enabled Web browser. The user first authenticates with a Clientless SSL VPN gateway, which
then allows the user to access pre-configured network resources.

Note Security contexts (also called firewall multimode) and Active/Active stateful failover are not supported when
Clientless SSL VPN is enabled.

Clientless SSL VPN creates a secure, remote-access VPN tunnel to an ASA using a web browser without
requiring a software or hardware client. It provides secure and easy access to a broad range of web resources
and both web-enabled and legacy applications from almost any device that can connect to the Internet via
HTTP. They include:
• Internal websites.
• Web-enabled applications.
• NT/Active Directory file shares.
• Microsoft Outlook Web Access Exchange Server 2000, 2003, 2007, and 2013.
• Microsoft Web App to Exchange Server 2010 in 8.4(2) and later.
• Application Access (smart tunnel or port forwarding access to other TCP-based applications).

Clientless SSL VPN uses Secure Sockets Layer Protocol and its successor, Transport Layer Security
(SSL/TLS1) to provide the secure connection between remote users and specific, supported internal resources
that you configure as an internal server. The ASA recognizes connections that must be proxied, and the HTTP
server interacts with the authentication subsystem to authenticate users.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
257
Clientless SSL VPN
Prerequisites for Clientless SSL VPN

The network administrator provides access to resources by users of Clientless SSL VPN sessions on a group
basis. Users have no direct access to resources on the internal network.

Prerequisites for Clientless SSL VPN


See the Supported VPN Platforms, Cisco ASA 5500 Series for the platforms and browsers supported by
Clientless SSL VPN on the ASA.

Guidelines and Limitations for Clientless SSL VPN


• ActiveX pages require that you enable ActiveX Relay or enter activex-relay on the associated group
policy. If you do so or assign a smart tunnel list to the policy, and the browser proxy exception list on
the endpoint specifies a proxy, the user must add a “shutdown.webvpn.relay.” entry to that list.
• The ASA does not support clientless access to Windows Shares (CIFS) Web Folders from Windows 7,
Vista, Internet Explorer 8 to 10, Mac OS X, or Linux.
• Certificate authentication, including the DoD Common Access Card and SmartCard, works with the
Safari keychain only.
• Even if you install a trusted certificate for clientless connections, clients might see an untrusted certificate
warning.
• The ASA does not support DSA certificates for Clientless SSL VPN connections. RSA certificates are
supported.
• Some domain-based security products have requirements beyond those requests that originate from the
ASA.
• Configuration control inspection and other inspection features under the Modular Policy Framework are
not supported.
• The vpn-filter command under group policy is for client-based access and is not supported. Filter under
Clientless SSL VPN mode in group policy is for clientless-based access only.
• Neither NAT or PAT is applicable to the client.
• The ASA does not support the use of the QoS rate-limiting commands, such as police or priority-queue.
• The ASA does not support the use of connection limits, checking via the static or the Modular Policy
Framework set connection command.
• Because AnyConnect works on lower network layers without a dependency to web content, we recommend
that you configure AnyConnect on ASA to access web applications that seem unsupported with clientless
WebVPN.
• Some components of Clientless SSL VPN require the Java Runtime Environment (JRE). With Mac OS
X v10.7 and later, Java is not installed by default. For details of how to install Java on Mac OS X, see
http://java.com/en/download/faq/java_mac.xml.
• When a clientless VPN session is initiated, RADIUS accounting start messaging is generated. The start
message will not contain a Framed-IP-Address because addresses are not assigned to clientless VPN
sessions. If a Layer3 VPN connection is subsequently initiated from the clientless portal page, an address

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
258
Clientless SSL VPN
Licensing for Clientless SSL VPN

is assigned and is reported to the RADIUS server in an interim-update accounting message. You can
expect similar RADIUS behavior when a Layer3 VPN tunnel is established using the weblaunch feature.
In this case, the accounting start message is sent without a framed IP address after a user is authenticated
but before the Layer3 tunnel is established. This start message is followed by an interim update message
once the Layer3 tunnel is established.
When you have several group policies configured for the clientless portal, they are displayed in a drop-down
on the logon page. When the first group policy in the list requires a certificate, then the user must have a
matching certificate. If some of your group policies do not use certificates, you must configure the list to
display a non-certificate policy first. Alternatively, you may want to create a dummy group policy with the
name “0-Select-a-group.”

Tip You can control which policy is displayed first by naming your group polices alphabetically, or prefix them
with numbers. For example, 1-AAA, 2-Certificate.

Licensing for Clientless SSL VPN


Use of the AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client requires that you purchase either an AnyConnect Plus and
Apex license. The license(s) required depends on the AnyConnect VPN Client and Secure Mobility features
that you plan to use, and the number of sessions that you want to support. These user-based licences include
access to support and software updates to align with general BYOD trends.
AnyConnect 4.4 licenses are used with ASA (and also ISR, CSR, and ASR), as well as other non-VPN
headends such as Identity Services Engine (ISE), Cloud Web Security (CWS), and Web Security Appliance
(WSA). A consistent model is used regardless of the headend, so there is no impact when headend migrations
occur.
For a full description of the licensing model for AnyConnect, refer to http://www.cisco.com/c/dam/en/us/
products/collateral/security/anyconnect-og.pdf.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
259
Clientless SSL VPN
Licensing for Clientless SSL VPN

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
260
CHAPTER 13
Basic Clientless SSL VPN Configuration
• Rewrite Each URL, on page 261
• Switch Off URL Entry on the Portal Page, on page 262
• Trusted Certificate Pools, on page 262
• Configure Browser Access to Plug-ins, on page 264
• Configure Port Forwarding, on page 270
• Configure File Access, on page 275
• Ensure Clock Accuracy for SharePoint Access, on page 278
• Virtual Desktop Infrastructure (VDI), on page 278
• Use SSL to Access Internal Servers, on page 281
• Configure Browser Access to Client-Server Plug-ins, on page 285

Rewrite Each URL


By default, the ASA allows all portal traffic to all Web resources (for example HTTPS, CIFS, RDP, and
plug-ins). Clientless SSL VPN rewrites each URL to one that is meaningful only to the ASA. The user cannot
use this URL to confirm that they are connected to the website they requested. To avoid placing users at risk
from phishing websites, assign a Web ACL to the policies configured for clientless access—group policies,
dynamic access policies, or both—to control traffic flows from the portal. We recommend switching off URL
Entry on these policies to prevent user confusion over what is accessible.
Figure 6: Example URL Entered by User

Figure 7: Same URL Rewritten by Security Appliance and Displayed in Browser Window

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
261
Clientless SSL VPN
Switch Off URL Entry on the Portal Page

Switch Off URL Entry on the Portal Page


The portal page opens when the user establishes a browser-based connection.

Before you begin


Configure a group policy for all users who require Clientless SSL VPN access, and enable Clientless SSL
VPN only for that group policy.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to group policy clientless ssl vpn configuration mode.


webvpn
Step 2 Control the ability of the user to enter any HTTP/HTTPS URL.
url-entry

Step 3 (Optional) Switch off URL Entry.


url-entry disable

Trusted Certificate Pools


The ASA groups trusted certificates into trustpools. Trustpools can be thought of as a special case of Trustpoint
representing multiple known CA certificates. The ASA includes a default bundle of certificates, similar to the
bundle of certificates provided with web browsers. Those certificates are inactive until activated by the
administrator by issuing the crypto ca import default command.
When connecting to a remote server with a web browser using the HTTPS protocol, the server provides a
digital certificate signed by a certificate authority (CA) to identify itself. Web browsers include a collection
of CA certificates which are used to verify the validity of the server certificate.
When connecting to a remote SSL-enabled server through Clientless SSL VPN, it is important to know that
you can trust the remote server, and that you are connecting to the correct remote server. ASA 9.0 introduced
support for SSL server certificate verification against a list of trusted certificate authority (CA) certificates
for Clientless SSL VPN.
On Configuration > Remote Access VPN > Certificate Management > Trusted Certificate Pool, you
can enable certificate verification for SSL connections to https sites. You can also manage the certificates in
the trusted certificate pool.

Note ASA trustpools are similar to but not identical to Cisco IOS trustpools.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
262
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Auto Import of Trustpool Certificates

Configure Auto Import of Trustpool Certificates


Smart licensing uses the Smart Call Home infrastructure. When the ASA configures Smart Call Home
anonymous reporting in the background, the ASA automatically creates a trustpoint containing the certificate
of the CA that issued the Call Home server certificate. The ASA now supports validation of the certificate if
the issuing hierarchy of the server certificate changes, without the need for customer involvement to adjust
certificate hierarchy changes. You can automate the update of the trustpool bundle at periodic intervals so
that Smart Call Home can remain active if the self-signed certificate of the CA server changes. This feature
is not supported under multi-context deployments.
Automatic import of trustpool certificate bundles requires you to specify the URL that ASA uses to download
and import the bundle. Use the following command so the import happens daily at a regular interval with the
default Cisco URL and default time of 22 hours:
ciscoasa(config-ca-trustpool)# auto-import-url Default

You can also enable auto import with a custom URL with the following command:
ciscoasa(config-ca-trustpool)# auto-import url http://www.thawte.com

To give you more flexibility to set downloads during off peak hours or other convenient times, enter the
following command which enables the import with a custom time:
ciscoasa(config-ca-trustpool)# auto-import time 23:23:23

Setting the automatic import with both a custom URL and custom time requires the following command:
ciscoasa(config-ca-trustpool)# auto-import time 23:23:23 url http://www.thawte.com

Show the State of the Trustpool Policy


Use the following command to see the current state of the trustpool policy:
show crypto ca trustpool policy

This command returns information like the following:


0 trustpool certificates installed
Trustpool auto renewal statistics:
State: Not in progress
Last import result: Not attempted N/A
Current Jitter: 0

Trustpool auto import statistics:


Last import result: N/A
Next schedule import at 22:00:00 Tues Jul 21 2015

Trustpool Policy

Trustpool revocation checking is disabled.


CRL cache time: 60 seconds
CRL next update field: required and enforced
Auto import of trustpool is enabled
Automatic import URL: http://www.cisco.com/security/pki/trs/ios_core.p7b
Download time: 22:00:00

Policy Overrides:
None configured

Clear CA Trustpool
To reset the trustpool policy to its default state, use the following command:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
263
Clientless SSL VPN
Edit the Policy of the Trusted Certificate Pool

clear configure crypto ca trustpool

Since the automatic import of trustpoint certificates is turned off by default, using this command disables the
feature.

Edit the Policy of the Trusted Certificate Pool


Procedure

Step 1 Revocation Check—Configure whether to check the certificates in the pool for revocation, and then choose
whether to use CLR or OCSP and whether to make the certificate invalid if checking for revocation fails.
Step 2 Certificate Matching Rules—Select certificate maps to exempt from revocation or expiration checks. A
certificate map links certificates to AnyConnect or clientless SSL connection profiles (also known as tunnel
groups).
Step 3 CRL Options—Decide how often to refresh the CRL cache, between 1 and 1440 minutes (1140 minutes is
24 hours).
Step 4 Automatic Import—Cisco periodically updates the "default" list of trusted CAs. If you check Enable Automatic
Import, and keep the default settings, the ASA checks for an updated list of trusted CAs on the Cisco site
every 24 hours. If the list has changed, the ASA downloads and imports the new default trusted CA list.

Configure Browser Access to Plug-ins


A browser plug-in is a separate program that a Web browser invokes to perform a dedicated function, such
as connect a client to a server within the browser window. The ASA lets you import plug-ins for download
to remote browsers in Clientless SSL VPN sessions. Of course, Cisco tests the plug-ins it redistributes, and
in some cases, tests the connectivity of plug-ins we cannot redistribute. However, we do not recommend
importing plug-ins that support streaming media at this time.
The ASA does the following when you install a plug-in onto the flash device:
• (Cisco-distributed plug-ins only) Unpacks the jar file specified in the URL.
• Writes the file to the ASA file system.
• Populates the drop-down list next to the URL attributes in ASDM.
• Enables the plug-in for all future Clientless SSL VPN sessions, and adds a main menu option and an
option to the drop-down list next to the Address field of the portal page.

The following shows the changes to the main menu and Address field of the portal page when you add the
plug-ins described in the following sections.

Table 12: Effects of Plug-ins on the Clientless SSL VPN Portal Page

Plug-in Main Menu Option Added to Portal Address Field Option Added to
Page Portal Page

ica Citrix MetaFrame Services ica://

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
264
Clientless SSL VPN
Prerequisites with Plug-Ins

Plug-in Main Menu Option Added to Portal Address Field Option Added to
Page Portal Page

rdp Terminal Servers rdp://

rdp2* Terminal Servers Vista rdp2://

ssh,telnet Secure Shell ssh://

Telnet Services (supporting v1 and telnet://


v2)

vnc Virtual Network Computing vnc://


services

* Not a recommended plug-in.


When the user in a Clientless SSL VPN session clicks the associated menu option on the portal page, the
portal page displays a window to the interface and displays a help pane. The user can choose the protocol
displayed in the drop-down list and enter the URL in the Address field to establish a connection.
The plug-ins support single sign-on (SSO).

Prerequisites with Plug-Ins


• Clientless SSL VPN must be enabled on the ASA to provide remote access to the plug-ins.
• To configure SSO support for a plug-in, you install the plug-in, add a bookmark entry to display a link
to the server, and specify SSO support when adding the bookmark.
• The minimum access rights required for remote use belong to the guest privilege mode.
• Plug-ins require ActiveX or Oracle Java Runtime Environment (JRE). See the Supported VPN Platforms,
Cisco ASA 5500 Series compatibility matrices for version requirements.

Restrictions with Plug-Ins

Note The remote desktop protocol plug-in does not support load balancing with a session broker. Because of the
way the protocol handles the redirect from the session broker, the connection fails. If a session broker is not
used, the plug-in works.

• The plug-ins support single sign-on (SSO). They use the same credentials entered to open the Clientless
SSL VPN session. Because the plug-ins do not support macro substitution, you do not have the options
to perform SSO on different fields such as the internal domain password or on an attribute on a RADIUS
or LDAP server.
• A stateful failover does not retain sessions established using plug-ins. Users must reconnect following
a failover.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
265
Clientless SSL VPN
Prepare the Security Appliance for a Plug-in

• If you use stateless failover instead of stateful failover, clientless features such as bookmarks,
customization, and dynamic access-policies are not synchronized between the failover ASA pairs. In the
event of a failover, these features do not work.

Prepare the Security Appliance for a Plug-in


Before you begin
Ensure that Clientless SSL VPN is enabled on an ASA interface.
Do not specify an IP address as the common name (CN) for the SSL certificate. The remote user attempts to
use the FQDN to communicate with the ASA. The remote PC must be able to use DNS or an entry in the
System32\drivers\etc\hosts file to resolve the FQDN.

Procedure

Step 1 Show whether Clientless SSL VPN is enabled on the ASA.


show running-config

Step 2 Install an SSL certificate onto the ASA interface and provide a fully-qualified domain name (FQDN) for
remote user connection.

Install Plug-ins Redistributed by Cisco


Cisco redistributes the following open-source, Java-based components to be accessed as plug-ins for Web
browsers in Clientless SSL VPN sessions.

Before you begin


Ensure Clientless SSL VPN is enabled on an interface on the ASA. To do so, enter the show running-config
command.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
266
Clientless SSL VPN
Install Plug-ins Redistributed by Cisco

Table 13: Plug-ins Redistributed by Cisco

Protocol Description Source of Redistributed Plug-in *

RDP Accesses Microsoft Terminal http://properjavardp.sourceforge.net/


Services hosted by Windows Vista
and Windows 2003 R2.
Supports Remote Desktop ActiveX
Control.
We recommend using this plug-in
that supports both RDP and RDP2.
Only versions up to 5.1 of the RDP
and RDP2 protocols are supported.
Version 5.2 and later are not
supported.

RDP2 Accesses Microsoft Terminal


Services hosted by Windows Vista
and Windows 2003 R2.
Supports Remote Desktop ActiveX
Control.
This legacy plug-in supports only
RDP2. We do not recommend
using this plug-in; instead, use the
RDP plug-in above.

SSH The Secure Shell-Telnet plug-in http://javassh.org/


lets the remote user establish a
Secure Shell (v1 or v2) or Telnet
connection to a remote computer.
Because keyboard-interactive
authentication is not supported by
JavaSSH, it cannot be supported
with SSH plugin (used to
implement different authentication
mechanisms).

VNC The Virtual Network Computing http://www.tightvnc.com/


plug-in lets the remote user use a
monitor, keyboard, and mouse to
view and control a computer with
remote desktop sharing (also
known as VNC server or service)
turned on. This version changes the
default color of the text and
contains updated French and
Japanese help files.

* Consult the plug-in documentation for information on deployment configuration and restrictions.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
267
Clientless SSL VPN
Provide Access to a Citrix XenApp Server

These plug-ins are available on the Cisco Adaptive Security Appliance Software Download site.

Note The ASA does not retain the import webvpn plug-in protocol command in the configuration. Instead, it
loads the contents of the csco-config/97/plugin directory automatically. A secondary ASA obtains the
plug-ins from the primary ASA.

Procedure

Step 1 Install the plug-in onto the flash device of the ASA.
import webvpn plug-in protocol [ rdp | rdp2 | [ ssh | telnet ] | vnc] URL
Note Do not enter this command once for SSH and once for Telnet. When typing ssh,telnet , do not insert
a space. This provides plug-in access to both Secure Shell and Telnet services.

Example:
The following example shows entering the hostname or address of the TFTP or FTP server and the path to
the plug-in, where URL is the remote path to the plug-in .jar file.
hostname# import webvpn plug-in protocol ssh,telnet
tftp://local_tftp_server/plugins/ssh-plugin.jar
Accessing
tftp://local_tftp_server/plugins/ssh-plugin.jar...!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
Writing file disk0:/csco_config/97/plugin/ssh...
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
238510 bytes copied in 3.650 secs (79503 bytes/sec)

Step 2 (Optional) Switch off and remove Clientless SSL VPN support for a plug-in, as well as removing it from the
flash drive of the ASA.
revert webvpn plug-in protocol protocol
Example:
hostname# revert webvpn plug-in protocol rdp

Provide Access to a Citrix XenApp Server


As an example of how to provide Clientless SSL VPN browser access to third-party plug-ins, this section
describes how to add Clientless SSL VPN support for the Citrix XenApp Server Client.
With a Citrix plug-in installed on the ASA, Clientless SSL VPN users can use a connection to the ASA to
access Citrix XenApp services.
A stateful failover does not retain sessions established using the Citrix plug-in. Citrix users must reauthenticate
after failover.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
268
Clientless SSL VPN
Create and Install the Citrix Plug-in

Create and Install the Citrix Plug-in

Before you begin


You must prepare the security application for a plug-in.
You must configure the Citrix Web Interface software to operate in a mode that does not use the (Citrix)
“secure gateway.” Otherwise, the Citrix client cannot connect to the Citrix XenApp Server.

Procedure

Step 1 Download the ica-plugin.zip file from the Cisco Software Download website.
This file contains files that Cisco customized for use with the Citrix plug-in.

Step 2 Download the Citrix Java client from the Citrix site.
In the download area of the Citrix website, choose Citrix Receiver, and Receiver for Other Platforms, and
click Find. Click the Receiver for Java hyperlink and download the archive.

Step 3 Extract the following files from the archive, and then add them to the ica-plugin.zip file:
• JICA-configN.jar
• JICAEngN.jar

Step 4 Ensure the EULA included with the Citrix Java client grants you the rights and permissions to deploy the
client on your Web servers.
Step 5 Install the plug-in by using ASDM, or entering the following CLI command in privileged EXEC mode:
import webvpn plug-in protocol ica URL
URL is the hostname or IP address and path to the ica-plugin.zip file.
Note Adding a bookmark is required to provide SSO support for Citrix sessions. We recommend that
you use URL parameters in the bookmark the provide convenient viewing, for example:
ica://10.56.1.114/?DesiredColor=4&DesiredHRes=1024&DesiredVRes=768

Step 6 Establish an SSL VPN clientless session and click the bookmark or enter the URL for the Citrix server.
Use the Client for Java Administrator’s Guide as needed.

View the Plug-ins Installed on the Security Appliance


Procedure

Step 1 List the Java-based client applications available to users of Clientless SSL VPN.
Example:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
269
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Port Forwarding

hostname# show import webvpn plug


ssh
rdp
vnc
ica

Step 2 Include hash and date of the plug-in.


Example:
hostname show import webvpn plug detail
post GXN2BIGGOAOkBMibDQsMu2GWZ3Q= Tues, 29 Apr 2008 19:57:03 GMT
rdp fHeyReIOUwDCgAL9HdTs PnjdBoo= Tues, 15 Sep 2009 23:23:56 GMT

Configure Port Forwarding


Port forwarding lets users access TCP-based applications over a Clientless SSL VPN connection. Such
applications include the following:
• Lotus Notes
• Microsoft Outlook
• Microsoft Outlook Express
• Perforce
• Sametime
• Secure FTP (FTP over SSH)
• SSH
• Telnet
• Windows Terminal Service
• XDDTS

Other TCP-based applications may also work, but we have not tested them. Protocols that use UDP do not
work.
Port forwarding is the legacy technology for supporting TCP-based applications over a Clientless SSL VPN
connection. You may choose to use port forwarding because you have built earlier configurations that support
this technology.
Consider the following alternatives to port forwarding:
• Smart tunnel access offers the following advantages to users:
• Smart tunnel offers better performance than plug-ins.
• Unlike port forwarding, smart tunnel simplifies the user experience by not requiring the user
connection of the local application to the local port.
• Unlike port forwarding, smart tunnel does not require users to have administrator privileges.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
270
Clientless SSL VPN
Prerequisites for Port Forwarding

• Unlike port forwarding and smart tunnel access, a plug-in does not require the client application to be
installed on the remote computer.

When configuring port forwarding on the ASA, you specify the port the application uses. When configuring
smart tunnel access, you specify the name of the executable file or its path.

Prerequisites for Port Forwarding


• Ensure Oracle Java Runtime Environment (JRE) 1.5.x or later is installed on the remote computers to
support port forwarding (application access) and digital certificates.
• Browser-based users of Safari on Mac OS X 10.5.3 must identify a client certificate for use with the
URL of the ASA, once with the trailing slash and once without it, because of the way Safari interprets
URLs. For example,
• https://example.com/
• https://example.com

For details, go to the Safari, Mac OS X 10.5.3: Changes in client certificate authentication.
• Users of Microsoft Windows Vista or later who use port forwarding or smart tunnels must add the URL
of the ASA to the Trusted Site zone. To access the Trusted Site zone, they must start Internet Explorer
and choose the Tools > Internet Options > Security tab. Vista (or later) users can also switch off
Protected Mode to facilitate smart tunnel access; however, we recommend against this method because
it increases the computer’s vulnerability to attack.

Restrictions for Port Forwarding


• Port forwarding supports only TCP applications that use static TCP ports. Applications that use dynamic
ports or multiple TCP ports are not supported. For example, SecureFTP, which uses port 22, works over
Clientless SSL VPN port forwarding, but standard FTP, which uses ports 20 and 21, does not.
• Port forwarding does not support protocols that use UDP.
• Port forwarding does not support Microsoft Outlook Exchange (MAPI) proxy. However, you can configure
smart tunnel support for Microsoft Office Outlook in conjunction with Microsoft Outlook Exchange
Server.
• A stateful failover does not retain sessions established using Application Access (either port forwarding
or smart tunnel access). Users must reconnect following a failover.
• Port forwarding does not support connections to personal digital assistants.
• Because port forwarding requires downloading the Java applet and configuring the local client, and
because doing so requires administrator permissions on the local system, it is unlikely that users will be
able to use applications when they connect from public remote systems.
The Java applet displays in its own window on the end user HTML interface. It shows the contents of
the list of forwarded ports available to the user, as well as which ports are active, and amount of traffic
in bytes sent and received.

• The port forwarding applet displays the local port and the remote port as the same when the local IP
address 127.0.0.1 is being used and cannot be updated by the Clientless SSL VPN connection from the

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
271
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure DNS for Port Forwarding

ASA. As a result, the ASA creates new IP addresses 127.0.0.2, 127.0.0.3, and so on for local proxy IDs.
Because you can modify the hosts file and use different loopbacks, the remote port is used as the local
port in the applet. To connect, you can use Telnet with the hostname, without specifying the port. The
correct local IP addresses are available in the local hosts file.

Configure DNS for Port Forwarding


Port forwarding forwards the domain name of the remote server or its IP address to the ASA for resolution
and connection. In other words, the port forwarding applet accepts a request from the application and forwards
it to the ASA. The ASA makes the appropriate DNS queries and establishes the connection on behalf of the
port forwarding applet. The port forwarding applet only makes DNS queries to the ASA. It updates the host
file so that when a port forwarding application attempts a DNS query, the query redirects to a loopback address.
Configure the ASA to accept the DNS requests from the port forwarding applet as follows:

Procedure

Step 1 Enter the dns server-group mode and configure a DNS server group named example.com.
Example:
hostname(config)# dns server-group example.com

Step 2 Specify the domain name. The default domain-name setting is DefaultDNS.
Example:
hostname(config-dns-server-group)# domain-name example.com

Step 3 Resolve the domain name to an IP address.


Example:
hostname(config-dns-server-group)# name-server 192.168.10.10

Step 4 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn

Step 5 Switch to tunnel-group Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


tunnel-group webvpn

Step 6 Specify the domain name that the tunnel groups will use. By default, the security appliance assigns the default
Clientless SSL VPN group as the default tunnel group for clientless connections. Follow this instruction if
the ASA uses that tunnel group to assign settings to the clientless connections. Otherwise, follow this step for
each tunnel configured for clientless connections.
Example:
asa2(config-dns-server-group)# exit
asa2(config)# tunnel-group DefaultWEBVPNGroup webvpn-attributes
asa2(config-tunnel-webvpn)# dns-group example.com

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
272
Clientless SSL VPN
Make Applications Eligible for Port Forwarding

Make Applications Eligible for Port Forwarding


The Clientless SSL VPN configuration of each ASA supports port forwarding lists, each of which specifies
local and remote ports used by the applications for which to provide access. Because each group policy or
username supports only one port forwarding list, you must group each set of ca supported into a list.

Procedure

Step 1 Display the port forwarding list entries already present in the ASA configuration.
show run webvpn port-forward

Step 2 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn
Following the configuration of a port forwarding list, assign the list to group policies or usernames, as described
in the next section.

Assign a Port Forwarding List


You can add or edit a named list of TCP applications to associate with users or group policies for access over
Clientless SSL VPN connections. For each group policy and username, you can configure Clientless SSL
VPN to do one of the following:

Note These options are mutually exclusive for each group policy and username. Use only one.

• Start port forwarding access automatically upon user login.

Before you begin


Before initiating the port-forward enable list name command, the user is required to start port forwarding
manually, using Application Access > Start Applications on the Clientless SSL VPN portal page.
These commands are available to each group policy and username. The configuration of each group policy
and username supports only one of these commands at a time, so when you enter one, the ASA replaces the
one present in the configuration of the group policy or username in question with the new one, or in the case
of the last command, simply removes the port-forward command from the group policy or username
configuration.

Procedure

Step 1 Start port forwarding automatically upon user login.


port-forward auto-start <list name>
Step 2 Enable or prevent port forwarding upon user login.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
273
Clientless SSL VPN
Automate Port Forwarding

port-forward enable <list name>


port-forward disable

Step 3 (Optional) Remove a port-forward command from the group policy or username configuration, which then
inherits the [no] port-forward command from the default group policy. The keywords following the no
port-forward command are optional; however, they restrict the removal to the named port-forward command.
no port-forward [auto-start <list name> | enable <list name> | disable]

Automate Port Forwarding


To start port forwarding automatically upon user login, enter the following commands:

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn

Step 2 Switch to group-policy or username Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


group-policy webvpn or username webvpn

Step 3 Start port forwarding automatically upon user login.


port-forward auto-start list_name
list_name names the port forwarding list already present in the ASA Clientless SSL VPN configuration. You
cannot assign more than one port forwarding list to a group policy or username.
Example:
The following example assigns the port forwarding list named apps1 to the group policy.
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward auto-start apps1

Step 4 Display the port forwarding list entries present in the ASA configuration.
show run webvpn port-forward

Step 5 (Optional) Remove the port-forward command from the group policy or username and reverts to the default.
no port-forward

Enable and Switch off Port Forwarding


By default, port forwarding is switched off.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
274
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure File Access

Procedure

Step 1 Enable port forwarding.


You do not have to start port forwarding manually if you entered port-forward auto-start list_name, where
list_name is the name of the port forwarding list already present in the ASA Clientless SSL VPN configuration.
You cannot assign more than one port forwarding list to a group policy or username.
port-forward [enable l<list name> | disable]
Example:
The following example assigns the port forwarding list named apps1 to the group policy.
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward enable apps1

Step 2 Display the port forwarding list entries.


show running-config port-forward

Step 3 (Optional) Remove the port-forward command from the group policy or username and revert to the default.
no port-forward

Step 4 (Optional) Switch off port forwarding.


port-forward disable

Configure File Access


Clientless SSL VPN serves remote users with HTTPS portal pages that interface with proxy CIFS and/or FTP
clients running on the ASA. Using either CIFS or FTP, Clientless SSL VPN provides users with network
access to the files on the network, to the extent that the users meet user authentication requirements and the
file properties do not restrict access. The CIFS and FTP clients are transparent; the portal pages delivered by
Clientless SSL VPN provide the appearance of direct access to the file systems.
When a user requests a list of files, Clientless SSL VPN queries the server designated as the master browser
for the IP address of the server containing the list. The ASA gets the list and delivers it to the remote user on
a portal page.
Clientless SSL VPN lets the user invoke the following CIFS and FTP functions, depending on user
authentication requirements and file properties:
• Navigate and list domains and workgroups, servers within a domain or workgroup, shares within a server,
and files within a share or directory.
• Create directories.
• Download, upload, rename, move, and delete files.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
275
Clientless SSL VPN
CIFS File Access Requirement and Limitation

The ASA uses a master browser, WINS server, or DNS server, typically on the same network as the ASA or
reachable from that network, to query the network for a list of servers when the remote user clicks Browse
Networks in the menu of the portal page or on the toolbar displayed during the Clientless SSL VPN session.
The master browser or DNS server provides the CIFS/FTP client on the ASA with a list of the resources on
the network, which Clientless SSL VPN serves to the remote user.

Note Before configuring file access, you must configure the shares on the servers for user access.

CIFS File Access Requirement and Limitation


To access \\server\share\subfolder\personal folder, the user must have a minimum of read permission
for all parent folders, including the share itself.
Use Download or Upload to copy and paste files to and from CIFS directories and the local desktop. The
Copy and Paste buttons are intended for remote to remote actions only, not local to remote, or remote to local.
If you drag and drop a file from a web folder to a folder on your workstation, you might get what appears to
be a temporary file. Refresh the folder on your workstation to update the view and show the transferred file.
The CIFS browse server feature does not support double-byte character share names (share names exceeding
13 characters in length). This only affects the list of folders displayed, and does not affect user access to the
folder. As a workaround, you can pre-configure the bookmark(s) for the CIFS folder(s) that use double-byte
share names, or the user can enter the URL or bookmark of the folder in the format
cifs://server/<long-folder-name>. For example:

cifs://server/Do you remember?


cifs://server/Do%20you%20remember%3F

Add Support for File Access

Note The procedure describes how to specify the master browser and WINS servers. As an alternative, you can use
ASDM to configure URL lists and entries that provide access to file shares.
Adding a share in ASDM does not require a master browser or a WINS server. However, it does not provide
support for the Browse Networks link. You can use a hostname or an IP address to refer to ServerA when
entering the nbns-server command. If you use a hostname, the ASA requires a DNS server to resolve it to an
IP address.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn
Step 2 Switch to tunnel-group Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.
tunnel-group webvpn

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
276
Clientless SSL VPN
Add Support for File Access

Step 3 Browse a network or domain for each NetBIOS Name Server (NBNS).
nbns-server {IPaddress | hostname} [master] [timeout timeout] [retry retries]
• master is the computer designated as the master browser. The master browser maintains the list of
computers and shared resources. Any NBNS server you identify with this command without entering
the master portion of the command must be a Windows Internet Naming Server (WINS). Specify the
master browser first, then specify the WINS servers. You can specify up to three servers, including the
master browser, for a connection profile.
• timeout is the number of seconds the ASA waits before sending the query again, to the same server if it
is the only one, or another server if there are more than one. The default timeout is 2 seconds; the range
is 1 to 30 seconds.
• retries is the number of times to retry queries to the NBNS server. The ASA recycles through the list of
servers this number of times before sending an error message. The default value is 2; the range is 1
through 10.

Example:
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server 192.168.1.20 master
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server 192.168.1.41
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)# nbns-server 192.168.1.47

Step 4 Display the NBNS servers already present in the connection profile configuration.
show tunnel-group webvpn-attributes

Step 5 (Optional) Specify the character set to encode in Clientless SSL VPN portal pages delivered to remote users.
By default, the encoding type set on the remote browser determines the character set for Clientless SSL VPN
portal pages, so you need to set the character encoding only if it is necessary to ensure proper encoding on
the browser.
character-encoding charset
charset is a string consisting of up to 40 characters, and is equal to one of the valid character sets identified
in http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets. You can use either the name or the alias of a character set
listed on that page. Examples include iso-8859-1, shift_jis, and ibm850.
Note The character-encoding and file-encoding values do not exclude the font family to be used by the
browser. You need to complement the setting of one these values with the page style command in
webvpn customization command mode to replace the font family if you are using Japanese Shift_JIS
character encoding, as shown in the following example, or enter the no page style command in
webvpn customization command mode to remove the font family.

Example:
The following example sets the character-encoding attribute to support Japanese Shift_JIS characters, removes
the font family, and retains the default background color.
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# character-encoding shift_jis
hostname(config-webvpn)# customization DfltCustomization
hostname(config-webvpn-custom)# page style background-color:white

Step 6 (Optional) Specify the encoding for Clientless SSL VPN portal pages from specific CIFS servers. Thus, you
can use different file-encoding values for CIFS servers that require different character encodings.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
277
Clientless SSL VPN
Ensure Clock Accuracy for SharePoint Access

file-encoding {server-name | server-ip-address} charset


Example:
The following example sets the file-encoding attribute of the CIFS server 10.86.5.174 to support IBM860
(alias “CP860”) characters.
hostname(config-webvpn)# file-encoding 10.86.5.174 cp860

Ensure Clock Accuracy for SharePoint Access


The Clientless SSL VPN server on the ASA uses cookies to interact with applications such as Microsoft Word
on the endpoint. The cookie expiration time set by the ASA can cause Word to malfunction when accessing
documents on a SharePoint server if the time on the ASA is incorrect. To prevent this malfunction, set the
ASA clock properly. We recommend configuring the ASA to dynamically synchronize the time with an NTP
server. For instructions, see the section on setting the date and time in the general operations configuration
guide.

Virtual Desktop Infrastructure (VDI)


The ASA supports connections to Citrix and VMWare VDI servers.
• For Citrix, the ASA allows access through clientless portal to user's running Citrix Receiver.
• VMWare is configured as a (smart tunnel) application.

VDI servers can also be accessed through bookmarks on the Clientless Portal, like other server applications.

Limitations to VDI
• Authentication using certificates or Smart Cards is not supported for auto sign-on, since these forms of
authentication do not allow the ASA in the middle.
• The XML service must be installed and configured on the XenApp and XenDesktop servers.
• Client certificate verifications, double Auth, internal passwords and CSD (all of CSD, not just Vault)
are not supported when standalone mobile clients are used.

Citrix Mobile Support


A mobile user running the Citrix Receiver can connect to the Citrix server by:
• Connecting to the ASA with AnyConnect, and then connecting to the Citrix server.
• Connecting to the Citrix server through the ASA, without using the AnyConnect client. Logon credentials
can include:
• A connection profile alias (also referred to as a tunnel-group alias) in the Citrix logon screen. A
VDI server can have several group policies, each with different authorization and connection settings.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
278
Clientless SSL VPN
Supported Mobile Devices for Citrix

• An RSA SecureID token value, when the RSA server is configured. RSA support includes next
token for an invalid entry, and also for entering a new PIN for an initial or expired PIN.

Supported Mobile Devices for Citrix


• iPad—Citrix Receiver version 4.x or later
• iPhone/iTouch—Citrix Receiver version 4.x or later
• Android 2.x/3.x/4.0/4.1 phone—Citrix Receiver version 2.x or later
• Android 4.0 phone—Citrix Receiver version 2.x or later

Limitations of Citrix

Certificate Limitations
• Certificate/Smart Card authentication is not supported as means of auto sign-on.
• Client certificate verifications and CSD are not supported
• Md5 signature in the certificates are not working because of security issue, which is a known problem
on iOS: http://support.citrix.com/article/CTX132798
• SHA2 signature is not supported except for Windows, as described on the Citrix website:
http://www.citrix.com/
• A key size >1024 is not supported

Other Limitations
• HTTP redirect is not supported; the Citrix Receiver application does not work with redirects.
• XML service must be installed and configured on the XenApp and XenDesktop servers.

About Citrix Mobile Receiver User Logon


The logon for mobile users connecting to the Citrix server depends on whether the ASA has configured the
Citrix server as a VDI server or a VDI proxy server.
When the Citrix server is configured as a VDI server:
1. Using the AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client, connect to ASA with VPN credentials.
2. Using Citrix Mobile Receiver, connect to Citrix server with Citrix server credentials (if single-signon is
configured, the Citrix credentials are not required).

When the ASA is configured as a to a VDI proxy server:


1. Using Citrix Mobile Receiver, connect to the ASA entering credentials for both the VPN and Citrix server.
After the first connection, if properly configured, subsequent connections only require VPN credentials.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
279
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure the ASA to Proxy a Citrix Server

Configure the ASA to Proxy a Citrix Server


You can configure the ASA to act as a proxy for the Citrix servers, so that connections to the ASA appear to
the user like connections to the Citrix servers. The AnyConnect client is not required when you enable VDI
proxy in ASDM. The following high-level steps show how the end user connects to Citrix.

Procedure

Step 1 A mobile user opens Citrix Receiver and connects to ASA's URL.
Step 2 The user provides credentials for the XenApp server and the VPN credentials on the Citrix logon screen.
Step 3 For each subsequent connection to the Citrix server, the user only needs to enter the VPN credentials.
Using the ASA as a proxy for XenApp and XenDesktop removes the requirement for a Citrix Access Gateway.
XenApp server info is logged on the ASA, and displays in ASDM.
Configure the Citrix server's address and logon credentials, and assign that VDI server to a Group Policy or
username. If both username and group-policy are configured, username settings override group-policy settings.

What to do next
http://www.youtube.com/watch?v=JMM2RzppaG8 - This video describes the advantages of using the ASA
as a Citrix proxy.

Assign a VDI Server to a Group Policy


VDI servers are configured and assigned to Group Policies by:
• Adding the VDI server on the VDI Access pane, and assigning a group policy to the server.
• Adding a VDI server to the group policy.

If both username and group policy are configured, username settings take precedence over group policy. Enter
the following:

configure terminal
group-policy DfltGrpPolicy attributes
webvpn
vdi type <citrix> url <url> domain <domain> username <username> password
<password>
configure terminal
username <username> attributes
webvpn
vdi type <citrix> url <url> domain <domain> username <username> password
<password>]

The syntax options are defined as follows:


• type—Type of VDI. For a Citrix Receiver type, this value must be citrix.
• url—Full URL of the XenApp or XenDesktop server including http or https, hostname, and port number,
as well as the path to the XML service.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
280
Clientless SSL VPN
Use SSL to Access Internal Servers

• username—Username for logging into the virtualization infrastructure server. This value can be a clientless
macro.
• password—Password for logging into the virtualization infrastructure server. This value can be a clientless
macro.
• domain—Domain for logging into the virtualization infrastructure server. This value can be a clientless
macro.

Use SSL to Access Internal Servers


Procedure

Step 1 Switch to group policy Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn

Step 2 Switch off URL entry.


url-entry disable
Clientless SSL VPN uses SSL and its successor, TLS1 to provide a secure connection between remote users
and specific, supported internal resources at an internal server.

Configure Clientless SSL VPN and ASDM Ports


From version 8.0(2), the ASA supports both Clientless SSL VPN sessions and ASDM administrative sessions
simultaneously on port 443 of the outside interface. You can configure these applications on different interfaces.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn
Step 2 Change the SSL listening port for Clientless SSL VPN.
port port_number
Example:
This example enables Clientless SSL VPN on port 444 of the outside interface. With this configuration, remote
users initiating Clientless SSL VPN sessions enter https://<outside_ip>:444 in the browser.

hostname(config)# http server enable


hostname(config)# http 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.0 outside
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# port 444
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
281
Clientless SSL VPN
Use HTTPS for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

Step 3 (Privileged mode) Change the listening port for ASDM.


http server enable
Example:
This example specifies that HTTPS ASDM sessions use port 444 on the outside interface. Clientless SSL
VPN is also enabled on the outside interface and uses the default port (443). With this configuration, remote
users initiate ASDM sessions by entering https://<outside_ip>:444.

hostname(config)# http server enable


hostname(config)# http 192.168.3.0 255.255.255.0 outside
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside

Use HTTPS for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions


Procedure

Step 1 Switch to clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


Enter webvpn.

Step 2 Enable Clientless SSL VPN sessions on the interface called outside.
Enter enable interface-name.

Example

hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# enable outside

What to do next
To see the current configuration, use the show running-config webvpn.
To clear the current configuration, use the clear configure webvpn.

Configure Support for Proxy Servers


The ASA can terminate HTTPS connections and forward HTTP and HTTPS requests to proxy servers. These
servers act as intermediaries between users and the public or private network. Requiring network access via
a proxy server that the organization controls provides another opportunity for filtering, to assure secure network
access and administrative control.
When configuring support for HTTP and HTTPS proxy services, you can assign preset credentials to send
with each request for basic authentication. You can also specify URLs to exclude from HTTP and HTTPS
requests.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
282
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Support for Proxy Servers

Before you begin


You can specify a proxy autoconfiguration (PAC) file to download from an HTTP proxy server, however,
you may not use proxy authentication when specifying the PAC file.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn
Step 2 Configure the ASA to use an external proxy server to handle HTTP and HTTPS requests.
http-proxy and https-proxy
Note Proxy NTLM authentication is not supported in http-proxy. Only proxy without authentication and
basic authentication are supported.

Step 3 Configure HTTP proxy.


http-proxy host [port] [exclude url] [username username {password password}]

Step 4 Configure HTTPS proxy.


https-proxy host [port] [exclude url] [username username {password password}]

Step 5 Set the PAC file URL.


http-proxy pac url

Step 6 (Optional) Exclude URLs from those that can be sent to the proxy server.
exclude

Step 7 Provide the hostname or IP address for the external proxy server.
host

Step 8 Download the proxy autoconfiguration file to the ASA using a JavaScript function which identifies a proxy
for each URL.
pac

Step 9 (Optional) (Only available if you specify a username) Accompanies each proxy request with a password to
provide basic, proxy authentication.
password

Step 10 Send the password to the proxy server with each HTTP or HTTPS request.
password

Step 11 (Optional) Provide the port number used by the proxy server. The default HTTP port is 80. The default HTTPS
port is 443. The ASA uses each of these ports if you do not specify an alternative value. The range is 1-65535.
port

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
283
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Support for Proxy Servers

Step 12 If you entered exclude, enter a URL or a comma-delimited list of several URLs to exclude from those that
can be sent to the proxy server. The string does not have a character limit, but the entire command cannot
exceed 512 characters. You can specify literal URLs or use the following wildcards:
• * to match any string, including slashes (/) and periods (.). You must accompany this wildcard with an
alphanumeric string.
• ? to match any single character, including slashes and periods.
• [x-y] to match any single character in the range of x and y, where x represents one character and y
represents another character in the ANSI character set.
• [!x-y] to match any single character that is not in the range.

Step 13 If you entered http-proxy pac, follow it with http:// and type the URL of the proxy autoconfiguration file.
(If you omit the http:// portion, the CLI ignores the command.)
Step 14 (Optional) Accompany each HTTP proxy request with a username for basic, proxy authentication. Only the
http-proxyhost command supports this keyword.
username

Step 15 Send the username to the proxy server with each HTTP or HTTPS request.
username

Step 16 Show how to configure use of an HTTP proxy server with an IP address of 209.165. 201.1 using the default
port, sending a username and password with each HTTP request.
Example:
hostname(config-webvpn)# http-proxy 209.165.201.1 user jsmith password
mysecretdonttell

Step 17 Show the same command, except when the ASA receives the specific URL www.example.com in an HTTP
request, it resolves the request instead of passing it on to the proxy server.
Example:
http-proxy 209.165.201.1 exclude www.example.com
hostname(config-webvpn)#
username jsmith password mysecretdonttell

Step 18 Show how to specify a URL to serve a proxy autoconfiguration file to the browser.
Example:
hostname(config-webvpn)# http-proxy pac http://www.example.com/pac

The ASA Clientless SSL VPN configuration supports only one http-proxy and one https-proxy command
each. For example, if one instance of the http-proxy command is already present in the running configuration
and you enter another, the CLI overwrites the previous instance.
Note Proxy NTLM authentication is not supported in http-proxy. Only proxy without authentication and
basic authentication is supported.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
284
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure SSL/TLS Encryption Protocols

Configure SSL/TLS Encryption Protocols


Port forwarding requires the Oracle Java Runtime Environment (JRE). Port forwarding does not work when
a user of Clientless SSL VPN connects with some SSL versions. Refer to the Supported VPN Platforms, Cisco
ASA 5500 Series for supported JRE versions.

Authenticate with Digital Certificates


SSL uses digital certificates for authentication. The ASA creates a self-signed SSL server certificate when it
boots; or you can install in the ASA an SSL certificate that has been issued in a PKI context. For HTTPS, this
certificate must then be installed on the client.

Restrictions of Digital Certificates Authentication


Email clients such as MS Outlook, MS Outlook Express, and Eudora lack the ability to access the certificate
store.
For more information on authentication and authorization using digital certificates, see the section on using
certificates and user login credentials in the general operations configuration guide.

Configure Browser Access to Client-Server Plug-ins


The Client-Server Plug-in table displays the plug-ins the ASA makes available to browsers in Clientless SSL
VPN sessions.
To add, change, or remove a plug-in, do one of the following:
• To add a plug-in, click Import. The Import Plug-ins dialog box opens.
• To remove a plug-in, choose it and click Delete.

About Installing Browser Plug-ins


A browser plug-in is a separate program that a Web browser invokes to perform a dedicated function, such
as connect a client to a server within the browser window. The ASA lets you import plug-ins for download
to remote browsers in Clientless SSL VPN sessions. Of course, Cisco tests the plug-ins it redistributes, and
in some cases, tests the connectivity of plug-ins we cannot redistribute. However, we do not recommend
importing plug-ins that support streaming media at this time.
The ASA does the following when you install a plug-in onto the flash device:
• (Cisco-distributed plug-ins only) Unpacks the jar file specified in the URL.
• Writes the file to the csco-config/97/plugin directory on the ASA file system.
• Populates the drop-down list next to the URL attributes in ASDM.
• Enables the plug-in for all future Clientless SSL VPN sessions, and adds a main menu option and an
option to the drop-down list next to the Address field of the portal page.

The following table shows the changes to the main menu and address field of the portal page when you add
the plug-ins described in the following sections.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
285
Clientless SSL VPN
About Installing Browser Plug-ins

Table 14: Effects of Plug-ins on the Clientless SSL VPN Portal Page

Plug-in Main Menu Option Added to Portal Address Field Option Added to
Page Portal Page

ica Citrix Client citrix://

rdp Terminal Servers rdp://

rdp2 Terminal Servers Vista rdp2://

ssh,telnet SSH ssh://

Telnet telnet://

vnc VNC Client vnc://

Note A secondary ASA obtains the plug-ins from the primary ASA.

When the user in a Clientless SSL VPN session clicks the associated menu option on the portal page, the
portal page displays a window to the interface and displays a help pane. The user can choose the protocol
displayed in the drop-down list and enter the URL in the Address field to establish a connection.

Note Some Java plug-ins may report a status of connected or online even when a session to the destination service
is not set up. The open-source plug-in reports the status, not the ASA.

Prerequisites for Installing Browser Plug-ins


• The plug-ins do not work if the security appliance configures the clientless session to use a proxy server.

Note The remote desktop protocol plug-in does not support load balancing with a
session broker. Because of the way the protocol handles the redirect from the
session broker, the connection fails. If a session broker is not used, the plug-in
works.

• The plug-ins support single sign-on (SSO). They use the same credentials entered to open the Clientless
SSL VPN session. Because the plug-ins do not support macro substitution, you do not have the options
to perform SSO on different fields such as the internal domain password or on an attribute on a RADIUS
or LDAP server.
• To configure SSO support for a plug-in, you install the plug-in, add a bookmark entry to display a link
to the server, and specify SSO support when adding the bookmark.
• The minimum access rights required for remote use belong to the guest privilege mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
286
Clientless SSL VPN
Requirements for Installing Browser Plug-ins

Requirements for Installing Browser Plug-ins


• Per the GNU General Public License (GPL), Cisco redistributes plug-ins without having made any
changes to them. Per the GPL, Cisco cannot directly enhance these plug-ins.
• Clientless SSL VPN must be enabled on the ASA to provide remote access to the plug-ins.
• A stateful failover does not retain sessions established using plug-ins. Users must reconnect following
a failover.
• Plug-ins require that ActiveX or Oracle Java Runtime Environment (JRE) is enabled on the browser.
There is no ActiveX version of the RDP plug-in for 64-bit browsers.

Set Up RDP Plug-in


To set up and use an RDP plug-in, you must add a new environment variable.

Procedure

Step 1 Right-click My Computer to access the System Properties, and choose the Advanced tab.
Step 2 On the Advanced tab, choose the environment variables button.
Step 3 In the new user variable dialog box, enter the RF_DEBUG variable.
Step 4 Verify the new Environment Variable in the user variables section.
Step 5 If you used the client computer with versions of Clientless SSL VPN before version 8.3, you must remove
the old Cisco Portforwarder Control. Go to the C:/WINDOWS/Downloaded Program Files directory, right-click
portforwarder control, and choose Remove.
Step 6 Clear all of the Internet Explorer browser cache.
Step 7 Launch your Clientless SSL VPN session and establish an RDP session with the RDP ActiveX Plug-in.
You can now observe events in the Windows Application Event viewer.

Prepare the Security Appliance for a Plug-in


Procedure

Step 1 Ensure that Clientless SSL VPN is enabled on an ASA interface.


Step 2 Install an SSL certificate onto the ASA interface to which remote users use a fully-qualified domain name
(FQDN) to connect.
Note Do not specify an IP address as the common name (CN) for the SSL certificate. The remote user
attempts to use the FQDN to communicate with the ASA. The remote PC must be able to use DNS
or an entry in the System32\drivers\etc\hosts file to resolve the FQDN.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
287
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure the ASA to Use the New HTML File

Configure the ASA to Use the New HTML File

Procedure

Step 1 Import the file and images as Web Content.


import webvpn webcontent <file> <url>
Example:
hostname# import webvpn webcontent /+CSCOU+/login.inc tftp://209.165.200.225/login.inc
!!!!* Web resource `+CSCOU+/login.inc' was successfully initialized
hostname#

Step 2 Export a customization template.


export webvpn customization <file> <URL>
Example:
hostname# export webvpn customization template tftp://209.165.200.225/sales_vpn_login
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
%INFO: Customization object 'Template' was exported to tftp://10.21.50.120/sales
_vpn_login

Step 3 Change the full customization mode tag in the file to enable.
Example:
This example supplies the URL of the login file stored in the ASA memory.
<full-customization>
<mode>enable</mode>
<url>/+CSCOU+/login.inc</url>
</full-customization>

Step 4 Import the file as a new customization object.


Example:
hostname# import webvpn customization sales_vpn_login tftp://10.21.50.120/sales_vpn_login$
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
%INFO: customization object 'sales_vpn_login' was successfully imported

Step 5 Apply the customization object to a Connection Profile (tunnel group).


Example:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group Sales webvpn-attributes
hostname(config-tunnel-webvpn)#customization sales_vpn_login

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
288
CHAPTER 14
Advanced Clientless SSL VPN Configuration
• Microsoft Kerberos Constrained Delegation Solution, on page 289
• Configure Application Profile Customization Framework, on page 295
• Encoding, on page 299
• Use Email over Clientless SSL VPN, on page 301

Microsoft Kerberos Constrained Delegation Solution


Many organizations want to authenticate their Clientless VPN users and extend their authentication credentials
seamlessly to web-based resources using authentication methods beyond what the ASA SSO feature can offer
today. With the growing demand to authenticate remote access users with smart cards and One-time Passwords
(OTPs), the SSO feature falls short in meeting that demand, because it forwards only conventional user
credentials, such as static username and password, to clientless web-based resources when authentication is
required.
For example, neither certificate- nor OTP-based authentication methods encompass a conventional username
and password necessary for the ASA to seamlessly perform SSO access to web-based resources. When
authenticating with a certificate, a username and password are not required for the ASA to extend to web-based
resources, making it an unsupported authentication method for SSO. On the other hand, OTP does include a
static username; however, the password is dynamic and will subsequently change throughout the VPN session.
In general, Web-based resources are configured to accept static usernames and passwords, thus also making
OTP an unsupported authentication method for SSO.
Microsoft’s Kerberos Constrained Delegation (KCD), a new feature introduced in software release 8.4 of the
ASA, provides access to Kerberos-protected Web applications in the private network. With this benefit, you
can seamlessly extend certificate- and OTP-based authentication methods to Web applications. Thus, with
SSO and KCD working together although independently, many organizations can now authenticate their
clientless VPN users and extend their authentication credentials seamlessly to Web applications using all
authentication methods supported by the ASA.

How KCD Works


Kerberos relies on a trusted third party to validate the digital identity of entities in a network. These entities
(such as users, host machines, and services running on hosts) are called principals and must be present in the
same domain. Instead of secret keys, Kerberos uses tickets to authenticate a client to a server. The ticket is
derived from the secret key and consists of the client’s identity, an encrypted session key, and flags. Each
ticket is issued by the key distribution center and has a set lifetime.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
289
Clientless SSL VPN
Authentication Flow with KCD

The Kerberos security system is a network authentication protocol used to authenticate entities (users,
computers, or applications) and protect network transmissions by scrambling the data so that only the device
that the information was intended for can decrypt it. You can configure KCD to provide Clientless SSL VPN
users with SSO access to any Web services protected by Kerberos. Examples of such Web services or
applications include Outlook Web Access (OWA), Sharepoint, and Internet Information Server (IIS).
Two extensions to the Kerberos protocol were implemented: protocol transition and constrained delegation.
These extensions allow the Clientless SSL VPN remote access users to access Kerberos-authenticated
applications in the private network.
Protocol transition provides you with increased flexibility and security by supporting different authentication
mechanisms at the user authentication level and by switching to the Kerberos protocol for security features
(such as mutual authentication and constrained delegation) in subsequent application layers. Constrained
delegation provides a way for domain administrators to specify and enforce application trust boundaries by
limiting where application services can act on a user’s behalf. This flexibility improves application security
designs by reducing the chance of compromise by an untrusted service.
For more information on constrained delegation, see RFC 1510 via the IETF website (http://www.ietf.org).

Authentication Flow with KCD


The following figure depicts the packet and process flow a user experiences directly and indirectly when
accessing resources trusted for delegation via the clientless portal. This process assumes that the following
tasks have been completed:
• Configured KCD on ASA
• Joined the Windows Active Directory and ensured services are trusted for delegation
• Delegated ASA as a member of the Windows Active Directory domain

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
290
Clientless SSL VPN
Authentication Flow with KCD

Figure 8: KCD Process

Note A clientless user session is authenticated by the ASA using the authentication mechanism configured for the
user. (In the case of smartcard credentials, ASA performs LDAP authorization with the userPrincipalName
from the digital certificate against the Windows Active Directory).

1. After successful authentication, the user logs in to the ASA clientless portal page. The user accesses a
Web service by entering a URL in the portal page or by clicking on the bookmark. If the Web service
requires authentication, the server challenges ASA for credentials and sends a list of authentication methods
supported by the server.

Note KCD for Clientless SSL VPN is supported for all authentication methods (RADIUS, RSA/SDI, LDAP, digital
certificates, and so on). Refer to the AAA Support table at
http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/security/asa/asa84/configuration/guide/access_aaa.html#wp1069492.

2. Based on the HTTP headers in the challenge, ASA determines whether the server requires Kerberos
authentication. (This is part of the SPNEGO mechanism.) If connecting to a backend server requires
Kerberos authentication, the ASA requests a service ticket for itself on behalf of the user from the key
distribution center.
3. The key distribution center returns the requested tickets to the ASA. Even though these tickets are passed
to the ASA, they contain the user’s authorization data.ASA requests a service ticket from the KCD for
the specific service that the user wants to access.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
291
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure the ASA for Cross-Realm Authentication

Note Steps 1 to 3 comprise protocol transition. After these steps, any user who authenticates to ASA using a
non-Kerberos authentication protocol is transparently authenticated to the key distribution center using
Kerberos.

4. ASA requests a service ticket from the key distribution center for the specific service that the user wants
to access.
5. The key distribution center returns a service ticket for the specific service to the ASA.
6. ASA uses the service ticket to request access to the Web service.
7. The Web server authenticates the Kerberos service ticket and grants access to the service. The appropriate
error message is displayed and requires acknowledgment if there is an authentication failure. If the Kerberos
authentication fails, the expected behavior is to fall back to basic authentication.

Configure the ASA for Cross-Realm Authentication


To configure the ASA for cross-realm authentication, you must use the following commands.

Procedure

Step 1 Join the Active Directory domain. A 10.1.1.10 domain controller (which is reachable inside the interface).
ntp hostname
Example:

hostname(config)# configure terminal


#Create an alias for the Domain Controller

hostname(config)# name 10.1.1.10 DC


#Configure the Name server

Step 2 Perform a lookup.


dns domain-lookup
dns server-group
Example:
This example shows a domain name of private.net and a service account on the domain controller using dcuser
as the username and dcuser123! as the password.

hostname(config)# ntp server DC


#Enable a DNS lookup by configuring the DNS server and Domain name
hostname(config)# dns domain-lookup inside
hostname(config)# dns server-group DefaultDNS
hostname(config-dns-server-group)# name-server DC
hostname(config-dns-server-group)# domain-name private.net

#Configure the AAA server group with Server and Realm

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
292
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure KCD

hostname(config)# aaa-server KerberosGroup protocol Kerberos


hostname(config-asa-server-group)# aaa-server KerberosGroup (inside) host DC
hostname(config-asa-server-group)# Kerberos-realm PRIVATE.NET

#Configure the Domain Join

hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# kcd-server KerberosGroup username dcuser password dcuser123!
hostname(config)#

Configure KCD
To have the ASA join a Windows Active Directory domain and return a success or failure status, perform
these steps.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn

Step 2 Configure the KCD.


kcd-server

Step 3 Specify the domain controller name and realm. The AAA server group must be a Kerberos type.
kcd-server aaa-server-group
Example:

ASA(config)# aaa-server KG protocol kerberos


ASA(config)# aaa-server KG (inside) host DC
ASA(config-aaa-server-host)# kerberos-realm test.edu
ASA(webvpn-config)# kcd-server KG username user1 password abc123
ASA(webvpn-config)# no kcd-server

Step 4 (Optional) Remove the specified behavior for the ASA.


no kcd-server

Step 5 (Optional) Reset to the internal state.


kcd-server reset

Step 6 Check for the presence of a KCD server and start the domain join process. The Active Directory username
and password are used only in EXEC mode and are not saved in the configuration.
Note Administrative privileges are required for initial join. A user with service-level privileges on the
domain controller will not get access.

kcd domain-join username <user> password <pass>

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
293
Clientless SSL VPN
Show KCD Status Information

user—Does not correspond to a specific administrative user but simply a user with service-level privileges to
add a device on the Windows domain controller.
pass—The password does not correspond to a specific password but simply a user with service-level password
privileges to add a device on the Windows domain controller

Step 7 Verify whether the KCD server command has a valid domain join status and then initiate a domain leave.
kcd domain-leave

Show KCD Status Information


Procedure

Command or Action Purpose


Step 1 With release 9.5.2, the following command show webvpn kcd
requests domain membership through ADI. At
a minimum, it returns the domain join status
(either joined or not joined) and the failure
reason (unknown, server unreachable, or invalid
permissions), if applicable.
Example:
ASA#show webvpn kcd
KCD-Server Name : DC
User : user1
Password : ****
KCD State : Joined
Failure Reason : Unknown

Debug KCD
The following command is used to control the output of the KCD specific debug messages, rather than to
control the level at which ADI emits syslogs, as was the case prior to version 9.5.2:
debug webvpn kcd

Show Cached Kerberos Tickets


To display all Kerberos tickets cached on the ASA, enter the following command:
show aaa kerberos[username user | host ip | hostname]

Example

ASA# show aaa kerberos

Default Principal Valid Starting Expires Service Principal


[email protected] 06/29/10 18:33:00 06/30/10 18:33:00
krbtgt/[email protected]

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
294
Clientless SSL VPN
Clear Cached Kerberos Tickets

[email protected] 06/29/10 17:33:00 06/30/10 17:33:00


asa$/[email protected]
[email protected] 06/29/10 17:33:00 06/30/10 17:33:00
http/[email protected]

ASA# show aaa kerberos username kcduser

Default Principal Valid Starting Expires Service Principal


[email protected] 06/29/10 17:33:00 06/30/10 17:33:00
asa$/[email protected]
[email protected] 06/29/10 17:33:00 06/30/10 17:33:00
http/[email protected]

ASA# show aaa kerberos host owa.example.com

Default Principal Valid Starting Expires Service Principal


[email protected] 06/29/10 06/30/10 17:33:00

Clear Cached Kerberos Tickets


To clear all Kerberos ticket information on the ASA, enter the following command:
clear aaa kerberos [ username user | host ip | hostname]
• user—Used to clear the Kerberos tickets of a specific user
• hostname—Used to clear the Kerberos tickets of a specific host

Requirements for Microsoft Kerberos


In order for the kcd-server command to function, the ASA must establish a trust relationship between the
source domain (the domain where the ASA resides) and the target or resource domain (the domain where
the Web services reside). The ASA, using its unique format, crosses the certification path from the source to
the destination domain and acquires the necessary tickets on behalf of the remote access user to access the
services.
This crossing of the certificate path is called cross-realm authentication. During each phase of cross-realm
authentication, the ASA relies on the credentials at a particular domain and the trust relationship with the
subsequent domain.

Configure Application Profile Customization Framework


Clientless SSL VPN includes an Application Profile Customization Framework (APCF) option that lets the
ASA handle non-standard applications and Web resources so they display correctly over a Clientless SSL
VPN connection. An APCF profile contains a script that specifies when (pre, post), where (header, body,
request, response), and what (data) to transform for a particular application. The script is in XML and uses
sed (stream editor) syntax to transform strings/text.
You can configure and run multiple APCF profiles in parallel on an ASA. Within an APCF profile script,
multiple APCF rules can apply. The ASA processes the oldest rule first, based on configuration history, the
next oldest rule next.
You can store APCF profiles on the ASA flash memory, or on an HTTP, HTTPS, or TFTP server.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
295
Clientless SSL VPN
Manage APCF Packets

We recommend that you configure an APCF profile only with the assistance of Cisco personnel.

Manage APCF Packets


Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn

Step 2 Identify and locate an APCF profile to load on the ASA.


apcf
Example:
This example shows how to enable an APCF profile named apcf1.xml, located in flash memory and how to
enable an APCF profile named apcf2.xml, located on an HTTPS server called myserver, port 1440, with the
path being /apcf.
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# apcf flash:/apcf/apcf1.xml

hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# apcf https://myserver:1440/apcf/apcf2.xml

APCF Syntax
APCF profiles use XML format, and sed script syntax, with the XML tags in the following table.

Guidelines for APCF


Misuse of an APCF profile can result in reduced performance and undesired rendering of content. In most
cases, Cisco Engineering supplies APCF profiles to solve specific application rendering issues.

Table 15: APCF XML Tags

Tag Use

<APCF>...</APCF> The mandatory root element that opens any APCF


XML file.

<version>1.0</version> The mandatory tag that specifies the APCF


implementation version. Currently the only version
is 1.0.

<application>...</application> The mandatory tag that wraps the body of the XML
description.

<id> text </id> The mandatory tag that describes this particular APCF
functionality.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
296
Clientless SSL VPN
APCF Syntax

Tag Use

<apcf-entities>...</apcf-entities> The mandatory tag that wraps a single or multiple


APCF entities.

<js-object>…</js-object> One of these tags specifies type of content or the stage


at which the APCF processing should take place.
<html-object>…</html-object>
<process-request-header>...</process-request-header>
<process-response-header>...</process-response-header>
<preprocess-response-body>...</preprocess-response-body>
<postprocess-response-body>...</postprocess-response-body>

<conditions>… </conditions> A child element of the pre/post-process tags that


specifies criteria for processing such as:
• http-version (such as 1.1, 1.0, 0.9)
• http-method (get, put, post, webdav)
• http-scheme (“http/”, “https/”, other)
• server-regexp regular expression containing
("a".."z" | "A".."Z" | "0".."9" | ".-_*[]?")
• server-fnmatch (regular expression containing
("a".."z" | "A".."Z" | "0".."9" | ".-_*[]?+()\{},"),
• user-agent-regexp
• user-agent-fnmatch
• request-uri-regexp
• request-uri-fnmatch
• If more than one of condition tags is present, the
ASA performs a logical AND for all tags.

<action> … </action> Wraps one or more actions to perform on the content


under specified conditions; you can use the following
tags to define these actions (shown below):
• <do>
• <sed-script>
• <rewrite-header>
• <add-header>
• <delete-header>

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
297
Clientless SSL VPN
APCF Syntax

Tag Use

<do>…</do> Child element of the action tag used to define one of


the following actions:
• <no-rewrite/>—Do not mangle the content
received from the remote server.
• <no-toolbar/>—Do not insert the toolbar.
• <no-gzip/>—Do not compress the content.
• <force-cache/>—Preserve the original caching
instructions.
• <force-no-cache/>—Make object non-cacheable.
• < downgrade-http-version-on-backend>—Use
HTTP/1.0 when sending the request to remote
server.

<sed-script> TEXT </sed-script> Child element of the action tag used to change the
content of text-based objects. The Text must be a valid
Sed script. The <sed-script> applies to the
<conditions> tag defined before it.

<rewrite-header></rewrite-header> Child element of the action tag. Changes the value of


the HTTP header specified in the child element
<header> tag shown below.

<add-header></add-header> Child element of the action tag used to add a new


HTTP header specified in the child element <header>
tag shown below.

<delete-header></delete-header> Child element of the action tag used to delete the


specified HTTP header specified by the child element
<header> tag shown below.

<header></header> Specifies the name HTTP header to be rewritten,


added, or deleted. For example, the following tag
changes the value of the HTTP header named
Connection:

<rewrite-header>
<header>Connection</header>
<value>close</value>
</rewrite-header>

Configuration Examples for APCF

<APCF>
<version>1.0</version>
<application>
<id>Do not compress content from example.com</id>
<apcf-entities>

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
298
Clientless SSL VPN
Encoding

<process-request-header>
<conditions>
<server-fnmatch>*.example.com</server-fnmatch>
</conditions>
<action>
<do><no-gzip/></do>
</action>
</process-request-header>
</apcf-entities>
</application>
</APCF>

<APCF>
<version>1.0</version>
<application>
<id>Change MIME type for all .xyz objects</id>
<apcf-entities>
<process-response-header>
<conditions>
<request-uri-fnmatch>*.xyz</request-uri-fnmatch>
</conditions>
<action>
<rewrite-header>
<header>Content-Type</header>
<value>text/html</value>
</rewrite-header>
</action>
</process-response-header>
</apcf-entities>
</application>
</APCF>

Encoding
Character encoding, also called “character coding” and “a character set,” is the pairing of raw data (such as
0s and 1s) with characters to represent the data. The language determines the character encoding method to
use. Some languages use a single method, while others do not. Usually, the geographic region determines the
default encoding method used by the browser, but the remote user can change it. The browser can also detect
the encoding specified on the page, and render the document accordingly.
The encoding attribute lets you specify the value of the character-encoding method used on the portal page
to ensure that the browser renders it properly, regardless of the region in which the user is using the browser,
and regardless of any changes made to the browser.
By default, the ASA applies the “Global Encoding Type” to pages from Common Internet File System servers.
The mapping of CIFS servers to their appropriate character encoding, globally with the “Global Encoding
Type” attribute, and individually with the file-encoding exceptions displayed in the table, provides for the
accurate handling and display of CIFS pages when the proper rendering of filenames or directory paths, as
well as pages, is an issue.

View or Specify Character Encoding


With encoding, you can view or specify the character encoding for Clientless SSL VPN portal pages.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
299
Clientless SSL VPN
View or Specify Character Encoding

Procedure

Step 1 Global Encoding Type determines the character encoding that all Clientless SSL VPN portal pages inherit
except for those from the CIFS servers listed in the table. You can type the string or choose one of the options
from the drop-down list, which contains the most common values, as follows:
• big5
• gb2312
• ibm-850
• iso-8859-1
• shift_jis
Note If you are using Japanese Shift_jis Character encoding, click Do Not Specify in the Font Family
area of the associated Select Page Font pane to remove the font family.

• unicode
• windows-1252
• none
Note If you click none or specify a value that the browser on the Clientless SSL VPN session does
not support, it uses its own default encoding.

You can type a string consisting of up to 40 characters, and equal to one of the valid character sets identified
in http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets. You can use either the name or the alias of a character set
listed on that page. The string is case-insensitive. The command interpreter converts upper-case to lower-case
when you save the ASA configuration.

Step 2 Enter the name or IP address of a CIFS server for which the encoding requirement differs from the “Global
Encoding Type” attribute setting. The ASA retains the case you specify, although it ignores the case when
matching the name to a server.
Step 3 Choose the character encoding that the CIFS server should provide for Clientless SSL VPN portal pages. You
can type the string, or choose one from the drop-down list, which contains only the most common values, as
follows:
• big5
• gb2312
• ibm-850
• iso-8859-1
• shift_jis
Note If you are using Japanese Shift_jis Character encoding, click Do Not Specify in the Font Family
area of the associated Select Page Font pane to remove the font family.

• unicode
• windows-1252

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
300
Clientless SSL VPN
Use Email over Clientless SSL VPN

• none

If you click none or specify a value that the browser on the Clientless SSL VPN session does not support, it
uses its own default encoding.
You can type a string consisting of up to 40 characters, and equal to one of the valid character sets identified
in http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets. You can use either the name or the alias of a character set
listed on that page. The string is case-insensitive. The command interpreter converts upper-case to lower-case
when you save the ASA configuration.

Use Email over Clientless SSL VPN


Configure Web email: MS Outlook Web App
The ASA supports Microsoft Outlook Web App to Exchange Server 2010 and Microsoft Outlook Web Access
to Exchange Server 2007, 2003, and 2000.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter the URL of the email service into the address field or click an associated bookmark in the Clientless
SSL VPN session.
Step 2 When prompted, enter the email server username in the format domain\username.
Step 3 Enter the email password.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
301
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Web email: MS Outlook Web App

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
302
CHAPTER 15
Policy Groups
• Create and Apply Clientless SSL VPN Policies for Accessing Resources, on page 303
• Connection Profile Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN, on page 303
• Group Policy and User Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN, on page 304
• Smart Tunnel Access, on page 320
• Clientless SSL VPN Capture Tool, on page 331
• Configure Portal Access Rules, on page 332
• Optimize Clientless SSL VPN Performance, on page 333

Create and Apply Clientless SSL VPN Policies for Accessing


Resources
Creating and applying policies for Clientless SSL VPN that govern access to resources at an internal server
requires you to assign group policies.
Assigning users to group policies simplifies the configuration by letting you apply policies to many users.
You can use an internal authentication server on the ASA or an external RADIUS or LDAP server to assign
users to group policies. See Chapter 4, “Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users” for a thorough
explanation of ways to simplify configuration with group policies.

Connection Profile Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN


The following table provides a list of connection profile attributes that are specific to Clientless SSL VPN.
In addition to these attributes, you configure general connection profile attributes common to all VPN
connections. For step-by-step information on configuring connection profiles, see Chapter 4, “Connection
Profiles, Group Policies, and Users”.

Note In earlier releases, “connection profiles” were known as “tunnel groups.” You configure a connection profile
with tunnel-group commands. This chapter often uses these terms interchangeably.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
303
Clientless SSL VPN
Group Policy and User Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN

Table 16: Connection Profile Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN

Command Function

authentication Sets the authentication method.

customization Identifies the name of a previously defined customization to apply.

exit Exits from tunnel-group Clientless SSL VPN attribute configuration mode.

nbns-server Identifies the name of the NetBIOS Name Service server (nbns-server) to use for
CIFS name resolution.

group-alias Specifies the alternate names by which the server can refer to a connection profile.

group-url Identifies one or more group URLs. If you establish URLs with this attribute, this
group is selected automatically for users when they access using these URLS.

dns-group Identifies the DNS server group that specifies the DNS server name, domain name,
name server, number of retries, and timeout values.

help Provides help for tunnel group configuration commands.

hic-fail-group-policy Specifies a VPN feature policy if you use the Cisco Secure Desktop Manager to set
the Group-Based Policy attribute to “Use Failure Group-Policy” or “Use Success
Group-Policy, if criteria match.”

no Removes an attribute value pair.

override-svc-download Overrides downloading the group-policy or username attributes configured for


downloading the AnyConnect VPN client to the remote user.

pre-fill-username Configures username-to-certificate binding on this tunnel group.

proxy-auth Identifies this tunnel-group as a specific proxy authentication tunnel group.

radius-reject-message Enables the display of the RADIUS reject message on the login screen when
authentication is rejected.

secondary-pre-fill-username Configures the secondary username-to-certificate binding on this tunnel group.

without-csd Switched off CSD for a tunnel group.

Group Policy and User Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN


The following table provides a list of group policy and user attributes for Clientless SSL VPN that. For
step-by-step instructions on configuring group policy and user attributes, see Configure Group Policy Attributes
for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions, on page 306 or Configure Clientless SSL VPN Access for Specific Users,
on page 313.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
304
Clientless SSL VPN
Group Policy and User Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN

Command Function

activex-relay Lets a user who has established a Clientless SSL VPN session use the browser to
launch Microsoft Office applications. The applications use the session to download
and upload ActiveX. The ActiveX relay remains in force until the Clientless SSL
VPN session closes.

auto-sign-on Sets values for auto sign-on, which requires that the user enter username and password
credentials only once for a Clientless SSL VPN connection.

customization Assigns a customization object to a group policy or user.

deny-message Specifies the message delivered to a remote user who logs into Clientless SSL VPN
successfully, but has no VPN privileges.

file-browsing Enables CIFS file browsing for file servers and shares. Browsing requires NBNS
(Master Browser or WINS).

file-entry Allows users to enter file server names to access.

filter Sets the name of the webtype access list.

hidden-shares Controls the visibility of hidden shares for CIFS files.

homepage Sets the URL of the Web page that displays upon login.

html-content-filter Configures the content and objects to filter from the HTML for this group policy.

http-comp Configures compression.

http-proxy Configures the ASA to use an external proxy server to handle HTTP requests.
Note Proxy NTLM authentication is not supported in http-proxy. Only proxy
without authentication and basic authentication are supported.

keep-alive-ignore Sets the maximum object size to ignore for updating the session timer.

port-forward Applies a list of Clientless SSL VPN TCP ports to forward. The user interface displays
the applications in this list.

post-max-size Sets the maximum object size to post.

smart-tunnel Configures a list of programs and several smart tunnel parameters to use smart tunnel.

storage-objects Configures storage objects for the data stored between sessions.

svc Configures SSL VPN Client attributes.

unix-auth-gid Sets the UNIX group ID.

unix-auth-uid Sets the UNIX user ID.

url-entry Controls the ability of the user to enter any HTTP/HTTPS URL.

url-list Applies a list of servers and URLs that Clientless SSL VPN portal page displays for
end-user access.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
305
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Group Policy Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions

Command Function

user-storage Configures a location for storing user data between sessions.

Configure Group Policy Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions


Clientless SSL VPN lets users establish a secure, remote-access VPN tunnel to the ASA using a web browser.
There is no need for either a software or hardware client. Clientless SSL VPN provides easy access to a broad
range of web resources and web-enabled applications from almost any computer that can reach HTTPS Internet
sites. Clientless SSL VPN uses SSL and its successor, TLS1, to provide a secure connection between remote
users and specific, supported internal resources that you configure at a central site. The ASA recognizes
connections that need to be proxied, and the HTTP server interacts with the authentication subsystem to
authenticate users. By default, clientless SSL VPN is disabled.
You can customize a configuration of clientless SSL VPN for specific internal group policies.

Note The webvpn mode that you enter from global configuration mode lets you configure global settings for
clientless SSL VPN sessions. The webvpn mode described in this section, which you enter from group-policy
configuration mode, lets you customize a configuration of group policies specifically for clientless SSL VPN
sessions.

In group-policy webvpn configuration mode, you can specify whether to inherit or customize the following
parameters, each of which is described in the subsequent sections:
• customizations
• html-content-filter
• homepage
• filter
• url-list
• port-forward
• port-forward-name
• auto-signon
• deny message
• AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client
• keep-alive ignore
• HTTP compression

In many instances, you define the webvpn attributes as part of configuring clientless SSL VPN, then you
apply those definitions to specific groups when you configure the group-policy webvpn attributes. Enter
group-policy webvpn configuration mode by using the webvpn command in group-policy configuration mode.
Webvpn commands for group policies define access to files, URLs and TCP applications over clientless SSL
VPN sessions. They also identify ACLs and types of traffic to filter. Clientless SSL VPN is disabled by default.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
306
Clientless SSL VPN
Specify a Deny Message

To remove all commands entered in group-policy webvpn configuration mode, enter the no form of this
command. These webvpn commands apply to the username or group policy from which you configure them.
webvpn
no webvpn
The following example shows how to enter group-policy webvpn configuration mode for the group policy
named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Specify a Deny Message


You can specify the message delivered to a remote user who logs into a clientless SSL VPN session successfully,
but has no VPN privileges, by entering the deny-message command in group-policy webvpn configuration
mode:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# deny-message value "message"


hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no deny-message value "message"
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# deny-message none

The no deny-message value command removes the message string, so that the remote user does not receive
a message.
The no deny-message none command removes the attribute from the connection profile policy configuration.
The policy inherits the attribute value.
The message can be up to 491 alphanumeric characters long, including special characters, spaces, and
punctuation, but not counting the enclosing quotation marks. The text appears on the remote user’s browser
upon login. When typing the string in the deny-message value command, continue typing even if the command
wraps.
The default deny message is: “Login was successful, but because certain criteria have not been met or due to
some specific group policy, you do not have permission to use any of the VPN features. Contact your IT
administrator for more information.”
The first command in the following example creates an internal group policy named group2. The subsequent
commands modify the attributes, including the webvpn deny message associated with that policy.

hostname(config)# group-policy group2 internal


hostname(config)# group-policy group2 attributes
hostname(config-group)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# deny-message value "Your login credentials are OK. However,
you have not been granted rights to use the VPN features. Contact your administrator for
more information."
hostname(config-group-webvpn)

Configure Group Policy Filter Attributes for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions
Specify whether to filter Java, ActiveX, images, scripts, and cookies from clientless SSL VPN sessions for
this group policy by using the html-content-filter command in webvpn mode. HTML filtering is disabled
by default.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
307
Clientless SSL VPN
Specify the User Home Page

To remove a content filter, enter the no form of this command. To remove all content filters, including a null
value created by issuing the html-content-filter command with the none keyword, enter the no form of this
command without arguments. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy. To
prevent inheriting an html content filter, enter the html-content-filter command with the none keyword.
Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting.

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# html-content-filter {java | images | scripts |


cookies | none}

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no html-content-filter [java | images | scripts |


cookies | none]

The table below describes the meaning of the keywords used in this command.

Table 17: filter Command Keywords

Keyword Meaning

cookies Removes cookies from images, providing limited ad


filtering and privacy.

images Removes references to images (removes <IMG> tags).

java Removes references to Java and ActiveX (removes


<EMBED>, <APPLET>, and <OBJECT> tags).

none Indicates that there is no filtering. Sets a null value,


thereby disallowing filtering. Prevents inheriting
filtering values.

scripts Removes references to scripting (removes <SCRIPT>


tags).

The following example shows how to set filtering of JAVA and ActiveX, cookies, and images for the group
policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# html-content-filter java cookies images
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Specify the User Home Page


Specify a URL for the web page that displays when a user in this group logs in by using the homepage
command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode. There is no default home page.
To remove a configured home page, including a null value created by issuing the homepage none command,
enter the no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy.
To prevent inheriting a home page, enter the homepage none command.
The none keyword indicates that there is no home page for clientless SSL VPN sessions. It sets a null value,
thereby disallowing a home page and prevents inheriting an home page.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
308
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Auto-Signon

The url-string variable following the keyword value provides a URL for the home page. The string must
begin with either http:// or https://.

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# homepage {value url-string | none}


hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no homepage
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Configure Auto-Signon
The auto-signon command is a single sign-on method for users of clientless SSL VPN sessions. It passes the
login credentials (username and password) to internal servers for authentication using NTLM authentication,
basic authentication, or both. Multiple auto-signon commands can be entered and are processed according to
the input order (early commands take precedence).
You can use the auto-signon feature in three modes: webvpn configuration, webvpn group configuration, or
webvpn username configuration mode. The typical precedence behavior applies where username supersedes
group, and group supersedes global. The mode you choose depends upon the desired scope of authentication.
To disable auto-signon for a particular user to a particular server, use the no form of the command with the
original specification of IP block or URI. To disable authentication to all servers, use the no form without
arguments. The no option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy.
The following example, entered in group-policy webvpn configuration mode, configures auto-signon for the
user named anyuser, using basic authentication, to servers with IP addresses ranging from 10.1.1.0 to 10.1.1.255:
The following example commands configure auto-signon for users of clientless SSL VPN sessions, using
either basic or NTLM authentication, to servers defined by the URI mask https://*.example.com/*:

hostname(config)# group-policy ExamplePolicy attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# auto-signon allow uri https://*.example.com/*
auth-type all
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

The following example commands configure auto-signon for users of clientless SSL VPN sessions, using
either basic or NTLM authentication, to the server with the IP address 10.1.1.0, using subnet mask
255.255.255.0:

hostname(config)# group-policy ExamplePolicy attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# auto-signon allow ip 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
auth-type all
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Specify the ACL for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions


Specify the name of the ACL to use for clientless SSL VPN sessions for this group policy or username by
using the filter command in webvpn mode. Clientless SSL VPN ACLs do not apply until you enter the filter
command to specify them.
To remove the ACL, including a null value created by issuing the filter none command, enter the no form of
this command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting
filter values, enter the filter value none command.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
309
Clientless SSL VPN
Apply a URL List

ACLs for clientless SSL VPN sessions do not apply until you enter the filter command to specify them.
You configure ACLs to permit or deny various types of traffic for this group policy. You then enter the filter
command to apply those ACLs for clientless SSL VPN traffic.

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# filter {value ACLname | none}


hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no filter

The none keyword indicates that there is no webvpntype ACL. It sets a null value, thereby disallowing an
ACL and prevents inheriting an ACL from another group policy.
The ACLname string following the keyword value provides the name of the previously configured ACL.

Note Clientless SSL VPN sessions do not use ACLs defined in the vpn-filter command.

The following example shows how to set a filter that invokes an ACL named acl_in for the group policy
named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# filter acl_in
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Apply a URL List


You can specify a list of URLs to appear on the clientless SSL VPN home page for a group policy. First, you
must create one or more named lists by entering the url-list command in global configuration mode. To apply
a list of servers and URLs for clientless SSL VPN sessions to a particular group policy, allowing access to
the URLs in a list for a specific group policy, use the name of the list or lists you create there with the url-list
command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode. There is no default URL list.
To remove a list, including a null value created by using the url-list none command, use the no form of this
command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a
URL list, use the url-list none command. Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# url-list {value name | none} [index]


hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no url-list

The table below shows the url-list command parameters and their meanings.

Table 18: url-list Command Keywords and Variables

Parameter Meaning

index Indicates the display priority on the home page.

none Sets a null value for url lists. Prevents inheriting a list
from a default or specified group policy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
310
Clientless SSL VPN
Enable ActiveX Relay for a Group Policy

Parameter Meaning

value name Specifies the name of a previously configured list of


urls. To configure such a list, use the url-list
command in global configuration mode.

The following example sets a URL list called FirstGroupURLs for the group policy named FirstGroup and
specifies that this should be the first URL list displayed on the homepage:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# url-list value FirstGroupURLs 1
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Enable ActiveX Relay for a Group Policy


ActiveX Relay lets a user who has established a Clientless SSL VPN session use the browser to launch
Microsoft Office applications. The applications use the session to download and upload Microsoft Office
documents. The ActiveX relay remains in force until the Clientless SSL VPN session closes.
To enable or disable ActiveX controls on Clientless SSL VPN sessions, enter the following command in
group-policy webvpn configuration mode:
activex-relay {enable | disable}
To inherit the activex-relay command from the default group policy, enter the following command:
no activex-relay
The following commands enable ActiveX controls on clientless SSL VPN sessions associated with a given
group policy:

hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# activex-relay enable
hostname(config-group-webvpn)

Enable Application Access on Clientless SSL VPN Sessions for a Group Policy
To enable application access for this group policy, enter the port-forward command in group-policy webvpn
configuration mode. Port forwarding is disabled by default.
Before you can enter the port-forward command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode to enable
application access, you must define a list of applications that you want users to be able to use in a clientless
SSL VPN session. Enter the port-forward command in global configuration mode to define this list.
To remove the port forwarding attribute from the group-policy configuration, including a null value created
by issuing the port-forward none command, enter the no form of this command. The no option allows
inheritance of a list from another group policy. To prevent inheriting a port forwarding list, enter the
port-forward command with the none keyword. The none keyword indicates that there is no filtering. It sets
a null value, thereby disallowing a filtering, and prevents inheriting filtering values.
The syntax of the command is as follows:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward {value listname | none}

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
311
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure the Port-Forwarding Display Name

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no port-forward

The listname string following the keyword value identifies the list of applications users of clientless SSL
VPN sessions can access. Enter the port-forward command in webvpn configuration mode to define the list.
Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting.
The following example shows how to set a port-forwarding list called ports1 for the internal group policy
named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup internal attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward value ports1
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Configure the Port-Forwarding Display Name


Configure the display name that identifies TCP port forwarding to end users for a particular user or group
policy by using the port-forward-name command in group-policy webvpn configuration mode. To delete
the display name, including a null value created by using the port-forward-name none command, enter the
no form of the command. The no option restores the default name, Application Access. To prevent a display
name, enter the port-forward none command. The syntax of the command is as follows:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward-name {value name | none}


hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no port-forward-name

The following example shows how to set the name, Remote Access TCP Applications, for the internal group
policy named FirstGroup:

hostname(config)# group-policy FirstGroup internal attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# port-forward-name value Remote Access TCP
Applications
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Configure the Maximum Object Size to Ignore for Updating the Session Timer
Network devices exchange short keepalive messages to ensure that the virtual circuit between them is still
active. The length of these messages can vary. The keep-alive-ignore command lets you tell the ASA to
consider all messages that are less than or equal to the specified size as keepalive messages and not as traffic
when updating the session timer. The range is 0 through 900 KB. The default is 4 KB.
To specify the upper limit of the HTTP/HTTPS traffic, per transaction, to ignore, use the keep-alive-ignore
command in group-policy attributes webvpn configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# keep-alive-ignore size


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

The no form of the command removes this specification from the configuration:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no keep-alive-ignore

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
312
Clientless SSL VPN
Specify HTTP Compression

hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

The following example sets the maximum size of objects to ignore as 5 KB:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# keep-alive-ignore 5
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Specify HTTP Compression


Enable compression of http data over a clientless SSL VPN session for a specific group or user by entering
the http-comp command in the group policy webvpn mode.

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# http-comp {gzip | none}


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

To remove the command from the configuration and cause the value to be inherited, use the no form of the
command:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no http-comp {gzip | none}


hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

The syntax of this command is as follows:


• gzip—Specifies compression is enabled for the group or user. This is the default value.
• none—Specifies compression is disabled for the group or user.

For clientless SSL VPN sessions, the compression command configured from global configuration mode
overrides the http-comp command configured in group policy and username webvpn modes.
In the following example, compression is disabled for the group-policy sales:

hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# http-comp none
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Configure Clientless SSL VPN Access for Specific Users


The following sections describe how to customize a configuration for specific users of clientless SSL VPN
sessions. Enter username webvpn configuration mode by using the webvpn command in username configuration
mode. Clientless SSL VPN lets users establish a secure, remote-access VPN tunnel to the ASA using a web
browser. There is no need for either a software or hardware client. Clientless SSL VPN provides easy access
to a broad range of web resources and web-enabled applications from almost any computer that can reach
HTTPS Internet sites. Clientless SSL VPN uses SSL and its successor, TLS1, to provide a secure connection
between remote users and specific, supported internal resources that you configure at a central site. The ASA
recognizes connections that need to be proxied, and the HTTP server interacts with the authentication subsystem
to authenticate users.
The username webvpn configuration mode commands define access to files, URLs and TCP applications over
clientless SSL VPN sessions. They also identify ACLs and types of traffic to filter. Clientless SSL VPN is

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
313
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Clientless SSL VPN Access for Specific Users

disabled by default. These webvpn commands apply only to the username from which you configure them.
Notice that the prompt changes, indicating that you are now in username webvpn configuration mode.

hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

To remove all commands entered in username webvpn configuration mode, use the no form of this command:

hostname(config-username)# no webvpn
hostname(config-username)#

You do not need to configure clientless SSL VPN to use e-mail proxies.

Note The webvpn mode that you enter from global configuration mode lets you configure global settings for
clientless SSL VPN sessions. The username webvpn configuration mode described in this section, which you
enter from username mode, lets you customize the configuration of specific users specifically for clientless
SSL VPN sessions.

In username webvpn configuration mode, you can customize the following parameters, each of which is
described in the subsequent steps:
• customizations
• deny message
• html-content-filter
• homepage
• filter
• url-list
• port-forward
• port-forward-name
• auto-signon
• AnyConnect Secure Mobility Client
• keep-alive ignore
• HTTP compression

The following example shows how to enter username webvpn configuration mode for the username anyuser
attributes:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
314
Clientless SSL VPN
Specify the Content/Objects to Filter from the HTML

Specify the Content/Objects to Filter from the HTML


To filter Java, ActiveX, images, scripts, and cookies for clientless SSL VPN sessions for this user, enter the
html-content-filter command in username webvpn configuration mode. To remove a content filter, enter the
no form of this command. To remove all content filters, including a null value created by issuing the
html-content-filter none command, enter the no form of this command without arguments. The no option
allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. To prevent inheriting an HTML content filter, enter the
html-content-filter none command. HTML filtering is disabled by default.
Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting.

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# html-content-filter {java | images | scripts |


cookies | none}

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no html-content-filter [java | images | scripts


| cookies | none]

The keywords used in this command are as follows:


• cookies—Removes cookies from images, providing limited ad filtering and privacy.
• images—Removes references to images (removes <IMG> tags).
• java—Removes references to Java and ActiveX (removes <EMBED>, <APPLET>, and <OBJECT>
tags).
• none—Indicates that there is no filtering. Sets a null value, thereby disallowing filtering. Prevents
inheriting filtering values.
• scripts—Removes references to scripting (removes <SCRIPT> tags).

The following example shows how to set filtering of JAVA and ActiveX, cookies, and images for the user
named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# html-content-filter java cookies images
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

Specify the User Home Page


To specify a URL for the web page that displays when this user logs into clientless SSL VPN session, enter
the homepage command in username webvpn configuration mode. To remove a configured home page,
including a null value created by issuing the homepage none command, enter the no form of this command.
The no option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. To prevent inheriting a home page, enter
the homepage none command.
The none keyword indicates that there is no clientless SSL VPN home page. It sets a null value, thereby
disallowing a home page and prevents inheriting a home page.
The url-string variable following the keyword value provides a URL for the home page. The string must
begin with either http:// or https://.
There is no default home page.

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# homepage {value url-string | none}

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
315
Clientless SSL VPN
Specify a Deny Message

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no homepage
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

The following example shows how to specify www.example.com as the home page for the user named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# homepage value www.example.com
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

Specify a Deny Message


You can specify the message delivered to a remote user who logs into clientless SSL VPN session successfully,
but has no VPN privileges by entering the deny-message command in username webvpn configuration mode:

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# deny-message value "message"


hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no deny-message value "message"
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# deny-message none

The no deny-message value command removes the message string, so that the remote user does not receive
a message.
The no deny-message none command removes the attribute from the connection profile policy configuration.
The policy inherits the attribute value.
The message can be up to 491 alphanumeric characters long, including special characters, spaces, and
punctuation, but not counting the enclosing quotation marks. The text appears on the remote user’s browser
upon login. When typing the string in the deny-message value command, continue typing even if the command
wraps.
The default deny message is: “Login was successful, but because certain criteria have not been met or due to
some specific group policy, you do not have permission to use any of the VPN features. Contact your IT
administrator for more information.”
The first command in the following example enters username mode and configures the attributes for the user
named anyuser. The subsequent commands enter username webvpn configuration mode and modify the deny
message associated with that user.

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# deny-message value "Your login credentials are OK. However,
you have not been granted rights to use the VPN features. Contact your administrator for
more information."
hostname(config-username-webvpn)

Apply a URL List


You can specify a list of URLs to appear on the home page for a user who has established a clientless SSL
VPN session. First, you must create one or more named lists by entering the url-list command in global
configuration mode. To apply a list of servers and URLs to a particular user of clientless SSL VPN, enter the
url-list command in username webvpn configuration mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
316
Clientless SSL VPN
Enable ActiveX Relay for a User

To remove a list, including a null value created by using the url-list none command, enter the no form of this
command. The no option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy. To prevent inheriting a url list,
enter the url-list none command.

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# url-list {listname displayname url | none}


hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no url-list

The keywords and variables used in this command are as follows:


• displayname—Specifies a name for the URL. This name appears on the portal page in the clientless SSL
VPN session.
• listname—Identifies a name by which to group URLs.
• none—Indicates that there is no list of URLs. Sets a null value, thereby disallowing a URL list. Prevents
inheriting URL list values.
• url—Specifies a URL that users of clientless SSL VPN can access.

There is no default URL list.


Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting.
The following example shows how to set a URL list called AnyuserURLs for the user named anyuser:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# url-list value AnyuserURLs
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

Enable ActiveX Relay for a User


ActiveX Relay lets a user who has established a Clientless SSL VPN session use the browser to launch
Microsoft Office applications. The applications use the session to download and upload Microsoft Office
documents. The ActiveX relay remains in force until the Clientless SSL VPN session closes.
To enable or disable ActiveX controls on Clientless SSL VPN sessions, enter the following command in
username webvpn configuration mode:
activex-relay {enable | disable}
To inherit the activex-relay command from the group policy, enter the following command:
no activex-relay
The following commands enable ActiveX controls on Clientless SSL VPN sessions associated with a given
username:

hostname(config-username-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# activex-relay enable
hostname(config-username-webvpn)

Enable Application Access for Clientless SSL VPN Sessions


To enable application access for this user, enter the port-forward command in username webvpn configuration
mode. Port forwarding is disabled by default.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
317
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure the Port-Forwarding Display Name

To remove the port forwarding attribute from the configuration, including a null value created by issuing the
port-forward none command, enter the no form of this command. The no option allows inheritance of a list
from the group policy. To disallow filtering and prevent inheriting a port forwarding list, enter the port-forward
command with the none keyword.

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# port-forward {value listname | none}


hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no port-forward
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

The listname string following the keyword value identifies the list of applications users of clientless SSL
VPN can access. Enter the port-forward command in configuration mode to define the list.
Using the command a second time overrides the previous setting.
Before you can enter the port-forward command in username webvpn configuration mode to enable application
access, you must define a list of applications that you want users to be able to use in a clientless SSL VPN
session. Enter the port-forward command in global configuration mode to define this list.
The following example shows how to configure a portforwarding list called ports1:

hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# port-forward value ports1
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

Configure the Port-Forwarding Display Name


Configure the display name that identifies TCP port forwarding to end users for a particular user by using the
port-forward-name command in username webvpn configuration mode. To delete the display name, including
a null value created by using the port-forward-name none command, enter the no form of the command.
The no option restores the default name, Application Access. To prevent a display name, enter the port-forward
none command.

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# port-forward-name {value name | none}


hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no port-forward-name

The following example shows how to configure the port-forward name test:

hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# port-forward-name value test
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

Configure the Maximum Object Size to Ignore for Updating the Session Timer
Network devices exchange short keepalive messages to ensure that the virtual circuit between them is still
active. The length of these messages can vary. The keep-alive-ignore command lets you tell the ASA to
consider all messages that are less than or equal to the specified size as keepalive messages and not as traffic
when updating the session timer. The range is 0 through 900 KB. The default is 4 KB.
To specify the upper limit of the HTTP/HTTPS traffic, per transaction, to ignore, use the keep-alive-ignore
command in group-policy attributes webvpn configuration mode:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# keep-alive-ignore size

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
318
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Auto-Signon

hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

The no form of the command removes this specification from the configuration:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# no keep-alive-ignore
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

The following example sets the maximum size of objects to ignore as 5 KB:

hostname(config-group-webvpn)# keep-alive-ignore 5
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#

Configure Auto-Signon
To automatically submit the login credentials of a particular user of clientless SSL VPN to internal servers
using NTLM, basic HTTP authentication, or both, use the auto-signon command in username webvpn
configuration mode.
The auto-signon command is a single sign-on method for users of clientless SSL VPN sessions. It passes the
login credentials (username and password) to internal servers for authentication using NTLM authentication,
basic authentication, or both. Multiple auto-signon commands can be entered and are processed according to
the input order (early commands take precedence).
You can use the auto-signon feature in three modes: webvpn configuration, webvpn group configuration, or
webvpn username configuration mode. The typical precedence behavior applies where username supersedes
group, and group supersedes global. The mode you choose depends upon the desired scope of authentication.
To disable auto-signon for a particular user to a particular server, use the no form of the command with the
original specification of IP block or URI. To disable authentication to all servers, use the no form without
arguments. The no option allows inheritance of a value from the group policy.
The following example commands configure auto-signon for a user of clientless SSL VPN named anyuser,
using either basic or NTLM authentication, to servers defined by the URI mask https://*.example.com/*:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# auto-signon allow uri https://*.example.com/*
auth-type all

The following example commands configure auto-signon for a user of clientless SSL VPN named anyuser,
using either basic or NTLM authentication, to the server with the IP address 10.1.1.0, using subnet mask
255.255.255.0:

hostname(config)# username anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# auto-signon allow ip 10.1.1.0 255.255.255.0
auth-type all
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

Specify HTTP Compression


Enable compression of http data over a clientless SSL VPN session for a specific user by entering the http-comp
command in the username webvpn configuration mode.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
319
Clientless SSL VPN
Smart Tunnel Access

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# http-comp {gzip | none}


hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

To remove the command from the configuration and cause the value to be inherited, use the no form of the
command:

hostname(config-username-webvpn)# no http-comp {gzip | none}


hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

The syntax of this command is as follows:


• gzip—Specifies compression is enabled for the group or user. This is the default value.
• none—Specifies compression is disabled for the group or user.

For clientless SSL VPN session, the compression command configured from global configuration mode
overrides the http-comp command configured in group policy and username webvpn modes.
In the following example, compression is disabled for the username testuser:

hostname(config)# username testuser internal


hostname(config)# username testuser attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# http-comp none
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#

Smart Tunnel Access


The following sections describe how to enable smart tunnel access with Clientless SSL VPN sessions, specify
the applications to be provided with such access, and provide notes on using it.
To configure smart tunnel access, you create a smart tunnel list containing one or more applications eligible
for smart tunnel access, and the endpoint operating system associated with the list. Because each group policy
or local user policy supports one smart tunnel list, you must group the nonbrowser-based applications to be
supported into a smart tunnel list. After creating a list, you assign it to one or more group policies or local
user policies.
The following sections describe smart tunnels and how to configure them:
• About Smart Tunnels, on page 321
• Prerequisites for Smart Tunnels, on page 321
• Guidelines for Smart Tunnels, on page 322
• Add Applications to Be Eligible for Smart Tunnel Access, on page 323
• About Smart Tunnel Lists, on page 323
• Configure and Apply Smart Tunnel Policy, on page 324
• Configure and Apply a Smart Tunnel Tunnel-Policy, on page 325
• Create a Smart Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List, on page 326

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
320
Clientless SSL VPN
About Smart Tunnels

• Add Servers to a Smart Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List, on page 327
• Automate Smart Tunnel Access, on page 328
• Enable and Switch Off Smart Tunnel Access, on page 329
• Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off, on page 330

About Smart Tunnels


A smart tunnel is a connection between a TCP-based application and a private site, using a clientless
(browser-based) SSL VPN session with the security appliance as the pathway, and the ASA as a proxy server.
You can identify applications for which to grant smart tunnel access, and specify the local path to each
application. For applications running on Microsoft Windows, you can also require a match of the SHA-1 hash
of the checksum as a condition for granting smart tunnel access.
Lotus SameTime and Microsoft Outlook are examples of applications to which you may want to grant smart
tunnel access.
Configuring smart tunnels requires one of the following procedures, depending on whether the application is
a client or is a web-enabled application:
• Create one or more smart tunnel lists of the client applications, then assign the list to the group policies
or local user policies for whom smart tunnel access is required.
• Create one or more bookmark list entries that specify the URLs of the web-enabled applications eligible
for smart tunnel access, then assign the list to the group policies or local user policies for whom smart
tunnel access is required.

You can also list web-enabled applications for which to automate the submission of login credentials in smart
tunnel connections over Clientless SSL VPN sessions.

Benefits of Smart Tunnels


Smart tunnel access lets a client TCP-based application use a browser-based VPN connection to access a
service. It offers the following advantages to users, compared to plug-ins and the legacy technology, port
forwarding:
• Smart tunnel offers better performance than plug-ins.
• Unlike port forwarding, smart tunnel simplifies the user experience by not requiring the user connection
of the local application to the local port.
• Unlike port forwarding, smart tunnel does not require users to have administrator privileges.

The advantage of a plug-in is that it does not require the client application to be installed on the remote
computer.

Prerequisites for Smart Tunnels


See the Supported VPN Platforms, Cisco ASA 5500 Series, for the platforms and browsers supported by smart
tunnels.
The following requirements and limitations apply to smart tunnel access on Windows:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
321
Clientless SSL VPN
Guidelines for Smart Tunnels

• ActiveX or Oracle Java Runtime Environment (JRE 6 or later recommended) on Windows must be
enabled on the browser.
ActiveX pages require that you enter the activex-relay command on the associated group policy. If you
do so or assign a smart tunnel list to the policy, and the browser proxy exception list on the endpoint
specifies a proxy, the user must add a “shutdown.webvpn.relay.” entry to this list.

• Only Winsock 2, TCP-based applications are eligible for smart tunnel access.
• For Mac OS X only, Java Web Start must be enabled on the browser.
• Smart tunnel is incompatible with IE's Enhanced Protected Mode.

Guidelines for Smart Tunnels


• Smart tunnel supports only proxies placed between computers running Microsoft Windows and the
security appliance. Smart Tunnel uses the Internet Explorer configuration, which sets system-wide
parameters in Windows. That configuration may include proxy information:
• If a Windows computer requires a proxy to access the ASA, then there must be a static proxy entry
in the client's browser, and the host to connect to must be in the client's list of proxy exceptions.
• If a Windows computer does not require a proxy to access the ASA, but does require a proxy to
access a host application, then the ASA must be in the client's list of proxy exceptions.

Proxy systems can be defined the client’s configuration of static proxy entry or automatic configuration,
or by a PAC file. Only static proxy configurations are currently supported by Smart Tunnels.

• Kerberos constrained delegation (KCD) is not supported for smart tunnels.


• With Windows, to add smart tunnel access to an application started from the command prompt, you must
specify “cmd.exe” in the Process Name of one entry in the smart tunnel list, and specify the path to the
application itself in another entry, because “cmd.exe” is the parent of the application.
• With HTTP-based remote access, some subnets may block user access to the VPN gateway. To fix this,
place a proxy in front of the ASA to route traffic between the Web and the end user. That proxy must
support the CONNECT method. For proxies that require authentication, Smart Tunnel supports only the
basic digest authentication type.
• When smart tunnel starts, the ASA by default passes all browser traffic through the VPN session if the
browser process is the same. The ASA only also does this if a tunnel-all policy (the default) applies. If
the user starts another instance of the browser process, it passes all traffic through the VPN session. If
the browser process is the same and the security appliance does not provide access to a URL, the user
cannot open it. As a workaround, assign a tunnel policy that is not tunnel-all.
• A stateful failover does not retain smart tunnel connections. Users must reconnect following a failover.
• The Mac version of smart tunnel does not support POST bookmarks, form-based auto sign-on, or POST
macro substitution.
• For macOS users, only those applications started from the portal page can establish smart tunnel
connections. This requirement includes smart tunnel support for Firefox. Using Firefox to start another
instance of Firefox during the first use of a smart tunnel requires the user profile named csco_st. If this
user profile is not present, the session prompts the user to create one.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
322
Clientless SSL VPN
Add Applications to Be Eligible for Smart Tunnel Access

• In macOS, applications using TCP that are dynamically linked to the SSL library can work over a smart
tunnel.
• Smart tunnel does not support the following on macOS:
• Sandboxed applications (verify in Activity Monitor using View > Columns).
• Proxy services.
• Auto sign-on.
• Applications that use two-level name spaces.
• Console-based applications, such as Telnet, SSH, and cURL.
• Applications using dlopen or dlsym to locate libsocket calls.
• Statically linked applications to locate libsocket calls.

• macOS requires the full path to the process and is case-sensitive. To avoid specifying a path for each
username, insert a tilde (~) before the partial path (e.g., ~/bin/vnc).

Add Applications to Be Eligible for Smart Tunnel Access


The Clientless SSL VPN configuration of each ASA supports smart tunnel lists, each of which identifies one
or more applications eligible for smart tunnel access. Because each group policy or username supports only
one smart tunnel list, you must group each set of applications to be supported into a smart tunnel list.

About Smart Tunnel Lists


For each group policy and username, you can configure Clientless SSL VPN to do one of the following:
• Start smart tunnel access automatically upon user login.
• Enable smart tunnel access upon user login, but require the user to start it manually, using the Application
Access > Start Smart Tunnels button on the Clientless SSL VPN Portal Page.

Note The smart tunnel logon options are mutually exclusive for each group policy and
username. Use only one.

The following smart tunnel commands are available to each group policy and username. The configuration
of each group policy and username supports only one of these commands at a time, so when you enter one,
the ASA replaces the one present in the configuration of the group policy or username in question with the
new one, or in the case of the last command, simply removes the smart-tunnel command already present in
the group policy or username.
• smart-tunnel auto-start list
Start smart tunnel access automatically upon user login.
• smart-tunnel enable list

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
323
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure and Apply Smart Tunnel Policy

Enable smart tunnel access upon user login, but requires the user to start smart tunnel access manually,
using the Application Access > Start Smart Tunnels button on the Clientless SSL VPN portal page.
• smart-tunnel disable
Prevent smart tunnel access.
• no smart-tunnel [auto-start list | enable list | disable]
Remove a smart-tunnel command from the group policy or username configuration which then inherits
the [no] smart-tunnel command from the default group-policy. The keywords following the no
smart-tunnel command are optional, however, they restrict the removal to the named smart-tunnel
command.

Configure and Apply Smart Tunnel Policy


The smart tunnel policy requires a per group policy/username configuration. Each group policy/username
references a globally configured list of networks. When the smart tunnel is turned on, you can allow traffic
outside of the tunnel with the use of 2 CLIs: one configures the network (a set of hosts), and the other uses
the specified smart-tunnel network to enforce a policy on a user. The following commands create a list of
hosts to use for configuring smart tunnel policies.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


webvpn

Step 2 Create a list of hosts to use for configuring smart tunnel policies:
[no] smart-tunnel network network name ip ip netmask
• network name is the name to apply to the tunnel policy.
• ip is the IP address of the network.
• netmask is the netmask of the network.

Step 3 Establish the hostname mask, such as *.cisco.com:


[no] smart-tunnel network network name host host mask

Step 4 Apply smart tunnel policies to a particular group or user policy:


[no] smart-tunnel tunnel-policy [{excludespecified | tunnelspecified} network name | tunnelall]
• network name is a list of networks to be tunneled.
• tunnelall makes everything tunneled (encrypted).
• tunnelspecified tunnels only networks specified by network name.
• excludespecified tunnels only networks that are outside of the networks specified by network name.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
324
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure and Apply a Smart Tunnel Tunnel-Policy

Configure and Apply a Smart Tunnel Tunnel-Policy


Like the split tunnel configuration in the SSL VPN client, the smart tunnel policy is a per group-policy/username
configuration. Each group policy/username references a globally configured list of networks:

Procedure

Step 1 Reference a globally configured list of networks:


[no]smart-tunnel tunnel-policy [{excludespecified | tunnelspecified} network name | tunnelall]
• network name is a list of networks to be tunneled.
• tunnelall makes everything tunneled (encrypted).
• tunnelspecified tunnels only networks specified by network name.
• excludespecified tunnels only networks that are outside of the networks specified by network name.

Step 2 Apply a tunnel policy to a group-policy/user policy:


[no] smart-tunnel network network name ip ip netmask
or
[no] smart-tunnel network network name host host mask
One command specifies host and the other specifies network IPs. Use only one.
• network name specifies the name of network to apply to tunnel policy
• ip specifies the IP address of a network
• netmask specifies the netmask of a network
• host mask specifies the hostname mask, such as *.cisco.com

Example:
Example:
Create a tunnel policy that contains only one host (assuming the inventory pages are hosted at
www.example.com (10.5.2.2), and you want to configure both IP address and name for the hosts).

ciscoasa(config-webvpn)# smart-tunnel network inventory ip 10.5.2.2


or
ciscoasa(config-webvpn)# smart-tunnel network inventory host www.example.com

Step 3 Apply the tunnel-specified tunnel policy to the partner’s group policy:
ciscoasa(config-group-webvpn)# smart-tunnel tunnel-policy tunnelspecified inventory

Step 4 (Optional) Specify the group policy home page and enable smart tunnel on it.
Example:
Example:

ciscoasa(config-group-webvpn)# homepage value http://www.example.com

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
325
Clientless SSL VPN
Create a Smart Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List

ciscoasa(config-group-webvpn)# homepage use-smart-tunnel


ciscoasa(config-webvpn)# smart-tunnel notification-icon

Note Without writing a script or uploading anything, an administrator can specify which homepage to
connect with via smart tunnel.

Smart tunnel policy configuration is a good option when a vendor wants to provide a partner with clientless
access to an internal inventory server page upon login without going through the clientless portal first.
By default, configuration of a smart tunnel application is not necessary because all processes initiated by the
browser with smart tunnel enabled have access to the tunnel. However, because no portal is visible, you may
want to enable the logout notification icon.

Create a Smart Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List


Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


webvpn

Step 2 Use for each server to add to the server list:


smart-tunnel auto-sign-on list [use-domain] [realm realm-string] [port port-num]{ip ip-address [netmask]
| host hostname-mask}
• list—names the list of remote servers. Use quotation marks around the name if it includes a space. The
string can be up to 64 characters. The ASA creates the list if it is not already present in the configuration.
Otherwise, it adds the entry to the list. Assign a name that will help you to distinguish.
• use-domain (optional)—Adds the Windows domain to the username if authentication requires it. If you
enter this keyword, ensure you specify the domain name when assigning the smart tunnel list to one or
more group policies, or usernames.
• realm—Configures a realm for the authentication. Realm is associated with the protected area of the
website and is passed back to the browser either in the authentication prompt or in the HTTP headers
during authentication. Once auto-sign is configured and a realm string is specified, users can configure
the realm string on a Web application (such as Outlook Web Access) and access Web applications without
signing on
• port—Specifies which port performs auto sign-on. For Firefox, if no port number is specified, auto sign
is performed on HTTP and HTTPS, accessed by the default port numbers 80 and 443 respectively.
• ip—Specifies the server by its IP address and netmask.
• ip-address[netmask]—Identifies the sub-network of hosts to auto-authenticate to.
• host—Specifies the server by its hostname or wildcard mask. Using this option protects the configuration
from dynamic changes to IP addresses.
• hostname-mask—Specifies which hostname or wildcard mask to auto-authenticate to.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
326
Clientless SSL VPN
Add Servers to a Smart Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List

Step 3 (Optional) Remove an entry from the list of servers, specifying both the list and IP address or hostname as it
appears in the ASA configuration:
no smart-tunnel auto-sign-on list [use-domain] [realm realm-string] [port port-num]{ip ip-address [netmask]
| host hostname-mask}

Step 4 Display the smart tunnel auto sign-on list entries:


show running-config webvpn smart-tunnel

Step 5 Switch to config-webvpn configuration mode:


config-webvpn

Step 6 Add all hosts in the subnet and adds the Windows domain to the username if authentication requires it:
smart-tunnel auto-sign-on HR use-domain ip 93.184.216.119 255.255.255.0

Step 7 (Optional) Remove that entry from the list and the list named HR if the entry removed is the only entry in the
list:
no smart-tunnel auto-sign-on HR use-domain ip 93.184.216.119 255.255.255.0

Step 8 Remove the entire list from the ASA configuration:


no smart-tunnel auto-sign-on HR

Step 9 Add all hosts in the domain to the smart tunnel auto sign-on list named intranet:
smart-tunnel auto-sign-on intranet host *.example.com

Step 10 Remove that entry from the list:


no smart-tunnel auto-sign-on intranet host *.example.com
Note After configuring of the smart tunnel auto sign-on server list, you must assign it to a group policy
or a local user policy for it to become active.For more information, see, Add Servers to a Smart
Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List, on page 327

Add Servers to a Smart Tunnel Auto Sign-On Server List


The following steps describe how to add servers to the list of servers for which to provide auto sign-on in
smart tunnel connections, and assign that list to a group policies or a local user.

Before you begin


• Use the smart-tunnel auto-sign-on list command to create a list of servers first. You can assign only
one list to a group policy or username.

Note The smart-tunnel auto sign-on feature supports only applications communicating
HTTP and HTTPS using Internet Explorer and Firefox.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
327
Clientless SSL VPN
Automate Smart Tunnel Access

• If you are using Firefox, make sure that you specify hosts using an exact hostname or IP address (instead
of a host mask with wildcards, a subnet using IP addresses, or a netmask). For example, within Firefox,
you cannot enter *.cisco.com and expect auto sign-on to host email.cisco.com.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


webvpn

Step 2 Switch to group-policy Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


group-policy webvpn

Step 3 Switch to username Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


username webvpn

Step 4 Enable smart tunnel auto sign-on Clientless SSL VPN sessions:
smart-tunnel auto-sign-on enable

Step 5 (Optional) Switch off smart tunnel auto sign-on Clientless SSL VPN session, remove it from the group policy
or username, and use the default:
[no] smart-tunnel auto-sign-on enable list [domain domain]
• list—The name of a smart tunnel auto sign-on list already present in the ASA Clientless SSL VPN
configuration.
• domain (optional)—The name of the domain to be added to the username during authentication. If you
enter a domain, enter the use-domain keyword in the list entries.

Step 6 View the smart tunnel auto sign-on list entries in the SSL VPN configuration:
show running-config webvpn smart-tunnel

Step 7 Enable the smart tunnel auto sign-on list named HR:
smart-tunnel auto-sign-on enable HR

Step 8 Enable the smart tunnel auto sign-on list named HR and adds the domain named CISCO to the username
during authentication:
smart-tunnel auto-sign-on enable HR domain CISCO

Step 9 (Optional) Remove the smart tunnel auto sign-on list named HR from the group policy and inherits the smart
tunnel auto sign-on list command from the default group policy:
no smart-tunnel auto-sign-on enable HR

Automate Smart Tunnel Access


To start smart tunnel access automatically upon user login, perform the following steps:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
328
Clientless SSL VPN
Enable and Switch Off Smart Tunnel Access

Before you begin


For Mac OS X, click the link for the application in the portal’s Application Access panel, with or without
auto-start configured.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


webvpn

Step 2 Switch to group-policy Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


group-policy webvpn

Step 3 Switch to username Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


username webvpn

Step 4 Start smart tunnel access automatically upon user login:


smart-tunnel auto-start list
list is the name of the smart tunnel list already present.
Example:

hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# smart-tunnel auto-start apps1

This assigns the smart tunnel list named apps1 to the group policy.

Step 5 Display the smart tunnel list entries in the SSL VPN configuration:
show running-config webvpn smart-tunnel

Step 6 Remove the smart-tunnel command from the group policy or username and reverts to the default:
no smart-tunnel

Enable and Switch Off Smart Tunnel Access


By default, smart tunnels are switched off.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


webvpn

Step 2 Switch to group-policy Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


group-policy webvpn

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
329
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off

Step 3 Switch to username Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


username webvpn

Step 4 Enable smart tunnel access:


smart-tunnel [enable list | disable]
list is the name of the smart tunnel list already present. You do not have to start smart tunnel access manually
if you entered smart-tunnel auto-start list from the previous table.
Example:

hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# smart-tunnel enable apps1
This example assigns the smart tunnel list named apps1 to the group policy.

Step 5 Display the smart tunnel list entries in the SSL VPN configuration:
show running-config webvpn smart-tunnel

Step 6 Remove the smart-tunnel command from the group policy or local user policy and reverts to the default group
policy:
no smart-tunnel

Step 7 Switch off smart tunnel access:


smart-tunnel disable

Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off


This section describes how to ensure that the smart tunnel is properly logged off. Smart tunnel can be logged
off when all browser windows have been closed, or you can right click the notification icon and confirm log
out.

Note We strongly recommend the use of the logout button on the portal. This method pertains to Clientless SSL
VPNs and logs off regardless of whether smart tunnel is used or not. The notification icon should be used
only when using standalone applications without the browser.

Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off when Its Parent Process Terminates
This practice requires the closing of all browsers to signify log off. The smart tunnel lifetime is now tied to
the starting process lifetime. For example, if you started a smart tunnel from Internet Explorer, the smart
tunnel is turned off when no iexplore.exe is running. Smart tunnel can determine that the VPN session has
ended even if the user closed all browsers without logging out.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
330
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off with a Notification Icon

Note In some cases, a lingering browser process is unintentional and is strictly a result of an error. Also, when a
Secure Desktop is used, the browser process can run in another desktop even if the user closed all browsers
within the secure desktop. Therefore, smart tunnel declares all browser instances gone when no more visible
windows exist in the current desktop.

Procedure

Step 1 Allow administrators to turn on the notification icon on a global basis:


[no] smart-tunnel notification-icon
This command configures log out properties and controls whether the user is presented with a logout icon for
logging out, as opposed to having logout triggered by closing browser windows.
This command also controls logging off when a parent process terminates, which is automatically turned on
or off when the notification icon is turned on or off.
notification-icon is the keyword that specifies when to use the icon for logout.
The no version of this command is the default, in which case, closing all browser windows logs off the SSL
VPN session.
Portal logout still takes effect and is not impacted.

Step 2 When using a proxy and adding to the proxy list exception, ensure that smart tunnel is properly closed when
you log off, regardless of icon usage or not.
*.webvpn.

Configure Smart Tunnel Log Off with a Notification Icon


You may also choose to switch off logging off when a parent process terminates so that a session survives if
you close a browser. For this practice, you use a notification icon in the system tray to log out. The icon
remains until the user clicks the icon to logout. If the session has expired before the user has logged out, the
icon remains until the next connection is tried. You may have to wait for the session status to update in the
system tray.

Note This icon is an alternative way to log out of SSL VPN. It is not an indicator of VPN session status.

Clientless SSL VPN Capture Tool


The Clientless SSL VPN CLI includes a capture tool that lets you log information about websites that do not
display properly over a WebVPN connection. The data this tool records can help your Cisco customer support
representative troubleshoot problems.
The output of the Clientless SSL VPN capture tool consists of two files:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
331
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Portal Access Rules

• mangled.1, 2,3, 4... and so on, depending on the Web page activity. The mangle files record the html
actions of the VPN Concentrator transferring these pages on a Clientless SSL VPN connection.
• original.1,2,3,4... and so on, depending on the Web page activity. The original files are the files the URL
sent to the VPN Concentrator.

To open and view the files output by the capture tool, go to Administration | File Management. Zip the output
files and send them to your Cisco support representative.

Note Using the Clientless SSL VPN capture tool does impact VPN Concentrator performance. Ensure you switch
off the capture tool after you have generated the output files.

Configure Portal Access Rules


This enhancement allows customers to configure a global Clientless SSL VPN access policy to permit or deny
Clientless SSL VPN sessions based on the data present in the HTTP header. If the ASA denies a Clientless
SSL VPN session, it returns an error code to the endpoint immediately.
The ASA evaluates this access policy before the endpoint authenticates to the ASA. As a result, in the case
of a denial, fewer ASA processing resources are consumed by additional connection attempts from the endpoint.

Before you begin


Log on to the ASA and enter global configuration mode. In global configuration mode, the ASA displays
hostname(config)#.

Procedure

Step 1 Enter Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


webvpn

Step 2 Permit or deny the creation of a Clientless SSL VPN session based on an HTTP header code or a string in the
HTTP header:
portal-access-rule priority [{permit | deny [code code]} {any | user-agent match string}
Example:

hostname(config-webvpn)# portal-access-rule 1 deny code 403 user-agent match *Thunderbird*


hostname(config-webvpn)# portal-access-rule 1 deny code 403 user-agent match “*my agent*”

The second example shows the proper syntax for specifying a string with a space. Surround the string with
wildcards (*) and then quotes (“ ”).

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
332
Clientless SSL VPN
Optimize Clientless SSL VPN Performance

Optimize Clientless SSL VPN Performance


The ASA provides several ways to optimize Clientless SSL VPN performance and functionality. Performance
improvements include caching and compressing Web objects. Functionality tuning includes setting limits on
content transformation and proxy-bypass. APCF provides an additional method of tuning content transformation.

Configure Caching
Caching enhances Clientless SSL VPN performance. It stores frequently reused objects in the system cache,
which reduces the need to perform repeated rewriting and compressing of content. It reduces traffic between
Clientless SSL VPN and the remote servers, with the result that many applications run much more efficiently.
By default, caching is enabled. You can customize the way caching works for your environment by using the
caching commands in cache mode.

Configure Content Transformation


By default, the ASA processes all Clientless SSL VPN traffic through a content transformation/rewriting
engine that includes advanced elements such as JavaScript and Java to proxy HTTP traffic that may have
different semantics and access control rules depending on whether the user is accessing an application within
or independently of an SSL VPN device.
Some Web resources require highly individualized treatment. The following sections describe functionality
that provides such treatment. Subject to the requirements of your organization and the Web content involved,
you may use one of these features.

Configure a Certificate for Signing Rewritten Java Content


Java objects that have been transformed by Clientless SSL VPN can subsequently be signed using a PKCS12
digital certificate associated with a trustpoint.

Procedure

Step 1 Import a certificate:


crypto ca import

Step 2 Employ a certificate:


ava-trustpoint
Example:

hostname(config)# crypto ca import mytrustpoint pkcs12 mypassphrase


Enter the base 64 encoded PKCS12.
End with the word “quit” on a line by itself.
[ PKCS12 data omitted ]
quit
INFO: Import PKCS12 operation completed successfully.
hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config)# java-trustpoint mytrustpoint

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
333
Clientless SSL VPN
Switch Off Content Rewrite

This example shows the creation of a trustpoint named mytrustpoint and its assignment to signing Java objects.

Switch Off Content Rewrite


You may not want some applications and Web resources, for example, public websites, to go through the
ASA. The ASA therefore lets you create rewrite rules that let users browse certain sites and applications
without going through the ASA. This is similar to split-tunneling in an IPsec VPN connection.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


webvpn

Step 2 Specify applications and resources to access outside a clientless SSLN VPN tunnel:
rewrite
You can use this command multiple times.

Step 3 Use in combination with the rewrite command:


disable
The rule order number is important because the security appliance searches rewrite rules by order number,
starting with the lowest, and applies the first rule that matches.

Use Proxy Bypass


You can configure the ASA to use proxy bypass when applications and Web resources work better with the
special content rewriting this feature provides. Proxy bypass is an alternative method of content rewriting that
makes minimal changes to the original content. It is often useful with custom Web applications.
You can use the proxy-bypass command multiple times. The order in which you configure entries is
unimportant. The interface and path mask or interface and port uniquely identify a proxy bypass rule.
If you configure proxy bypass using ports rather than path masks, depending on your network configuration,
you may need to change your firewall configuration to allow these ports access to the ASA. Use path masks
to avoid this restriction. Be aware, however, that path masks can change, so you may need to use multiple
pathmask statements to exhaust the possibilities.
A path is everything in a URL after the .com or .org or other types of domain name. For example, in the URL
www.example.com/hrbenefits, hrbenefits is the path. Similarly, for the URL www.example.com/hrinsurance,
hrinsurance is the path. To use proxy bypass for all hr sites, you can avoid using the command multiple times
by using the * wildcard as follows: /hr*.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
334
Clientless SSL VPN
Use Proxy Bypass

webvpn

Step 2 Configure proxy bypass:


proxy-bypass

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
335
Clientless SSL VPN
Use Proxy Bypass

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
336
CHAPTER 16
Clientless SSL VPN Remote Users
This chapter summarizes configuration requirements and tasks for the user remote system. It also helps users
get started with Clientless SSL VPN. It includes the following sections:

Note Make sure that the ASA has been configured for Clientless SSL VPN.

• Clientless SSL VPN Remote Users, on page 337

Clientless SSL VPN Remote Users


This chapter summarizes configuration requirements and tasks for the user remote system. It also helps users
get started with Clientless SSL VPN. It includes the following sections:

Note Make sure that the ASA has been configured for Clientless SSL VPN.

Usernames and Passwords


Depending on your network, during a remote session users may have to log on to any or all of the following:
the computer itself, an Internet service provider, Clientless SSL VPN, mail or file servers, or corporate
applications. Users may have to authenticate in many different contexts, requiring different information, such
as a unique username, password, or PIN. Ensure users have the required access.
The following table lists the type of usernames and passwords that Clientless SSL VPN users may need to
know.

Table 19: Usernames and Passwords to Give to Clientless SSL VPN Users

Login Username/ Password Type Entered When

Computer Access the computer Starting the computer

Internet Service Provider Access the Internet Connecting to an Internet service


provider

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
337
Clientless SSL VPN
Communicate Security Tips

Login Username/ Password Type Entered When

Clientless SSL VPN Access remote network Starting a Clientless SSL VPN
session

File Server Access remote file server Using the Clientless SSL VPN file
browsing feature to access a remote
file server

Corporate Application Login Access firewall-protected internal Using the Clientless SSL VPN Web
server browsing feature to access an
internal protected website

Mail Server Access remote mail server via Sending or receiving email
Clientless SSL VPN messages

Communicate Security Tips


Communicate the following security tips:
• Always log out from a Clientless SSL VPN session, click the logout icon on the Clientless SSL VPN
toolbar or close the browser.
• Using Clientless SSL VPN does not ensure that communication with every site is secure. Clientless SSL
VPN ensures the security of data transmission between the remote computer or workstation and the ASA
on the corporate network. If a user then accesses a non-HTTPS Web resource (located on the Internet or
on the internal network), the communication from the corporate ASA to the destination Web server is
not secure.

Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features


The following table includes the tasks involved in setting up remote systems to use Clientless SSL VPN,
requirements/prerequisites for the task and recommended usage:
You may have configured user accounts differently, and different features maybe available to each Clientless
SSL VPN user. This table also organizes information by user activity.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
338
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features

Table 20: Clientless SSL VPN Remote System Configuration and End User Requirements

Task Remote System or End User Requirements Specifications or Use Suggestions

Starting Clientless SSL VPN Connection to the Internet Any Internet connection is supported,
including:
• Home DSL, cable, or dial-up
• Public kiosks
• Hotel hook-ups
• Airport wireless nodes
• Internet cafes

Clientless SSL VPN-supported browser We recommend the following browsers for


Clientless SSL VPN. Other browsers may
not fully support Clientless SSL VPN
features.
On Microsoft Windows:
• Internet Explorer 8
• Firefox 8

On Linux:
• Firefox 8

On Mac OS X:
• Safari 5
• Firefox 8

Cookies enabled on browser Cookies must be enabled on the browser in


order to access applications via port
forwarding.

URL for Clientless SSL VPN An HTTPS address in the following form:
https://address
where address is the IP address or DNS
hostname of an interface of the ASA (or
load balancing cluster) on which Clientless
SSL VPN is enabled. For example:
https://10.89.192.163 or
https://cisco.example.com.

Clientless SSL VPN username and


password

[Optional] Local printer

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
339
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features

Task Remote System or End User Requirements Specifications or Use Suggestions


Clientless SSL VPN does not support
printing from a Web browser to a network
printer. Printing to a local printer is
supported.

Using the Floating Toolbar in a Clientless A floating toolbar is available to simplify


SSL VPN Connection the use of Clientless SSL VPN. The toolbar
lets you enter URLs, browse file locations,
and choose preconfigured Web connections
without interfering with the main browser
window.
If you configure your browser to block
popups, the floating toolbar cannot display.
The floating toolbar represents the current
Clientless SSL VPN session. If you click
the Close button, the ASA prompts you to
close the Clientless SSL VPN session.
Tip To paste text into a text field,
use Ctrl-V. (Right-clicking is not
enabled on the Clientless SSL
VPN toolbar.)

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
340
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features

Task Remote System or End User Requirements Specifications or Use Suggestions

Web Browsing Usernames and passwords for protected Using Clientless SSL VPN does not ensure
websites that communication with every site is
secure. See “Communicate Security Tips,
on page 338.”

The look and feel of Web browsing with


Clientless SSL VPN may be different from
what users are accustomed to. For example:
• The Clientless SSL VPN title bar
appears above each Web page.
• You access websites by:
• Entering the URL in the Enter
Web Address field on the
Clientless SSL VPN Home page.
• Clicking on a preconfigured
website link on the Clientless
SSL VPN Home page.
• Clicking a link on a webpage
accessed via one of the previous
two methods.
Also, depending on how you
configured a particular account,
it may be that:

• Some websites are blocked.


• Only the websites that appear as links
on the Clientless SSL VPN Home
page are available.

Network Browsing and File Management File permissions configured for shared Only shared folders and files are accessible
remote access via Clientless SSL VPN.

Server name and passwords for protected —


file servers

Domain, workgroup, and server names Users may not be familiar with how to
where folders and files reside locate their files through your organization
network.

— Do not interrupt the Copy File to Server


command or navigate to a different screen
while the copying is in progress.
Interrupting the operation can cause an
incomplete file to be saved on the server.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
341
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features

Task Remote System or End User Requirements Specifications or Use Suggestions

Using Applications Note On Mac OS X, only the Safari browser supports this feature.
(called Port Forwarding or Application
Access) Note Because this feature requires installing Oracle Java Runtime Environment
(JRE) and configuring the local clients, and because doing so requires
administrator permissions on the local system, it is unlikely that users will
be able to use applications when they connect from public remote systems.

Users should always close the Application Access window when they finish using
applications by clicking the Close icon. Failure to close the window properly can cause
Application Access or the applications themselves to be inaccessible.

Client applications installed —

Cookies enabled on browser —

Administrator privileges User must have administrator access on the


computer if you use DNS names to specify
servers because modifying the hosts file
requires it.

Oracle Java Runtime Environment (JRE) If JRE is not installed, a pop-up window
installed. displays, directing users to a site where it
is available.
JavaScript must be enabled on the browser.
By default, it is enabled. On rare occasions, the port forwarding
applet fails with Java exception errors. If
this happens, do the following:
1. Clear the browser cache and close the
browser.
2. Verify that no Java icons are in the
computer task bar. Close all instances
of Java.
3. Establish a Clientless SSL VPN session
and launch the port forwarding Java
applet.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
342
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features

Task Remote System or End User Requirements Specifications or Use Suggestions


Client applications configured, if necessary. To configure the client application, use the
server’s locally mapped IP address and port
Note The Microsoft Outlook client
number. To find this information:
does not require this
configuration step. 1. Start Clientless SSL VPN on the remote
system and click the Application
All non-Windows client
Access link on the Clientless SSL VPN
applications require
Home page. The Application Access
configuration.
window appears.
To see if configuration is
necessary for a Windows 2. In the Name column, find the name of
application, check the value of the server to use, then identify its
the Remote Server. corresponding client IP address and
port number (in the Local column).
• If the Remote Server contains the 3. Use this IP address and port number to
server hostname, you do not need to configure the client application.
configure the client application. Configuration steps vary for each client
• If the Remote Server field contains an application.
IP address, you must configure the
client application.

Note Clicking a URL (such as one in an -email message) in an application running


over Clientless SSL VPN does not open the site over Clientless SSL VPN.
To open a site over Clientless SSL VPN, cut and paste the URL into the Enter
(URL) Address field.

Using email via Application Access Fulfill requirements for Application Access To use mail, start Application Access from
(See Using Applications) the Clientless SSL VPN Home page. The
mail client is then available for use.

Note If you are using an IMAP client and you lose your mail server connection or
are unable to make a new connection, close the IMAP application and restart
Clientless SSL VPN.

Other email clients We have tested Microsoft Outlook Express


versions 5.5 and 6.0.

Using email via Web Access Web-based email product installed Supported products include:
• Outlook Web Access
For best results, use OWA on Internet
Explorer 8.x or higher, or Firefox 8.x.
• Lotus Notes

Other web-based email products should


also work, but we have not verified them.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
343
Clientless SSL VPN
Capture Clientless SSL VPN Data

Task Remote System or End User Requirements Specifications or Use Suggestions

Using email via email Proxy SSL-enabled mail application installed Supported mail applications:
Do not set the ASA SSL version to TLSv1 • Microsoft Outlook
Only. Outlook and Outlook Express do not
support TLS. • Microsoft Outlook Express versions
5.5 and 6.0

Other SSL-enabled mail clients should also


work, but we have not verified them.

Mail application configured

Capture Clientless SSL VPN Data


The CLI capture command lets you log information about websites that do not display correctly over a
Clientless SSL VPN connection. This data can help your Cisco customer support engineer troubleshoot
problems. The following sections describe how to use the capture command:
• Create a Capture File, on page 344
• Use a Browser to Display Capture Data, on page 345

Note Enabling Clientless SSL VPN capture affects the performance of the ASA. Ensure
that you switch off the capture after you generate the capture files needed for
troubleshooting.

Create a Capture File

Procedure

Step 1 Start the Clientless SSL VPN capture utility, to capture packets
capture capture-name type webvpn user csslvpn-username
• capture-name is a name you assign to the capture, which is also prefixed to the name of the capture files.
• csslvpn-username is the username to match for capture.

Example:

hostname# capture hr type webvpn user user2

Step 2 Stop the capture by using the no version of the command:


no capture capture-name
Example:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
344
Clientless SSL VPN
Use a Browser to Display Capture Data

hostname# no capture hr

The capture utility creates a capture-name.zip file, which is encrypted with the password koleso

Step 3 Send the .zip file to Cisco, or attach it to a Cisco TAC service request.
Step 4 To look at the contents of the .zip file, unzip it using the password koleso.

Use a Browser to Display Capture Data

Procedure

Step 1 Start the Clientless SSL VPN capture utility:


capture capture-name type webvpn user csslvpn-username
• capture-name is a name you assign to the capture, which is also prefixed to the name of the capture files.
• csslvpn-username is the username to match for capture.

Example:

hostname# capture hr type webvpn user user2

Step 2 Open a browser and in the address box enter:


https://IP address or hostname of the ASA/webvpn_capture.html
The captured content displays in a sniffer format.

Step 3 Stop the capture by using the no version of the command:


no capture capture-name
Example:

hostname# no capture hr

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
345
Clientless SSL VPN
Use a Browser to Display Capture Data

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
346
CHAPTER 17
Clientless SSL VPN Users
• Manage Passwords, on page 347
• Use Single Sign-On with Clientless SSL VPN, on page 349
• Username and Password Requirements, on page 364
• Communicate Security Tips, on page 365
• Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features, on page 365

Manage Passwords
Optionally, you can configure the ASA to warn end users when their passwords are about to expire.
The ASA supports password management for the RADIUS and LDAP protocols. It supports the
“password-expire-in-days” option for LDAP only.
You can configure password management for IPsec remote access and SSL VPN tunnel-groups.
When you configure password management, the ASA notifies the remote user at login that the user’s current
password is about to expire or has expired. The ASA then offers the user the opportunity to change the
password. If the current password has not yet expired, the user can still log in using that password.
This command is valid for AAA servers that support such notification.
The ASA, releases 7.1 and later, generally supports password management for the following connection types
when authenticating with LDAP or with any RADIUS configuration that supports MS-CHAPv2:
• AnyConnect VPN Client
• IPsec VPN Client
• Clientless SSL VPN

The RADIUS server (for example, Cisco ACS) could proxy the authentication request to another authentication
server. However, from the ASA perspective, it is talking only to a RADIUS server.

Before you begin


• Native LDAP requires an SSL connection. You must enable LDAP over SSL before attempting to do
password management for LDAP. By default, LDAP uses port 636.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
347
Clientless SSL VPN
Manage Passwords

• If you are using an LDAP directory server for authentication, password management is supported with
the Sun Java System Directory Server (formerly named the Sun ONE Directory Server) and the Microsoft
Active Directory.
• Sun—The DN configured on the ASA to access a Sun directory server must be able to access the
default password policy on that server. We recommend using the directory administrator, or a user
with directory administrator privileges, as the DN. Alternatively, you can place an ACI on the default
password policy.
• Microsoft—You must configure LDAP over SSL to enable password management with Microsoft
Active Directory.

• Some RADIUS servers that support MSCHAP currently do not support MSCHAPv2. This command
requires MSCHAPv2 so check with your vendor.
• Password management is not supported for any of these connection types for Kerberos/Active Directory
(Windows password) or NT 4.0 Domain.
• For LDAP, the method to change a password is proprietary for the different LDAP servers on the market.
Currently, the ASA implements the proprietary password management logic only for Microsoft Active
Directory and Sun LDAP servers.
• The ASA ignores this command if RADIUS or LDAP authentication has not been configured.
• The password-management command does not change the number of days before the password expires,
but rather, the number of days ahead of expiration that the ASA starts warning the user that the password
is about to expire.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to general-attributes mode:


tunnel-group general-attributes

Step 2 Notify remote users that their password is about to expire:


password-management password-expire-in-days days
Example:

hostname(config-general)# password-management password-expire-in-days 90

• If you specify the password-expire-in-days keyword, you must also specify the number of days.
• If you set the number of days to 0, this command is switched off.

In this example, the ASA starts warning the user of the password expiration, 90 days before the expiration
date.
Note If the password-expire-in-days keyword is not set, the ASA does not notify the user of the pending
expiration, but the user can change the password after it expires.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
348
Clientless SSL VPN
Use Single Sign-On with Clientless SSL VPN

Use Single Sign-On with Clientless SSL VPN


SSO Using SAML 2.0
About SSO and SAML 2.0
The ASA supports SAML 2.0 so that Clientless VPN end users will be able to input their credentials only one
time when they switch between Clientless VPN and other SAAS applications outside of the private network.
For instance, an enterprise customer has enabled PingIdentity as their SAML Identity Provider (IdP) and has
accounts on Rally, Salesforce, Oracle OEM, Microsoft ADFS, onelogin, or Dropbox which have been SAML
2.0 SSO enabled. When you configure the ASA to support SAML 2.0 SSO as a Service Provider (SP), end
users are able to sign in once and have access to all these services including Clientless VPN.
The ASA is SP enabled when SAML is configured as the authentication method for a tunnel group, the default
tunnel group or any other. The Clientless VPN end user initiates Single sign-on by accessing an enabled ASA
or the SAML IdP. Each of these scenarios is described below.

SAML SP-initiated SSO


When the end user initiates login by accessing the ASA using Clientless VPN, sign-on behavior proceeds as
follows:
1. When the Clientless VPN end user accesses or chooses a SAML enabled tunnel group, the end user will
be redirected to the SAML idP for Authentication. The user will be prompted unless the user access the
group-url directly, in which case the redirect is silent.
The ASA generates a SAML Authentication Request which the browser redirects to the SAML IdP.
2. The IdP challenges the end user for credential and the end user logs in. The entered credentials must
satisfy the IdP authentication configuration.
3. The IdP Response is sent back to the browser and posted to the ASA's sign-in URL. The ASA verifies
the response to complete the login.

SAML IdP-initiated SSL


When the user initiates login by accessing the IdP, sign-on behavior proceeds as follows:
1. An end user accesses the IdP. The IdP challenges the end user for credentials according to the IdP's
authentication configuration. The end user submits credentials and logs in to the IdP.
2. In general, the end user gets a list of SAML enabled services that have been configured with the IdP. The
end user chooses the ASA.
3. A SAML response is sent back to the browser, and posted to the ASA sign-in URL. The ASA verifies
the response to complete the login.

Circle of Trust
The trust relationship between the ASA and the SAML Identity Provider is established through configured
certificates (ASA trustpoints).

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
349
Clientless SSL VPN
Guidelines and Limitations for SAML 2.0

The trust relationship between the end user and SAML Identity Provider is established through the authentication
configured on IdP.

SAML Timeouts
In SAML assertion, there are NotBefore and NotOnOrAfter as follows: <saml:Conditions
NotBefore="2015-03-10T19:47:41Z" NotOnOrAfter="2015-03-10T20:47:41Z">
A SAML timeout configured on the ASA will override NotOnOrAfter if the sum of NotBefore and timeout
is earlier than NotOnOrAfter. If NotBefore + timeout is later than NotOnOrAfter, then NotOnOrAfter will
take effect.
The timeout should be very short to prevent the assertion from being re-used after the timeout. You must
synchronize your ASA's Network Time Protocol (NTP) server with the IdP NTP server in order to use the
SAML feature.

Guidelines and Limitations for SAML 2.0


• SAML 2.0 SSO support is a Clientless VPN feature, so it has the same limitation and allowances as
Clientless VPN such as:
• Multi-context mode and load balancing are not supported.
• Active/Standby failover is supported, not Active/Active failover.
• IPv4 and IPv6 sessions are supported.

• SAML 2.0 SSO support applies to Clientless VPN only. AnyConnect is not supported.
• ASA supports SAML 2.0 Redirect-POST binding , which is supported by all SAML IdPs.
• The ASA functions as a SAML SP only. It cannot act as an Identity Provider in gateway mode or peer
mode.
• SAML 2.0 SSO does not support internal SAML IdP and SPs, only external ones outside of the private
network.
• This SAML SSO SP feature is a mutual exclusion authentication method. It cannot be used with AAA
and certificate together.
• Features that are based on username/password authentication, certificate authentication, and KCD are
not supported. For instance, username/password pre-filling feature, form-based Auto sign-on, Macro
Substitution based Auto sign-on, KCD SSO, and so on.
• DAP is not supported for SAML enabled tunnel groups.
• Existing Clientless VPN timeout settings still apply to SAML sessions.
• ASA administrators need to ensure clock synchronization between the ASA and the SAML IdP for proper
handling of authentication assertions and proper timeout behavior.
• ASA administrators have the responsibility to maintain a valid signing certificate on both ASA and IdP
considering the following:
• The IdP signing certificate is mandatory when configuring an IdP on the ASA.
• The ASA does not do a revocation check on the signing certificate received from the IdP.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
350
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure a SAML 2.0 Identity Provider (IdP)

• In SAML assertions, there are NotBefore and NotOnOrAfter conditions. The ASA SAML configured
timeout interacts with these conditions as follows:
• Timeout overrides NotOnOrAfter if the sum of NotBefore and timeout is earlier than NotOnOrAfter.
• If NotBefore + timeout is later than NotOnOrAfter, then NotOnOrAfter takes effect.
• If the NotBefore attribute is absent, the ASA denies the login request. If the NotOnOrAfter attribute
is absent and SAML timeout is not set, ASA denies the login request.

Configure a SAML 2.0 Identity Provider (IdP)

Before you begin


Get the Sign-in and Sign-out URLs for your SAML (IdP) provider. You can get the URLs from the provider's
website, or they may provide that information in a metadata file.

Procedure

Step 1 Create a SAML identity provider in webvpn config mode and enter saml-idp sub-mode under webvpn.
[no] saml idp idp-entityID
idp-entityID— The SAML IdP entityID must contain 4 to 256 characters.
To remove a SAML IdP, use the no form of this command.

Step 2 Configure the IdP URLs.


url [sign-in | sign-out] value
value —This is the URL for signing into the IdP or the URL for redirecting to when signing out of the IdP.
The sign-in URL is required, the sign-out URL is optional The url value must contain 4 to 500 characters.

Step 3 (Optional) Configure the Clientless VPN base URL.


base-url URL
This URL is provided to third-party IdPs to redirect end users back to the ASA.
When base-url is configured, we use it as the base URL of the AssertionConsumerService and
SingleLogoutService attribute in show saml metadata.
When base-url is not configured, the URL is determined by the ASA's hostname and domain-name. For
example, we use https://ssl-vpn.cisco.com when hostname is ssl-vpn and domain-name is
cisco.com.
An error occurs if neither base-url nor the hostname/domain-name are configured when entering show saml
metadata.

Step 4 Configure trustpoints between the IdP and SP (ASA).


trustpoint [idp | sp] trustpoint-name
idp—Specifies the trustpoint that contains the IdP certificate for the ASA to verify SAML assertions.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
351
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure a SAML 2.0 Identity Provider (IdP)

sp —Specifies the trustpoint that contains the ASA (SP)'s certificate for the IdP to verify ASA's signature or
encrypted SAML assertion.
trustpoint-name—Must be a previously configured trustpoint.

Step 5 (Optional) Configure SAML timeout.


timeout assertion timeout-in-seconds
If specified, this configuration overrides NotOnOrAfter if the sum of NotBefore and timeout-in-seconds is
earlier than NotOnOrAfter.
If not specified, NotBefore and NotOnOrAfter in the assertion is used to determine the validity.
Note For a tunnel group with existing SAML IdP configured, any changes to the saml idp CLI under
webvpn are only applied to the tunnel group when SAML is re-enabled for that particular tunnel
group. After you configure the timeout, the updated timeout takes effect only after re-issuing the
saml identity-provider CLI in the tunnel group webvpn-attributes.

Step 6 (Optional) Enable or disable (default setting) the signature in SAML request.
signature

Step 7 Use show webvpn saml idp to view the configuration.

Example
The following example configures an IdP named salesforce_idp and uses preconfigured trustpoints:
ciscoasa(config)# webvpn
ciscoasa(config-webvpn)#saml idp salesforce_idp

ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)#url sign-in
https://asa-dev-ed.my.salesforce.com/idp/endpoint/HttpRedirect
ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)#url sign-out
https://asa-dev-ed.my.salesforce.com/idp/endpoint/HttpRedirect

ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)#trustpoint idp salesforce_trustpoint


ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)#trustpoint sp asa_trustpoint

ciscoasa(config)#show webvpn saml idp


saml idp salesforce_idp
url sign-in https://asa-dev-ed.my.salesforce.com/idp/endpoint/HttpRedirect
url sign-out https://asa-dev-ed.my.salesforce.com/idp/endpoint/HttpRedirect
trustpoint idp salesforce_trustpoint
trustpoint sp asa_trustpoint

The following web page shows an example of how to get URLs for Onelogin,
https://onelogin.zendesk.com/hc/en-us/articles/202767260-Configuring-SAML-for-Clarizen
The following web page is an example of how to use metadata to find the URLs from OneLogin.
http://onlinehelp.tableau.com/current/online/en-us/saml_config_onelogin.htm

What to do next
Apply SAML authentication to connection profiles, as described in Configure ASA as a SAML 2.0 Service
Provider (SP), on page 353.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
352
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure ASA as a SAML 2.0 Service Provider (SP)

Configure ASA as a SAML 2.0 Service Provider (SP)


Follow this procedure to configure a particular tunnel group as a SAML SP.

Note If you are using SAML authentication with AnyConnect 4.4 or 4.5 and you deploy ASA version 9.7.1.24 (or
later), 9.8.2.28 (or later), or 9.9.2.1 (or later) (Release Date: 18-APR-2018), the defaulted SAML behavior is
the embedded browser, which is not supported on AnyConnect 4.4 and 4.5. Therefore, you must enable the
saml external-browser command in tunnel group configuration in order for AnyConnect 4.4 and 4.5 clients
to authenticate with SAML using the external (native) browser.
The saml external-browser command is for migration purposes for those upgrading to AnyConnect 4.6 or
later. Because of security limitations, use this solution only as part of a temporary migration while upgrading
AnyConnect software. The command itself will be depreciated in the future.

Before you begin


The IdP must have been previously configured. See Configure a SAML 2.0 Identity Provider (IdP), on page
351.

Procedure

Step 1 In tunnel-group webvpn sub-mode, use the saml identify-provider command to assign an IdP.
[no] saml identify-provider idp-entityID
idp-entityID—Must be one of the existing IdPs previously configured.
To disable SAML SP, use the no form of this command.

Step 2 Enable SAML SP feature for the current tunnel group.


authentication saml
SAML authentication method is mutually exclusive.

Example
ciscoasa(config)# webvpn
ciscoasa(config-webvpn)# tunnel-group-list enable
ciscoasa(config)# tunnel-group cloud_idp_onelogin type remote-access
ciscoasa(config)# tunnel-group cloud_idp_onelogin webvpn-attributes
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-webvpn)# authentication saml
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias cloud_idp enable
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-webvpn)# saml identity-provider
https://app.onelogin.com/saml/metadata/462950

Example SAML 2.0 and Onelogin


Follow this example using your third party SAML 2.0 IdP in place of the Onelogin information and naming.
1. Set time synchronization between the IdP and the ASA(SP).

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
353
Clientless SSL VPN
Example SAML 2.0 and Onelogin

ciscoasa(config)# ntp server 209.244.0.4

2. Obtain the IdP's SAML metadata from the IdP following procedures provided by your third party IdP.
3. Import the IdP's signing certificate into a trustpoint.
ciscoasa(config)# crypto ca trustpoint onelogin
ciscoasa(config-ca-trustpoint)# enrollment terminal
ciscoasa(config-ca-trustpoint)# no ca-check
ciscoasa(config-ca-trustpoint)# crypto ca authenticate onelogin
Enter the base 64 encoded CA certificate.
End with the word "quit" on a line by itself
quit
INFO: Certificate has the following attributes:
Fingerprint: 85de3781 07388f5b d92d9d14 1e22a549
Do you accept this certificate? [yes/no]: yes
Trustpoint CA certificate accepted.
% Certificate successfully imported

4. Import the SP (ASA) signing PKCS12 into a trustpoint


ciscoasa(config)# crypto ca import asa_saml_sp pkcs12 password
Enter the base 64 encoded pkcs12.
End with the word "quit" on a line by itself:
quit
INFO: Import PKCS12 operation completed successfully

5. Add a SAML IdP:


ciscoasa(config-webvpn)# saml idp https://app.onelogin.com/saml/metadata/462950

6. Configure attributes under saml-idp sub-mode:


Configure the IdP sign-in URL and sign-ou URL:
ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)# url sign-in
https://ross.onelogin.com/trust/saml2/http-post/sso/462950
ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)# url sign-out
https://ross.onelogin.com/trust/saml2/http-redirect/slo/462950

Configure the IdP trustpoint and the SP trustpoint


ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)# trustpoint idp onelogin
ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)# trustpoint sp asa_saml_sp

Configure the Clientless VPN base URL, SAML request signature and SAML assertion timout:
ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)# base-url https://172.23.34.222
ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)# signature
ciscoasa(config-webvpn-saml-idp)# timeout assertion 7200

7. Configure an IdP for a tunnel group and enable SAML authentication.


ciscoasa(config)# webvpn
ciscoasa(config-webvpn)# tunnel-group-list enable
ciscoasa(config)# tunnel-group cloud_idp_onelogin type remote-access
ciscoasa(config)# tunnel-group cloud_idp_onelogin webvpn-attributes
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-webvpn)# authentication saml
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-webvpn)# group-alias cloud_idp enable
ciscoasa(config-tunnel-webvpn)# saml identity-provider
https://app.onelogin.com/saml/metadata/462950

8. Show the ASA's SAML SP metadata:


You can get the ASA's SAML SP metadata from
https://172.23.34.222/saml/sp/metadata/cloud_idp_onelogin. In the URL,
cloud_idp_onelogin is the tunnel group name.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
354
Clientless SSL VPN
Troubleshooting SAML 2.0

9. Configure a SAML SP on your third party IdP following procedures provided by your third party IdP.

Troubleshooting SAML 2.0


Use debug webvpn samlvalue to debug SAML 2.0 behavior. The following SAML messages will be displayed
depending on the value :
• 8—errors
• 16—warnings and errors
• 128 or 255—debug, warnings, and errors

Configure SSO with HTTP Basic or NTLM Authentication


This section describes single sign-on with HTTP Basic or NTLM authentication. You can configure the ASA
to implement SSO using either or both of these methods. The auto-sign-on command configures the ASA to
automatically pass Clientless SSL VPN user login credentials (username and password) on to internal servers.
You can enter multiple auto-sign-on commands. The ASA processes them according to the input order (early
commands take precedence). You specify the servers to receive the login credentials using either IP address
and IP mask, or URI mask.
Use the auto-sign-on command in any of three modes: Clientless SSL VPN configuration, Clientless SSL
VPN group-policy mode, or Clientless SSL VPN username mode. Username supersedes group, and group
supersedes global. Choose the mode with the required scope of authentication:

Mode Scope

webvpn configuration All Clientless SSL VPN users globally.

webvpn group-policy configuration A subset of Clientless SSL VPN users defined by a


group policy.

webvpn username configuration An individual user of Clientless SSL VPN.

Examples
• Configure auto-sign-on for all users of Clientless SSL VPN to servers with IP addresses ranging
from 10.1.1.0 to 10.1.1.255 using NTLM authentication:
hostname(config-webvpn)# auto-sign-on allow ip 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 auth-type ntlm

• Configure auto-sign-on for all users of Clientless SSL VPN, using basic HTTP authentication,
to servers defined by the URI mask https://*.example.com/*:
hostname(config-webvpn)# auto-sign-on allow uri https://*.example.com/* auth-type

• Configure auto-sign-on for Clientless SSL VPN sessions associated with the ExamplePolicy
group policy, using either basic or NTLM authentication, to servers defined by the URI mask:

hostname(config)# group-policy ExamplePolicy attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# auto-sign-on allow uri https://*.example.com/* auth-type

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
355
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure SSO with the HTTP Form Protocol

all

• Configure auto-sign-on for a user named Anyuser to servers with IP addresses ranging from
10.1.1.0 to 10.1.1.255 using HTTP Basic authentication:

hostname(config)# username Anyuser attributes


hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# auto-sign-on allow ip 10.1.1.1 255.255.255.0 auth-type
basic

• Configure auto-sign-on with a specific port and realm for authentication:


smart-tunnel auto-sign-on host-list [use-domain] [realm realm string] [port port num]
[host host mask | ip address subnet mask]

Configure SSO with the HTTP Form Protocol


This section describes using the HTTP Form protocol for SSO. HTTP Form protocol is an approach to SSO
authentication that can also qualify as a AAA method. It provides a secure method for exchanging authentication
information between users of Clientless SSL VPN and authenticating Web servers. You can use it in conjunction
with other AAA servers such as RADIUS or LDAP servers.
The ASA again serves as a proxy for users of Clientless SSL VPN to an authenticating Web server but, in
this case, it uses HTTP Form protocol and the POST method for requests. You must configure the ASA to
send and receive form data.
To configure SSO with the HTTP protocol correctly, you must have a thorough working knowledge of
authentication and HTTP protocol exchanges.
As a common protocol, it is applicable only when the following conditions are met for the Web server
application used for authentication:
• The authentication cookie must be set for successful request and not set for unauthorized logons. In this
case, ASA cannot distinguish successful from failed authentication.

The following figure illustrates the SSO authentication steps, described below:
Figure 9: SSO Authentication Using HTTP Forms

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
356
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure SSO with the HTTP Form Protocol

1. A user of Clientless SSL VPN first enters a username and password to log on to the Clientless SSL VPN
server on the ASA.
2. The Clientless SSL VPN server acts as a proxy for the user and forwards the form data (username and
password) to an authenticating Web server using a POST authentication request.
3. If the authenticating Web server approves the user data, it returns an authentication cookie to the Clientless
SSL VPN server where it is stored on behalf of the user.
4. The Clientless SSL VPN server establishes a tunnel to the user.
5. The user can now access other websites within the protected SSO environment without re-entering a
username and password.
While you would expect to configure form parameters that let the ASA include POST data such as the username
and password, you initially may not be aware of additional hidden parameters that the Web server requires.
Some authentication applications expect hidden data which is neither visible to nor entered by the user. You
can, however, discover hidden parameters the authenticating Web server expects by making a direct
authentication request to the Web server from your browser without the ASA in the middle acting as a proxy.
Analyzing the Web server response using an HTTP header analyzer reveals hidden parameters in a format
similar to the following:

<param name>=<URL encoded value>&<param name>=<URL encoded>

Some hidden parameters are mandatory and some are optional. If the Web server requires data for a hidden
parameter, it rejects any authentication POST request that omits that data. Because a header analyzer does
not tell you if a hidden parameter is mandatory or not, we recommend that you include all hidden parameters
until you determine which are mandatory.
To configure SSO with the HTTP Form protocol, you must perform the following:
• Configure the uniform resource identifier on the authenticating Web server to receive and process the
form data (action-uri).
• Configure the username parameter (user-parameter).
• Configure the user password parameter (password-parameter).

You may also need to do the following tasks depending upon the requirements of authenticating Web server:
• Configure a starting URL if the authenticating Web server requires a pre-login cookie exchange (start-url).
• Configure any hidden authentication parameters required by the authenticating Web server
(hidden-parameter).
• Configure the name of an authentication cookie set by the authenticating Web server (auth-cookie-name).

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to the aaa-server-host configuration mode:


aaa-server-host

Step 2 If the authenticating Web server requires it, specify the URL from which to retrieve a pre-login cookie from
the authenticating Web server:
start-url

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
357
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure SSO with the HTTP Form Protocol

Example:

hostname(config)# aaa-server testgrp1 protocol http-form


hostname(config)# aaa-server testgrp1 host 10.0.0.2
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# start-url http://example.com/east/Area.do?Page-Grp1

This example specifies the authenticating Web server URL http://example.com/east/Area.do?Page-Grp1 in


the testgrp1 server group with an IP address of 10.0.0.2.

Step 3 Specify a URI for an authentication program on the authenticating Web server:
action-uri
Example:

http://www.example.com/auth/index.html/appdir/authc/forms/MCOlogin.fcc?TYPE=33554433
&REALMOID=06-000a1311-a828-1185-ab41-8333b16a0008&GUID=&SMAUTHREASON=0&METHOD=GET&SMAGENTNA
ME=$SM$5FZmjnk3DRNwNjk2KcqVCFbIrNT9%2bJ0H0KPshFtg6rB1UV2PxkHqLw%3d%3d&TARGET=https%3A%2F%2F
auth.example.com

To specify this action URI, enter the following commands:

hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri http://www.example.com/auth/index.htm


hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri l/appdir/authc/forms/MCOlogin.fcc?TYP
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri 554433&REALMOID=06-000a1311-a828-1185
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri -ab41-8333b16a0008&GUID=&SMAUTHREASON
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri =0&METHOD=GET&SMAGENTNAME=$SM$5FZmjnk
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri 3DRNwNjk2KcqVCFbIrNT9%2bJ0H0KPshFtg6r
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri B1UV2PxkHqLw%3d%3d&TARGET=https%3A%2F
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# action-uri %2Fauth.example.com

A URI can be entered on multiple, sequential lines. The maximum number of characters per line is 255. The
maximum number of characters for a complete URI is 2048.
You must include the hostname and protocol in the action URI. In this example, these appear at the start of
the URI in http://www.example.com.

Step 4 Configure the userid username parameter for the HTTP POST request:
user-parameter
Example:

hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# user-parameter userid

Step 5 Configure the user_password user password parameter for the HTTP POST request:
password-parameter
Example:

hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# password-parameter user_password

Step 6 Specify hidden parameters for exchange with the authenticating Web server:
hidden-parameter

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
358
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure SSO with the HTTP Form Protocol

Example:

hostname(config)# aaa-server testgrp1 host example.com


hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# hidden-parameter SMENC=ISO-8859-1&SMLOCALE=US-EN&targe
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# hidden-parameter t=https%3A%2F%2Ffanyv88.com%3A443%2Fhttps%2Fwww.example.com%2Femc
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# hidden-parameter o%2Fappdir%2FAreaRoot.do%3FEMCOPageCo
hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# hidden-parameter de%3DENG&smauthreason=0

This example shows an example hidden parameter excerpted from a POST request. This hidden parameter
includes four form entries and their values, separated by &. The entries and their values are:
• SMENC with a value of ISO-8859-1.
• SMLOCALE with a value of US-EN.
• target with a value of https%3A%2F%2Ffanyv88.com%3A443%2Fhttps%2Fwww.example.com%2Femco%2Fappdir%2FAreaRoot.do.
• %3FEMCOPageCode%3DENG.
• smauthreason with a value of 0.

Step 7 Specify the name for the authentication cookie:


auth-cookie-name cookie-name
Example:

hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# auth-cookie-name SsoAuthCookie

This example specifies an authentication cookie name of SsoAuthCookie.

Step 8 Switch to tunnel-group general-attributes configuration mode:


tunnel-group general-attributes

Step 9 Configure a tunnel-group to use the SSO server configured in the previous steps:
authentication-server-group
Example:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#authentication-server-group testgrp1

This example configures the tunnel-group named /testgroup/ to use the SSO server(s) named /testgrp1/”.

Step 10 Switch to AAA server host configuration mode:


aaa-server-host

Step 11 Specify the name for the authentication cookie:


auth-cookie-name cookie-name
Example:

hostname(config-aaa-server-host)# auth-cookie-name SsoAuthCookie

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
359
Clientless SSL VPN
Gather HTTP Form Data

This example specifies an authentication cookie name of SsoAuthCookie.

Step 12 Switch to tunnel-group general-attributes mode:


tunnel-group general-attributes

Step 13 Configure a tunnel-group to use the SSO server configured in the previous steps:
authentication-server-group group
Example:

hostname(config)# tunnel-group testgroup general-attributes


hostname(config-tunnel-general)#authentication-server-group testgrp1

This example configures a tunnel-group named /testgroup/ to use the SSO server(s) named /testgrp1/”.

Gather HTTP Form Data


This section presents the steps for discovering and gathering necessary HTTP Form data. If you do not know
what parameters the authenticating Web server requires, you can gather parameter data by analyzing an
authentication exchange.

Before you begin


These steps require a browser and an HTTP header analyzer.

Procedure

Step 1 Start your browser and HTTP header analyzer, and connect directly to the Web server login page without
going through the ASA.
Step 2 After the Web server login page has loaded in your browser, examine the login sequence to determine if a
cookie is being set during the exchange. If the Web server has loaded a cookie with the login page, configure
this login page URL as the start-URL.
Step 3 Enter the username and password to log on to the Web server, and press Enter. This action generates the
authentication POST request that you examine using the HTTP header analyzer.
An example POST request—with host HTTP header and body—follows:
POST
/emco/myemco/authc/forms/MCOlogin.fcc?TYPE=33554433&REALMOID=06-000430e1-7443-125c
-ac05-83846dc90034&GUID=&SMAUTHREASON=0&METHOD=GET&SMAGENTNAME=$SM$5FZmjnk3DRNwNjk
2KcqVCFbIrNT9%2bJ0H0KPshFtg6rB1UV2PxkHqLw%3d%3d&TARGET=https%3A%2F%2Ffanyv88.com%3A443%2Fhttps%2Fwww.example.c
om%2Femco%2Fmyemco%2FHTTP/1.1

Host: www.example.com

(BODY)

SMENC=ISO-8859-1&SMLOCALE=US-EN&USERID=Anyuser&USER_PASSWORD=XXXXXX&target=https
%3A%2F%2Fwww.example.com%2Femco%2Fmyemco%2F&smauthreason=0

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
360
Clientless SSL VPN
Gather HTTP Form Data

Step 4 Examine the POST request and copy the protocol, host, and the complete URL to configure the action-uri
parameter.
Step 5 Examine the POST request body and copy the following:
a) Username parameter. In the preceding example, this parameter is USERID, not the value anyuser.
b) Password parameter. In the preceding example, this parameter is USER_PASSWORD.
c) Hidden parameter.
This parameter is everything in the POST body except the username and password parameters. In the
preceding example, the hidden parameter is:
SMENC=ISO-8859-1&SMLOCALE=US-EN&target=https%3A%2F%2Ffanyv88.com%3A443%2Fhttps%2Fwww.example.com%2
Femco%2Fmyemco%2F&smauthreason=0

The following figure highlights the action URI, hidden, username and password parameters within sample
output from an HTTP analyzer. This is only an example; output varies widely across different websites.
Figure 10: Action-uri, hidden, username and password parameters

1 Action URI parameter

2 Hidden parameters

3 Username and password parameters

Step 6 If you successfully log on to the Web server, examine the server response with the HTTP header analyzer to
locate the name of the session cookie set by the server in your browser. This is the auth-cookie-name parameter.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
361
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure SSO for Plug-ins

In the following server response header, the name of the session cookie is SMSESSION. You just need the
name, not the value.
Set-Cookie:
SMSESSION=yN4Yp5hHVNDgs4FT8dn7+Rwev41hsE49XlKc+1twie0gqnjbhkTkUnR8XWP3hvDH6PZ
PbHIHtWLDKTa8ngDB/lbYTjIxrbDx8WPWwaG3CxVa3adOxHFR8yjD55GevK3ZF4ujgU1lhO6fta0d
SSOSepWvnsCb7IFxCw+MGiw0o88uHa2t4l+SillqfJvcpuXfiIAO06D/gtDF40Ow5YKHEl2KhDEvv
+yQzxwfEz2cl7Ef5iMr8LgGcDK7qvMcvrgUqx68JQOK2+RSwtHQ15bCZmsDU5vQVCvSQWC8OMHNGw
pS253XwRLvd/h6S/tM0k98QMv+i3N8oOdj1V7flBqecH7+kVrU01F6oFzr0zM1kMyLr5HhlVDh7B0
k9wp0dUFZiAzaf43jupD5f6CEkuLeudYW1xgNzsR8eqtPK6t1gFJyOn0s7QdNQ7q9knsPJsekRAH9
hrLBhWBLTU/3B1QS94wEGD2YTuiW36TiP14hYwOlCAYRj2/bY3+lYzVu7EmzMQ+UefYxh4cF2gYD8
RZL2RwmP9JV5l48I3XBFPNUw/3V5jf7nRuLr/CdfK3OO8+Pa3V6/nNhokErSgyxjzMd88DVzM41Lx
xaUDhbcmkoHT9ImzBvKzJX0J+o7FoUDFOxEdIqlAN4GNqk49cpi2sXDbIarALp6Bl3+tbB4MlHGH+
0CPscZXqoi/kon9YmGauHyRs+0m6wthdlAmCnvlJCDfDoXtn8DpabgiW6VDTrvl3SGPyQtUv7Wdah
uq5SxbUzjY2JxQnrUtwB977NCzYu2sOtN+dsEReWJ6ueyJBbMzKyzUB4L3i5uSYN50B4PCv1w5KdR
Ka5p3N0Nfq6RM6dfipMEJw0Ny1sZ7ohz3fbvQ/YZ7lw/k7ods/8VbaR15ivkE8dSCzuf/AInHtCzu
Q6wApzEp9CUoG8/dapWriHjNoi4llJOgCst33wEhxFxcWy2UWxs4EZSjsI5GyBnefSQTPVfma5dc/
emWor9vWr0HnTQaHP5rg5dTNqunkDEdMIHfbeP3F90cZejVzihM6igiS6P/CEJAjE;Domain=.exa
mple.com;Path=/

The following figure shows an example of authorization cookies in HTTP analyzer output. This is only an
example; output varies widely across different websites.
Figure 11: Authorization Cookies in Sample HTTP Analyzer Output

1 Authorization cookies

Step 7 In some cases, the server may set the same cookie regardless of whether the authentication was successful or
not, and such a cookie is unacceptable for SSO purposes. To confirm that the cookies are different, repeat
Step 1 through Step 6 using invalid login credentials and then compare the “failure” cookie with the “success”
cookie. You now have the necessary parameter data to configure the ASA for SSO with HTTP Form protocol.

Configure SSO for Plug-ins


Plug-ins support single sign-on (SSO). They use the same credentials (username and password) entered to
authenticate the Clientless SSL VPN session. Because the plug-ins do not support macro substitution, you do

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
362
Clientless SSL VPN
Configure SSO with Macro Substitution

not have the option to perform SSO on different fields, such as the internal domain password or the attribute
on a RADIUS or LDAP server.
To configure SSO support for a plug-in, you install the plug-in and add a bookmark entry to display a link to
the server, specifying SSO support using the csco_sso=1 parameter. The following examples show plug-in
bookmarks enabled for SSO:

ssh://ssh-server/?cisco_sso=1
rdp://rdp-server/?Parameter1=value&Parameter2=value&csco_sso=1

Configure SSO with Macro Substitution


This section describes using macro substitution for SSO. Configuring SSO with macro substitution allows
for you to inject certain variables into bookmarks to substitute for dynamic values.

Note Smart tunnel bookmarks support auto-sign-on but not variable substitution. For example, a SharePoint bookmark
configured for smart tunnel uses the same username and password credentials to log on to the application as
the credentials used to log on to Clientless SSL VPN. (This SSO functionality applies only to clientless VPN
and not to AnyConnect.) You can use variable substitutions and auto sign-on simultaneously or separately.
You can now use bookmarks with macro substitutions for auto sign-on on some Web pages. The former POST
plug-in approach was created so that administrators could specify a POST bookmark with sign-on macros
and receive a kick-off page to load prior to posting the POST request. This POST plug-in approach eliminated
those requests that required the presence of cookies or other header items. Now an an administrator determines
the pre-load page and URL, which specifies where the post login request is sent. A pre-load page enables an
endpoint browser to fetch certain information that is sent along to the webserver or Web application rather
than just using a POST request with credentials.

The following variables (or macros) allow for substitutions in bookmarks and forms-based HTTP POST
operations:
• CSCO_WEBVPN_USERNAME—User login ID
• CSCO_WEBVPN_PASSWORD—User login password
• CSCO_WEBVPN_INTERNAL_PASSWORD—User internal (or domain) password. This cached
credential is not authenticated against a AAA server. When you enter this value, the security appliance
uses it as the password for auto sign-on, instead of the password/primary password value.

Note You cannot use any of these three variables in GET-based http(s) bookmarks.
Only POST-based http(s) and cifs bookmarks can use these variables.

• CSCO_WEBVPN_CONNECTION_PROFILE—User login group drop-down (connection profile alias)


• CSCO_WEBVPN_MACRO1—Set with the RADIUS-LDAP Vendor Specific Attribute (VSA). If you
are mapping from LDAP with an ldap-attribute-map command, use the
WebVPN-Macro-Substitution-Value1 Cisco attribute for this macro. See the Active Directory
ldap-attribute-mapping examples at
http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/security/asa/asa83/configuration/guide/ref_extserver.html#wp1572118.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
363
Clientless SSL VPN
Username and Password Requirements

The CSCO_WEBVPN_MACRO1 macro substitution with RADIUS is performed by VSA#223 .

Table 21: VSA#223

WebVPN-Macro-Value1 Y 223 String Single Unbounded

WebVPN-Macro-Value2 Y 224 String Single Unbounded

A value such as www.cisco.com/email dynamically populates a bookmark on the Clientless SSL VPN
portal, such as https://CSCO_WEBVPN_MACRO1 or https://CSCO_WEBVPN_MACRO2 for the
particular DAP or group policy.

• CSCO_WEBVPN_MACRO2—set with RADIUS-LDAP Vendor Specific Attribute (VSA). If you are


mapping from LDAP with an ldap-attribute-map command, use the WebVPN-Macro-Substitution-Value2
Cisco attribute for this macro. See the Active Directory ldap-attribute-mapping examples at
http://www.cisco.com/en/US/docs/security/asa/asa83/configuration/guide/ref_extserver.html#wp1572118.
The CSCO_WEBVPN_MACRO2 macro substitution with RADIUS is performed by VSA#224.

Each time Clientless SSL VPN recognizes one of these six strings in an end-user request (in the form of a
bookmark or Post Form), it replaces the string with the user-specified value and then passes the request to a
remote server.
If the lookup of the username and password fails on the ASA, an empty string is substituted, and the behavior
converts back as if no auto sign-in is available.

Username and Password Requirements


Depending on your network, during a remote session users may have to log on to any or all of the following:
the computer itself, an Internet service provider, Clientless SSL VPN, mail or file servers, or corporate
applications. Users may have to authenticate in many different contexts, requiring different information, such
as a unique username, password, or PIN. The following table lists the type of usernames and passwords that
Clientless SSL VPN users may need to know:

Login Username/ Password Type Entered When

Computer Access the computer Starting the computer

Internet Service Provider Access the Internet Connecting to an Internet service provider

Clientless SSL VPN Access remote network Starting Clientless SSL VPN

File Server Access remote file server Using the Clientless SSL VPN file
browsing feature to access a remote file
server

Corporate Application Login Access firewall-protected internal server Using the Clientless SSL VPN Web
browsing feature to access an internal
protected website

Mail Server Access remote mail server via Clientless Sending or receiving email messages
SSL VPN

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
364
Clientless SSL VPN
Communicate Security Tips

Communicate Security Tips


Advise users to always click the logout icon on the toolbar to close the Clientless SSL VPN session. (Closing
the browser window does not close the session.)
Clientless SSL VPN ensures the security of data transmission between the remote PC or workstation and the
ASA on the corporate network. Advise users that using Clientless SSL VPN does not ensure that communication
with every site is secure. If a user then accesses a non-HTTPS Web resource (located on the Internet or on
the internal network), the communication from the corporate ASA to the destination Web server is not private
because it is not encrypted.

Configure Remote Systems to Use Clientless SSL VPN Features


This section describes how to set up remote systems to use Clientless SSL VPN.
• About Clientless SSL VPN, on page 365
• Prerequisites for Clientless SSL VPN, on page 366
• Use the Clientless SSL VPN Floating Toolbar, on page 366
• Browse the Web, on page 366
• Browse the Network (File Management), on page 367
• Use Port Forwarding, on page 368
• Use email Via Port Forwarding, on page 369
• Use email Via Web Access, on page 370
• Use email Via email Proxy, on page 370
• Use Smart Tunnel, on page 370

You may configure user accounts differently and different Clientless SSL VPN features can be available to
each user.

About Clientless SSL VPN


You can connect to the internet using any supported connection including:
• Home DSL, cable, or dial-ups.
• Public kiosks.
• Hotel hotspots.
• Airport wireless nodes.
• Internet cafes.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
365
Clientless SSL VPN
Prerequisites for Clientless SSL VPN

Note See the Supported VPN Platforms, Cisco ASA 5500 Series for the list of Web browsers supported by Clientless
SSL VPN.

Prerequisites for Clientless SSL VPN


• Cookies must be enabled on the browser in order to access applications via port forwarding.
• You must have a URL for Clientless SSL VPN. The URL must be an https address in the following form:
https://address, where address is the IP address or DNS hostname of an interface of the ASA (or load
balancing cluster) on which SSL VPN is enabled. For example, https://cisco.example.com.
• You must have a Clientless SSL VPN username and password.

Note Clientless SSL VPN supports local printing, but it does not support printing
through the VPN to a printer on the corporate network.

Use the Clientless SSL VPN Floating Toolbar


A floating toolbar is available to simplify the use of Clientless SSL VPN. The toolbar lets you enter URLs,
browse file locations, and choose preconfigured Web connections without interfering with the main browser
window.
The floating toolbar represents the current Clientless SSL VPN session. If you click the Close button, the
ASA prompts you to close the Clientless SSL VPN session.

Tip To paste text into a text field, use Ctrl-V. (Right-clicking is switched off on the toolbar displayed during the
Clientless SSL VPN session.)

Note If you configure your browser to block popups, the floating toolbar cannot display.

Browse the Web


Using Clientless SSL VPN does not ensure that communication with every site is secure. See Communicate
Security Tips, on page 365.
The look and feel of Web browsing with Clientless SSL VPN may be different from what users are accustomed
to. For example:
• The title bar for Clientless SSL VPN appears above each Web page.
• You access websites by:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
366
Clientless SSL VPN
Browse the Network (File Management)

• Entering the URL in the Enter Web Address field on the Clientless SSL VPN Home page
• Clicking on a preconfigured website link on the Clientless SSL VPN Home page
• Clicking a link on a webpage accessed via one of the previous two methods
• You need the username and password for protected websites

Depending on how you configured a particular account, it may be that:


• Some websites are blocked
• Only the websites that appear as links on the Clientless SSL VPN Home page are available

Also, depending on how you configured a particular account, it may be that:


• Some websites are blocked
• Only the websites that appear as links on the Clientless SSL VPN Home page are available

Browse the Network (File Management)


Users may not be familiar with how to locate their files through your organization network.

Note Do not interrupt the Copy File to Server command or navigate to a different screen while the copying is in
progress. Interrupting the operation can cause an incomplete file to be saved on the server.

It is important to remember that


• You must configure file permissions for shared remote access.
• You must have the server names and passwords for protected file servers.
• You must have the domain, workgroup, and server names where folders and files reside.

Note Only shared folders and files are accessible via Clientless SSL VPN.

Use the Remote File Explorer


The Remote File Explorer provides the user with a way to browse the corporate network from their Web
browser. When the users clicks the Remote File System icon on the Cisco SSL VPN portal page, an applet is
launched on the user’s system displaying the remote file system in a tree and folder view.

Note This functionality requires that the Oracle Java Runtime Environment (JRE) is installed on the user’s machine
and that Java is enabled in the Web browser. Launching remote files requires JRE 1.6 or later.

The browser enables the user to:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
367
Clientless SSL VPN
Use Port Forwarding

• Browse the remote file system.


• Rename files.
• Move or copy files within the remote file system and between the remote and local file systems.
• Perform bulk uploads and downloads of files.
You can download a file by clicking it in the browser, selecting Operations > Download, and providing
a location and name to save the file in the Save dialog.
You can upload a file by clicking the destination folder, selecting Operations > Upload, and providing
the location and name of the file in the Open dialog,
This functionality has the following restrictions:
• The user cannot view sub-folders for which they are not permitted access.
• Files that the user is not permitted to access cannot be moved or copied, even though they are
displayed in the browser.
• The maximum depth of nested folders is 32.
• The tree view does not support drag and drop copying.
• When moving files between multiple instances of the Remote File Explorer, all instances must be
exploring the same server (root share).
• The Remote File Explorer can display a maximum of 1500 files and folders in a single folder. If a
folder exceeds this limit the folder cannot be displayed.

Use Port Forwarding


To use port forwarding, you must configure the client application, using the server’s locally mapped IP address
and port number.
• Users should always close the Application Access window when they finish using applications by clicking
the Close icon. Failure to quit the window properly can cause Application Access or the applications
themselves to be switched off.

Before you begin


• On Mac OS X, only the Safari browser supports this feature.
• You must have client applications installed.
• You must have Cookies enabled on the browser.
• You must have administrator access on the PC if you use DNS names to specify servers, because modifying
the hosts file requires it.
• You must have Oracle Java Runtime Environment (JRE) installed.
If JRE is not installed, a pop-up window displays, directing users to a site where it is available. On rare
occasions, the port forwarding applet fails with Java exception errors. If this happens, do the following:
1. Clear the browser cache and close the browser.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
368
Clientless SSL VPN
Use email Via Port Forwarding

2. Verify that no Java icons are in the computer task bar.


3. Close all instances of Java.
4. Establish a Clientless SSL VPN session and launch the port forwarding Java applet.

• You must have JavaScript enabled on the browser. By default, it is enabled.


• If necessary, you must configure client applications.

Note The Microsoft Outlook client does not require this configuration step. All
non-Windows client applications require configuration. To determine if
configuration is necessary for a Windows application, check the value of the
Remote Server field. If the Remote Server field contains the server hostname,
you do not need to configure the client application. If the Remote Server field
contains an IP address, you must configure the client application.

Procedure

Step 1 Start a Clientless SSL VPN session and click the Application Access link on the Home page. The Application
Access window appears.
Step 2 In the Name column, find the name of the server to use, then identify its corresponding client IP address and
port number (in the Local column).
Step 3 Use this IP address and port number to configure the client application. Configuration steps vary for each
client application.
Note Clicking a URL (such as one in an -email message) in an application running over a Clientless SSL
VPN session does not open the site over that session. To open a site over the session, paste the URL
into the Enter Clientless SSL VPN (URL) Address field.

Use email Via Port Forwarding


To use email, start Application Access from the Clientless SSL VPN home page. The mail client is then
available for use.

Note If you are using an IMAP client and you lose your mail server connection or are unable to make a new
connection, close the IMAP application and restart Clientless SSL VPN.

You must fulfill requirements for application access and other mail clients.
We have tested Microsoft Outlook Express versions 5.5 and 6.0.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
369
Clientless SSL VPN
Use email Via Web Access

Use email Via Web Access


The following email applications are supported:
• Microsoft Outlook Web App to Exchange Server 2010.
OWA requires Internet Explorer 7 or later, or Firefox 3.01 or later.
• Microsoft Outlook Web Access to Exchange Server 2007, 2003, and 2000.
For best results, use OWA on Internet Explorer 8.x or later, or Firefox 8.x.
• Lotus iNotes

Note You must have the web-based email product installed and other web-based email
applications should also work, but we have not verified them.

Use email Via email Proxy


The following legacy email applications are supported:
• Microsoft Outlook 2000 and 2002
• Microsoft Outlook Express 5.5 and 6.0

See the instructions and examples for your mail application in Use Email over Clientless SSL VPN, on page
301.

Before You Begin


You must have the SSL-enabled mail application installed.
Do not set the ASA SSL version to TLSv1 Only. Outlook and Outlook Express do not support TLS.
You must have your mail application properly configured.
Other SSL-enabled clients should also work, but we have not verified them.

Use Smart Tunnel


Administration privileges are not required to use Smart Tunnel.

Note Java is not automatically downloaded for you as in port forwarder.

• Smart tunnel requires either ActiveX or JRE on Windows and Java Web Start on Mac OS X.
• You must ensure cookies enabled on the browser.
• You must ensure JavaScript is enabled on the browser.
• Mac OS X does not support a front-side proxy.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
370
Clientless SSL VPN
Use Smart Tunnel

• Use only supported operating systems and browsers.


• Only TCP socket-based applications are supported.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
371
Clientless SSL VPN
Use Smart Tunnel

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
372
CHAPTER 18
Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile Devices
• Use Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile Devices, on page 373

Use Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile Devices


You can access Clientless SSL VPN from your Pocket PC or other certified mobile device. Neither the ASA
administrator nor the Clientless SSL VPN user need do anything special to use Clientless SSL VPN with a
certified mobile device.
Cisco has certified the following mobile device platforms:
• HP iPaq H4150
• Pocket PC 2003
• Windows CE 4.20.0, build 14053
• Pocket Internet Explorer (PIE)
• ROM version 1.10.03ENG
• ROM Date: 7/16/2004

Some differences in the mobile device version of Clientless SSL VPN exist:
• A banner Web page replaces the popup Clientless SSL VPN window.
• An icon bar replaces the standard Clientless SSL VPN floating toolbar. This bar displays the Go, Home
and Logout buttons.
• The Show Toolbar icon is not included on the main Clientless SSL VPN portal page.
• Upon Clientless SSL VPN logout, a warning message provides instructions for closing the PIE browser
properly. If you do not follow these instructions and you close the browser window in the common way,
PIE does not disconnect from Clientless SSL VPN or any secure website that uses HTTPS.

Restrictions of Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile


• Clientless SSL VPN supports OWA 2000 and OWA 2003 Basic Authentication. If Basic Authentication
is not configured on an OWA server and a Clientless SSL VPN user attempts to access that server, access
is denied.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
373
Clientless SSL VPN
Restrictions of Clientless SSL VPN with Mobile

• Unsupported Clientless SSL VPN features:


• Application Access and other Java-dependent features.
• HTTP proxy.
• The Citrix Metaframe feature (if the PDA does not have the corresponding Citrix ICA client software).

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
374
CHAPTER 19
Customizing Clientless SSL VPN
• Clientless SSL VPN End User Setup, on page 375
• Customize Bookmark Help, on page 385

Clientless SSL VPN End User Setup


This section is for the system administrator who sets up Clientless SSL VPN for end users. It describes how
to customize the end-user interface and summarizes configuration requirements and tasks for a remote system.
It specifies information to communicate to users to get them started using Clientless SSL VPN.

Define the End User Interface


The Clientless SSL VPN end user interface consists of a series of HTML panels. A user logs on to Clientless
SSL VPN by entering the IP address of an ASA interface in the format https://address. The first panel that
displays is the login screen.

View the Clientless SSL VPN Home Page


After the user logs in, the portal page opens.
The home page displays all of the Clientless SSL VPN features you have configured, and its appearance
reflects the logo, text, and colors you have selected. This sample home page includes all available Clientless
SSL VPN features with the exception of identifying specific file shares. It lets users browse the network, enter
URLs, access specific websites, and use Application Access (port forwarding and smart tunnels) to access
TCP applications.

View the Clientless SSL VPN Application Access Panel


To start port forwarding or smart tunnels, a user clicks the Go button in the Application Access box.
The Application Access window opens and displays the TCP applications configured for this Clientless SSL
VPN connection. To use an application with this panel open, the user starts the application in the normal way.

Note A stateful failover does not retain sessions established using Application Access. Users must reconnect
following a failover.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
375
Clientless SSL VPN
View the Floating Toolbar

View the Floating Toolbar


The floating toolbar shown in the following figure represents the current Clientless SSL VPN session.
Figure 12: Clientless SSL VPN Floating Toolbar

Be aware of the following characteristics of the floating toolbar:


• The toolbar lets you enter URLs, browse file locations, and choose preconfigured Web connections
without interfering with the main browser window.
• If you configure your browser to block popups, the floating toolbar cannot display.
• If you close the toolbar, the ASA prompts you to end the Clientless SSL VPN session.

Customize Clientless SSL VPN Pages


You can change the appearance of the portal pages displayed to Clientless SSL VPN users. This includes the
Login page displayed to users when they connect to the security appliance, the Home page displayed to users
after the security appliance authenticates them, the Application Access window displayed when users launch
an application, and the Logout page displayed when users log out of Clientless SSL VPN sessions.
After you customize the portal pages, you can save your customization and apply it to a specific connection
profile, group policy, or user. The changes do not take effect until you reload the ASA, or you switch off and
then enable clientless SSL.
You can create and save many customization objects, enabling the security appliance to change the appearance
of portal pages for individual users or groups of users.

Information About Customization


The ASA uses customization objects to define the appearance of user screens. A customization object is
compiled from an XML file which contains XML tags for all the customizable screen items displayed to
remote users. The ASA software contains a customization template that you can export to a remote PC. You
can edit this template and import the template back into the ASA as a new customization object.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
376
Clientless SSL VPN
Export a Customization Template

When you export a customization object, an XML file containing XML tags is created at the URL you specify.
The XML file created by the customization object named Template contains empty XML tags and provides
the basis for creating new customization objects. This object cannot be changed or deleted from cache memory
but can be exported, edited, and imported back into the ASA as a new customization object.

Customization Objects, Connection Profiles, and Group Policies


Initially, when a user first connects, the default customization object (named DfltCustomization) identified in
the connection profile (tunnel group) determines how the logon screen appears. If the connection profile list
is enabled, and the user selects a different group which has its own customization, the screen changes to reflect
the customization object for that new group.
After the remote user is authenticated, the screen appearance is determined by whether a customization object
has been assigned to the group policy.

Export a Customization Template


When you export a customization object, an XML file is created at the URL you specify. The customization
template (named Template) contains empty XML tags and provides the basis for creating new customization
objects. This object cannot be changed or deleted from cache memory but can be exported, edited, and imported
back into the ASA as a new customization object.

Procedure

Step 1 Export a customization object and and make changes to the XML tags:
export webvpn customization

Step 2 Import the file as a new object:


import webvpn customization
Example:
The following example exports the default customization object (DfltCustomization) and creates the XML
file named dflt_custom.

hostname# export webvpn customization DfltCustomization tftp://209.165.200.225/dflt_custom


!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!INFO: Customization object 'DfltCustomization' was exported to
tftp://10.86.240.197/dflt_custom
hostname#

Edit the Customization Template


This section shows the contents of the customization template and has convenient figures to help you quickly
choose the correct XML tag and make changes that affect the screens.
You can use a text editor or an XML editor to edit the XML file. The following example shows the XML tags
of the customization template. Some redundant tags have been removed for easier viewing:

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
377
Clientless SSL VPN
Edit the Customization Template

The following figure shows the Logon page and its customizing XML tags. All these tags are nested within
the higher-level tag <auth-page>.
Figure 13: Logon Page and Associated XML Tags

The following figure shows the Language Selector drop-down list that is available on the Logon page, and
the XML tags for customizing this feature. All these tags are nested within the higher-level <auth-page> tag.
Figure 14: Language Selector on Logon Screen and Associated XML Tags

The following figure shows the Information Panel that is available on the Logon page, and the XML tags for
customizing this feature. This information can appear to the left or right of the login box. These tags are nested
within the higher-level <auth-page> tag.
Figure 15: Information Panel on Logon Screen and Associated XML Tags

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
378
Clientless SSL VPN
Import a Customization Object

The following figure shows the Portal page and the XML tags for customizing this feature. These tags are
nested within the higher-level <auth-page> tag.
Figure 16: Portal Page and Associated XML Tags

Import a Customization Object


After you edit and save the XML file, import it into the cache memory of the ASA. When you import the
customization object, the ASA checks the XML code for validity. If the code is valid, the ASA stores the
object in a hidden location in cache memory.

import webvpn customization

The following example shows importing the customization object General.xml from the URL
209.165.201.22/customization and naming it custom1:

import webvpn customization custom1


hostname#
tftp://209.165.201.22/customization /General.xml
Accessing
tftp://209.165.201.22/customization/General.xml...!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
Writing file disk0:/csco_config/97/custom1...
!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
329994 bytes copied in 5.350 secs (65998 bytes/sec)

Apply Customizations to Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users


After you create a customization, you can apply the customization to a connection profile (tunnel group), a
group, or a user, with the customization command. The options displayed with this command are different
depending on the mode you are in.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
379
Clientless SSL VPN
Apply Customizations to Connection Profiles, Group Policies, and Users

Note After you customize the portal pages, the changes do not take effect until you reload the ASA, or you disable
and then enable clientless SSL.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode:


webvpn

Step 2 Switch to either tunnel-group, group-policy, or username Clientless SSL VPN configuration:
tunnel-group webvpn OR group-policy webvpn OR username webvpn

Step 3 Apply a customization to a connection profile with name as the name of a customization to apply to the
connection profile:
customization name
Or apply a customization to a group or user. The following options are included:
• none disables the customization for the group or user, prevents the value from being inherited, and
displays the default Clientless SSL VPN pages.
• value name is the name of a customization for a group or user.

Example:
This example enters tunnel-group Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode and enables the customization
cisco for the connection profile cisco_telecommutes:
hostname(config)# tunnel-group cisco_telecommuters webvpn-attributes
hostname(tunnel-group-webvpn)# customization cisco

This example enters group policy Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode, queries the security appliance for
a list of customizations, and enables the customization cisco for the group policy cisco_sales:

hostname(config)# group-policy cisco_sales attributes


hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)# customization value ?
config-username-webvpn mode commands/options:
Available configured customization profiles:
DfltCustomization
cisco
hostname(config-group-webvpn)#customization value cisco

This example enters username Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode and enables the customization cisco
for the user cisco_employee:
hostname(config)# username cisco_employee attributes
hostname(config-username)# webvpn
hostname(config-username-webvpn)#customization value cisco

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
380
Clientless SSL VPN
Login Screen Advanced Customization

Step 4 (Optional) Remove the command from the configuration and remove a customization from the connection
profile:
[ no] customization name

Step 5 (Optional) Remove the command from the configuration and revert to the default:
[no] customization {none | value name}

Step 6 Show a list of existing customizations:


customization ?

Login Screen Advanced Customization


If you prefer to use your own, custom login screen, rather than changing specific screen elements of the login
screen we provide, you can perform this advanced customization using the Full Customization feature.
With Full Customization, you provide the HTML for your own login screen, and you insert Cisco HTML
code that calls functions on the ASA that create the Login form and the Language Selector drop-down list.
This section describes the modifications you need to make to your HTML code and the tasks required to
configure the ASA to use your code.
The following figure shows the standard Cisco login screen that displays to Clientless SSL VPN users. The
Login form is displayed by a function called by the HTML code.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
381
Clientless SSL VPN
Login Screen Advanced Customization

Figure 17: Standard Cisco Login Page

The following figure shows the Language Selector drop-down list. This feature is an option for Clientless
SSL VPN users and is also called by a function in the HTML code of the login screen.
Figure 18: Language Selector Drop-down List

The following figure shows a simple example of a custom login screen enabled by the Full Customization
feature.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
382
Clientless SSL VPN
Login Screen Advanced Customization

Figure 19: Example of Full Customization of Login Screens

The following HTML code is used as an example and is the code that displays:

<head>
<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=windows-1252">
<title>New Page 3</title>
<base target="_self">
</head>

<p align="center">
<img border="0" src="/+CSCOU+/cisco_logo.jpg" width="188" height="48"><font face="Snap ITC"
size="6" color="#FF00FF">
</font><font face="Snap ITC" color="#FF00FF" size="7">&nbsp;</font><i><b><font color="#FF0000"
size="7" face="Sylfaen"> SSL VPN Service by the Cisco ASA5500</font></b></i></p>

<body onload="csco_ShowLoginForm('lform');csco_ShowLanguageSelector('selector')">

<table>

<tr><td colspan=3 height=20 align=right><div id="selector" style="width:


300px"></div></td></tr>
<tr><td></td><td></td><td></td></tr>
<tr>
<td height="379"></td>
<td height="379"></td>
<td align=middle valign=middle>
<div id=lform >
<p>&nbsp;</p>

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
383
Clientless SSL VPN
Modify Your HTML File

<p>&nbsp;</p>
<p>&nbsp;</p>
<p>Loading...</p>
</div>
</td>
</tr>
<tr>
<td width="251"></td>
<td width="1"></td>
<td align=right valign=right width="800">
<img border="1" src="/+CSCOU+/asa5500.jpg" width="660" height="220" align="middle">
</td></tr>

</table>

The indented code injects the Login form and the Language Selector on the screen. The function
csco_ShowLoginForm('lform') injects the logon form. csco_ShowLanguageSelector('selector') injects the
Language Selector.

Modify Your HTML File


Procedure

Step 1 Name your file logon.inc. When you import the file, the ASA recognizes this filename as the logon screen.
Step 2 Modify the paths of images used by the file to include /+CSCOU+/.
Files that are displayed to remote users before authentication must reside in a specific area of the ASA cache
memory represented by the path /+CSCOU+/. Therefore, the source for each image in the file must include
this path.
For example:
src=”/+CSCOU+/asa5520.gif”

Step 3 Insert the special HTML code below. This code contains the Cisco functions, described earlier, that inject the
login form and language selector onto the screen.

<body onload="csco_ShowLoginForm('lform');csco_ShowLanguageSelector('selector')">

<table>

<tr><td colspan=3 height=20 align=right><div id="selector" style="width:


300px"></div></td></tr>
<tr><td></td><td></td><td></td></tr>
<tr>
<td height="379"></td>
<td height="379"></td>
<td align=middle valign=middle>
<div id=lform >
<p>&nbsp;</p>
<p>&nbsp;</p>
<p>&nbsp;</p>
<p>Loading...</p>
</div>
</td>
</tr>
<tr>

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
384
Clientless SSL VPN
Customize Bookmark Help

<td width="251"></td>
<td width="1"></td>
<td align=right valign=right width="800">
<img border="1" src="/+CSCOU+/asa5500.jpg" width="660" height="220" align="middle">
</td></tr>

</table>

Customize Bookmark Help


The ASA displays help content on the application panels for each selected bookmark. You can customize
those help files or create help files in other languages. You then import them to flash memory for display
during subsequent sessions. You can also retrieve previously imported help content files, modify them, and
reimport them to flash memory.
Each application panel displays its own help file content using a predetermined filename. The prospective
location of each is in the /+CSCOE+/help/language/ URL within flash memory of the ASA. The following
table shows the details about each of the help files you can maintain for VPN sessions.

Table 22: VPN Application Help Files

Application Type Panel URL of Help File in Flash Help File Provided By
Memory of the Security Cisco in English?
Appliance

Standard Application Access /+CSCOE+/help/language/app-access-hlp.inc Yes

Standard Browse Networks /+CSCOE+/help/language/file-access-hlp.inc Yes

Standard AnyConnect Client /+CSCOE+/help/language/net-access-hlp.inc Yes

Standard Web Access /+CSCOE+/help/language/web-access-hlp.inc Yes

Plug-in MetaFrame Access /+CSCOE+/help/language/ica-hlp.inc No

Plug-in Terminal Servers /+CSCOE+/help/language/rdp-hlp.inc Yes

Plug-in Telnet/SSH Servers /+CSCOE+/help/language/ssh,telnet-hlp.inc Yes

Plug-in VNC Connections /+CSCOE+/help/language/vnc-hlp.inc Yes

language is the abbreviation of the language rendered by the browser. This field is not used for file translation;
it indicates the language used in the file. To specify a particular language code, copy the language abbreviation
from the list of languages rendered by your browser. For example, a dialog window displays the languages
and associated language codes when you use one of the following procedures:
• Open Internet Explorer and choose Tools > Internet Options > Languages > Add.
• Open Mozilla Firefox and choose Tools > Options > Advanced > General, click Choose next to
Languages, and click Select a language to add.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
385
Clientless SSL VPN
Import a Help file to Flash Memory

Import a Help file to Flash Memory


Procedure

Import a help content file to flash memory for display in Clientless SSL VPN sessions.
import webvpn webcontent destination_url source_url
• destination_url is the string in the URL of Help File in Flash Memory of the Security Appliance column.
• source_url is the URL of the file to import. Valid prefixes are ftp://, http://, and tftp://.

Example
This example copies the help file app-access-help.inc to flash memory from the TFTP server at
209.165.200.225.The URL includes the abbreviation en for the English language:

hostname# import webvpn webcontent /+CSCOE+/help/en/app-access-hlp.inc


tftp://209.165.200.225/app-access-hlp.inc

Export a Previously Imported Help File from Flash Memory


Procedure

Retrieve a previously imported help content file for subsequent edits.


export webvpn webcontent source_url destination_url
• source_url is the string in “URL of Help File in Flash Memory of the Security Appliance.”
• destination_url is the target URL. Valid prefixes are ftp:// and tftp://. The maximum number of characters
is 255.

Example
This example copies the English language help file file-access-hlp.inc displayed on the Browser
Networks panel to TFTP Server 209.165.200.225.

export webvpn webcontent /+CSCOE+/help/en/file-access-hlp.inc


hostname#
tftp://209.165.200.225/file-access-hlp.inc

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
386
Clientless SSL VPN
Understand Language Translation

Understand Language Translation


The ASA provides language translation for the entire Clientless SSL VPN session. This includes login, logout
banners, and portal pages displayed after authentication such as plugins and AnyConnect. Functional areas
and their messages that are visible to remote users are organized into translation domains. The following table
shows the translation domains and the functional areas translated.
Language Translation Domain Options

Translation Domain Functional Areas Translated

AnyConnect Messages displayed on the user interface of the Cisco


AnyConnect VPN client.

banners Message displayed when VPN access is denied for a


clientless connection.

CSD Messages for the Cisco Secure Desktop (CSD).

customization Messages on the logon and logout pages, portal page,


and all the messages customizable by the user.

plugin-ica Messages for the Citrix plug-in.

plugin-rdp Messages for the Remote Desktop Protocol plug-in.

plugin-rdp2 Messages for the Java Remote Desktop Protocol


plug-in.

plugin-telnet,ssh Messages for the Telnet and SSH plug-in.

plugin-vnc Messages for the VNC plug-in.

PortForwarder Messages displayed to Port Forwarding users.

url-list Text that user specifies for URL bookmarks on the


portal page.

webvpn All the layer 7, AAA and portal messages that are not
customizable.

The ASA includes a translation table template for each domain that is part of standard functionality. The
templates for plug-ins are included with the plug-ins and define their own translation domains.
You can export the template for a translation domain, which creates an XML file of the template at the URL
you provide. The message fields in this file are empty. You can edit the messages and import the template to
create a new translation table object that resides in flash memory.
You can also export an existing translation table. The XML file created displays the messages you edited
previously. Reimporting this XML file with the same language name creates a new version of the translation
table object, overwriting previous messages.
Some templates are static, but some change based on the configuration of the ASA. Because you can customize
the logon and logout pages, portal page, and URL bookmarks for clientless users, the ASA generates the
customization and url-list translation domain templates dynamically, and the template automatically reflects
your changes to these functional areas.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
387
Clientless SSL VPN
Create Translation Tables

After creating translation tables, they are available to customization objects that you create and apply to group
policies or user attributes. With the exception of the AnyConnect translation domain, a translation table has
no affect, and messages are not translated on user screens until you create a customization object, identify a
translation table to use in that object, and specify that customization for the group policy or user. Changes to
the translation table for the AnyConnect domain are immediately visible to AnyConnect client users.

Create Translation Tables


You can create translation tables in both single context mode and multi-context mode:

Procedure

Step 1 Export a translation table template to a computer.


export webvpn translation-table
Example:
This example shows available translation table templates and exports them for the customization domain,
which affects messages displayed for users in Clientless SSL VPN sessions. The filename of the XML file
created is portal (user-specified) and contains empty message fields.

hostname# show import webvpn translation-table


Translation Tables' Templates:
customization
AnyConnect

PortForwarder
url-list
webvpn
Citrix-plugin
RPC-plugin
Telnet-SSH-plugin
VNC-plugin

Translation Tables:

hostname#export webvpn translation-table customization template


tftp://209.165.200.225/portal

Step 2 Edit the translation table XML file.


Example:
This example shows a portion of the template that was exported as portal. The end of this output includes a
message ID field (msgid) and a message string field (msgstr) for the message which is displayed on the portal
page when a user establishes a Clientless SSL VPN session. The complete template contains many pairs of
message fields.

# Copyright (C) 2006 by Cisco Systems, Inc.


#
#, fuzzy
msgid ""
msgstr ""
"Project-Id-Version: ASA\n"

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
388
Clientless SSL VPN
Reference the Language in a Customization Object

"Report-Msgid-Bugs-To: [email protected]\n"
"POT-Creation-Date: 2007-03-12 18:57 GMT\n"
"PO-Revision-Date: YEAR-MO-DA HO:MI+ZONE\n"
"Last-Translator: FULL NAME <EMAIL@ADDRESS>\n"
"Language-Team: LANGUAGE <[email protected]>\n"
"MIME-Version: 1.0\n"
"Content-Type: text/plain; charset=UTF-8\n"
"Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit\n"

#: DfltCustomization:24 DfltCustomization:64
msgid "Clientless SSL VPN Service"
msgstr ""

Step 3 Import the translation table.


import webvpn translation-table
Example:
This example imports the XML file. es-us is the abbreviation for Spanish spoken in the United States.

import webvpn translation-table customization language es-us


hostname#
tftp://209.165.200.225/portal
hostname# !!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!
hostname# show import webvpn translation-table
Translation Tables' Templates:
AnyConnect
PortForwarder

customization
keepout
url-list
webvpn
Citrix-plugin
RPC-plugin
Telnet-SSH-plugin
VNC-plugin

Translation Tables:
es-us customization

If you import a translation table for the AnyConnect domain, your changes are effective immediately. If you
import a translation table for any other domain, you must create a customization object, identify the translation
table to use in that object, and specify that customization object for the group policy or user.

Reference the Language in a Customization Object


This section describes how to export the customization template, edit it, and import it as a customization object
so that you can refer to it.

Before you begin


For the customization object to call these translation tables correctly, the tables must have been previously
imported using the same names. These names must be compatible with language options of the browser.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
389
Clientless SSL VPN
Reference the Language in a Customization Object

Procedure

Step 1 Export a customization template to a URL where you can edit it.
export webvpn customization template
This example exports the template and creates the copy sales at the URL specified.
hostname# export webvpn customization template tftp://209.165.200.225/sales

Step 2 Two areas of XML code in the customization template pertain to translation tables. Edit the customization
template and reference the previously-imported translation table.
This example specifies the translation table to use.
• The <languages> tag in the XML code is followed by the names of the translation tables. In this example,
they are en, ja, zh, ru, and ua.
• The <default-language> tag specifies the language that the remote user first encounters when connecting
to the ASA. In the example code above, the language is English.

<localization>
<languages>en,ja,zh,ru,ua</languages>
<default-language>en</default-language>
</localization>

This example affects the display of the Language Selector and includes the <language selector> tag and the
associated <language> tags that enable and customize the Language Selector:
• The <language-selector> group of tags includes the <mode> tag that enables and disables the displaying
of the Language Selector and the <title> tag that specifies the title of the drop-down box listing the
languages.
• The <language> group of tags includes the <code> and <text> tags that map the language name displayed
in the Language Selector drop-down box to a specific translation table.

<auth-page>
....
<language-selector>
<mode>enable</mode>
<title l10n="yes">Language:</title>
<language>
<code>en</code>
<text>English</text>
</language>
<language>
<code>es-us</code>
<text>Spanish</text>
</language>
</language-selector>

Step 3 Save the file after making your changes.


Step 4 Import the customization template as a new object.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
390
Clientless SSL VPN
Change a Group Policy or User Attributes to Use the Customization Object

import webvpn customization


Example:
Step 5 Show the new customization object sales.
show import webvpn customization
Example:
hostname# import webvpn customization sales tftp://209.165.200.225/sales
hostname# !!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!!

Change a Group Policy or User Attributes to Use the Customization Object


This section describes how to activate your changes for specific groups or users.

Procedure

Step 1 Switch to Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


webvpn

Step 2 Switch to group-policy Clientless SSL VPN configuration mode.


group-policy webvpn

Step 3 Enable the customization object.


customization

Example
This example shows the customization object sales enabled in the group policy sales.
hostname(config)# group-policy sales attributes
hostname(config-group-policy)# webvpn
hostname(config-group-webvpn)# customization value sales

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
391
Clientless SSL VPN
Change a Group Policy or User Attributes to Use the Customization Object

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
392
CHAPTER 20
Clientless SSL VPN Troubleshooting
• Recover from Hosts File Errors When Using Application Access, on page 393
• WebVPN Conditional Debugging, on page 396
• Capture Data, on page 396
• Protect Clientless SSL VPN Session Cookies, on page 398

Recover from Hosts File Errors When Using Application Access


To prevent hosts file errors that can interfere with Application Access, close the Application Access window
properly when you finish using Application Access. To do so, click the close icon.
When Application Access terminates abnormally, the hosts file remains in a Clientless SSL VPN-customized
state. Clientless SSL VPN checks the state the next time you start Application Access by searching for a
hosts.webvpn file. If it finds one, a Backup HOSTS File Found error message appears, and Application Access
is temporarily switched off.
If Application Access is stopped improperly, you leave the remote access client/server applications in limbo.
If you try to start these applications without using Clientless SSL VPN, they may malfunction. You may find
that hosts that you normally connect to are unavailable. This situation could commonly occur if you run
applications remotely from home, fail to quit the Application Access window before shutting down the
computer, then try to run the applications later from the office.
The following errors can occur if you do not close the Application Access window properly:
• The next time you try to start Application Access, it may be switched off; you receive a Backup HOSTS
File Found error message.

• The applications themselves may be switched off or malfunction, even when you are running them
locally.

These errors can result from terminating the Application Access window in any improper way. For example:
• Your browser crashes while you are using Application Access.
• A power outage or system shutdown occurs while you are using Application Access.
• You minimize the Application Access window while you are working, then shut down your computer
with the window active (but minimized).

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
393
Clientless SSL VPN
Understanding the Hosts File

Understanding the Hosts File


The hosts file on your local system maps IP addresses to hostnames. When you start Application Access,
Clientless SSL VPN modifies the hosts file, adding Clientless SSL VPN-specific entries. Stopping Application
Access by properly closing the Application Access window returns the file to its original state.

Before invoking Application Access... hosts file is in original state.

When Application Access starts.... • Clientless SSL VPN copies the hosts file to
hosts.webvpn, thus creating a backup.
• Clientless SSL VPN then edits the hosts file,
inserting Clientless SSL VPN-specific
information.

When Application Access stops... • Clientless SSL VPN copies the backup file to
the hosts file, thus restoring the hosts file to its
original state.
• Clientless SSL VPN deletes hosts.webvpn.

After finishing Application Access... hosts file is in original state.

Note Microsoft anti-spyware software blocks changes that the port forwarding Java applet makes to the hosts file.
See www.microsoft.com for information on how to allow hosts file changes when using anti-spyware software.

Reconfigure a Host’s File Automatically Using Clientless SSL VPN


If you are able to connect to your remote access server, follow these steps to reconfigure the host’s file and
re-enable both Application Access and the applications.

Procedure

Step 1 Start Clientless SSL VPN and log in.


Click the Applications Access link.

Step 2 Choose one of the following options:


• Restore from backup—Clientless SSL VPN forces a proper shutdown. It copies the hosts.webvpn
backup file to the hosts file, restoring it to its original state, then deletes hosts.webvpn. You then have
to restart Application Access.
• Do nothing—Application Access does not start. The remote access home page reappears.
• Delete backup—Clientless SSL VPN deletes the hosts.webvpn file, leaving the hosts file in its Clientless
SSL VPN-customized state. The original hosts file settings are lost. Application Access then starts,
using the Clientless SSL VPN-customized hosts file as the new original. Choose this option only if you
are unconcerned about losing hosts file settings. If you or a program you use may have edited the hosts

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
394
Clientless SSL VPN
Reconfigure Hosts File Manually

file after Application Access has shut down improperly, choose one of the other options, or edit the hosts
file manually.

Reconfigure Hosts File Manually


If you are not able to connect to your remote access server from your current location, or if you have customized
the hosts file and do not want to lose your edits, follow these steps to reconfigure the hosts file and reenable
both Application Access and the applications.

Procedure

Step 1 Locate and edit your hosts file. The most common location is c:\windows\sysem32\drivers\etc\hosts.
Step 2 Check to see if any lines contain the string: # added by WebVpnPortForward If any lines contain this string,
your hosts file is Clientless SSL VPN-customized. If your hosts file is Clientless SSL VPN-customized, it
looks similar to the following example:

server1 # added by WebVpnPortForward


server1.example.com invalid.cisco.com # added by WebVpnPortForward
server2 # added by WebVpnPortForward
server2.example.com invalid.cisco.com # added by WebVpnPortForward
server3 # added by WebVpnPortForward
server3.example.com invalid.cisco.com # added by WebVpnPortForward

# Copyright (c) 1993-1999 Microsoft Corp.


#
# This is a sample HOSTS file used by Microsoft TCP/IP for Windows.
#
# This file contains the mappings of IP addresses to hostnames. Each
# entry should be kept on an individual line. The IP address should
# be placed in the first column followed by the corresponding hostname.
# The IP address and the hostname should be separated by at least one
# space.
#
# Additionally, comments (such as these) may be inserted on individual
# lines or following the machine name denoted by a '#' symbol.
#
# For example:
#
# 102.54.94.97 cisco.example.com # source server
# 38.25.63.10 x.example.com # x client host

123.0.0.1 localhost

Step 3 Delete the lines that contain the string: # added by WebVpnPortForward
Step 4 Save and close the file.
Step 5 Start Clientless SSL VPN and log in.
Step 6 Click the Application Access link.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
395
Clientless SSL VPN
WebVPN Conditional Debugging

WebVPN Conditional Debugging


With multiple sessions running on a remote access VPN, troubleshooting can be difficult given the size of
the logs. You can use the debug webvpn condition command to set up filters to target your debug process
more precisely.
debug webvpn condition {group name | p-ipaddress ip_address [{subnet subnet_mask | prefix length}] |
reset | user name}
Where:
• group name filters on a group policy (not a tunnel group or connection profile).
• p-ipaddress ip_address [{subnet subnet_mask | prefix length}] filters on the public IP address of the
client. The subnet mask (for IPv4) or prefix (for IPv6) is optional.
• reset resets all filters. You can use the no debug webvpn condition command to turn off a specific filter.
• user name filters by username.

If you configure more than one condition, the conditions are conjoined (ANDed), so that debugs are shown
only if all conditions are met.
After setting up the condition filter, use the base debug webvpn command to turn on the debug. Simply setting
the conditions does not enable the debug. Use the show debug and show webvpn debug-condition commands
to view the current state of debugging.
The following shows an example of enabling a conditional debug on the user jdoe.

asa3(config)# debug webvpn condition user jdoe

asa3(config)# show webvpn debug-condition


INFO: Webvpn conditional debug is turned ON
INFO: User name filters:
INFO: jdoe

asa3(config)# debug webvpn


INFO: debug webvpn enabled at level 1.

asa3(config)# show debug


debug webvpn enabled at level 1
INFO: Webvpn conditional debug is turned ON
INFO: User name filters:
INFO: jdoe

Capture Data
The CLI capture command lets you log information about websites that do not display properly over a
Clientless SSL VPN session. This data can help your Cisco customer support engineer troubleshoot problems.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
396
Clientless SSL VPN
Create a Capture File

Prerequisites
Enabling Clientless SSL VPN capture affects the performance of the security appliance. Ensure you switch
off the capture after you generate the capture files needed for troubleshooting.

Create a Capture File


Procedure

Step 1 Start the capture utility for Clientless SSL VPN and create a capture named hr, which captures traffic for user2
to a file.
capture capture_name type webvpn user webvpn_username
capture_name is a name you assign to the capture, which is also prepended to the name of the capture files.
webvpn_user is the username to match for capture.
Example:

hostname# capture hr type webvpn user user2


WebVPN capture started.
capture name hr
user name user2
hostname# no capture hr

Step 2 (Optional) Stop the capture utility from capturing packets after a user has logged in and began a Clientless
SSL VPN session. The capture utility creates a capture_name.zip file, which is encrypted with the password
koleso.
no capture capture_name

Step 3 Send the .zip file to Cisco Systems or attach it to a Cisco TAC service request.
Step 4 Unzip the contents of the file using the koleso password.

Use a Browser to Display Capture Data


Procedure

Step 1 Start the capture utility for Clientless SSL VPN.


capture capture_name type webvpn user webvpn_username
• capture_name is a name you assign to the capture, which is also prepended to the name of the capture
files.
• webvpn_user is the username to match for capture.

Step 2 (Optional) Stop the capture utility from capturing packets after a user has logged in and began a Clientless
SSL VPN session.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
397
Clientless SSL VPN
Protect Clientless SSL VPN Session Cookies

no capture capture_name

Step 3 Open a browser and display the capture named hr in a sniffer format:
https://asdm_enabled_interface_of_the_security_appliance:port/admin/capture/capture_name/pcap
Example:

https://192.0.2.1:60000/admin/capture/hr/pcap

Protect Clientless SSL VPN Session Cookies


Embedded objects such as Flash applications and Java applets, as well as external applications, usually rely
on an existing session cookie to work with the server. They get it from a browser using some Javascript on
initialization. Adding the httponly flag to the Clientless SSL VPN session cookie makes the session cookie
only visible to the browser, not the client-side scripts, and it makes session sharing impossible.

Before you begin


• Change the VPN session cookie setting only when there are no active Clientless SSL VPN sessions.
• Use the show vpn-sessiondb webvpn command to check the status of Clientless SSL VPN sessions.
• Use the vpn-sessiondb logoff webvpn command to log out of all Clientless SSL VPN sessions.
• The following Clientless SSL VPN features will not work when the http-only-cookie command is
enabled:
• Java plug-ins
• Java rewriter
• Port forwarding
• File browser
• Sharepoint features that require desktop applications (for example, MS Office applications)
• AnyConnect Web launch
• Citrix Receiver, XenDesktop, and Xenon
• Other non-browser-based and browser plugin-based applications

To prevent a Clientless SSL VPN session cookie from being accessed by a third party through a client-side
script such as Javascript, perform the following steps:

Procedure

Enable the httponly flag for a Clientless SSL VPN session cookie. This is enabled by default.
http-only-cookie

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
398
Clientless SSL VPN
Protect Clientless SSL VPN Session Cookies

Example:

hostname(config)# webvpn
hostname(config-webvpn)# http-only-cookie
Note Use this command only if Cisco TAC advises you to do so. Enabling this command presents a
security risk because the Clientless SSL VPN features listed under the Guidelines section will not
work without any warning.

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
399
Clientless SSL VPN
Protect Clientless SSL VPN Session Cookies

CLI Book 3: Cisco ASA Series VPN CLI Configuration Guide, 9.6
400

You might also like